2020
FRONTIER
OWNER’S MANUAL
and MAINTENANCE INFORMATION
For your safety, read carefully and keep in this vehicle.
CALIFORNIA PROPOSITION 65 WARNING
WARNING
Operating, servicing and maintaining a passenger
vehicle or off-highway motor vehicle can expose you to
chemicals including engine exhaust, carbon monoxide,
phthalates, and lead, which are known to the State of
California to cause cancer and birth defects or other
reproductive harm. To minimize exposure, avoid
breathing exhaust, do not idle the engine except as
necessary, service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area
and wear gloves or wash your hands frequently when
servicing your vehicle. For more information go to
www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.
FOREWORD
This manual was prepared to help you understand the operation and maintenance
of your vehicle so that you may enjoy many
miles (kilometers) of driving pleasure.
Please read through this manual before
operating your vehicle.
A separate Warranty Information Booklet explains details about the warranties
covering your vehicle. The “Maintenance
and schedules” section of this manual
explains details about maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Additionally, a
separate Customer Care/Lemon Law
Booklet (U.S. only) will explain how to resolve any concerns you may have with
your vehicle, and clarify your rights under your state's lemon law.
When you require any service or have any
questions, a NISSAN dealer will be glad to
assist you with the extensive resources
available to them.
In addition to factory-installed options,
your vehicle may also be equipped with
additional accessories installed prior to delivery. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for details concerning the
particular accessories with which your vehicle is equipped. It is important that you
familiarize yourself with all disclosures,
warnings, cautions and instructions con-
READ FIRST—THEN DRIVE SAFELY
cerning proper use of such accessories
prior to operating the vehicle and/or accessory. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for details concerning the
particular accessories with which your vehicle is equipped.
Before driving your vehicle, please read this
Owner's Manual carefully. This will ensure
familiarity with controls and maintenance
requirements assisting you in the safe operation of your vehicle.
WARNING
IMPORTANT SAFETY INFORMATION REMINDERS!
Follow these important driving rules to
help ensure a safe and comfortable trip
for you and your passengers!
• NEVER drive under the influence of
alcohol or drugs.
• ALWAYS observe posted speed limits
and never drive too fast for conditions.
• ALWAYS give your full attention to
driving and avoid using vehicle features or taking other actions that
could distract you.
• ALWAYS use your seat belts and appropriate child restraint systems.
Pre-teen children should be seated in
the rear seat.
• ALWAYS provide information about
the proper use of vehicle safety features to all occupants of the vehicle.
• ALWAYS review this Owner’s Manual
for important safety information.
WHEN READING THE MANUAL
For descriptions specified for 4-wheel drive
mark is placed at the bemodels, a
ginning of the applicable sections/items.
As with other vehicles with features for
off-road use, failure to operate 4-wheel
drive models correctly may result in loss
of control or a collision. For additional
information, refer to “Driving safety precautions” in the “Starting and driving”
section of this manual.
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD DRIVING
This vehicle will handle and maneuver
differently from an ordinary passenger
car because it has a higher center of
gravity for off-road use. As with other
vehicles with features of this type, failure to operate this vehicle correctly may
result in loss of control or an accident.
For additional information, refer to “Onpavement and off-road driving precautions”, “Avoiding collision and roll- over”
and “Driving safety precautions” in the
“Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
MODIFICATION OF YOUR VEHICLE
This vehicle should not be modified.
Modification could affect its performance, safety, emissions or durability
and may even violate governmental
regulations. In addition, damage or performance problems resulting from
modifications may not be covered under NISSAN warranties.
WARNING
Installing an aftermarket On-Board Diagnostic (OBD) plug-in device that uses
the port during normal driving, for example remote insurance company
monitoring, remote vehicle diagnostics, telematics or engine reprogramming, may cause interference or damage to vehicle systems. We do not
recommend or endorse the use of any
aftermarket OBD plug-in devices, unless specifically approved by NISSAN.
The vehicle warranty may not cover
damage caused by any aftermarket
plug-in device.
This manual includes information for all
features and equipment available on this
model. Features and equipment in your vehicle may vary depending on model, trim
level, options selected, order, date of production, region or availability. Therefore,
you may find information about features or
equipment that are not included or installed on your vehicle.
All information, specifications and illustrations in this manual are those in effect at
the time of printing. NISSAN reserves the
right to change specifications, performance, design or component suppliers
without notice and without obligation.
From time to time, NISSAN may update or
revise this manual to provide Owners with
the most accurate information currently
available. Please carefully read and retain
with this manual all revision updates sent
to you by NISSAN to ensure you have access to accurate and up-to-date information regarding your vehicle. Current versions of vehicle Owner's Manuals and any
updates can also be found in the Owner
section of the NISSAN website at https://
owners.nissanusa.com/nowners/
navigation/manualsGuide. If you have
questions concerning any information in
CALIFORNIA PERCHLORATE
ADVISORY
your Owner's Manual, contact NISSAN Consumer Affairs. For contact information, refer to the NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM page in this Owner’s Manual.
Some vehicle parts, such as lithium batteries, may contain perchlorate material.
The following advisory is provided: “Perchlorate Material – special handling may
apply. For additional information, refer
to www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/
perchlorate/”.
IMPORTANT INFORMATION ABOUT
THIS MANUAL
You will see various symbols in this manual.
They are used in the following ways:
WARNING
This is used to indicate the presence of
a hazard that could cause death or serious personal injury. To avoid or reduce the risk, the procedures must be
followed precisely.
CAUTION
This is used to indicate the presence of
a hazard that could cause minor or
moderate personal injury or damage to
your vehicle. To avoid or reduce the risk,
the procedures must be followed
carefully.
APD1005
If you see this symbol, it means “Do not do
this” or “Do not let this happen.”
If you see a symbol similar to these in an
illustration, it means the arrow points to the
front of the vehicle.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to
these indicate movement or action.
Arrows in an illustration that are similar to
these call attention to an item in the illustration.
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and
licensed to Panasonic
and Bosch.
SiriusXM® services
require a subscription
after trial period and
are sold separately or
as a package. The
satellite service is
available only in the
48 contiguous USA
and DC. SiriusXM®
satellite service is also
available in Canada;
see www.siriusxm.ca.
© 2020 NISSAN NORTH AMERICA, INC.
All rights reserved. No part of this Owner's
Manual may be reproduced or stored in a
retrieval system, or transmitted in any
form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording or otherwise, without the prior written permission of Nissan North America, Inc.
NISSAN CUSTOMER CARE PROGRAM
NISSAN CARES . . .
Both NISSAN and your NISSAN dealer are dedicated to serving all your automotive needs. Your satisfaction with your vehicle and your
NISSAN dealer are our primary concerns. Your NISSAN dealer is always available to assist you with all your automobile sales and service
needs.
However, if there is something that your
The Consumer Affairs Department will ask
You can write to NISSAN with the informaNISSAN dealer cannot assist you with or
for the following information:
tion at:
you would like to provide NISSAN directly
– Your name, address, and telephone
For U.S. customers
with comments or questions, please connumber
Nissan North America, Inc.
tact the NISSAN Consumer Affairs Depart– Vehicle identification number (attached
Consumer Affairs Department
ment using our toll-free number:
to the top of the instrument panel on the
P.O. Box 685003
For U.S. customers
driver's side)
Franklin, TN 37068-5003
1-800-NISSAN-1
or via e-mail at:
– Date of purchase
(1-800-647-7261)
[email protected]
– Current odometer reading
For Canadian customers
1-800-387-0122
– Your NISSAN dealer's name
– Your comments or questions
OR
For Canadian customers
Nissan Canada Inc.
5290 Orbitor Drive
Mississauga, Ontario L4W 4Z5
or via e-mail at:
[email protected]
If you prefer, visit us at:
www.nissanusa.com (for U.S. customers)
or
www.nissan.ca (for Canadian customers)
We appreciate your interest in NISSAN and thank you for buying a quality NISSAN vehicle.
Table of
contents
Illustrated table of contents
0
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
1
Instruments and controls
2
Pre-driving checks and adjustments
3
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
4
Starting and driving
5
In case of emergency
6
Appearance and care
7
Do-it-yourself
8
Maintenance and schedules
9
Technical and consumer information
10
Index
11
0 Illustrated table of contents
Air bags, seat belts and child restraints . . . . . . . . . . 0-2
Exterior front . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-3
Exterior rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-4
Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-5
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-6
Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . 0-8
Warning and indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 0-9
AIR BAGS, SEAT BELTS AND CHILD
RESTRAINTS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Rear seat belts (P. 1-15)
Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag (P. 1-70)
Head restraints/headrests (P. 1-10)
Front seat belts with pretensioner(s)
and shoulder height adjuster
(P. 1-15, 1-70)
Supplemental front-impact air bags
(P. 1-70)
Seats (P. 1-2)
Occupant classification sensor
(pressure sensor) (P. 1-70)
Front seat-mounted side-impact
supplemental air bag (P. 1-70)
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) system (P. 1-28)
Top tether strap anchor (P. 1-28)
Refer to the page number indicated in
parentheses for operating details.
LII2310
0-2 Illustrated table of contents
EXTERIOR FRONT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Engine hood (P. 3-13)
Wiper and washer switch (P. 2-28)
Windshield (P. 8-18)
Windows (P. 2-49)
Door locks (P. 3-4)
NISSAN Intelligent Key® (P. 3-2)
Key fob (P. 3-2)
Keys (P. 3-2)
Mirrors (P. 3-17)
Tire pressure (P. 8-30)
Flat tire (P. 6-3)
Tire chains (P. 8-30)
Headlight and turn signal switch
(P. 2-30)
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) system
(if so equipped) (P. 2-30)
Replacing bulbs (P. 8-26)
Fog light switch (if so equipped) (P. 2-30)
Refer to the page number indicated in
parentheses for operating details.
LII2481
Illustrated table of contents 0-3
EXTERIOR REAR
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Rear sliding window (if so equipped)
(P. 2-49)
Vehicle loading (P. 10-14)
Tailgate (P. 3-20)
Truck box (P. 3-20)
Rearview camera (P. 4-21)
Towing (if so equipped) (P. 10-25)
Rear sonar sensors (if so equipped)
(P. 5-39)
Replacing bulbs (P. 8-26)
Fuel-filler cap (P. 3-13)
Fuel recommendation (P. 10-2)
Refer to the page number indicated in
parentheses for operating details.
LIC3975
0-4 Illustrated table of contents
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Power moonroof (if so equipped)
(P. 2-52)
Map lights (P. 2-54)
Sun visors (P. 3-16)
Rearview mirror (P. 3-17)
Glove box (P. 2-40)
Shift lever (P. 5-14)
Cup holders (P. 2-40)
Console box (P. 2-40)
Spare tire tools location (P. 6-3)
Refer to the page number indicated in
parentheses for operating details.
LII2646
Illustrated table of contents 0-5
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
LIC4475
0-6 Illustrated table of contents
Vents (P. 4-22)
Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/
turn signal switch (P. 2-30)
Steering wheel switch for audio control
(P. 4-71)
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
(P. 4-79, 4-96)
Driver supplemental air bag (P. 1-70)
Horn (P. 2-34)
Meters and gauges (P. 2-4)
Warning and indicator lights (P. 2-24)
Cruise control switches (P. 5-19)
Wiper and washer switch (P. 2-28)
Storage (P. 2-40)
Audio system (P. 4-36)
Front passenger supplemental air bag
(P. 1-70)
Upper and lower glove box (P. 2-40)
Passenger air bag status light (P. 1-70)
USB connection port (P. 4-55)
AUX input (P. 4-55)
Power outlets (P. 2-39)
Electronic locking rear differential
(E-Lock) system switch (if so equipped)
(P. 2-37)
Heated seat switches (if so equipped)
(P. 2-35)
Rear sonar switch (if so equipped)
(P. 2-38)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch (P. 2-36)
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
Shift lever (P. 5-14)
Push-button ignition switch (P. 5-10)
4WD shift switch (if so equipped)
(P. 5-23)
Climate controls (P. 4-22, P. 4-31)
Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-2)
Tilt steering wheel control (P. 3-16)
Cargo lamp switch (P. 2-34)
Hill descent control switch
(if so equipped) (P. 2-36)
Outside mirror controls (if so equipped)
(P. 3-17)
Illustrated table of contents 0-7
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK
LOCATIONS
VQ38DD engine
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir
(P. 8-12)
Fuse/Fusible link box (P. 8-20)
Fuse/Fusible link box (P. 8-20)
Fuse box (P. 8-20)
Engine oil filler cap (P. 8-6)
Engine oil dipstick (P. 8-6)
Brake fluid reservoir (P. 8-11)
Air cleaner (P. 8-17)
Drive belt location (P. 8-15)
Power steering fluid reservoir (P. 8-10)
Radiator cap (P. 8-4)
Battery (P. 8-13)
Engine coolant reservoir (P. 8-4)
*Engine cover removed for clarity.
Refer to the page number indicated in
parentheses for operating details.
LDI3520
0-8 Illustrated table of contents
WARNING AND INDICATOR LIGHTS
Warning
light
or
Name
Page
4WD warning light
model)
(
Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS)
warning light
Apply parking brake
warning light
Warning
light
Name
Page
2-15
Automatic transmission park warning
light (
model)
2-15
Brake warning light
Name
Page
2-16
Engine oil pressure
warning light
2-17
2-16
Low fuel warning
light
2-18
Low tire pressure
warning light
2-18
Low windshieldwasher fluid warning
light (if so equipped)
2-19
NISSAN Intelligent
Key® warning light
(if so equipped)
2-20
Seat belt warning
light and chime
2-20
or
2-16
Charge warning light
2-17
or
Automatic transmission check warning
light
Warning
light
Door open warning
light
2-17
Electric shift control
system warning light
2-17
2-16
Illustrated table of contents 0-9
Warning
light
Indicator
light
Name
Page
Shift P (Park)
warning light
(if so equipped)
2-20
Supplemental air
bag warning light
2-20
Name
Page
4WD shift indicator light
(
model)
2-21
Automatic transmission position
indicator light
2-21
CRUISE indicator
light
2-21
0-10 Illustrated table of contents
Indicator
light
Name
Page
Electronic locking
rear differential
(E-Lock) system
ON indicator light
(if so equipped)
2-21
Engine start
operation
indicator light
(if so equipped)
2-21
Front passenger
air bag status light
2-22
High beam indicator light (blue)
2-22
Hill descent
control system
ON indicator light
(if so equipped)
2-22
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
2-22
Indicator
light
Name
Page
Security indicator
light (if so
equipped)
2-23
SET indicator light
2-23
Slip indicator light
2-23
Transfer 4LO position indicator light
(
model)
2-23
Turn signal/
hazard indicator
lights
2-24
Vehicle Dynamic
Control (VDC) OFF
indicator light
2-24
MEMO
Illustrated table of contents 0-11
1 Safety-Seats, seat belts and
supplemental restraint system
Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2
Front manual seat adjustment
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-3
Front power seat adjustment
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5
Rear bench seat (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6
Jump seat (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Armrest (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Flexible seating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Head restraints/headrests . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-10
Adjustable head restraint/headrest
components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11
Non-adjustable head restraint/headrest
components . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12
Remove . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-12
Install . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13
Adjust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-13
Front-seat active head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-14
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15
Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15
Seat belt warning light and chime . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Injured persons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Three-point type seat belt with
retractor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-19
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24
Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25
Infants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Small children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-26
Child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
Precautions on child restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-28
LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-30
Rear-facing child restraint installation
using LATCH (Crew Cab models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-34
Rear-facing child restraint installation
using LATCH — jump seat
(King Cab® models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-36
Rear-facing child restraint installation
using the seat belts (Crew Cab models) . . . . . 1-39
Rear-facing child restraint installation
using the seat belts — jump seat
(King Cab® models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-42
Forward-facing child restraint
installation using LATCH
(Crew Cab models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-47
Forward-facing child restraint
installation using LATCH — jump seat
(King Cab® models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-50
Forward-facing child restraint
installation using the seat belts —
front passenger and rear bench seat
(Crew Cab models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-54
Forward-facing child restraint
installation using the seat belts —
front passenger and jump seats
(King Cab® models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-59
Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-65
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) . . . . . . . . . . 1-70
Precautions on SRS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-70
Supplemental air bag warning labels . . . . . . . . 1-85
Supplemental air bag warning light . . . . . . . . . 1-85
SEATS
ARS1152
WARNING
• Do not ride in a moving vehicle when
the seatback is reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not
be against your body. In an accident,
you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries.
You could also slide under the lap belt
and receive serious internal injuries.
• For the most effective protection
when the vehicle is in motion, the
seat should be upright. Always sit
well back and upright in the seat with
both feet on the floor and adjust the
seat properly. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat
belt usage” in this section.
• After adjustment, gently rock in the
seat to make sure it is securely
locked.
1-2 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
• Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls or
make the vehicle move. Unattended
children could become involved in
serious accidents.
• To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not
leave children, people who require
the assistance of others or pets unattended in your vehicle. Additionally,
the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm day can quickly become high enough to cause a significant risk of injury or death to people
and pets.
• Do not adjust the driver’s seat while
driving so full attention may be given
to vehicle operation. The seat may
move suddenly and could cause loss
of control of the vehicle.
• The seatback should not be reclined
any more than needed for comfort.
Seat belts are most effective when
the passenger sits well back and
straight up in the seat. If the seatback
is reclined, the risk of sliding under
the lap belt and being injured is
increased.
CAUTION
When adjusting the seat positions, be
sure not to contact any moving parts to
avoid possible injuries and/or damage.
FRONT MANUAL SEAT
ADJUSTMENT (if so equipped)
Your vehicle seats can be adjusted manually. For additional information about adjusting the seats, refer to the steps outlined
in this section.
WRS0175
WRS0176
Forward and backward
Reclining
Pull the lever up and hold it while you slide
the seat forward or backward to the desired position. Release the lever to lock the
seat in position.
To recline the seatback, pull the lever up
and lean back. To bring the seatback forward, pull the lever up and lean your body
forward. Release the lever to lock the seatback in position.
The reclining feature allows adjustment of
the seatback for occupants of different
sizes for added comfort and to help obtain
proper seat belt fit. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section. Also, the seatback can
be reclined to allow occupants to rest
when the vehicle is stopped and the shift
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-3
lever is in P (Park) or N (Neutral) position
with the parking brake fully applied.
WRS0131
WRS0389
Seat lifter (if so equipped for
driver's seat)
Lumbar support (if so equipped
for driver's seat)
Turn either dial to adjust the angle and
height of the seat cushion to the desired
position.
The lumbar support feature provides adjustable lower back support to the driver.
Move the lever forward or backward to adjust the seat lumbar area.
1-4 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Reclining
Move the recline switch as shown until the
desired angle is obtained.
The reclining feature allows adjustment of
the seatback for occupants of different
sizes for added comfort and to help obtain
proper seat belt fit. For additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section. Also, the seatback can
be reclined to allow occupants to rest
when the vehicle is stopped and the shift
lever is in P (Park) or N (Neutral) position
with the parking brake fully applied.
LRS2897
FRONT POWER SEAT ADJUSTMENT
(if so equipped)
Operating tips
Forward and backward
Moving the switch as shown will slide the
seat forward or backward to the desired
position.
• The power seat motor has an auto-reset
overload protection circuit. If the motor
stops during operation, wait 30 seconds
then reactivate the switch.
• Do not operate the power seat switch for
a long period of time when the engine is
off. This will discharge the battery.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-5
LRS2898
WRS0389
LRS2903
Seat lifter (driver's seat)
Lumbar support (driver's seat)
REAR BENCH SEAT (if so equipped)
Move the switch as shown to adjust the
angle and height of the seat cushion.
The lumbar support feature provides adjustable lower back support to the driver.
Move the lever forward or backward to adjust the seat lumbar area.
The rear bench seat is non-adjustable.
However, the seats can be folded up and
folded to lay flat. For additional information,
refer to “Flexible seating” in this section.
1-6 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
FLEXIBLE SEATING
WARNING
LRS0556
JUMP SEAT (if so equipped)
WARNING
• Do not use a child restraint in the
driver's side jump seat. This seating
position is not suitable for child restraint installation. A child restraint
can be installed in the passenger's
side jump seat when the seat extension is unfolded from the seat base.
• When folding the jump seat, be careful not to squeeze your finger between the seat cushion and the body
side.
LRS2901
ARMREST (if so equipped)
To use the center armrest on the rear
bench seat, pull on the tab in the center of
the seat and fold it down as shown.
• Never allow anyone to ride in the
cargo area or on the rear seats when
they are in the fold-down position. In
a collision, people riding in these areas without proper restraints are
more likely to be seriously injured or
killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any
area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat belts.
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in
a seat and using a seat belt properly.
• Do not allow more than one person
to use the same seat belt.
• Do not fold down the rear seats when
occupants are in the rear seat area or
any luggage is on the rear seats.
– Make sure that the seat path is
clear before moving the seat.
– Be careful not to allow hands or
feet to get caught or pinched in
the seat.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-7
• Head restraints/headrests should be
adjusted properly as they may provide significant protection against
injury in an accident. Always replace
and adjust them properly if they have
been removed for any reason.
• If the head restraints/headrests are
removed for any reason, they should
be securely stored to prevent them
from causing injury to passengers or
damage to the vehicle in case of sudden braking or an accident.
• When returning the seatbacks to the
upright position, be certain they are
completely secured in the latched
position. If they are not completely
secured, passengers may be injured
in an accident or sudden stop.
• Properly secure all cargo to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not
place cargo higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal injury.
LRS2475
Folding the rear bench seat up (if
so equipped)
To fold the rear bench seat up:
1. Lift up on the lever, located on the side of
the seat, while lifting the front of the seat
cushion up.
1-8 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2476
2. Fold the bottom of the seat cushion toward the back of the vehicle until it locks
in place.
WARNING
LRS2477
3. Repeat this process to raise and secure
the seat cushion on the other side of the
vehicle for maximum storage capacity.
To return the rear bench seat to a seating
position, reverse the process. Make sure to
properly push the seat cushion down
into place.
• When the vehicle is being used to
carry cargo, properly secure all cargo
to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. Do not place cargo higher
than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop
or collision, unsecured cargo could
cause personal injury.
• Do not allow people to ride in any
area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat belts.
Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in
a seat and using a seat belt properly.
Never ride in the rear seat unless the
seat bottom cushions are in place
and latched.
• When returning the seatbacks to the
upright position, be certain they are
completely secured in the latched
position. If they are not completely
secured, passengers may be injured
in an accident or sudden stop.
LRS2478
A.
Child restraint anchor points
Folding the rear bench seat down
(if so equipped)
The rear bench seatback can be tilted forward to access the child restraint anchor
point locations or the jacking equipment.
To tilt the seatback forward, pull the strap
1 and tilt the seatback. The child reup O
straint anchor points can be accessed behind the rear bench seatback. The jacking
equipment can be accessed from behind
the passenger's side seatback.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-9
HEAD RESTRAINTS/HEADRESTS
WARNING
Never allow anyone to ride in the cargo
area or on the rear seat when it is in the
fold-down position. Use of these areas
by passengers without proper restraints could result in serious injury or
death in an accident or sudden stop.
WARNING
Head restraints/headrests supplement
the other vehicle safety systems. They
may provide additional protection
against injury in certain rear end collisions. Adjustable head restraints/
headrests must be adjusted properly,
as specified in this section. Check the
adjustment after someone else uses
the seat. Do not attach anything to the
head restraint/headrest stalks or remove the head restraint/headrest. Do
not use the seat if the head restraint/
headrest has been removed. If the head
restraint/headrest was removed, reinstall and properly adjust the head
restraint/headrest before an occupant
uses the seating position. Failure to follow these instructions can reduce the
effectiveness of the head restraints/
headrests. This may increase the risk of
serious injury or death in a collision.
1-10 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2020
Crew Cab
LRS3150
King Cab®
The illustration shows the seating positions equipped with head restraints/
headrests.
䉱 Indicates the seating position
equipped with a head restraint.
is
쮿 Indicates the seating
equipped with a headrest.
is
position
• Adjustable head restraints/headrests
have multiple notches along the stalk(s)
to lock them in a desired adjustment position.
• The non-adjustable head restraints/
headrests have a single locking notch to
secure them to the seat frame.
• Proper Adjustment:
– For the adjustable type, align the head
restraint/headrest so the center of
your ear is approximately level with the
center of the head restraint/headrest.
– If your ear position is still higher than
the recommended alignment, place
the head restraint/headrest at the
highest position.
• If the head restraint/headrest has been
removed, ensure that it is reinstalled and
locked in place before riding in that designated seating position.
LRS2300
ADJUSTABLE HEAD RESTRAINT/
HEADREST COMPONENTS
1. Removable head restraint/headrest
2. Multiple notches
3. Lock knob
4. Stalks
+ Indicates the seating position is not
equipped with a head restraint or headrest
(if applicable).
• Your vehicle is equipped with a head
restraint/headrest that may be integrated, adjustable or non-adjustable.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-11
5. Reinstall and properly adjust the head
restraint/headrest before an occupant
uses the seating position.
LRS2299
LRS2302
NON-ADJUSTABLE HEAD
RESTRAINT/HEADREST
COMPONENTS
REMOVE
1. Removable head restraint/headrest
1. Pull the head restraint/headrest up to
the highest position.
2. Single notch
3. Lock knob
4. Stalks
Use the following procedure to remove the
head restraint/headrest:
2. Push and hold the lock knob.
3. Remove the head restraint/headrest
from the seat.
4. Store the head restraint/headrest properly in a secure place so it is not loose in
the vehicle.
1-12 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2303
WRS0134
INSTALL
ADJUST
1. Align the head restraint/headrest stalks
with the holes in the seat. Make sure that
the head restraint/headrest is facing the
correct direction. The stalk with the
1 must be installed in
notch (notches) O
2 .
the hole with the lock knob O
For adjustable head restraint/headrest
Adjust the head restraint/headrest so the
center is level with the center of your ears. If
your ear position is still higher than the
recommended alignment, place the head
restraint/headrest at the highest position.
LRS2351
For non-adjustable
headrest
head
restraint/
Make sure the head restraint/headrest is
positioned so the lock knob is engaged in
the notch before riding in that designated
seating position.
2. Push and hold the lock knob and push
the head restraint/headrest down.
3. Properly adjust the head restraint/
headrest before an occupant uses the
seating position.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-13
LRS2305
LRS2306
Raise
Lower
To raise the head restraint/headrest, pull it
up.
To lower, push and hold the lock knob and
push the head restraint/headrest down.
Make sure the head restraint/headrest is
positioned so the lock knob is engaged in
the notch before riding in that designated
seating position.
Make sure the head restraint/headrest is
positioned so the lock knob is engaged in
the notch before riding in that designated
seating position.
1-14 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SPA1025
FRONT-SEAT ACTIVE HEAD
RESTRAINTS
WARNING
• Always adjust the head restraints
properly as specified in this section.
Failure to do so can reduce the effectiveness of the active head restraint.
• Active head restraints are designed to
supplement other safety systems. Always wear seat belts. No system can
prevent all injuries in any accident.
SEAT BELTS
• Do not attach anything to the head
restraint stalks. Doing so could impair active head restraint function.
The active head restraint moves forward
utilizing the force that the seatback receives from the occupant in a rear-end collision. The movement of the head restraint
helps support the occupant's head by reducing its backward movement and helping absorb some of the forces that may
lead to whiplash-type injuries.
Active head restraints are effective for collisions at low to medium speeds in which it
is said that whiplash injury occurs most.
Active head restraints operate only in certain rear-end collisions. After the collision,
the head restraints return to their original
positions.
Properly adjust the active head restraints
as described in this section.
SSS0136
PRECAUTIONS ON SEAT BELT
USAGE
If you are wearing your seat belt properly
adjusted and you are sitting upright and
well back in your seat with both feet on the
floor, your chances of being injured or killed
in a collision and/or the severity of injury
may be greatly reduced. NISSAN strongly
encourages you and all of your passengers
to buckle up every time you drive, even if
your seating position includes a supplemental air bag.
Most U.S. states and Canadian provinces
or territories specify that seat belts be
worn at all times when a vehicle is being
driven.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-15
SSS0134
WARNING
• Every person who drives or rides in
this vehicle should use a seat belt at
all times. Children should be in the
rear seats and in an appropriate
restraint.
1-16 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SSS0016
WARNING
• The seat belt should be properly adjusted to a snug fit. Failure to do so
may reduce the effectiveness of the
entire restraint system and increase
the chance or severity of injury in an
accident. Serious injury or death can
occur if the seat belt is not worn
properly.
SSS0014
WARNING
• Always route the shoulder belt over
your shoulder and across your chest.
Never put the belt behind your back,
under your arm or across your neck.
The belt should be away from your
face and neck, but not falling off your
shoulder.
• Position the lap belt as low and snug
as possible AROUND THE HIPS, NOT
THE WAIST. A lap belt worn too high
could increase the risk of internal injuries in an accident.
• Be sure the seat belt tongue is securely fastened to the proper buckle.
• Do not wear the seat belt inside out
or twisted. Doing so may reduce its
effectiveness.
• Do not allow more than one person
to use the same seat belt.
• Never carry more people in the vehicle than there are seat belts.
• If the seat belt warning light glows
continuously while the ignition is
turned ON with all doors closed and
all seat belts fastened, it may indicate a malfunction in the system.
Have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• No changes should be made to the
seat belt system. For example, do not
modify the seat belt, add material, or
install devices that may change the
seat belt routing or tension. Doing so
may affect the operation of the seat
belt system. Modifying or tampering
with the seat belt system may result
in serious personal injury.
• Once seat belt pretensioner(s) have
activated, they cannot be reused and
must be replaced together with the
retractor. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
• All seat belt assemblies, including retractors and attaching hardware,
should be inspected after any collision. It is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer for this service.
NISSAN recommends that all seat
belt assemblies in use during a collision be replaced unless the collision
was minor and the belts show no
damage and continue to operate
properly. Seat belt assemblies not in
use during a collision should also be
inspected and replaced if either
damage or improper operation is
noted.
• All child restraints and attaching
hardware should be inspected after
any collision. Always follow the restraint manufacturer's inspection instructions and replacement recommendations. The child restraints
should be replaced if they are
damaged.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-17
• The front passenger’s seat belt is not fastened and the seat is occupied by a passenger for 7 seconds after the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position.
• The front passenger’s seat belt is not fastened and objects or external force on
the passenger seat change the seat belt
reminder classification to Occupied.
The seat belt warning light will flash under
the conditions shown above until the necessary seat belt is securely fastened.
LRS0786
SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT AND
CHIME
The driver and front passenger seat is
equipped with an enhanced seat belt reminder function. If your vehicle is equipped
with an enhanced seat belt reminder function, a visual and audible alert (Driver’s seat
only) will operate if a driver or front passenger seat belt is unbuckled at speeds of approximately 9 mph (15 km/h) or more under the following conditions:
• If the driver seat belt is not fastened.
A warning chime will sound for approximately 90 seconds or until one of the following conditions is met:
• The unbuckled front occupant’s seat belt
is securely fastened.
• The ignition is turned off.
The below situations could result in the
seat belt reminder light being illuminated
and the chime sounding (Driver’s seat only),
even with no occupant present in the passenger seat:
• Heavy objects placed on the seat.
• Someone pushing or pulling on the front
passenger seat.
1-18 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
• An object placed under the front passenger seat.
• An object placed between the seat cushion and center console or between the
seat cushion and the door.
• An object hanging on the seat or placed
in the seatback pocket.
• A child restraint or other object pressing
against the rear of the seatback.
PREGNANT WOMEN
NISSAN recommends that pregnant
women use seat belts. The seat belt should
be worn snug and always position the lap
belt as low as possible around the hips, not
the waist. Place the shoulder belt over your
shoulder and across your chest. Never run
the lap/shoulder belt over your abdominal
area. Contact your doctor for specific recommendations.
INJURED PERSONS
NISSAN recommends that injured persons
use seat belts. Check with your doctor for
specific recommendations.
THREE-POINT TYPE SEAT BELT
WITH RETRACTOR
WARNING
• Every person who drives or rides in
this vehicle should use a seat belt at
all times. Children should be in the
rear seats and in an appropriate
restraint.
• Do not ride in a moving vehicle when
the seatback is reclined. This can be
dangerous. The shoulder belt will not
be against your body. In an accident,
you could be thrown into it and receive neck or other serious injuries.
You could also slide under the lap belt
and receive serious internal injuries.
• For the most effective protection
when the vehicle is in motion, the
seat should be upright. Always sit
well back and upright in the seat with
both feet on the floor and adjust the
seat belt properly.
• Do not allow children to play with the
seat belts. Most seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking
Retractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If
the seat belt becomes wrapped
around a child’s neck with the ALR
mode activated, the child can be seriously injured or killed if the seat belt
retracts and becomes tight. This can
occur even if the vehicle is parked.
Unbuckle the seat belt to release the
child. If the seat belt cannot be unbuckled or is already unbuckled, release the child by cutting the seat
belt with a suitable tool (such as a
knife or scissors) to release the seat
belt.
WRS0175
Manual front seat shown
(if so equipped)
Fastening the seat belts (front
seats all models and rear seats
Crew Cab models)
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-19
LRS2897
Power front seat shown (if so equipped)
1. Adjust the seat. For additional information, refer to “Seats” in this section.
1-20 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2674
2. Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle
A
until you hear and feel the latch
O
engage.
• The retractor is designed to lock
during a sudden stop or on impact. A
slow pulling motion permits the
seat belt to move, and allows you
some freedom of movement in the
seat.
• If the seat belt cannot be pulled
from its fully retracted position,
firmly pull the belt and release it.
Then smoothly pull the belt out of
the retractor.
The ELR mode allows the seat belt to extend and retract to allow the driver and
passengers some freedom of movement
in the seat. The ELR locks the seat belt
when the vehicle slows down rapidly or
during certain impacts.
The ALR mode (child restraint mode) locks
the seat belt for child restraint installation.
LRS2675
3. Position the lap belt portion low and
B as shown.
snug on the hips O
4. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the
C . Be
retractor to take up extra slack O
sure the shoulder belt is routed over
your shoulder and across your chest.
The front passenger seat and the rear
seating positions’ three-point seat belts
have two modes of operation:
• Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
• Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
WARNING
When fastening the seat belts, be certain that the seatbacks are completely
secured in the latched position. If they
are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or
sudden stop.
When the ALR mode is activated, the seat
belt cannot be extended again until the
seat belt tongue is detached from the
buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt
fully retracts. For additional information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
The ALR mode should be used only for
child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR
mode should not be activated. If it is activated it may cause uncomfortable seat
belt tension. It can also change the operation of the front passenger air bag.
For additional information, refer to
“Front passenger air bag and status
light” in this section.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-21
LRS0556
Fastening the seat belts ( jump
seats for King Cab® models)
1. Open the jump seat. For additional information, refer to “Seats” in this section.
LRS2723
LRS2724
2. Slowly pull the seat belt out of the retractor and insert the tongue into the buckle
A
until you hear and feel the latch
O
engage.
• The retractor is designed to lock
during a sudden stop or on impact. A
slow pulling motion permits the
seat belt to move, and allows you
some freedom of movement in the
seat.
• If the seat belt cannot be pulled
from its fully retracted position,
firmly pull the belt and release it.
Then smoothly pull the belt out of
the retractor.
3. Position the lap belt portion low and
B as shown.
snug on the hips O
4. Pull the shoulder belt portion toward the
C . Be
retractor to take up extra slack O
sure the shoulder belt is routed over
your shoulder and across your chest.
The jump seat position's three-point seat
belts have two modes of operation:
• Emergency Locking Retractor (ELR)
• Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR)
The ELR mode allows the seat belt to extend
and retract to allow the passengers some
freedom of movement in the seat. The ELR
locks the seat belt when the vehicle slows
down rapidly or during certain impacts.
1-22 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Checking seat belt operation
The ALR mode (child restraint mode) locks
the seat belt for child restraint installation.
Seat belt retractors are designed to lock
seat belt movement by two separate
methods:
• When the seat belt is pulled quickly from
the retractor
• When the vehicle slows down rapidly
When the ALR mode is activated, the seat
belt cannot be extended again until the
seat belt tongue is detached from the
buckle and fully retracted. The seat belt returns to the ELR mode after the seat belt
fully retracts. For additional information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
The ALR mode should be used only for
child restraint installation. During normal seat belt use by an occupant, the ALR
mode should not be activated. If it is activated it may cause uncomfortable seat
belt tension. It can also change the operation of the front passenger air bag.
For additional information, refer to
“Front passenger air bag and status
light” in this section.
To increase your confidence in the seat
belts, check the operation as follows:
• Grasp the shoulder belt and pull forward
quickly. The retractor should lock and restrict further belt movement.
WRS0139
Unfastening the seat belts
To unfasten the seat belt, press the button
1 . The seat belt automation the buckle O
cally retracts.
If the retractor does not lock during this
check, get the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service or to learn more about seat belt
operation.
WARNING
When fastening the seat belts, be certain that the seatbacks are completely
secured in the latched position. If they
are not completely secured, passengers may be injured in an accident or
sudden stop.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-23
WARNING
• After adjustment, release the adjustment button and try to move the
shoulder belt anchor up and down to
make sure it is securely fixed in
position.
• The shoulder belt anchor height
should be adjusted to the position
best for you. Failure to do so may reduce the effectiveness of the entire
restraint system and increase the
chance or severity of injury in an
accident.
LRS0242
Shoulder belt height adjustment
(front seats)
The shoulder belt anchor height should be
adjusted to the position best for you. For
additional information, refer to “Precautions on seat belt usage” in this section. To
1
adjust, pull out the adjustment button O
and move the shoulder belt anchor to the
2 , so the belt passes over
desired position O
the center of the shoulder. The belt should
be away from your face and neck, but not
falling off your shoulder. Release the adjustment button to lock the shoulder belt
anchor into position.
SEAT BELT EXTENDERS
If, because of body size or driving position, it
is not possible to properly fit the lap/
shoulder belt and fasten it, an extender
that is compatible with the installed seat
belts is available for purchase. The extender adds approximately 8 in (200 mm)
of length and may be used for either the
driver or front passenger seating position.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for assistance with purchasing an
extender if an extender is required.
1-24 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WARNING
• Only NISSAN seat belt extenders,
made by the same company which
made the original equipment seat
belts, should be used with NISSAN
seat belts.
• Adults and children who can use the
standard seat belt should not use an
extender. Such unnecessary use
could result in serious personal injury
in the event of an accident.
• Never use seat belt extenders to install child restraints. If the child restraint is not secured properly, the
child could be seriously injured or
killed in a collision or a sudden stop.
SEAT BELT MAINTENANCE
• To clean the seat belt webbing, apply a
mild soap solution or any solution recommended for cleaning upholstery or
carpet. Then wipe with a cloth and allow
the seat belts to dry in the shade. Do not
allow the seat belts to retract until they
are completely dry.
• If dirt builds up in the shoulder belt
guide of the seat belt anchors, the seat
belts may retract slowly. Wipe the shoulder belt guide with a clean, dry cloth.
CHILD SAFETY
• Periodically check to see that the seat
belt and the metal components, such
as buckles, tongues, retractors, flexible
wires and anchors, work properly. If loose
parts, deterioration, cuts or other damage on the webbing is found, the entire
seat belt assembly should be replaced.
WARNING
Do not allow children to play with the
seat belts. Most seating positions are
equipped with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) mode seat belts. If the seat
belt becomes wrapped around a child’s
neck with the ALR mode activated, the
child can be seriously injured or killed if
the seat belt retracts and becomes
tight. This can occur even if the vehicle
is parked. Unbuckle the seat belt to release the child. If the seat belt cannot
be unbuckled or is already unbuckled,
release the child by cutting the seat
belt with a suitable tool (such as a knife
or scissors) to release the seat belt.
Children need adults to help protect
them. They need to be properly restrained.
In addition to the general information in
this manual, child safety information is
available from many other sources, including doctors, teachers, government traffic
safety offices, and community organizations. Every child is different, so be sure to
learn the best way to transport your child.
There are three basic types of child restraint systems:
• Rear-facing child restraint
• Forward-facing child restraint
• Booster seat
The proper restraint depends on the child's
size. Generally, infants up to about 1 year
and less than 20 lbs. (9 kg) should be placed
in rear-facing child restraints. Forwardfacing child restraints are available for children who outgrow rear-facing child restraints and are at least 1 year old. Booster
seats are used to help position a vehicle
lap/shoulder belt on a child who can no
longer use a forward-facing child restraint.
WARNING
Infants and children need special protection. The vehicle's seat belts may
not fit them properly. The shoulder belt
may come too close to the face or neck.
The lap belt may not fit over their small
hip bones. In an accident, an improperly fitting seat belt could cause serious
or fatal injury. Always use appropriate
child restraints.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-25
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories require the use of approved child
restraints for infants and small children. For
additional information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
A child restraint may be secured in the vehicle by using either the LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) system or
with the vehicle seat belt. For additional
information, refer to “Child restraints” in this
section.
NISSAN recommends that all pre-teens
and children be restrained in the rear
seat if available (Crew Cab models). Studies show that children are safer when
properly restrained in the rear seat than
in the front seat.
This is especially important because
your vehicle has a supplemental restraint system (air bag system) for the
front passenger. For additional information, refer to “Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS)” in this section.
INFANTS
LARGER CHILDREN
Infants up to at least 1 year old should be
placed in a rear-facing child restraint. NISSAN
recommends that infants be placed in child
restraints that comply with Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards or Canadian Motor
Vehicle Safety Standards. You should choose
a child restraint that fits your vehicle and
always follow the manufacturer's instructions for installation and use.
Children should remain in a forward-facing
child restraint with a harness until they
reach the maximum height or weight limit
allowed by the child restraint manufacturer.
SMALL CHILDREN
Children that are over 1 year old and weigh
at least 20 lbs. (9 kg) should remain in a
rear-facing child restraint as long as possible up to the height or weight limit of the
child restraint. Children who outgrow the
height or weight limit of the rear-facing
child restraint and are at least 1 year old
should be secured in a forward-facing child
restraint with a harness. Refer to the manufacturer’s instructions for minimum and
maximum weight and height recommendations. NISSAN recommends that small
children be placed in child restraints that
comply with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety
Standards or Canadian Motor Vehicle
Safety Standards. You should choose a
child restraint that fits your vehicle and always follow the manufacturer’s instructions for installation and use.
1-26 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Once a child outgrows the height or weight
limit of the harness-equipped forwardfacing child restraint, NISSAN recommends
that the child be placed in a commercially
available booster seat to obtain proper
seat belt fit. For a seat belt to fit properly, the
booster seat should raise the child so that
the shoulder belt is properly positioned
across the chest and the top, middle portion of the shoulder. The shoulder belt
should not cross the neck or face and
should not fall off the shoulder. The lap belt
should lie snugly across the lower hips or
upper thighs, not the abdomen. A booster
seat can only be used in seating positions
that have a three-point type seat belt. The
booster seat should fit the vehicle seat and
have a label certifying that it complies with
Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standards or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standards.
A booster seat should be used until the
child can pass the seat belt fit test below:
• Are the child’s back and hips against the
vehicle seatback?
• Is the child able to sit without slouching?
• Do the child’s knees bend easily over the
front edge of the seat with feet flat on the
floor?
• Can the child safely wear the seat belt (lap
belt low and snug across the hips and
shoulder belt across mid-chest and
shoulder)?
• Is the child able to use the properly adjusted head restraint/headrest?
• Will the child be able to stay in position for
the entire ride?
WARNING
Never let a child stand or kneel on any
seat and do not allow a child in the
cargo area. The child could be seriously
injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.
LRS2690
If you answered no to any of these questions, the child should remain in a booster
seat using a three-point type seat belt.
NOTE:
Laws in some communities may follow
different guidelines. Check local and
state regulations to confirm your child is
using the correct restraint system before
traveling.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-27
CHILD RESTRAINTS
ARS1098
PRECAUTIONS ON CHILD
RESTRAINTS
WARNING
• Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result
in serious injury or death of a child or
other passengers in a sudden stop or
collision:
– Do not install rear-facing child restraints in the driver's side rear
seating position.
WRS0256
– For forward-facing child seats
and boosters, DO NOT install if the
child restraint base extends past
the forward edge of the seat
cushion.
– The child restraint must be used
and installed properly. Always follow all of the child restraint manufacturer's instructions for installation and use.
– Infants and children should never
be held on anyone's lap. Even the
strongest adult cannot resist the
forces of a collision.
1-28 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
– Do not put a seat belt around both
a child and another passenger.
– NISSAN recommends that all child
restraints be installed in the rear
seat. Studies show that children
are safer when properly restrained in the rear seat than in
the front seat. If you must install a
forward-facing child restraint in
the front seat, refer to “Forwardfacing child restraint installation
using the seat belts” in this
section.
– Even with the NISSAN Advanced
Air Bag System, never install a
rear-facing child restraint in the
front seat. An inflating air bag
could seriously injure or kill a child.
A rear-facing child restraint must
only be used in the rear seat.
– Be sure to purchase a child restraint that will fit the child and
vehicle. Some child restraints may
not fit properly in your vehicle.
– Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those
loads imposed by correctly fitted
child restraints. Under no circumstances are they to be used to attach adult seat belts, or other
items or equipment to the vehicle.
Doing so could damage the child
restraint anchorages. The child restraint will not be properly installed using the damaged anchorage, and a child could be
seriously injured or killed in a
collision.
– Never use the anchor points for
adult seat belts, or other items.
– A child restraint with a top tether
strap should not be used in the
front passenger seat (King Cab®
models).
– Keep seatbacks as upright as possible after fitting the child restraint.
– Infants and children should always be placed in an appropriate
child restraint while in the vehicle.
• When the child restraint is not in use,
keep it secured with the LATCH system or a seat belt. In a sudden stop or
collision, loose objects can injure occupants or damage the vehicle.
CAUTION
A child restraint in a closed vehicle can
become very hot. Check the seating
surface and buckles before placing a
child in the child restraint.
This vehicle is equipped with a universal
child restraint anchor system, referred to
as the LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers
for CHildren) system. Some child restraints
include rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to these anchors. For additional information, refer to
“LATCH (Lower Anchors and Tethers for
CHildren) system” in this section.
If you do not have a LATCH compatible
child restraint, the vehicle seat belts can be
used.
Several manufacturers offer child restraints for infants and children of various
sizes. When selecting any child restraint,
keep the following points in mind:
• Choose only a restraint with a label certifying that it complies with Federal Motor
Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
• Check the child restraint in your vehicle to
be sure it is compatible with the vehicle's
seat and seat belt system.
• If the child restraint is compatible with
your vehicle, place your child in the child
restraint and check the various adjustments to be sure the child restraint is
compatible with your child. Choose a
child restraint that is designed for your
child's height and weight. Always follow
all recommended procedures.
• If the combined weight of the child and
child restraint is less than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg),
you may use either the LATCH anchors or
the seat belt to install the child restraint
(not both at the same time).
• If the combined weight of the child and
child restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5
kg), use the vehicle’s seat belt (not the
lower anchors) to install the child restraint.
• Be sure to follow the child restraint
manufacturer’s instructions for installation.
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories require that infants and small
children be restrained in an approved
child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated. Canadian law requires the top tether strap on forwardfacing child restraints be secured to the
designated anchor point on the vehicle.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-29
LATCH lower anchor
WARNING
LRS2962
LATCH system lower anchor locations
(Crew Cab models)
LATCH (Lower Anchors and
Tethers for CHildren) SYSTEM
Your vehicle is equipped with special anchor points that are used with LATCH system compatible child restraints. This system may also be referred to as the ISOFIX
or ISOFIX compatible system. With this system, you do not have to use a vehicle seat
belt to secure the child restraint unless the
combined weight of the child and child restraint exceeds 65 lbs., (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and child restraint
is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg) use the vehi-
LRS2963
LATCH system lower anchor locations
(King Cab® models)
cle’s seat belt (not the lower anchors) to
install the child restraint. Be sure to follow
the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for installation.
The LATCH lower anchor points are provided to install child restraints in the rear
outboard seating positions only. Do not attempt to install a child restraint in the center position using the LATCH lower anchors.
1-30 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use and installation of child restraints could result in serious injury or death of a child or other
passengers in a sudden stop or collision:
– Attach LATCH system compatible
child restraints only at the locations
shown in the illustration.
– Do not secure a child restraint in the
center rear seating position using the
LATCH lower anchors. The child restraint will not be secured properly.
– Inspect the lower anchors by inserting your fingers into the lower anchor area. Feel to make sure there
are no obstructions over the anchors such as seat belt webbing or
seat cushion material. The child restraint will not be secured properly if
the lower anchors are obstructed.
Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage the
child restraint anchorages. The child
restraint will not be properly installed
using the damaged anchorage, and a
child could be seriously injured or killed
in a collision.
LRS3036
LATCH lower anchor location
LATCH lower anchor location
LRS2984
LATCH label locations
(Crew Cab models)
The LATCH lower anchors are located as
shown. A label is attached to the seatback
(Crew Cab models) to help you locate the
LATCH lower anchors.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-31
Top tether anchor
WARNING
LRS0661
LATCH webbing-mounted attachment
Installing child restraint LATCH
lower anchor attachments
LATCH compatible child restraints include
two rigid or webbing-mounted attachments that can be connected to two anchors located at certain seating positions
in your vehicle. With this system, you do not
have to use a vehicle seat belt to secure the
child restraint. Check your child restraint for
a label stating that it is compatible with
LATCH. This information may also be in the
instructions provided by the child restraint
manufacturer.
LRS0662
LATCH rigid-mounted attachment
When installing a child restraint, carefully
read and follow the instructions in this
manual and those supplied with the child
restraint.
1-32 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
• Do not allow cargo to contact the top
tether strap when it is attached to
the top tether anchor. Properly secure the cargo so it does not contact
the top tether strap. Cargo that is not
properly secured or cargo that contacts the top tether strap may damage it during a collision. A child could
be seriously injured or killed in a collision if the top tether strap is
damaged.
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The
child restraint will not be properly installed using the damaged anchorages, and a child could be seriously
injured or killed in a collision.
LRS0572
Front passenger seat
(King Cab® models)
LRS0393
LRS2101
1. Top tether strap
Jump seats
(King Cab® models - passenger side
shown)
1. Cover plate
2. Anchor point
2. Routing bracket
Top tether anchor point locations
3. Anchor point
• On the floor between the jump seat belt
buckles in the center of the vehicle (King
Cab® models) as shown.
Anchor points are located in the following
locations:
• On the back of the front passenger seat
(King Cab® models) as shown.
Rear bench seat (Crew Cab models)
• Under the rear window behind the rear
bench seat (Crew Cab models) as shown.
The anchor point is located on the floor
between the jump seat belt buckles in the
center of the vehicle. The routing bracket is
located behind the cover plate under the
rear window above the jump seat.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-33
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING LATCH (Crew
Cab models)
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs., (29.5 kg) use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing
child restraint in the rear seats using the
LATCH system:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
LRS2997
Rear-facing webbing-mounted – step 2
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors.
Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower
anchors.
1-34 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2996
Rear-facing rigid-mounted – step 2
vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all
child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
5. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 2
through 4.
LRS0673
LRS0674
Rear-facing – step 3
3. For child restraints that are equipped
with webbing-mounted attachments,
remove any additional slack from the
anchor attachments. Press downward
and rearward firmly in the center of the
child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of
the anchor attachments.
Rear-facing – step 4
4. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the LATCH attachment
path. The child restraint should not
move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from
side to side. Try to tug it forward and
check to see if the LATCH attachment
holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH
attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again.
You may need to try a different child
restraint or try installing by using the
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-35
– Do not install a child restraint system on the passenger's side jump
seat without unfolding the seat
extender.
LRS2357
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING LATCH —
JUMP SEAT (King Cab® models)
WARNING
• If a child restraint system is not installed properly, the child could be
seriously injured or killed in a sudden
stop or collision.
– Never install a rear-facing child restraint system on the driver's side
jump seat.
1-36 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2356
WARNING
• To install a rear-facing child restraint on
the passenger's side jump seat, it will
be necessary to move the front passenger's seat fully forward and place the
front seatback upright or tilt it forward.
Failure to do so may cause the child
restraint to not be installed properly
and cause serious injury or death in a
sudden stop or collision.
– The front seat cannot be used when
a rear-facing child restraint is installed on the jump seat. Attempting
to do so could cause serious injury in
a sudden stop or collision.
Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the jump seat.
1. To access the jump seat extension (pasA on the jump seat,
senger's side only) O
B on the extension to unfold it to
pull up O
the open position. Then unfold the two
C and lower the jump seat
support legs O
to the full open seating position.
LRS2725
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
LRS2502
Full open seating position
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs., (29.5 kg) use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-37
LRS2552
LRS2997
Rear-facing — step 2
2. Move the front passenger's seat into the
full forward position. Then move the
front seatback to the upright or tilted
forward position. Position the child restraint on the jump seat. The direction of
the child restraint depends on the type
of the child restraint and the size of the
child. Always follow the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions.
Rear-facing webbing-mounted – step 4
4. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors.
Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower
anchors.
3. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
1-38 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2996
Rear-facing rigid-mounted – step 4
vehicle seat belt (if applicable). Not all
child restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
7. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1
through 6.
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT
BELTS (Crew Cab models)
WARNING
LRS0673
LRS0674
Rear-facing – step 5
5. For child restraints that are equipped
with webbing-mounted attachments,
remove any additional slack from the
anchor attachments. Press downward
and rearward firmly in the center of the
child restraint with your hand to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of
the anchor attachments.
Rear-facing – step 6
6. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the LATCH attachment
path. The child restraint should not
move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from
side to side. Try to tug it forward and
check to see if the LATCH attachment
holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH
attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again.
You may need to try a different child
restraint or try installing by using the
The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be
used when installing a child restraint.
Failure to use the ALR mode will result
in the child restraint not being properly
secured. The restraint could tip over or
be loose and cause injury or death to a
child in a sudden stop or collision. Also,
it can change the operation of the front
passenger air bag. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air
bag and status light” in this section.
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-39
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg), use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
Follow these steps to install a rear-facing
child restraint using the vehicle seat belts in
the rear seats:
WRS0256
WRS0761
Rear-facing – step 1
1. Child restraints for infants must be
used in the rear-facing direction and
therefore must not be used in the front
seat. Position the child restraint on the
seat. Always follow the child restraint
manufacturer’s instructions.
Rear-facing – step 2
2. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the
buckle until you hear and feel the latch
engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for
belt routing.
1-40 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS0669
LRS0670
WRS0762
Rear-facing – step 3
3. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the ALR mode (child restraint
mode). It reverts to the ELR mode when
the seat belt is fully retracted.
Rear-facing – step 4
4. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on
the shoulder belt to remove any slack in
the belt.
Rear-facing – step 5
5. Remove any additional slack from the
seat belt; press downward and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
to compress the vehicle seat cushion
and seatback while pulling up on the
seat belt.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-41
7. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each
use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat
steps 3 through 6.
After the child restraint is removed and the
seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode
(child restraint mode) is canceled.
WRS0763
Rear-facing – step 6
6. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the seat belt path. The
child restraint should not move more
than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try
to tug it forward and check to see if the
belt holds the restraint in place. If the
restraint is not secure, tighten the seat
belt as necessary, or put the restraint in
another seat and test it again. You may
need to try a different child restraint. Not
all child restraints fit in all types of
vehicles.
1-42 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS0597
REAR-FACING CHILD RESTRAINT
INSTALLATION USING THE SEAT
BELTS — JUMP SEAT (King Cab®
models)
WARNING
• The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must
be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode
will result in the child restraint not
being properly secured. The restraint
could tip over or be loose and cause
injury to a child in a sudden stop or
collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front passenger air
bag. For additional information, refer
to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this section.
• A child restraint system will not be
installed properly and the child could
be seriously injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision.
– Never install a rear-facing child restraint system on the driver's side
jump seat.
– Do not install a child restraint system on the passenger's side jump
seat without unfolding the seat
extender.
tempting to do so could cause serious injury in a sudden stop or
collision.
LRS0549
WARNING
• To install a rear-facing child restraint
on the passenger's side jump seat, it
will be necessary to move the front
passenger's seat fully forward and
place the front seatback upright or
tilt it forward. Failure to do so may
cause the child restraint to not be installed properly and cause serious
injury or death in a sudden stop or
collision.
– The front seat cannot be used
when a rear-facing child restraint
is installed on the jump seat. At-
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-43
Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the passenger's side jump seat.
A on
1. To access the jump seat extension O
the passenger's side jump seat, pull up
B on the extension to unfold it to the
O
open position. Then unfold the two supC and lower the jump seat to
port legs O
the full open seating position.
LRS2725
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg), use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
1-44 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2502
Full open seating position
LRS2552
LRS2726
LRS2727
Rear-facing — step 2
2. Move the front passenger's seat into the
full forward position. Then move the
front seatback to the upright or tilted
forward position. Position the child restraint on the jump seat. The direction of
the child restraint depends on the type
of the child restraint and the size of the
child. Always follow the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions.
Rear-facing — step 3
3. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the
buckle until you hear and feel the latch
A .
engage O
Rear-facing — step 4
4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
B . At this time, the seat belt
extended O
retractor is in the ALR mode (child restraint mode). It reverts to the ELR mode
when the seat belt is fully retracted.
Be sure to follow the child restraint
manufacturer's instructions for belt
routing.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-45
LRS2728
WRS0762
WRS0918
Rear-facing — step 5
5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on
C to remove any slack
the shoulder belt O
in the belt.
Rear-facing – step 6
6. Remove any additional slack from the
seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint to compress the vehicle seat
cushion and seatback while pulling up
on the seat belt.
Rear-facing — step 7
7. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the seat
near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1 inch
(25 mm), from side to side. Try to tug it
forward and check to see if the seat belt
holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the seat belt
as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may
need to try a different child restraint. Not
all child restraints fit in all types of
vehicles.
1-46 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
8. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each
use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat
steps 3 through 7.
After the child restraint is removed and the
seat belt fully retracted, the ALR mode
(child restraint mode) is canceled.
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
LATCH (Crew Cab models)
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs., (29.5 kg) use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
Follow these steps to install a forwardfacing child restraint in the rear seats using
the LATCH system:
1. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
LRS2995
LRS2994
Forward-facing webbing-mounted –
step 2
2. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors.
Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower
anchors.
Forward-facing rigid-mounted – step 2
Do not install child restraints that require
the use of a top tether strap in seating
positions that do not have a top tether
anchor.
If the child restraint is equipped with a
top tether strap, route the top tether
strap and secure the tether strap to the
tether anchor point. For additional information, refer to “Installing top tether
strap” in this section.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-47
3. The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
child restraint fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the child restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or
a different child restraint.
LRS0671
WRS0697
Forward-facing – step 4
4. For child restraints that are equipped
with webbing-mounted attachments,
remove any additional slack from the
anchor attachments. Press downward
and rearward firmly in the center of the
child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of
the anchor attachments.
Forward-facing – step 6
6. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the LATCH attachment
path. The child restraint should not
move more than 1 inch (25 mm), from
side to side. Try to tug it forward and
check to see if the LATCH attachment
holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the LATCH
attachment as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again.
You may need to try a different child
restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all
types of vehicles.
5. Tighten the tether strap according to
the manufacturer's instructions to remove any slack.
1-48 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
7. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 3
through 6.
LRS0392
LRS0576
Anchor point access
1. Pull strap
Rear bench seat (Crew Cab models)
1. Top tether strap
2. Anchor points
2. Tether strap
Installing top tether strap (rear
bench seat for Crew Cab models)
3. Tether anchor point
Before securing the child restraint with the
LATCH lower anchors (rear outboard seating positions for Crew Cab models) follow
these steps.
To access the anchor points behind the
rear bench seat, tilt the rear seatback forward by lifting up on the pull strap behind
the seatback.
1. If necessary, raise or remove the head
restraint/headrest to position the top
tether strap as shown. If the head
restraint/headrest is removed, store it in
a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the
head restraint/headrest when the child
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-49
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
– For forward-facing child seats
and boosters, DO NOT install if the
child restraint base extends past
the forward edge of the driver's
side seat cushion.
2. Position the top tether strap as shown.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point as shown.
4. Return the seatback to the locked
position.
5. Refer back to child restraint installation
steps before tightening the tether strap.
If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
LRS2360
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
LATCH — JUMP SEAT (King Cab®
models)
WARNING
• If a child restraint system is not installed properly, the child could be
seriously injured or killed in a sudden
stop or collision.
– Do not install a child restraint system on the passenger's side jump
seat without unfolding the seat
extender.
1-50 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
Follow these steps to install a child restraint on the jump seat.
1. To access the jump seat extension (pasA on the jump seat,
senger's side only) O
B on the extension to unfold it to
pull up O
the open position. Then unfold the two
C and lower the jump seat
support legs O
to the full open seating position.
LRS2725
LRS2502
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Full open seating position
2. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg), use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-51
4. The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
child restraint fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the child restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
LRS2995
LRS2994
Forward-facing webbing-mounted –
step 3
3. Secure the child restraint anchor attachments to the LATCH lower anchors.
Check to make sure the LATCH attachment is properly attached to the lower
anchors.
Forward-facing rigid-mounted – step 3
If the child restraint is equipped with a
top tether strap, route the top tether
strap and secure the tether strap to the
tether anchor point. For additional information, refer to “Installing top tether
strap” in this section. Do not install child
restraints that require the use of a top
tether strap in seating positions that do
not have a top tether anchor.
1-52 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or
a different child restraint.
8. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
child restraint is loose, repeat steps 1
through 7.
LRS0671
WRS0697
Forward-facing – step 5
5. For child restraints that are equipped
with webbing-mounted attachments,
remove any additional slack from the
anchor attachments. Press downward
and rearward firmly in the center of the
child restraint with your knee to compress the vehicle seat cushion and seatback while tightening the webbing of
the anchor attachments.
Forward-facing – step 7
7. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the LATCH attachment
path. The child restraint should not move
more than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to
side. Try to tug it forward and check to
see if the LATCH attachment holds the
restraint in place. If the restraint is not
secure, tighten the LATCH attachment
as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again. You may
need to try a different child restraint. Not
all child restraints fit in all types of
vehicles.
6. Tighten the tether strap according to
the manufacturer's instructions to remove any slack.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-53
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The
child restraint will not be properly installed using the damaged anchorages, and a child could be seriously
injured or killed in a collision.
LRS0561
Jump seat (King Cab® models)
1. Top tether strap
2. Routing bracket
3. Tether anchor point
Installing top tether strap — jump
seat (King Cab® models)
WARNING
• Do not secure the top tether strap to
the routing bracket. If the child restraint
is not anchored properly, the risk of a
child being injured or killed in a collision
or a sudden stop greatly increases.
The child restraint top tether strap must be
used when installing the child restraint with
LATCH lower anchor attachments.
First, secure the child restraint with the
LATCH lower anchors (rear seating positions).
1. Pull the cover plate off to access the top
tether strap routing bracket for the jump
seat.
2. Route the top tether strap through the
routing bracket.
3. Secure the top tether strap to the tether
anchor point as shown.
4. Refer back to child restraint installation
steps before tightening the tether strap.
1-54 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
THE SEAT BELTS — FRONT
PASSENGER AND REAR BENCH
SEAT (Crew Cab models)
WARNING
The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must be
used when installing a child restraint.
Failure to use the ALR mode will result
in the child restraint not being properly
secured. The restraint could tip over or
be loose and cause injury to a child in a
sudden stop or collision. Also, it can
change the operation of the front passenger air bag. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag
and status light” in this section.
Follow these steps to install a forwardfacing child restraint using the vehicle seat
belt in the rear seats (Crew Cab models) or
in the front passenger seat:
1. If you must install a child restraint in the
front seat, it should be placed in a
forward-facing direction only. Move the
seat to the rearmost position. Child restraints for infants must be used in the
rear-facing direction and therefore
must not be used in the front seat.
2. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
WRS0699
Forward-facing (front passenger seat) –
step 1
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg), use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
child restraint fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the child restraint
is removed. For additional information, refer
to “Head restraints/headrests” in this section.
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or
a different child restraint.
WRS0680
Forward-facing – step 3
3. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the
buckle until you hear and feel the latch
engage. Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions for
belt routing.
If the child restraint is equipped with a
top tether strap, route the top tether
strap and secure the tether strap to the
tether anchor point (rear seat installation only). For additional information, refer to “Installing top tether strap” in this
section.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-55
Do not install child restraints that require
the use of a top tether strap in seating
positions that do not have a top tether
anchor.
LRS0667
LRS0668
Forward-facing – step 4
4. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the ALR mode (child restraint
mode). It reverts to ELR mode when the
seat belt is fully retracted.
Forward-facing – step 5
5. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on
the shoulder belt to remove any slack in
the belt.
1-56 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
9. Check to make sure the child restraint is
properly secured prior to each use. If the
seat belt is not locked, repeat steps 3
through 8.
WRS0681
WRS0698
Forward-facing – step 6
6. Remove any additional slack from the
seat belt; press downward and rearward firmly in the center of the child restraint with your knee to compress the
vehicle seat cushion and seatback while
pulling up on the seat belt.
Forward-facing – step 8
8. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the child
restraint near the seat belt path. The
child restraint should not move more
than 1 inch (25 mm), from side to side. Try
to tug it forward and check to see if the
seat belt holds the restraint in place. If
the restraint is not secure, tighten the
seat belt as necessary, or put the restraint in another seat and test it again.
You may need to try a different child
restraint. Not all child restraints fit in all
types of vehicles.
7. Tighten the tether strap according to the
manufacturer's instructions to remove
any slack.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-57
WRS0475
Forward-facing – step 10
10. If the child restraint is installed in the
front passenger seat, place the ignition
switch in the ON position. The front
passenger air bag status light
should illuminate. If this light is not illuminated, refer to "Front passenger air
bag and status light" in this section.
Move the child restraint to another
seating position. Have the system
checked. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
LRS0392
LRS0576
Anchor point access
1. Pull strap
Rear bench seat (Crew Cab models)
1. Top tether strap
2. Anchor points
2. Tether strap
Installing top tether strap (rear
bench seat for Crew Cab models)
3. Tether anchor point
The child restraint top tether strap must be
used when installing the child restraint with
the seat belts.
To access the anchor points behind the
rear bench seat, tilt the rear seatback forward by lifting up on the pull strap behind
the seatback.
After the child restraint is removed and the
seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode
(child restraint mode) is canceled.
1-58 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
First, secure the child restraint with the seat
belt.
1. If necessary, raise or remove the head
restraint/headrest to position the top
tether strap as shown. If the head
restraint/headrest is removed, store it in
a secure place. Be sure to reinstall the
head restraint/headrest when the child
restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
2. Position the top tether strap as shown.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point as shown.
4. Return the seatback to the locked
position.
5. Refer back to child restraint installation
steps before tightening the tether strap.
If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
LRS0598
FORWARD-FACING CHILD
RESTRAINT INSTALLATION USING
THE SEAT BELTS — FRONT
PASSENGER AND JUMP SEATS
(King Cab® models)
injury to a child in a sudden stop or
collision. Also, it can change the operation of the front passenger air
bag. For additional information, refer
to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this section.
• If a child restraint system is not installed properly, the child could be
seriously injured or killed in a sudden
stop or collision.
– Do not install a child restraint system on the passenger's side jump
seat without unfolding the seat
extender.
– For forward-facing child seats
and boosters, DO NOT install if the
child restraint system base extends past the forward edge of
the driver's side seat cushion.
WARNING
• The three-point seat belt with Automatic Locking Retractor (ALR) must
be used when installing a child restraint. Failure to use the ALR mode
will result in the child restraint not
being properly secured. The restraint
could tip over or be loose and cause
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-59
WRS0699
LRS2725
LRS2502
Forward-facing (front passenger seat)
— step 1
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety” and
“Child restraints” sections of this manual
before installing a child restraint.
Forward-facing ( jump seat for King
Cab® models) — step 2
Follow these steps to install a forwardfacing child restraint using the vehicle seat
belt in the jump seats (King Cab® models)
or in the front passenger seat:
Do not use the lower anchors if the combined weight of the child and the child restraint exceeds 65 lbs. (29.5 kg). If the combined weight of the child and the child
restraint is greater than 65 lbs. (29.5 kg) use
the vehicle's seat belt (not the lower anchors) to install the child restraint. Be sure
to follow the child restraint manufacturer's
instructions for installation.
1. If you must install a child restraint in
the front seat, it should be placed in a
forward-facing direction only. Move
the seat to the rearmost position.
Child restraints for infants must be
used in the rear-facing direction and
therefore must not be used in the front
seat.
Full open seating position
2. To access the jump seat extension (pasA on the jump seat,
senger's side only) O
B on the extension to unfold it to
pull up O
the open position. Then unfold the two
C and lower the jump seat
support legs O
to the full open seating position.
1-60 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper child restraint fit, try another seating position or
a different child restraint.
WRS0919
WRS0680
Forward-facing — step 3
3. Position the child restraint on the seat.
Always follow the child restraint manufacturer’s instructions.
Forward-facing — step 4
4. Route the seat belt tongue through the
child restraint and insert it into the buckle
until you hear and feel the latch engage.
Be sure to follow the child restraint manufacturer's instructions for belt routing.
The back of the child restraint should be
secured against the vehicle seatback.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
child restraint fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the child restraint is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
If the child restraint is equipped with a top
tether strap, route the top tether strap and
secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point. For additional information, refer
to “Installing top tether strap” in this section.
Do not install child restraints that require
the use of a top tether strap to seating
positions that do not have a top tether
anchor.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-61
LRS0667
LRS0668
WRS0681
Forward-facing — step 5
5. Pull the shoulder belt until the belt is fully
extended. At this time, the seat belt retractor is in the ALR mode (child restraint
mode). It reverts to the ELR mode when
the seat belt is fully retracted.
Forward-facing — step 6
6. Allow the seat belt to retract. Pull up on
the shoulder belt to remove any slack in
the belt.
Forward-facing – step 7
7. Remove any additional slack from the
seat belt; press downward and rearward
firmly in the center of the child restraint
with your knee to compress the vehicle
seat cushion and seatback while pulling
up on the seat belt.
8. Tighten the tether strap according to
the manufacturer's instructions to remove any slack.
1-62 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
10. Check to make sure that the child restraint is properly secured prior to each
use. If the seat belt is not locked, repeat
steps 3 through 9.
WRS0698
WRS0475
Forward-facing — step 9
9. After attaching the child restraint, test it
before you place the child in it. Push it
from side to side while holding the seat
near the seat belt path. The child restraint should not move more than 1
inch (25 mm) from side to side. Try to tug
it forward and check to see if the belt
holds the restraint in place. If the restraint is not secure, tighten the belt as
necessary, or put the restraint in another
seat and test it again. You may need to
try a different child restraint. Not all child
restraints fit in all types of vehicles.
Forward-facing — step 11
11. If the child restraint is installed in the
front passenger seat, place the ignition
switch in the ON position. The front passhould
senger air bag status light
illuminate. If this light is not illuminated,
refer to “Front passenger air bag and
status light” in this section. Move the
child restraint to another seating position. Have the system checked. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
After the child restraint is removed and the
seat belt is fully retracted, the ALR mode
(child restraint mode) is canceled.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-63
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage the
child restraint anchorages. The child
restraint will not be properly installed
using the damaged anchorages, and a
child could be seriously injured or killed
in a collision.
The child restraint top tether strap must be
used when installing the child restraint with
the seat belts.
First, secure the child restraint with the seat
belt.
LRS0572
Front passenger seat (King Cab®
models)
1. Top tether strap
2. Anchor point
Installing top tether strap — front
passenger seat (King Cab®
models)
WARNING
Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
1. If necessary, raise or remove the head
restraint/headrest to position the top
tether straps over the top of the seatback. If the head restraint/headrest is
removed, store it in a secure place. Be
sure to reinstall the head restraint/
headrest when the child restraint is removed. For additional information, refer
to “Head restraints/headrests” in this
section.
2. Position the top tether strap as shown.
3. Secure the tether strap to the tether anchor point as shown.
1-64 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
4. Tighten the tether strap according to
the manufacturer’s instructions to remove any slack.
If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
• Child restraint anchorages are designed to withstand only those loads
imposed by correctly fitted child restraints. Under no circumstances are
they to be used to attach adult seat
belts, or other items or equipment to
the vehicle. Doing so could damage
the child restraint anchorages. The
child restraint will not be properly installed using the damaged anchorages, and a child could be seriously
injured or killed in a collision.
LRS0561
Jump seat (King Cab® models)
1. Top tether strap
2. Routing bracket
3. Tether anchor point
Installing top tether strap — jump
seat (King Cab® models)
WARNING
• Do not secure the top tether strap to
the routing bracket. If the child restraint is not anchored properly, the
risk of a child being injured or killed in
a collision or a sudden stop greatly
increases.
The child restraint top tether strap must be
used when installing the child restraint with
the seat belts.
First, secure the child restraint with the seat
belt.
1. Pull the cover plate off to access the top
tether strap routing bracket for the jump
seat.
2. Route the top tether strap through the
routing bracket.
3. Secure the top tether strap to the tether
anchor point as shown.
4. Refer back to child restraint installation
steps before tightening the tether strap.
If you have any questions when installing a top tether strap, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
BOOSTER SEATS
For additional information on installing a
booster seat in your vehicle, follow the instructions outlined in this section.
Precautions on booster seats
WARNING
If a booster seat and seat belt are not
used properly, the risk of a child being
injured or killed in a sudden stop or collision greatly increases:
– Make sure the shoulder portion of
the belt is away from the child's face
and neck and the lap portion of the
belt does not cross the stomach.
– Make sure the shoulder belt is not
behind the child or under the child's
arm.
– A booster seat must only be installed
in a seating position that has a lap/
shoulder belt.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-65
LRS2479
LRS0453
LRS0464
B. High back booster seat
Booster seats of various sizes are offered
by several manufacturers. When selecting
any booster seat, keep the following points
in mind:
• Choose only a booster seat with a label
certifying that it complies with Federal
Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
• Check the booster seat in your vehicle to
be sure it is compatible with the vehicle’s
seat and seat belt system.
• Make sure the child’s head will be properly
supported by the booster seat or vehicle
seat. The seatback must be at or above
the center of the child’s ears. For example,
if a low back booster seat is chosen, the
vehicle seatback must be at or above the
center of the child’s ears. If the seatback is
lower than the center of the child’s ears, a
high back booster seat should be used.
• If the booster seat is compatible with
your vehicle, place the child in the booster
seat and check the various adjustments
to be sure the booster seat is compatible
with the child. Always follow all recommended procedures.
All U.S. states and Canadian provinces or
territories require that infants and small
children be restrained in an approved
child restraint at all times while the vehicle is being operated.
A. Low back booster seat
1-66 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
The instructions in this section apply to
booster seat installation in the rear seats
or the front passenger seat.
Booster seat installation — front
passenger seat (all models) and
rear seat (Crew Cab models)
WARNING
To avoid injury to child, do not use the
lap/shoulder belt in the Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) mode when using a booster seat with the seat belts.
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety”,
“Child restraints” and “Booster seats” sections of this manual before installing a child
restraint.
Follow these steps to install a booster seat
in the rear seat or in the front passenger
seat:
WRS0699
LRS0454
1. If you must install a booster seat in the
front seat, move the seat to the rearmost position.
Front passenger position
3. The booster seat should be positioned
on the vehicle seat so that it is stable.
2. Position the booster seat on the seat.
Only place it in a front-facing direction.
Always follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
booster seat fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the booster
seat is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraints/
headrests” in this section.
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper booster
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-67
Booster seat installation — jump
seat (King Cab® models)
seat fit, try another seating position or a
different booster seat.
4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt
low and snug on the child’s hips. Be sure
to follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the seat
belt routing.
5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat
belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is
positioned across the top, middle portion of the child’s shoulder. Be sure to
follow the booster seat manufacturer’s
instructions for adjusting the seat belt
routing.
6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instructions for properly fastening a seat
belt shown in “Three-point type seat belt
with retractor” in this section.
WARNING
WRS0475
7. If the booster seat is installed in the front
passenger seat, place the ignition switch
in the ON position. The front passenger
may or may not
air bag status light
illuminate, depending on the size of the
child and the type of booster seat being
used. For additional information, refer to
“Front passenger air bag and status
light” in this section.
1-68 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
• If a child restraint system is not installed properly, the child could be
seriously injured or killed in a sudden
stop or collision.
– For boosters, DO NOT install if the
child restraint system base extends past the forward edge of
the seat cushion.
– Do not install a child restraint system on the passenger's side jump
seat without unfolding the seat
extender.
• To avoid injury to child, do not use the
lap/shoulder belt in the Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) mode when
using a booster seat with the seat
belts.
For additional information, refer to all Warnings and Cautions in the “Child safety”,
“Child restraints” and “Booster seats” sections of this manual before installing a child
restraint.
Follow these steps to install a booster seat
in the jump seats:
LRS2725
LRS2502
1. To access the jump seat extension (pasA on the jump seat,
senger's side only) O
B on the extension to unfold it to
pull up O
the open position. Then unfold the two
C and lower the jump seat
support legs O
to the full open seating position.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-69
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(SRS)
If the seating position does not have an
adjustable head restraint/headrest and
it is interfering with the proper booster
seat fit, try another seating position or a
different booster seat.
4. Position the lap portion of the seat belt
low and snug on the child’s hips. Be sure
to follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions for adjusting the seat
belt routing.
LRS0539
2. Position the booster seat on the seat.
Only place it in a front-facing direction.
Always follow the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.
3. The booster seat should be positioned
on the vehicle seat so that it is stable.
If necessary, adjust or remove the head
restraint/headrest to obtain the correct
booster seat fit. If the head restraint/
headrest is removed, store it in a secure
place. Be sure to reinstall the head
restraint/headrest when the booster
seat is removed. For additional information, refer to “Head restraint/
headrest” in this section.
5. Pull the shoulder belt portion of the seat
belt toward the retractor to take up extra slack. Be sure the shoulder belt is
positioned across the top, middle portion of the child’s shoulder. Be sure to
follow the booster seat manufacturer’s
instructions for adjusting the seat belt
routing.
6. Follow the warnings, cautions and instructions for properly fastening a seat
belt shown in “Three-point type seat belt
with retractor” in this section.
1-70 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
PRECAUTIONS ON SRS
This SRS section contains important information concerning the following systems:
• Driver and front passenger supplemental
front-impact air bag (NISSAN Advanced
Air Bag System)
• Front seat-mounted side-impact supplemental air bag
• Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag
• Seat belt with pretensioner(s) (front
seats)
Supplemental front-impact air bag system
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System can
help cushion the impact force to the head
and chest of the driver and front passenger
in certain frontal collisions.
Front
seat-mounted
side-impact
supplemental air bag system
This system can help cushion the impact
force to the chest area of the driver and
front passenger in certain side-impact collisions. The side air bags are designed to
inflate on the side where the vehicle is impacted.
Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag system
This system can help cushion the impact
force to the head of occupants in front and
rear outboard seating positions in certain
side-impact or rollover collisions. In a sideimpact, the curtain air bags are designed
to inflate on the side where the vehicle is
impacted. In a rollover, the curtain air bags
are designed to inflate and remain inflated
for a short time.
The SRS is designed to supplement the
crash protection provided by the seat belts
and is not a substitute for them. Seat belts
should always be correctly worn and the
occupant seated a suitable distance away
from the steering wheel, instrument panel
and door finishers. For additional information, refer to “Seat belts” in this section.
The supplemental air bags operate only
when the ignition switch is in the ON or
START position.
After placing the ignition switch in the
ON position, the supplemental air bag
warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off
after about 7 seconds if the system is
operational.
WRS0031
WARNING
• The front air bags ordinarily will not inflate in the event of a side impact, rear
impact, rollover, or lower severity frontal collision. Always wear your seat
belts to help reduce the risk or severity
of injury in various kinds of accidents.
• The front passenger air bag will not
inflate if the passenger air bag status
light is lit or if the front passenger seat
is unoccupied. For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag
and status light” in this section.
• The seat belts and the front air bags
are most effective when you are sitting well back and upright in the seat.
The front air bags inflate with great
force. Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, if you are unrestrained, leaning forward, sitting
sideways or out of position in any
way, you are at greater risk of injury
or death in a crash. You may also receive serious or fatal injuries from
the front air bag if you are up against
it when it inflates. Always sit back
against the seatback and as far away
as practical from the steering wheel
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-71
or instrument panel. Always properly
use the seat belts.
• The driver and front passenger seat
belt buckles are equipped with sensors that detect if the seat belts are
fastened. The NISSAN Advanced Air
Bag System monitors the severity of
a collision and seat belt usage, then
inflates the air bags as needed. Failure to properly wear seat belts can
increase the risk or severity of injury
in an accident.
• The front passenger seat is equipped
with an occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) that turns the
front passenger air bag OFF under
some conditions. This sensor is only
used in this seat. Failure to be properly seated and wearing the seat belt
can increase the risk or severity of
injury in an accident. For additional
information, refer to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this
section.
• Keep hands on the outside of the
steering wheel. Placing them inside
the steering wheel rim could increase
the risk that they are injured when
the front air bag inflates.
1-72 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
ARS1133
ARS1041
WARNING
• Never let children ride unrestrained
or extend their hands or face out of
the window. Do not attempt to hold
them in your lap or arms. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the illustrations.
ARS1042
ARS1043
WARNING
• Children may be severely injured or
killed when the front air bags, side air
bags or curtain air bags inflate if they
are not properly restrained. Preteens and children should be properly restrained in the rear seat, if
possible.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-73
ARS1044
ARS1045
WRS0256
WARNING
• Even with the NISSAN Advanced Air
Bag System, never install a rearfacing child restraint in the front seat.
An inflating front air bag could seriously injure or kill your child. For additional information, refer to “Child
restraints” in this section.
1-74 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
WRS0431
Do not lean against the door.
LRS0396
Do not lean against doors or windows.
SSS0162
Do not lean against doors or windows.
WARNING
Front
seat-mounted
side-impact
supplemental air bags and roofmounted curtain side-impact and rollover supplemental air bags:
• The side air bags and curtain air bags
ordinarily will not inflate in the event
of a frontal impact, rear impact, or
lower severity side collision. Always
wear your seat belts to help reduce
the risk or severity of injury in various
kinds of accidents.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-75
WARNING
• The seat belts, the side air bags and
curtain air bags are most effective
when you are sitting well back and
upright in the seat. The side air bag
and curtain air bag inflate with great
force. Do not allow anyone to place
their hand, leg or face near the side
air bag on the side of the seatback of
the front seat or near the side roof
rails. Do not allow anyone sitting in
the front seats or rear outboard seats
to extend their hand out of the window or lean against the door. Some
examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the previous
illustrations.
LRS0421
WARNING
• When sitting in the rear seat, do not
hold onto the seatback of the front
seat. If the side air bag inflates, you
may be seriously injured. Be especially careful with children, who
should always be properly restrained. Some examples of dangerous riding positions are shown in the
illustrations.
• Do not use seat covers on the front
seatbacks. They may interfere with
side air bag inflation.
1-76 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
SSS0159
NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System
(front seats)
1. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bag inflators
2. Seat belt with pretensioner(s) (front
seats)
3. Front
seat-mounted
side-impact
supplemental air bag module
4. Roof-mounted curtain side-impact and
rollover supplemental air bags
5. Seat belt buckle switches
6. Air bag Control Unit (ACU)
7. Front door satellite sensor (driver’s side
shown; passenger’s side similar)
8. Supplemental front-impact air bag
modules
9. Crash zone sensor
10. Occupant classification system control
unit
11. Occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor)
12. Satellite sensors (passenger’s side
shown; driver’s side similar)
LRS3124
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-77
This vehicle is equipped with the NISSAN
Advanced Air Bag System for the driver and
front passenger seats. This system is designed to meet certification requirements
under U.S. regulations. It is also permitted in
Canada. However, all of the information,
cautions and warnings in this manual
still apply and must be followed.
The driver supplemental front-impact air
bag is located in the center of the steering
wheel. The front passenger supplemental
front-impact air bag is mounted in the
dashboard above the glove box. The front
air bags are designed to inflate in higher
severity frontal collisions, although they
may inflate if the forces in another type of
collision are similar to those of a higher
severity frontal impact. They may not inflate in certain frontal collisions. Vehicle
damage (or lack of it) is not always an indication of proper front air bag system operation.
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System
monitors information from the crash zone
sensor, the Air bag Control Unit (ACU), seat
belt buckle sensors, occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor) and passenger seat belt tension sensor. Inflator operation is based on the severity of a collision
and seat belt usage for the driver. For the
front passenger, it additionally monitors
the weight of an occupant or object on the
seat and seat belt tension. Based on information from the sensors, only one front air
bag may inflate in a crash, depending on
the crash severity and whether the front
occupants are belted or unbelted. Additionally, the front passenger air bag may be
automatically turned off under some conditions, depending on the weight detected
on the front passenger seat and how the
seat belt is used. If the front passenger air
bag is OFF, the front passenger air bag status light will be illuminated (if the seat is
unoccupied, the light will not be illuminated, but the air bag will be off). For additional information, refer to “Front passenger air bag and status light” in this section.
One front air bag inflating does not indicate
improper performance of the system.
If you have any questions about your air
bag system, it is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer to obtain information
about the system. If you are considering
modification of your vehicle due to a disability, you may also contact NISSAN. Contact information is contained in the front of
this Owner's Manual.
1-78 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
When a front air bag inflates, a fairly loud
noise may be heard, followed by the release of smoke. This smoke is not harmful
and does not indicate a fire. Care should be
taken to not inhale it, as it may cause irritation and choking. Those with a history of a
breathing condition should get fresh air
promptly.
Front air bags, along with the use of seat
belts, help to cushion the impact force on
the face and chest of the front occupants.
They can help save lives and reduce serious injuries. However, an inflating front air
bag may cause facial abrasions or other
injuries. Front air bags do not provide restraint to the lower body.
Even with NISSAN Advanced Air Bags, seat
belts should be correctly worn and the
driver and front passenger seated upright
as far as practical away from the steering
wheel or instrument panel. The front air
bags inflate quickly in order to help protect
the front occupants. Because of this, the
force of the front air bag inflating can increase the risk of injury if the occupant is
too close to, or is against, the front air bag
module during inflation.
The front air bags deflate quickly after a
collision.
The front air bags operate only when the
ignition switch is in the ON or START position.
Status light
After placing the ignition switch in the
ON position, the supplemental air bag
warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off
after about 7 seconds if the system is
operational.
WRS0475
Front passenger air bag and status light
WARNING
The front passenger air bag is designed
to automatically turn OFF under some
conditions. Read this section carefully
to learn how it operates. Proper use of
the seat, seat belt and child restraints is
necessary for most effective protection. Failure to follow all instructions in
this manual concerning the use of
seats, seat belts and child restraints
can increase the risk or severity of injury in an accident.
The front passenger air bag status light
is located near the climate controls.
After the ignition switch is placed in the
"ON" position, the front passenger air bag
status light on the instrument panel illuminates for about 7 seconds and then turns
off or remains illuminated depending on
the front passenger seat occupied status.
The light operates as follows:
• Unoccupied front passenger's seat: The
light is OFF and the front passenger
air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a
crash.
• Front passenger's seat occupied by a
small adult, child or child restraint as outlight illumilined in this section: The
nates to indicate that the front passenger air bag is OFF and will not inflate in a
crash.
• Occupied front passenger seat and the
passenger meet the conditions outlined
light is OFF to
in this section: The
indicate that the front passenger air bag
is operational.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-79
Front passenger air bag
The front passenger air bag is designed to
automatically turn OFF when the vehicle is
operated under some conditions as described below in accordance with U.S. regulations. If the front passenger air bag is OFF
it will not inflate in a crash. The driver air bag
and other air bags in your vehicle are not
part of this system.
the air bag to turn OFF. Occupant classification sensor operation can vary depending on the front passenger seat belt sensors.
The purpose of the regulation is to help
reduce the risk of injury or death from an
inflating air bag to certain front passenger
seat occupants, such as children, by requiring the air bag to be automatically turned
OFF. Certain sensors are used to meet the
requirements.
The front passenger seat belt sensors are
designed to detect if the seat belt is buckled and the amount of tension on the seat
belt, such as when it is in the Automatic
Locking Retractor (ALR) mode (child restraint mode). Based on the weight on the
seat detected by the occupant classification sensor and the belt tension detected
on the seat belt, the NISSAN Advanced Air
Bag System determines whether the front
passenger air bag should be automatically
turned OFF as required by the regulations.
One sensor used is the occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor). It is in the
bottom of the front passenger seat cushion and is designed to detect an occupant
and objects on the seat by weight. It works
together with seat belt sensors described
in this section. For example, if a child is in
the front passenger seat, the NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System is designed to turn
the front passenger air bag OFF in accordance with the regulations. Also, if a child
restraint of the type specified in the regulations is on the seat, its weight and the
child’s weight can be detected and cause
Front passenger seat adult occupants who
are properly seated and using the seat belt
as outlined in this manual should not
cause the front passenger air bag to be
automatically turned OFF. For small adults
it may be turned OFF, however, if the occupant does not sit in the seat properly (for
example, by not sitting upright, by sitting on
an edge of the seat, or by otherwise being
out of position), this could cause the sensor
to turn the air bag OFF. In addition, if the
occupant improperly uses the seat belt in
the ALR mode, this could cause the air bag
to be turned OFF. Always be sure to be
1-80 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
seated and wearing the seat belt properly
for the most effective protection by the
seat belt and supplemental air bag.
NISSAN recommends that pre-teens and
children be properly restrained in a rear
seat. NISSAN also recommends that appropriate child restraints and booster
seats be properly installed in a rear seat. If
this is not possible, the occupant classification sensor and seat belt sensors are designed to operate as described above to
turn the front passenger air bag OFF for
specified child restraints as required by the
regulations. Failing to properly secure child
restraints and to use the ALR mode may
allow the restraint to tip or move in a collision or sudden stop. This can also result in
the passenger air bag inflating in a crash
instead of being OFF. For additional information, refer to “Child restraints” in this section.
If the front passenger seat is not occupied,
the front passenger air bag is designed not
to inflate in a crash. However, heavy objects
placed on the seat could result in air bag
inflation, because of the object’s weight detected by the occupant classification sensor. Other conditions could also result in air
bag inflation, such as if a child is standing
on the seat, or if two children are on the
seat, contrary to the instructions in this
manual. Always be sure that you and all
vehicle occupants are seated and restrained properly.
Using the front passenger air bag status
light, you can monitor when the front passenger air bag is automatically turned OFF
with the seat occupied. The light will not
illuminate when the front passenger seat is
unoccupied.
If an adult occupant is in the seat but the
front passenger air bag status light is illuminated (indicating that the air bag is OFF),
it could be that the person is a small adult,
or is not sitting on the seat properly or not
using the seat belt properly.
If a child restraint must be used in the front
seat, the front passenger air bag status light
may or may not be illuminated, depending
on the size of the child and the type of child
restraint being used. If the air bag status light
is not illuminated (indicating that the air bag
might inflate in a crash), it could be that the
child restraint or seat belt is not being used
properly. Make sure that the child restraint is
installed properly, the seat belt is used properly and the occupant is positioned properly.
If the air bag status light is not illuminated,
reposition the occupant or child restraint in a
rear seat.
If the front passenger air bag status light
will not illuminate even though you believe
that the child restraint, the seat belts and
the occupant are properly positioned, the
system may be sensing an unoccupied
seat (in which case the air bag is OFF). A
NISSAN dealer can check that the system is
OFF by using a special tool. However, until
you have confirmed with a dealer that your
air bag is working properly, reposition the
occupant or child restraint in a rear seat.
The NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System and
front passenger air bag status light will
take a few seconds to register a change in
the passenger seat status. For example, if a
large adult who is sitting in the front passenger seat exits the vehicle, the front passenger air bag status light will go from OFF
to ON for a few seconds and then to OFF.
This is normal system operation and does
not indicate a malfunction.
If a malfunction occurs in the front passenger air bag system, the supplemental air
, located in the mebag warning light
ter and gauges area of the instrument
panel, will blink. Have the system checked. It
is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
Other supplemental front-impact air
bag precautions
WARNING
• Do not place any objects on the
steering wheel pad or on the instrument panel. Also, do not place any
objects between any occupant and
the steering wheel or instrument
panel. Such objects may become
dangerous projectiles and cause injury if the front air bags inflate.
• Immediately after inflation, several
front air bag system components will
be hot. Do not touch them; you may
severely burn yourself.
• No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring
of the supplemental air bag system.
This is to prevent accidental inflation
of the supplemental air bag or damage to the supplemental air bag
system.
• Do not make unauthorized changes
to your vehicle's electrical system,
suspension system or front end
structure. This could affect proper
operation of the front air bag system.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-81
• Tampering with the front air bag system may result in serious personal
injury. Tampering includes changes
to the steering wheel and the instrument panel assembly by placing material over the steering wheel pad
and above the instrument panel or
by installing additional trim material
around the air bag system.
• Modifying or tampering with the
front passenger seat may result in
serious personal injury. For example,
do not change the front seats by
placing material on the seat cushion
or by installing additional trim material, such as seat covers, on the seat
that are not specifically designed to
assure proper air bag operation. Additionally, do not stow any objects
under the front passenger seat or the
seat cushion and seatback. Such objects may interfere with the proper
operation of the occupant classification sensor (pressure sensor).
• No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring
of the seat belt system. This may affect the front air bag system. Tampering with the seat belt system may
result in serious personal injury.
• It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for work on and
around the front air bag. It is also recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for installation of electrical
equipment. The Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) wiring harnesses* should not be modified or
disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing devices should not be used on the air
bag system.
• A cracked windshield should be replaced immediately by a qualified repair facility. A cracked windshield
could affect the function of the
supplemental air bag system.
*The SRS wiring harness connectors are
yellow and orange for easy identification.
When selling your vehicle, we request that
you inform the buyer about the front air
bag system and guide the buyer to the
appropriate sections in this Owner's
Manual.
1-82 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
LRS2501
Front seat-mounted side-impact
supplemental air bag and
roof-mounted curtain
side-impact and rollover
supplemental air bag systems
The side air bags are located in the outside
of the seatback of the front seats. The curtain air bags are located in the side roof
rails. All of the information, cautions and
warnings in this manual apply and must
be followed. The side air bags and curtain
air bags are designed to inflate in higher
severity side collisions, although they may
inflate if the forces in another type of collision are similar to those of a higher severity
impact. They are designed to inflate on the
side where the vehicle is impacted. They
may not inflate in certain side collisions.
Curtain air bags are also designed to inflate in
certain types of rollover collisions or near rollovers. As a result, certain vehicle movements
(for example, during severe off-roading) may
cause the curtain air bags to inflate.
Vehicle damage (or lack of it) is not always
an indication of proper side air bag and
curtain air bag operation.
When the side air bags and curtain air bags
inflate, a fairly loud noise may be heard,
followed by release of smoke. This smoke is
not harmful and does not indicate a fire.
Care should be taken not to inhale it, as it
may cause irritation and choking. Those
with a history of a breathing condition
should get fresh air promptly.
Side air bags, along with the use of seat
belts, help to cushion the impact force on
the chest and pelvic area of the front occupants. Curtain air bags help to cushion the
impact force to the head of occupants in
the front and rear outboard seating positions. They can help save lives and reduce
serious injuries. However, an inflating side
air bag or curtain air bag may cause abrasions or other injuries. Side air bags and
curtain air bags do not provide restraint to
the lower body.
The seat belts should be correctly worn
and the driver and passenger seated upright as far as practical away from the side
air bag. Rear seat passengers should be
seated as far away as practical from the
door finishers and side roof rails. The side
air bags and curtain air bags inflate quickly
in order to help protect the occupants. Because of this, the force of the side air bag
and curtain air bag inflating can increase
the risk of injury if the occupant is too close
to, or is against, these air bag modules during inflation. The side air bag will deflate
quickly after the collision is over.
The curtain air bags will remain inflated for
a short time.
The side air bags and curtain air bags
operate only when the ignition switch is
in the ON or START position.
After placing the ignition switch in the
ON position, the supplemental air bag
warning light illuminates. The supplemental air bag warning light will turn off
after about 7 seconds if the system is
operational.
WARNING
• Do not place any objects near the
seatback of the front seats. Also, do
not place any objects (an umbrella,
bag, etc.) between the front door finisher and the front seat. Such objects
may become dangerous projectiles
and cause injury if a side air bag
inflates.
• Right after inflation, several side air
bag and curtain air bag system components will be hot. Do not touch
them; you may severely burn
yourself.
• No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring
of the side air bag and curtain air bag
systems. This is to prevent damage
to or accidental inflation of the side
air bag and curtain air bag systems.
• Do not make unauthorized changes
to your vehicle's electrical system,
suspension system or side panel.
This could affect proper operation of
the curtain air bag systems.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-83
• Tampering with the side air bag system may result in serious personal
injury. For example, do not change
the front seats by placing material
near the seatbacks or by installing
additional trim material, such as seat
covers, around the side air bag.
• It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for work on and
around the side air bag and curtain
air bag. It is also recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for installation of electrical equipment. The SRS
wiring harnesses* should not be
modified or disconnected. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and
probing devices should not be used
on the side air bag or curtain air bag
systems.
* The SRS wiring harness or connectors
are yellow or orange for easy identification.
Seat belt with pretensioner(s)
(front seats)
WARNING
• The pretensioner(s) cannot be reused after activation. They must be
replaced together with the retractor
and buckle as a unit.
• If the vehicle becomes involved in a
collision but pretensioner(s) are not
activated, be sure to have the pretensioner system checked and, if necessary, replaced. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
• No unauthorized changes should be
made to any components or wiring
of the pretensioner system. This is to
prevent damage to or accidental activation of the pretensioner(s). Tampering with the pretensioner system
may result in serious personal injury.
When selling your vehicle, we request that
you inform the buyer about the side air bag
and curtain air bag systems and guide the
buyer to the appropriate sections in this
Owner's Manual.
1-84 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
• It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for work on and
around the pretensioner system. It is
also recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for installation of electrical equipment. Unauthorized electrical test equipment and probing
devices should not be used on the
pretensioner system.
• If you need to dispose of the pretensioner(s) or scrap the vehicle, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service. Incorrect disposal procedures could cause personal injury.
The pretensioner system may activate
with the supplemental air bag system in
certain types of collisions. Working with the
seat belt retractor, the pretensioner(s) help
tighten the seat belt when the vehicle becomes involved in certain types of collisions, helping to restrain front seat occupants.
The pretensioner(s) are encased within the
seat belt retractor and to the seat belt anchor affixed to the floor of the vehicle.
These seat belts are used the same way as
conventional seat belts.
When pretensioner(s) activate, smoke is released and a loud noise may be heard. This
smoke is not harmful and does not indicate a fire. Care should be taken not to
inhale it, as it may cause irritation and
choking. Those with a history of a breathing condition should get fresh air promptly.
After the pretensioner(s’) activation, load
limiters allow the seat belt to release webbing (if necessary) to reduce forces against
the chest.
The supplemental air bag warning light
is used to indicate malfunctions in the
pretensioner system. For additional information, refer to "Supplemental air bag
warning light" in this section. If the operation of the supplemental air bag warning
light indicates there is a malfunction, have
the system checked. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
When selling your vehicle, we request that
you inform the buyer about the pretensioner system and guide the buyer to the
appropriate sections in this Owner's
Manual.
WRS0885
LRS0100
1. SRS Air bag warning labels
The warning labels are located on the
surface of the sun visor.
SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING
LIGHT
SUPPLEMENTAL AIR BAG WARNING
LABELS
Warning labels about the supplemental
front-impact air bag system are placed in
the vehicle as shown in the illustration.
WARNING
Do not use a rear-facing child restraint
on a seat protected by an air bag in
front of it. If the air bag deploys, it may
cause serious injury or death.
The supplemental air bag warning light,
in the instrument panel,
displaying
monitors the circuits for the air bag systems, pretensioner(s) and all related wiring.
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
or START position, the supplemental air
bag warning light illuminates for about 7
seconds and then turns off. This means the
system is operational.
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-85
If any of the following conditions occur, the
front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag
and pretensioner systems need servicing:
• The supplemental air bag warning light
remains on after approximately 7 seconds.
• The supplemental air bag warning light
flashes intermittently.
• The supplemental air bag warning light
does not come on at all.
Under these conditions, the front air bag,
side air bag, curtain air bag or pretensioner
systems may not operate properly. They
must be checked and repaired. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
WARNING
If the supplemental air bag warning
light is on, it could mean that the front
air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag
and/or pretensioner systems will not
operate in an accident. To help avoid
injury to yourself or others, have your
vehicle checked as soon as possible. It
is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
Repair and replacement
procedure
The front air bags, side air bags, curtain air
bags and pretensioner(s) are designed to
inflate on a one-time-only basis. As a reminder, unless it is damaged, the supplemental air bag warning light remains illuminated after inflation has occurred. These
systems should be repaired and/or replaced as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
When maintenance work is required on the
vehicle, the front air bags, side air bags,
curtain air bags, pretensioner(s) and related parts should be pointed out to the
person performing the maintenance. The
ignition switch should always be placed in
the LOCK position when working under the
hood or inside the vehicle.
WARNING
• Once a front air bag, side air bag, or
curtain air bag has inflated, the air
bag module will not function again
and must be replaced. Additionally,
the activated pretensioner(s) must
also be replaced. The air bag module
and pretensioner(s) should be re-
1-86 Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system
placed. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
However, the air bag module and pretensioner(s) cannot be repaired.
• The front air bag, side air bag, curtain
air bag systems and the pretensioner system should be inspected if
there is any damage to the front end
or side portion of the vehicle. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• If you need to dispose of the supplemental air bag or pretensioner systems or scrap the vehicle, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer. Incorrect disposal procedures
could cause personal injury.
• If there is an impact to your vehicle
from any direction, your Occupant
Classification Sensor (OCS) should be
checked to verify it is still functioning
correctly. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
The OCS should be checked even if no
air bags deploy as a result of the impact. Failure to verify proper OCS
function may result in an improper
air bag deployment resulting in injury or death.
MEMO
Safety-Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system 1-87
2 Instruments and controls
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2
Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . . . . . . . . 2-7
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Distance To Empty (DTE) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-8
Trip computer (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9
Compass and outside temperature display
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Outside temperature display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-10
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11
Warning lights, indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14
Checking lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-15
Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-21
Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-24
Security systems (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-25
Vehicle security system (if so equipped) . . . . . 2-25
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-27
Wiper and washer switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
Switch operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28
Rear window or outside mirror defroster
switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-29
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-30
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) system
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-32
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Fog light switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-33
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
Cargo lamp switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34
Heated seat switches (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 2-35
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF switch . . . . . 2-36
Hill descent control switch (if so equipped) . . . . . 2-36
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system switch (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-37
Rear Sonar System (RSS) OFF switch
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38
Power outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-39
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Front-door pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Rear-door pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-40
Seatback pocket (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41
Under-seat storage bins
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-42
Storage trays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-44
Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Overhead sunglasses storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45
Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-46
Roof rack (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-48
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
Manual windows (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-49
Power windows (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-50
Rear sliding window (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 2-52
Moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52
Power moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-52
Interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-54
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-55
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56
Programming HomeLink® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56
Programming HomeLink® for Canadian
customers and gate openers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58
Operating the HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-58
Programming trouble-diagnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
Clearing the programmed information . . . . . . 2-59
Reprogramming a single HomeLink®
button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
If your vehicle is stolen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-59
INSTRUMENT PANEL
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
LIC4475
2-2 Instruments and controls
Vents (P. 4-22)
Headlight/fog light (if so equipped)/
turn signal switch (P. 2-30)
Steering wheel switch for audio control
(P. 4-71)
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
(P. 4-79, 4-96)
Driver supplemental air bag (P. 1-70)
Horn (P. 2-34)
Meters and gauges (P. 2-4)
Warning and indicator lights (P. 2-24)
Cruise control switches (P. 5-19)
Wiper and washer switch (P. 2-28)
Storage (P. 2-40)
Audio system (P. 4-36)
Front passenger supplemental air bag
(P. 1-70)
Upper and lower glove box (P. 2-40)
Passenger air bag status light (P. 1-70)
USB connection port (P. 4-55)
AUX input (P. 4-55)
Power outlets (P. 2-39)
Electronic locking rear differential
(E-Lock) system switch (if so equipped)
(P. 2-37)
Heated seat switches (if so equipped)
(P. 2-35)
Rear sonar switch (if so equipped)
(P. 2-38)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch (P. 2-36)
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
Shift lever (P. 5-14)
Push-button ignition switch (P. 5-10)
4WD shift switch (if so equipped)
(P. 5-23)
Climate controls (P. 4-22, P. 4-31)
Hazard warning flasher switch (P. 6-2)
Tilt steering wheel control (P. 3-16)
Cargo lamp switch (P. 2-34)
Hill descent control switch
(if so equipped) (P. 2-36)
Outside mirror controls (if so equipped)
(P. 3-17)
Instruments and controls 2-3
METERS AND GAUGES
SPEEDOMETER AND ODOMETER
This vehicle is equipped with a speedometer and odometer. The speedometer is
located on the right side of the meter cluster. The odometer is located within the trip
computer.
LIC4376
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Warning and indicator lights
Tachometer
Speedometer
Fuel gauge
Change/reset button
2-4 Instruments and controls
6.
7.
Odometer
Twin trip odometer
Trip computer (if so equipped)
Instrument brightness control knob
Engine coolant temperature gauge
LIC4377
Speedometer
The speedometer indicates vehicle speed.
Odometer/Twin trip odometer
The odometer/twin trip odometer is displayed when the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position.
The odometer records the total distance
the vehicle is driven.
The twin trip odometer records the distance of individual trips.
LIC0780
With twin trip odometer
Changing the display
For vehicles equipped with a twin trip
odometer, pressing the change/reset button changes the display as follows:
Trip
→ Trip
→ Trip
WIC0922
With trip computer
For vehicles equipped with a trip computer,
pressing
the
change/reset
button
changes the display as follows:
Trip
→ Trip
→ Distance to
Empty → Average speed → Average fuel
consumption → Journey time → Trip
For additional information, refer to “Trip
computer” in this section.
Resetting the trip odometer
Pressing the change/reset button for
more than 1 second resets the currently
displayed trip odometer to zero.
Instruments and controls 2-5
The low tire pressure warning light remains
illuminated until the tires are inflated to the
recommended COLD tire pressure. The
CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed each time the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position as long
as the low tire pressure warning light remains illuminated.
For additional information, refer to “Low tire
pressure warning light” in this section, “Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the
“Starting and driving” section, and “Wheels
and tires” in the “Do-it-yourself” section of
this manual.
LIC4378
Loose fuel cap warning message
A for more
Press the change/reset button O
than 1 second to reset the LOOSE FUEL CAP
warning message after the fuel cap has
been tightened. For additional information,
refer to “Fuel-filler cap” in the “Pre-driving
checks and adjustments” section of this
manual.
2-6 Instruments and controls
LIC4379
Check tire pressure warning
message
The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning
message is displayed when the low tire
pressure warning light is illuminated and
low tire pressure is detected. Check and
adjust the tire pressure to the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the
Tire and Loading Information label. The
CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message turns off when the low tire pressure
warning light turns off.
CAUTION
If the gauge indicates coolant temperature near the hot (H) end of the
normal range, reduce vehicle speed to
decrease temperature. If the gauge is
over the normal range, stop the vehicle
as soon as safely possible. If the engine
is overheated, continued operation of
the vehicle may seriously damage the
engine. For additional information, refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in the
“In case of emergency” section of this
manual for immediate action required.
LIC4407
TACHOMETER
The tachometer indicates engine speed in
revolutions per minute (rpm).
1 .
Do not rev the engine into the red zone O
CAUTION
Operating the engine in the red zone
may cause serious engine damage.
When engine speed approaches the
red zone, shift to a higher gear or reduce engine speed.
LIC0739
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
GAUGE
The gauge indicates the engine coolant
temperature. The engine coolant tempera1 when
ture is within the normal range O
the gauge needle points within the zone
shown in the illustration.
The engine coolant temperature varies
with the outside air temperature and driving conditions.
Instruments and controls 2-7
indicates that the fuel-filler door
The
is located on the driver's side of the vehicle.
CAUTION
LIC0740
FUEL GAUGE
The gauge indicates the approximate fuel
level in the tank.
The gauge may move slightly during braking, turning, acceleration, or going up or
down hills.
The gauge needle returns to 0 (Empty) after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF
position.
The low fuel warning light comes on when
the amount of fuel in the tank is getting low.
Refill the fuel tank before the gauge registers 0 (Empty).
2-8 Instruments and controls
• If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL) may
come on. Refuel as soon as possible.
light
After a few driving trips, the
should turn off. If the light remains on
after a few driving trips, have the vehicle inspected. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
• For additional information, refer to
“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in
this section.
DISTANCE TO EMPTY (DTE)
Displays the estimated distance the vehicle can be driven before refueling. The
value is calculated based on recent fuel
economy, the amount of fuel remaining in
the fuel tank, and the actual fuel consumption.
Changes in driving patterns or conditions
can cause the DTE value to vary. As a result,
the value displayed may differ from the actual distance that can be driven.
DTE display will change to “---” when the
fuel level in the tank is getting low, prior to
the fuel gauge reaching 0 (Empty).
NOTE:
• The DTE value after refill is estimated
based on recent fuel economy and
amount of fuel added.
• If a small amount of fuel is added, or
the ignition is on during refueling, the
display may not be updated.
• Conditions that affect the fuel
economy will also affect the estimated
DTE value (city/highway driving, idle
time, remote start time, terrain, seasonal weather, added vehicle weight,
added deflectors, roof racks, etc.).
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, modes of the trip computer can
be selected by pressing the change/reset
button. The following modes can be selected:
Average fuel consumption (Mpg
or l/100km)
LIC4381
TRIP COMPUTER (if so equipped)
The display of the trip computer is situated
in the speedometer display. When the ignition switch is placed in the ON position, the
display scrolls all the modes of the trip
computer and then shows the mode chosen before the ignition switch was placed
in the OFF position.
The average fuel consumption mode
shows the average fuel consumption since
the last reset. Resetting is done by pressing
the change/reset button for more than approximately 1 second. The display is updated every 30 seconds. At about the first
1/3 miles (500 m) after a reset, the display
shows (----).
Journey time
The journey time mode shows the time
since the last reset. The displayed time can
be reset by pressing the change/reset button for more than approximately 1 second.
Trip computer reset
Pressing the change/reset button for
more than 3 seconds will reset all modes
except Trip A and distance to empty.
Average speed (mph or km/h)
The average speed mode shows the average vehicle speed since last reset. Resetting is done by pressing the change/reset
button for more than approximately 1 second. The display is updated every 30 seconds. The first 30 seconds after a reset, the
display shows (----).
Instruments and controls 2-9
COMPASS AND OUTSIDE
TEMPERATURE DISPLAY (if so
equipped)
This unit has the following functions:
• Measures terrestrial magnetism and indicates the heading direction of the vehicle
• Indicates outside air temperature
With the ignition switch in the ON position,
or
button as described
press the
in the charts below to activate various features of the automatic anti-glare rearview
mirror.
Type A (if so equipped)
Press and hold
Feature:
the
(Press button again for about 1
button for
second to change settings)
about:
1 second
Compass toggles on/off
8 seconds
Automatic anti-glare/indicator
light toggles on/off
11 seconds
Compass zone can be changed
to correct false compass readings
13 seconds
Compass enters calibration
mode
2-10 Instruments and controls
Type B (if so equipped)
Press and hold
Feature:
the
(Press button again for about 1
button for
second to change settings)
about:
1 second
Compass toggles on/off
8 seconds
Compass zone can be changed
to correct false compass readings
10 seconds
Compass enters calibration
mode
For additional information, refer to “Automatic anti-glare rearview mirror” in the
“Pre-driving checks and adjustments” section of this manual.
WIC0904
Type A (if so equipped
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE DISPLAY
Press the
or
button for about 1
second when the push-button ignition
switch is in the ON position to toggle the
outside temperature and compass direc1 on or off.
tion display O
• To change from °F to °C, press and hold
button for about 5 seconds or
the
button for about 3 seconds until
the
the display begins to flash. Press the button again to toggle between °C and °F.
• The outside temperature sensor is located in front of the radiator. The sensor
may be affected by road or engine heat,
wind direction and other driving conditions. The display may differ from the actual outside temperature or the temperature displayed on various signs or
billboards.
If the display reads “C,” calibrate the compass by driving the vehicle in three complete circles at less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
You can also calibrate the compass by driving your vehicle on your everyday route.
The compass will be calibrated once it has
tracked three complete circles.
COMPASS
LIC0583
Type B (if so equipped
• When the outside temperature is between 140°F (60°C) and 194°F (90°C), the
display will read 140°F (60°C). When the
temperature is above 194°F (90°C), the
display will read “SC.”
• When the outside temperature is between than -40°F (-40°C) and -60°F (-51°C),
the display will read -40°F (-40°C). When
the temperature is below -60°F (-51°C),
the display will read “OC.”
Press the
or
button for about 1
second when the ignition switch is placed
in the ON position to toggle the outside
temperature and compass direction dis1 on or off. The display will indicate
play O
the direction that the vehicle is heading.
N: North
E: East
S: South
W: West
Instruments and controls 2-11
Zone variation change procedure
The difference between magnetic north
and geographical north is known as variance. In some areas, this difference can
sometimes be great enough to cause false
compass readings. Follow these instructions to set the variance for your particular
location if this happens:
button for about
1. Press and hold the
button for about 8
11 seconds or the
seconds. The current zone number will
appear in the display. Release the button.
2. Find your current location on the zone
map. Refer to the illustration.
or the
button re3. Press the
peatedly to toggle through the zone
numbers until the desired number appears in the display. Once you have selected a zone number, the display will
show a compass direction within a few
seconds.
NOTE:
Use zone number 5 for Hawaii.
WIC0355
2-12 Instruments and controls
Inaccurate compass direction
The compass display is equipped with automatic correction function. If the correct
direction is not shown, follow this procedure.
1. With the display turned on, press and
button for about 13 sechold the
button for about 10
onds or the
seconds. The “C” icon in the compass
display will illuminate.
2. Calibrate the compass by driving the vehicle in three complete circles at a maximum speed of 5 mph (8 km/h).
CAUTION
• Do not install a ski rack, antenna, etc.,
which are attached to the vehicle by
means of a magnet. They affect the
operation of the compass.
• When cleaning the mirror, use a paper towel or similar material dampened with glass cleaner. Do not spray
glass cleaner directly on the mirror
as it may cause the liquid cleaner to
enter the mirror housing.
3. After completing the circles, the display
should return to normal.
Instruments and controls 2-13
WARNING LIGHTS, INDICATOR LIGHTS
AND AUDIBLE REMINDERS
Low tire pressure warning light
Front passenger air bag status light
Low windshield-washer fluid warning light
(if so equipped)
High beam indicator light (blue)
NISSAN Intelligent Key® warning light
(if so equipped)
Hill descent control system ON indicator
light (if so equipped)
Automatic transmission check warning light
Seat belt warning light and chime
Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)
Automatic transmission park warning
model)
light (
Shift P (Park) warning light (if so equipped)
Security indicator light (if so equipped)
or
Supplemental air bag warning light
SET indicator light
Charge warning light
4WD shift indicator light (
Slip indicator light
Door open warning light
Automatic transmission position indicator
light
Transfer 4LO position indicator light
model)
(
Electric shift control system warning light
CRUISE indicator light
Turn signal/hazard indicator lights
Engine oil pressure warning light
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system ON indicator light (if so equipped)
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
indicator light
Low fuel warning light
Engine start operation indicator light
(if so equipped)
4WD warning light (
or
or
model)
Anti-lock Braking System
(ABS) warning light
Apply parking brake warning
light
Brake warning light
2-14 Instruments and controls
model)
CHECKING LIGHTS
With all doors closed, apply the parking
brake, fasten the seat belts and place the
ignition switch in the ON position without
starting the engine. The following lights (if
so equipped) will come on:
or
,
,
,
,
The following lights (if so equipped) will
come on briefly and then go off:
,
,
or
,
,
,
,
,
,
.
,
,
,
If any light fails to come on or operate in a
way other than described, it may indicate a
burned-out bulb and/or a system malfunction. Have the system checked. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
WARNING LIGHTS
This vehicle has various warning lights that
may illuminate to indicate a potential problem. For additional information, refer to the
specific light in this section.
4WD warning light
(
model)
The 4WD warning light comes on when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
It turns off soon after the engine is started.
If the engine or vehicle is not functioning
properly, the warning light will either remain illuminated or blink. For additional information, refer to “Using 4–wheel drive
(4WD)” in the “Starting and driving” section
of this manual.
CAUTION
• If the warning light comes on or
blinks during operation, have your
vehicle checked as soon as possible.
It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
• Do not drive on dry hard surface
roads in the 4H or 4LO position. If the
4WD warning light turns on when you
are driving on dry hard surface roads:
– In the 4H position, shift the 4WD
shift switch to 2WD.
– In the 4LO position for automatic
transmission models, stop the vehicle and shift the shift lever to
the N (Neutral) position with the
brake pedal depressed and shift
the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.
• If the warning light is still on after the
above operation, have your vehicle
checked as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
or
Anti-lock Braking
System (ABS)
warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the ABS warning light illuminates
and then turns off. This indicates the ABS is
operational.
If the ABS warning light illuminates while
the engine is running or while driving, it
may indicate the ABS is not functioning
properly. Have the system checked. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
Instruments and controls 2-15
If an ABS malfunction occurs, the anti-lock
function is turned off. The brake system
then operates normally but without antilock assistance. For additional information,
refer to “Brake system” in the “Starting and
driving” section of this manual.
or
Apply parking
brake warning
light (if so
equipped)
This warning light appears when a malfunction occurs in the electric shift control
system below 3 mph (5 km/h).
Have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Automatic Transmission
check warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the light comes on for about 2
seconds. If the light comes on at any other
time, it may indicate the automatic transmission system is not functioning properly.
Have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
2-16 Instruments and controls
Automatic Transmission
Park warning light (
model)
WARNING
• If the ATP light is ON, this indicates
that the automatic transmission P
(Park) position will not function and
the transfer case is in neutral.
• When parking, always make sure that
the 4WD shift indicator light illuminates and the parking brake is set.
Failure to engage the transfer position in 2WD, 4H or 4LO could result in
the vehicle moving unexpectedly, resulting in serious personal injury or
property damage.
• Shift the 4WD switch into the 2WD, 4H
or 4LO position again to turn off the
ATP warning light when the shift lever is in the P position and the ATP
warning light is ON. (Before shifting
the 4WD switch into the 4LO position,
move the shift lever into the N position once, shift the shift lever into P
again and make sure the ATP warning light is OFF.)
This light indicates that the automatic
transmission parking function is not engaged. If the transfer control is not secured
in any drive position while the shift lever is
in the P (Park) position, the transmission will
disengage and the drive wheels will not
lock.
or
Brake warning
light
This light functions for both the parking
brake and the foot brake systems.
Parking brake indicator
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the light comes on when the parking brake is applied.
Low brake fluid warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the light warns of a low brake fluid
level. If the light comes on while the engine
is running with the parking brake not applied, stop the vehicle and perform the following:
1. Check the brake fluid level. Add brake
fluid as necessary. For additional information, refer to “Brake fluid” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
2. If the brake fluid level is correct, have the
warning system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
WARNING
• Your brake system may not be working properly if the warning light is on.
Driving could be dangerous. If you
judge it to be safe, drive carefully to
the nearest service station for repairs. Otherwise, have your vehicle
towed because driving it could be
dangerous.
• Pressing the brake pedal with the engine stopped and/or a low brake
fluid level may increase your stopping distance and braking will require greater pedal effort as well as
pedal travel.
• If the brake fluid level is below the
MINIMUM or MIN mark on the brake
fluid reservoir, do not drive until the
brake system has been checked. It is
recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
Charge warning light
If this light comes on while the engine is
running, it may indicate the charging system is not functioning properly. Turn the
engine off and check the generator belt. If
the belt is loose, broken, or missing, or if the
light remains on, have the system checked.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
CAUTION
• Do not ground electrical accessories
directly to the battery terminal. Doing so will bypass the variable voltage control system and the vehicle
battery may not charge completely.
For additional information, refer to
“Variable voltage control system” in
the “Do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
• Do not continue driving if the generator belt is loose, broken or missing.
Electric shift control system
warning light
This light illuminates when a malfunction
occurs in the electric shift control system.
Have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Engine oil pressure
warning light
This light warns of low engine oil pressure. If
the light flickers or comes on during normal driving, pull off the road in a safe area,
stop the engine immediately and call a
NISSAN dealer or other authorized repair
shop.
The engine oil pressure warning light is
not designed to indicate a low oil level.
Use the dipstick to check the oil level. For
additional information, refer to “Engine oil”
in the “Do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
Door open warning light
This light comes on when any of the doors
are not closed securely while the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
Instruments and controls 2-17
CAUTION
Running the engine with the engine oil
pressure warning light on could cause
serious damage to the engine almost
immediately. Such damage is not covered by the NISSAN New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. Turn off the engine as soon
as it is safe to do so.
Low fuel warning light
This light comes on when the fuel level in
the fuel tank is getting low. Refuel as soon
as it is convenient, preferably before the
fuel gauge reaches E (Empty). There will be
a small reserve of fuel in the tank when
the fuel gauge needle reaches E (Empty).
Low tire pressure warning
light
Your vehicle is equipped with a Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) that monitors the tire pressure of all tires except the
spare.
The low tire pressure warning light warns
of low tire pressure or indicates that the
TPMS is not functioning properly.
2-18 Instruments and controls
After the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, this light illuminates for about 1
second and turns off.
placed in the ON position as long as the low
tire pressure warning light remains illuminated.
Low tire pressure warning
For additional information, refer to “Check
tire pressure warning message” in this section and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section
and in the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
If the vehicle is being driven with low tire
pressure, the warning light will illuminate. A CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure)
warning message is also displayed in the
odometer.
When the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates, you should stop and adjust
the tire pressure of all four tires to the
recommended COLD tire pressure shown
on the Tire and Loading Information label located in the driver's door opening.
The low tire pressure warning light does
not automatically turn off when the tire
pressure is adjusted. After the tire is inflated to the recommended pressure,
the vehicle must be driven at speeds
above 16 mph (25 km/h) to activate the
TPMS and turn off the low tire pressure
warning light. Use a tire pressure gauge
to check the tire pressure.
The low tire pressure warning light remains
illuminated until the tires are inflated to the
recommended COLD tire pressure. The
CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is displayed each time the ignition switch is
TPMS malfunction
If the TPMS is not functioning properly, the
low tire pressure warning light will flash for
approximately 1 minute when the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position. The
light will remain on after 1 minute. Have the
system checked. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
The "CHECK TIRE PRES" warning does not
appear if the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction.
For additional information, refer to “Tire
Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the
“Starting and driving” section and “Tire
pressure” in the “Do-it-yourself” section of
this manual.
WARNING
• Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those
who use a pacemaker should contact
the electric medical equipment
manufacturer for the possible influences before use.
• If the light does not illuminate with
the ignition switch placed in the ON
position, have the vehicle checked as
soon as possible. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
• If the light illuminates while driving,
avoid sudden steering maneuvers or
abrupt braking, reduce vehicle
speed, pull off the road to a safe location and stop the vehicle as soon as
possible. Driving with under-inflated
tires may permanently damage the
tires and increase the likelihood of
tire failure. Serious vehicle damage
could occur and may lead to an accident and could result in serious personal injury or death. Check the tire
pressure for all four tires. Adjust the
tire pressure to the recommended
COLD tire pressure show on the Tire
and Loading Information label located in the driver’s door opening to
turn the low tire pressure warning
light off. If the light still illuminates
while driving after adjusting the tire
pressure, a tire may be flat or the
TPMS may be malfunctioning. If you
have a flat tire, replace it with a spare
tire as soon as possible. If no tire is
flat and all tires are properly inflated,
have the vehicle checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• When replacing a wheel without the
TPMS such as the spare tire, the TPMS
will not function and the low tire
pressure warning light will flash for
approximately 1 minute. The light will
remain on after 1 minute. Have your
tires replaced and/or TPMS system
reset as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for these services.
• Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the
TPMS.
CAUTION
• The TPMS is not a substitute for the
regular tire pressure check. Be sure
to check the tire pressure regularly.
• If the vehicle is being driven at
speeds of less than 16 mph (25 km/h),
the TPMS may not operate correctly.
• Be sure to install the specified size of
tires to the four wheels correctly.
Low windshield-washer
fluid warning light (if so
equipped)
This light comes on when the windshieldwasher fluid is at a low level. Add
windshield-washer fluid as necessary. For
additional information, refer to “Windshieldwasher fluid” in the “Do-it-yourself” section
of this manual.
Instruments and controls 2-19
NISSAN Intelligent Key®
warning light (if so
equipped)
After the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, this light comes on for about 2
seconds and then turns off. This light illuminates or blinks as follows:
• The light blinks in yellow when the door is
closed with the Intelligent Key left outside
the vehicle and the ignition switch in the
ON position. Make sure that the Intelligent
Key is inside the vehicle.
• The light blinks in green when the Intelligent Key battery is running out of power.
Replace the battery with a new one. For
additional information, refer to “Battery”
in the “Do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
• The light illuminates in yellow when it
warns of a malfunction with the electrical
steering lock system or the Intelligent Key
system.
If the warning light illuminates in yellow
while the engine is stopped, it may be impossible to free the steering lock or to start
the engine. If the light comes on while the
engine is running, you can drive the vehicle.
However, in these cases, have the vehicle
checked and repaired as soon as possible.
2-20 Instruments and controls
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN
Intelligent Key®” in the “Pre-driving checks
and adjustments” section of this manual.
Seat belt warning light and
chime
The light and chime remind you to fasten
your seat belts. The light illuminates whenever the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position and remains illuminated until the
driver's seat belt is fastened. At the same
time, the chime sounds for about 6 seconds unless the driver's seat belt is securely fastened.
The seat belt warning light may also illuminate if the front passenger's seat belt is not
fastened when the front passenger's seat
is occupied. For 7 seconds after the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position, the system does not activate the warning light for
the front passenger.
For additional information, refer to “Seat
belts” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and
supplemental restraint system” section of
this manual.
Shift P (Park) warning light
(if so equipped)
This light blinks red and the key reminder
chime sounds if the shift lever is in any
position other than P (Park) and the ignition
switch is in the OFF position. Return the
shift lever to P (Park) with the ignition
switch in the OFF position and the warning
light along with the chime will turn off. For
additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the “Pre-driving checks
and adjustments” section of this manual.
Supplemental air bag
warning light
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, the supplemental air bag warning
light illuminates for about 7 seconds and
then turns off. This means the system is
operational.
If any of the following conditions occur, the
front air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag,
and pretensioner seat belt systems need
servicing:
• The supplemental air bag warning light
remains on after approximately 7 seconds.
• The supplemental air bag warning light
flashes intermittently.
• The supplemental air bag warning light
does not come on at all.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for these services.
Unless checked and repaired, the supplemental restraint system (air bag system)
and/or the pretensioner(s) may not function properly. For additional information, refer to “Supplemental Restraint System
(SRS)” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and
supplemental restraint system” section of
this manual.
WARNING
If the supplemental air bag warning
light is on, it could mean that the front
air bag, side air bag, curtain air bag
and/or pretensioner systems will not
operate in an accident. To help avoid
injury to yourself or others, have your
vehicle checked as soon as possible. It
is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
INDICATOR LIGHTS
This vehicle has various indicator lights
that may illuminate to indicate a system
status. For additional information, refer to
the specific light in this section.
4WD shift indicator light
(
model)
The light should turn off within 1 second
after placing the ignition switch in the ON
position.
While the engine is running, the 4WD shift
indicator light will illuminate the position
selected by the 4WD shift switch.
The 4WD shift indicator light may blink
while shifting from one drive mode to
the other.
Automatic transmission
position indicator light
For additional information, refer to “Driving
the vehicle” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
CRUISE indicator light
The light comes on when the cruise control
ON/OFF switch is pushed. The light goes
out when the ON/OFF switch is pushed
again. When the CRUISE indicator light
comes on, the cruise control system is operational. For additional information, refer
to “Cruise control” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
Electronic locking rear
differential (E-Lock) system
ON indicator light (if so
equipped)
This light comes on when the electronic
locking rear differential (E-Lock) system
clutch is fully engaged.
The indicator light flashes when the system is first turned on. When the system fully
engages, the light remains on. If the switch
is on and the indicator light continues to
flash, the system is not engaged.
For additional information, refer to “Electronic
locking rear differential (E-Lock) system
switch” in this section and “Electronic locking
rear differential (E-Lock) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
Engine start operation
indicator light (if so
equipped)
For vehicles equipped with push-button ignition this indicator illuminates when the ignition switch is in the LOCK, OFF or ON position
with the shift lever in the P (Park) position.
This indicator means that the engine will
start by pushing the push-button ignition
switch with the brake pedal depressed.
Instruments and controls 2-21
Front passenger air bag
status light
The front passenger air bag status light
will be lit and the passenger front air
bag will be off depending on how the front
passenger seat is being used.
For additional information, refer to “Front
passenger air bag and status light” in the
“Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
High beam indicator light
(blue)
This blue light comes on when the headlight high beams are on and goes out when
the low beams are selected.
The high beam indicator light also comes
on when the passing signal is activated.
Hill descent control system
ON indicator light (if so
equipped)
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, this light comes on briefly and
then turns off.
The light comes on when the hill descent
control system is activated.
2-22 Instruments and controls
If the hill descent control switch is on and
the indicator light blinks, the system is not
engaged.
If the indicator light does not come on
when the hill descent switch is on, the system may not be functioning properly. Have
the system checked. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
For additional information, refer to “Hill descent control switch” in this section and “Hill
descent control system” in the “Starting
and driving” section of this manual.
Malfunction Indicator Light
(MIL)
If this indicator light comes on steady or
blinks while the engine is running, it may
indicate a potential emission control malfunction.
The MIL may also come on steady if the
fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, or if the
vehicle runs out of fuel. Check to make sure
the fuel-filler cap is installed and closed
tightly, and that the vehicle has at least 3
gal (11.4 L) of fuel in the fuel tank.
light
After a few driving trips, the
should turn off if no other potential emission control system malfunction exists.
If this indicator light comes on steady for 20
seconds and then blinks for 10 seconds
when the engine is not running, it indicates
that the vehicle is not ready for an emission
control system inspection/maintenance
test. For additional information, refer to
“Readiness for inspection/maintenance
(I/M) test” in the “Technical and consumer
information” section of this manual.
Operation
The MIL will come on in one of two ways:
• MIL on steady — An emission control system malfunction has been detected.
Check the fuel-filler cap if the LOOSE FUEL
CAP warning appears in the trip computer. If the fuel-filler cap is loose or missing, tighten or install the cap and conlight
tinue to drive the vehicle. The
should turn off after a few driving trips. If
light does not turn off after a few
the
driving trips, have the vehicle inspected. It
is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service. You do not need to
have your vehicle towed to the dealer.
• MIL blinking — An engine misfire has been
detected which may damage the emission control system. To reduce or avoid
emission control system damage:
– Do not drive at speeds above 45 mph
(72 km/h).
– Avoid hard acceleration or deceleration.
– Avoid steep uphill grades.
– If possible, reduce the amount of cargo
being hauled or towed.
The MIL may stop blinking and come on
steady. Have the vehicle inspected. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service. You do not need to have
your vehicle towed to the dealer.
SET indicator light
The light comes on while the vehicle speed
is controlled by the cruise control system. If
the light blinks while the engine is running,
it may indicate the cruise control system is
not functioning properly. Have the system
checked. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
Slip indicator light
CAUTION
Continued vehicle operation without
having the emission control system
checked and repaired as necessary
could lead to poor driveability, reduced
fuel economy, and possible damage to
the emission control system.
Security indicator light
(if so equipped)
This light blinks when the ignition switch is
in the OFF, LOCK or ACC position. This function indicates the security systems
equipped on the vehicle are operational.
For additional information, refer to “Security
systems” in this section.
This indicator will blink when the VDC system is operating, thus alerting the driver to
the fact that the road surface is slippery
and the vehicle is nearing its traction limits.
You may feel or hear the system working;
this is normal.
The light will blink for a few seconds after
the VDC system stops limiting wheel spin.
indicator light also comes on
The
when you place the ignition switch in the
ON position. The light will turn off after approximately 2 seconds if the system is operational. If the light does not come on
have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Transfer 4LO position
indicator light
(
model)
This light comes on when the 4WD shift
switch is set in the 4LO position with the
ignition switch in the ON position.
The transfer case may be damaged if you
shift the switch while driving.
Make sure the transfer 4LO position indicator light turns on when you shift the 4WD
shift switch to 4LO.
The indicator light may blink while shifting from one drive mode to the other.
The 4LO indicator light must stop blinking
and remain illuminated or turn off before
shifting the transmission into gear. If the
shift lever is shifted from the N (Neutral)
position to any other gear when the 4LO
indicator light is blinking, the vehicle may
move unexpectedly.
When you shift between 4H and 4LO, follow
the instructions below:
• Stop the vehicle and move the shift lever
to the N (Neutral) position with the brake
pedal depressed, then depress and turn
the 4WD shift switch to 4LO or 4H.
Instruments and controls 2-23
You cannot move the transfer 4WD shift
switch between 4H and 4LO unless you
stop the vehicle and move the shift lever to
the N (Neutral) position with the brake
pedal depressed.
Turn signal/hazard
indicator lights
The appropriate light flashes when the turn
signal switch is activated.
NOTE:
In case of turn signal light bulb malfunction, the turn signal will flash at a higher
frequency when the turn signal switch is
activated.
Both lights flash when the hazard switch is
turned on.
Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) OFF indicator light
This indicator light comes on when the
VDC OFF switch is pushed to the OFF position, the transfer case is in the 4LO position
model), or when the VDC system is
(
not functioning properly. This indicates the
VDC system is not operating.
Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart
the engine and the system will operate
2-24 Instruments and controls
normally. For additional information, refer
to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system”
in the “Starting and driving” section of this
manual.
The VDC light also comes on when the
push-button ignition switch is in the ON
position. The light will turn off after about 2
seconds if the system is operational. If the
light stays on or comes on along with the
indicator light while you are driving,
have the VDC system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
If the battery is removed or discharged, the
VDC system is disabled and the VDC indicator light will not turn off after 2 seconds
when the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position. To reset the system, you must
perform the reset procedure. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
If the light does not go off after performing
the reset procedure, have the traction control system checked. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
While the VDC system is operating, you
might feel slight vibration or hear the system working when starting the vehicle or
accelerating, but this is normal.
The VDC system will be disabled and the
VDC light will illuminate when the electronic locking rear differential (E-lock) system switch (if so equipped) is turned on
and the E-lock system is engaged. If the
E-lock system disengages or the switch is
turned off, the VDC system will be enabled
and the VDC light will turn off.
AUDIBLE REMINDERS
Brake pad wear warning
The disc brake pads have audible wear
warnings. When a disc brake pad requires
replacement, it makes a high pitched
scraping sound when the vehicle is in motion, whether or not the brake pedal is depressed. Have the brakes checked as soon
as possible if the warning sound is heard.
Light reminder chime
With the ignition switch placed in the OFF
position, a chime sounds when the driver's
door is opened if the headlights or parking
lights are on.
Turn the headlight control switch off before
leaving the vehicle.
SECURITY SYSTEMS (if so equipped)
NISSAN Intelligent Key® door
buzzer
VEHICLE SECURITY SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
The Intelligent Key door buzzer sounds if
any one of the following improper operations is found.
• The Intelligent Key is left inside the vehicle
when locking the doors.
• The Intelligent Key is taken outside the
vehicle when operating the vehicle.
The vehicle security system provides visual
and audible alarm signals if someone
opens the doors when the system is
armed. It is not, however, a motion
detection-type system that activates
when a vehicle is moved or when a vibration occurs.
When the buzzer sounds, be sure to check
both the vehicle and the Intelligent Key. For
additional information, refer to “NISSAN Intelligent Key®” in the “Pre-driving checks
and adjustments” section of this manual.
The system helps deter vehicle theft but
cannot prevent it, nor can it prevent the
theft of interior or exterior vehicle components in all situations. Always secure your
vehicle even if parking for a brief period.
Never leave your keys in the vehicle, and
always lock the vehicle when unattended.
Be aware of your surroundings, and park in
secure, well-lit areas whenever possible.
LIC3766
Your vehicle may have two types of security
systems:
• Vehicle security system (if so equipped)
• NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System (if so
equipped)
Many devices offering additional protection, such as component locks, identification markers, and tracking systems, are
available at auto supply stores and specialty shops. A NISSAN dealer may also offer
such equipment. Check with your insurance company to see if you may be eligible
for discounts for various theft protection
features.
Instruments and controls 2-25
How to arm the vehicle security
system
1. Close all windows. (The system can be
armed even if the windows are open.)
2. Remove the Intelligent Key from the
vehicle.
3. Close all doors. Lock all doors. The doors
can be locked with the key, power door
lock switch (if the door is opened, locked
and then closed), or with the key fob.
Key fob operation:
button on the key fob. All
• Press the
doors lock. The hazard lights flash twice
and the horn beeps once to indicate all
doors are locked.
button is pressed with all
• When the
doors locked, the hazard lights flash twice
and the horn beeps once as a reminder
that the doors are already locked.
The horn may or may not beep. For additional information, refer to “Silencing the
horn beep feature” in the “Pre-driving
checks and adjustments” section of this
manual.
2-26 Instruments and controls
indicator light
4. Confirm that the
indicator light
comes on. The
stays on for about 30 seconds. The vehicle security system is now pre-armed.
After about 30 seconds the vehicle security system automatically shifts into
indicator
the armed phase. The
light begins to flash once every 3 seconds. If, during the 30-second pre-arm
time period, the driver's door is unlocked
by the key or the key fob or the ignition
switch is placed in ACC or ON position,
the system will not arm.
• If the key is turned slowly when locking
the driver's door, the system may not
arm. Furthermore, if the key is turned
beyond the vertical position toward
the unlock position the system may be
disarmed when the key is removed. If
the indicator light fails to glow for a
period of time, unlock the door once
and lock it again.
• Even when the driver and/or passengers are in the vehicle, the system will
arm with all doors closed and locked
with the ignition switch placed in the
OFF position.
Vehicle security system activation
The vehicle security system will give the
following alarm:
• The headlights blink and the horn sounds
intermittently.
• The alarm automatically turns off after a
period of time. However, the alarm reactivates if the vehicle is tampered with
again. The alarm can be shut off by unlocking the driver's door with the key or
button on the key
by pressing the
fob.
The alarm is activated by:
• Opening a door without using the key or
key fob (even if the door is unlocked by
using the inside lock knob or the power
door lock switch).
How to stop an activated alarm
The alarm stops only by unlocking the driver's door with the key or by pressing the
button on the key fob.
NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
FCC Notice:
The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
will not allow the engine to start without
the use of a registered key.
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions; (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of
the device.
If the engine fails to start using a registered
key (for example, when interference is
caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the
engine using the following procedures:
1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds.
2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or
LOCK position, and wait approximately
10 seconds.
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.
4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered
key.
If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN
recommends placing the registered key on
a separate key ring to avoid interference
from other devices.
For USA:
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user's authority to operate the equipment.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry
Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
LIC0474
Security indicator light (if so
equipped)
This light blinks when the ignition switch is
placed in the LOCK position.
This function indicates the NISSAN Vehicle
Immobilizer System is operational.
If the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System is
malfunctioning, the light will remain on
while the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position.
Instruments and controls 2-27
WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
4 to have one sweep
Push the lever up O
operation (MIST) of the wiper.
If the light still remains on and/or the
engine will not start, seek service for the
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System as
soon as possible. Please bring all registered keys that you have. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
5 to operate the
Pull the lever toward you O
washer. The wiper will also operate several
times.
WARNING
In freezing temperatures the washer
solution may freeze on the windshield
and obscure your vision which may
lead to an accident. Warm the windshield with the defroster before you
wash the windshield.
LIC3775
SWITCH OPERATION
The windshield wiper and washer operates
when the ignition switch is in the ON position.
Push the lever down to operate the wiper
at the following speed:
1
䊊
2
䊊
3
䊊
2-28 Instruments and controls
Intermittent (INT) — intermittent operation can be adjusted by turning the
A (Slower) or O
B (Faster)
knob toward O
Low (LO) — continuous low speed
operation
High (HI) — continuous high speed
operation
CAUTION
• Do not operate the washer continuously for more than 30 seconds.
• Do not operate the washer if the reservoir tank is empty.
REAR WINDOW OR OUTSIDE MIRROR
DEFROSTER SWITCH (if so equipped)
The rear window/outside mirror defroster
(if so equipped) automatically turns off after approximately 15 minutes.
CAUTION
When cleaning the inner side of the rear
window, be careful not to scratch or
damage the rear window defroster.
LIC1419
LIC3279
Type A (if so equipped)
To defrost the rear window glass (if so
equipped), place the ignition switch in the
ON position and push the rear window defroster switch on. The rear window defroster indicator light on the switch comes
on. Push the switch again to turn the defroster off.
Type B (if so equipped)
To defrost the outside mirrors (if so
equipped), place the ignition switch in the
ON position and push the outside mirror
defroster switch on. The outside mirror defroster indicator light on the switch comes
on. Push the switch again to turn the defroster off.
Instruments and controls 2-29
HEADLIGHT AND TURN SIGNAL
SWITCH
WIC1424
Type A (if so equipped)
HEADLIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
Lighting
1
䊊
2
䊊
Rotate the switch to the
position,
and the front parking, tail, license plate,
and instrument panel lights will come
on.
Rotate the switch to the
position,
and the headlights will come on and all
the other lights remain on.
2-30 Instruments and controls
WIC1452
Type B (if so equipped)
CAUTION
Use the headlights with the engine running to avoid discharging the vehicle
battery.
WIC1426
Type C (if so equipped)
To turn on the autolight system:
1. Turn the headlight switch to the AUTO
1 .
position O
2. Place the ignition switch in the ON
position.
3. The autolight system automatically
turns the headlights on and off.
Initially, if the ignition switch is placed in the
OFF position and a door is opened and left
open, the headlights remain on for a period
of time. If another door is opened while the
headlights are on, then the timer is reset.
LIC0561
Autolight system (if so equipped)
The autolight system allows the headlights
to be set so they turn on and off automatically. The autolight system can:
• Turn on the headlights, front parking, tail,
license plate and instrument panel lights
automatically when it is dark.
• Turn off all the lights when it is light.
• Keep all the lights on for a period of time
after you place the ignition switch in the
OFF position and all doors are closed.
To turn the autolight system off, turn the
, or
position.
switch to the OFF,
The headlights will turn on automatically at
twilight or in rainy weather (when the windshield wiper is operated continuously).
If the ignition switch is pushed to the OFF
position and one of the doors is opened
and this condition is continued, the headlights remain on for 5 minutes.
LIC0835
Be sure you do not put anything on top
1 located in the
of the autolight sensor O
top side of the instrument panel. The autolight sensor controls the autolight; if it
is covered, the autolight sensor reacts as
if it is dark out and the headlights will
illuminate. If this occurs while parked
with the engine off and the switch in the
ON position, your vehicle's battery could
become discharged.
Instruments and controls 2-31
Battery saver system
LIC0562
Headlight beam select
1
䊊
2
䊊
3
䊊
To select the high beam function, ensure the low beams are engaged and
push the lever forward. The high beam
light illumilights come on and the
nates. For additional information, refer
to “Headlight control switch” in this
section.
Pull the lever back to return to the low
beams.
Pulling and releasing the lever flashes
the headlight high beams on and off.
The low beams need not be engaged
for this function.
2-32 Instruments and controls
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHTS (DRL)
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
The battery saver system automatically
turns off the following lights after a period
of time when the ignition switch is placed in
the OFF position and the doors are closed:
• Headlights, when the headlight switch is
or
position
in the
• Interior lights, when left in the ON position
(if so equipped)
The DRL system automatically illuminates
when the engine is started with the parking
brake released. The DRL system operates
with the headlight switch in the OFF posiposition. Turn the headtion or in the
position for full
light switch to the
illumination when driving at night.
After the headlights automatically turn off
or
with the headlight switch in the
position, the headlights will illuminate
again if the headlight switch is moved to
the OFF position and then turned to the
or
position.
If the parking brake is applied before the
engine is started, the DRL system does not
illuminate. The DRL system illuminates
when the parking brake is released. The
DRL system will remain on until the ignition
switch is placed in the OFF position.
CAUTION
Even though the battery saver feature
automatically turns off the headlights
after a period of time, you should turn
the headlight switch to the OFF position when the engine is not running to
avoid discharging the vehicle battery.
WARNING
When the DRL system is active, tail
lights on your vehicle are not on. It is
necessary at dusk to turn on your
headlights. Failure to do so could cause
an accident injuring yourself and others.
LIC4382
LIC0563
INSTRUMENT BRIGHTNESS
CONTROL
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
Turn signal
The instrument brightness control operates when the headlight control switch is in
or
the AUTO (if so equipped),
position.
1
䊊
A to adjust the brightTurn the control O
ness of the instrument panel lights when
driving at night.
Move the lever up or down to signal the
turning direction. When the turn is completed, the turn signal cancels
automatically.
Lane change signal
2
䊊
Move the lever up or down until the turn
signal begins to flash, but the lever
does not latch, to signal a lane change.
Hold the lever until the lane change is
complete.
LIC0393
FOG LIGHT SWITCH (if so equipped)
To turn the fog lights on, turn the headlight
position, then turn the
switch to the
position.
fog light switch to the
To turn the fog lights on with the headlight
switch in the AUTO position (if so equipped),
the headlights must be on, then turn the
position.
fog light switch to the
To turn the fog lights off, turn the fog light
switch to the OFF position.
Instruments and controls 2-33
HORN
CARGO LAMP SWITCH
The headlights must be on and the low
beams selected for the fog lights to operate. The fog lights automatically turn off
when the high beam headlights are selected.
WIC1449
LIC0616
To sound the horn, push the area between
the horn icons on the steering wheel.
To turn on the cargo lamp, push the switch
down to the ON position.
WARNING
Do not disassemble the horn. Doing so
could affect proper operation of the
supplemental front air bag system.
Tampering with the supplemental
front air bag system may result in serious personal injury.
2-34 Instruments and controls
CAUTION
Be sure to turn the light switch to the
OFF position when you leave the vehicle for extended periods of time, otherwise the battery will go dead.
HEATED SEAT SWITCHES (if so
equipped)
3. When the seat is warmed or before you
leave the vehicle, be sure to turn the
switch off.
WARNING
Do not use or allow occupants to use
the seat heater if you or the occupants
cannot monitor elevated seat temperatures or have an inability to feel
pain in body parts that contact the
seat. Use of the seat heater by such
people could result in serious injury.
LIC3762
The front seats are warmed by built-in
heaters.
1. Place the ignition switch in the ON
position.
2. Push the LO or HI position of the switch,
as desired, depending on the temperature. The indicator light in the switch will
illuminate.
The heater is controlled by a thermostat,
automatically turning the heater on and
off. The indicator light will remain on as
long as the switch is on.
CAUTION
• Any liquid spilled on the heated seat
should be removed immediately with
a dry cloth.
• When cleaning the seat, never use
gasoline, benzine, thinner, or any
similar materials.
• If any malfunctions are found or the
heated seat does not operate, turn
the switch off and have the system
checked. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
• The battery could run down if the
seat heater is operated while the engine is not running.
• Do not use the seat heater for extended periods or when no one is using the seat.
• Do not put anything on the seat
which insulates heat, such as a blanket, cushion, seat cover, etc. Otherwise, the seat may become
overheated.
• Do not place anything hard or heavy
on the seat or pierce it with a pin or
similar object. This may result in
damage to the heater.
Instruments and controls 2-35
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)
OFF SWITCH
HILL DESCENT CONTROL SWITCH (if
so equipped)
Push the VDC OFF switch again or restart
the engine to turn on the system. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
LIC3344
The vehicle should be driven with the VDC
system on for most driving conditions.
If the vehicle is stuck in mud or snow, the
VDC system reduces the engine output to
reduce wheel spin. The engine speed will
be reduced even if the accelerator is depressed to the floor. If maximum engine
power is needed to free a stuck vehicle,
turn the VDC system off.
To turn off the VDC system, push the VDC
indicator will come
OFF switch. The
on.
2-36 Instruments and controls
LIC0743
WARNING
• Never rely solely on the hill descent
control system to control vehicle
speed when driving on steep downhill grades. Always drive carefully
when using the hill descent control
system and decelerate the vehicle
speed by depressing the brake pedal
if necessary. Be especially careful
when driving on frozen, muddy or extremely steep downhill roads. Failure
to control vehicle speed may result in
a loss of control of the vehicle and
possible serious injury or death.
ELECTRONIC LOCKING REAR
DIFFERENTIAL (E-Lock) SYSTEM
SWITCH (if so equipped)
• The hill descent control may not control the vehicle speed on a hill under
all load or road conditions. Always be
prepared to depress the brake pedal
to control vehicle speed. Failure to do
so may result in a collision or serious
personal injury.
CAUTION
When the hill descent control system operates continuously for a long time, the
temperature of the brake pads may increase and the hill descent control system may be temporarily disabled (the indicator light will blink). If the indicator
light does not come on continuously after blinking, stop using the system.
The hill descent control system is designed
to reduce driver workload when going down
steep hills. The hill descent control system
helps to control vehicle speed so the driver
can concentrate on steering the vehicle.
To activate the hill descent control system:
• The shift lever must be in forward or reverse gear,
• The 4WD switch must be in the 4L position and the vehicle speed must be under
15 mph (25 km/h) or
• The 4WD switch must be in the 4H position and the vehicle speed must be under
21 mph (35 km/h), and
• The hill descent control system switch
must be ON.
The hill descent control system ON indicator light will come on when the system is
activated. Also, the stop/tail lights illuminate while the hill descent control system
applies the brakes to control vehicle speed.
If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed
while the hill descent control system is on,
the system will stop operating temporarily.
As soon as the accelerator or brake pedal is
released, the hill descent control system begins to function again if the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled.
The hill descent control system ON indicator light blinks if the switch is on and all
conditions for system activation are not
met or if the system becomes disengaged
for any reason.
To turn off the hill descent control system,
push the switch to the OFF position.
For additional information, refer to “Hill descent control system ON indicator light” in
this section and “Hill descent control system” in the “Starting and driving” section of
this manual.
LIC0729
The E-Lock system can help provide added
traction if the vehicle is stuck or becoming
stuck.
To activate the E-Lock system:
• The 4WD switch must be in the 4LO position (4-Wheel Drive vehicles),
• The vehicle must be stopped or moving
at 4 mph (7 km/h) or less, and
• The E-Lock system switch must be
turned on.
Instruments and controls 2-37
REAR SONAR SYSTEM (RSS) OFF
SWITCH (if so equipped)
When the E-Lock switch is turned on, the
indicator light will flash until the system
engages. However, if all operation conditions listed above are not met or the system becomes disengaged, the indicator
light will continue to flash.
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) is disabled and the ABS light illuminates when
the E-Lock system is on. Also, the Vehicle
Dynamic Control (VDC) system is disabled
and the VDC light illuminates when the
E-Lock system is on.
For additional information, refer to “Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock) system” in the “Starting and driving” section of
this manual for further explanation and
system limitations.
WARNING
• Never leave the E-Lock system on
when driving on paved or hardsurfaced roads. Turning the vehicle
may result in the rear wheels slipping
and result in an accident and personal injury. After using the E-Lock
system to free the vehicle, turn the
system off.
2-38 Instruments and controls
• Use the E-Lock system only when
freeing a stuck vehicle. Try the 4LO
position before using the E-Lock system. Never use the E-Lock system on
a slippery road surface such as snow
or ice surface. Using the E-Lock system when driving in these road conditions may cause unexpected
movement of the vehicle during engine braking, accelerating or turning,
which may result in an accident and
serious personal injury.
CAUTION
• After using the E-Lock system, turn
the switch off to prevent possible
damage to driveline components
from extended use.
• Do not drive over 12 mph (20 km/h)
when the system is engaged. Doing
so could result in possible damage to
the driveline.
• Do not turn on the E-Lock system
while the tires are spinning. Doing so
could damage drivetrain components.
LIC0471
WARNING
The Rear Sonar System is a convenience but it is not a substitute for
proper backing. Always turn and check
that it is safe to do so before backing
up. Always back up slowly.
The RSS (if so equipped) is active when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position
and the shift lever is in R (Reverse).
When sensors detect obstacles within 6 ft
(1.8 m) of the rear bumper, a beeping tone is
emitted.
POWER OUTLETS
The RSS can be disabled by pushing the
OFF switch. When the system is disabled,
the indicator light on the switch will illuminate.
The system will automatically reset the
next time the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position.
For additional information, refer to “Rear
Sonar System (RSS)” in the “Starting and
driving” section in this manual.
LIC4418
Front row
The power outlets are for powering electrical accessories such as cellular telephones. They are rated at 12 volt, 120W (10A)
maximum.
The power outlets are powered only when
the ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position.
Open the cap to use a power outlet.
LIC0761
Center console
CAUTION
• The outlet and plug may be hot during or immediately after use.
• Only certain power outlets are designed for use with a cigarette lighter
unit. Do not use any other power outlet for an accessory lighter. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for additional information.
Instruments and controls 2-39
STORAGE
• Do not use with accessories that exceed a 12 volt, 120W (10A) power draw.
• Do not use double adapters or more
than one electrical accessory.
• Use power outlets with the engine
running to avoid discharging the vehicle battery.
• Avoid using power outlets when the
air conditioner, headlights or rear
window defroster is on.
• Before inserting or disconnecting a
plug, be sure the electrical accessory
being used is turned off.
• Push the plug in as far as it will go. If
good contact is not made, the plug
may overheat or the internal temperature fuse may open.
• When not in use, be sure to close the
cap. Do not allow water or any other
liquids to contact the outlet.
2-40 Instruments and controls
WIC0824
FRONT-DOOR POCKETS
LIC0826
Type A (if so equipped)
REAR-DOOR POCKETS
WARNING
To ensure proper operation of the passenger’s NISSAN Advanced Air Bag System, please observe the following
items:
• Do not allow a passenger in the rear
seat to push or pull on the seatback
pocket or head restraint/headrest.
• Do not place heavy loads heavier
than 9.1 lbs. (4 kg) on the seatback,
head restraint/headrest or in the
seatback pocket.
LIC0825
Type B (if so equipped)
LIC1328
SEATBACK POCKET (if so
equipped)
A seatback pocket may be located on the
back of the driver's seat. The pocket may
be used to store maps.
Instruments and controls 2-41
WARNING
LIC4496
Rear row under-seat storage bin
(King Cab® model)
UNDER-SEAT STORAGE BINS (if so
equipped)
2-42 Instruments and controls
LIC4497
Rear row under-seat storage bin
(Crew Cab model)
• Properly secure all cargo with ropes
or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or
collision, unsecured cargo could
cause personal injury.
• The cargo restrained in the underseat storage bins must not exceed
the weight limits listed below or the
bins may not stay secured. In a sudden stop or collision, the unsecured
bins could cause personal injury.
King Cab® model: 16 lbs. (7.25 kg)
Crew Cab model
Driver’s side: 16 lbs. (7.25 kg)
Passenger’s side: 25 lbs. (11.33 kg)
• If the under-seat storage bins are removed for any reason, they should be
securely stored to prevent them from
causing injury to passengers or damage to the vehicle in case of sudden
braking or an accident.
• Do not place sharp objects in the
under-seat storage bins. Such objects may become dangerous projectiles and cause injury when the vehicle is moving or if the vehicle is
involved in a collision.
To access the under-seat storage bins:
To install the under-seat storage bins:
For King Cab® models, lift up the jump seat.
For additional information, refer to “Jump
seat” in the “Safety—Seats, seat belts and
supplemental restraint system” section of
this manual.
1. Position the under-seat storage bin so
the holes line up with the holes in the
floorboard.
2. Insert the knobs and turn them to the
1 .
LOCK position O
For Crew Cab models, lift up the rear bench
seat. For additional information, refer to
“Folding the rear bench seat down” in the
“Safety—Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
LIC0822
To remove the under-seat storage bins:
1. Turn the knobs to the UNLOCK position
2 .
O
2. Remove the tray by lifting it out of the
storage bin (King Cab® model).
Instruments and controls 2-43
LIC1539
Top center tray
STORAGE TRAYS
LIC4419
Instrument panel
WARNING
Do not place sharp objects in the trays
to help prevent injury in an accident or
sudden stop.
LIC0768
GLOVE BOX
To open the top portion of the glove box,
A up and raise the lid.
push the latch O
To open the lower portion of the glove box,
B down and lower the lid.
pull the handle O
WARNING
Keep the glove box lid closed while
driving to help prevent injury in an accident or a sudden stop.
2-44 Instruments and controls
WARNING
Keep the sunglasses holder closed
while driving to avoid obstructing the
driver’s view and to help prevent an accident.
CAUTION
LIC0766
CONSOLE BOX
1 to open the console
Pull up on the lever O
2 .
box lid O
LIC3387
• Do not use for anything other than
sunglasses.
• Do not leave sunglasses in the sunglasses holder while parking in direct
sunlight. The heat may damage the
sunglasses.
OVERHEAD SUNGLASSES
STORAGE
To open the sunglasses holder, push and
release.
Only store one pair of sunglasses in the
holder.
Instruments and controls 2-45
WARNING
• The cup holder should not be used
while driving so full attention may be
given to vehicle operation.
• Avoid abrupt starting and braking
when the cup holder is being used to
prevent spilling the drink. If the liquid
is hot, it can scald you or your
passenger.
CAUTION
LIC4420
Front
CUP HOLDERS
The front cup holders have adapters that
can be removed to accommodate larger
cups.
Use only soft cups in the cup holder.
Hard objects can injure you in an
accident.
WIC0771
Rear seat (rear of front console)
To open the rear row cup holders (rear of
the front console), lower the lid. To close,
raise the lid. If stepped on, the cup holder is
designed to snap loose from the console.
To re-install, close the cup holder assembly
and push it back into the console opening.
To fold the rear seat back, first close the cup
holder.
2-46 Instruments and controls
CAUTION
• Do not use the bottle holder for any
other objects that could be thrown
about in the vehicle and possibly injure people during sudden braking or
an accident.
• Do not use the bottle holder for open
liquid containers.
LIC0784
Front bottle holders
WIC0828
Rear bottle holders
Instruments and controls 2-47
• Heavy loading of the roof rack has
the potential to affect the vehicle
stability and handling during sudden
or abnormal handling maneuvers.
• Roof rack load should be evenly
distributed.
• Do not exceed maximum roof rack
load weight capacity.
• Properly secure all cargo with ropes
or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or
collision, unsecured cargo could
cause personal injury.
CAUTION
Use care when placing or removing
items from the roof rack. If you cannot
comfortably lift the items onto the roof
rack from the ground, use a ladder or
stool.
WIC0857
ROOF RACK (if so equipped)
WARNING
• Drive extra carefully when the vehicle
is loaded at or near the cargo carrying capacity, especially if the significant portion of that load is carried on
the roof rack.
2-48 Instruments and controls
Always evenly distribute the cargo on the
tubular roof rack. The maximum total
load is 125 lbs. (56 kg) evenly distributed.
Be careful that your vehicle does not exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight Ratings
(GAWR front and rear). The GVWR and GAWR
are located on the F.M.V.S.S. label (located
WINDOWS
on the driver's side door jamb pillar). For
additional information, refer to “Vehicle
loading information” in the “Technical and
consumer information” section of this
manual.
The front crossbar can be adjusted or removed. Use the TORX® driver provided in
the tool kit to loosen both crossbar adjusting screws.
To adjust:
1. Loosen the adjusting screws with the
1
by turning counterTORX® driver O
A .
clockwise O
2. When the clamp is loosened, move the
crossbar so the cargo can be positioned
B .
on the crossbar O
3. Tighten the crossbar adjusting screws
with the TORX® driver by turning
clockwise.
To remove:
1. Loosen the adjusting screws with the
1
by turning counterTORX® driver O
A .
clockwise O
C .
2. Rotate the clamps O
3. Remove the crossbar.
4. Reverse to install.
5. Always check the tightness of the crossbar adjusting screws.
If you hear wind noise coming from the roof
rack while driving, adjust the roof rack
crossbar to the neutral position.
LIC3352
MANUAL WINDOWS (if so
equipped)
The side windows can be opened or closed
by turning the hand crank on each door.
4. Secure the cargo with rope.
5. Always check the tightness of the crossbar adjusting screws.
Instruments and controls 2-49
POWER WINDOWS (if so equipped)
To open a window, push the switch and
hold it down. To close a window, pull the
switch and hold it up. To stop the opening
or closing function at any time, simply release the switch.
WARNING
• Make sure that all passengers have
their hands, etc., inside the vehicle
while it is in motion and before closing the windows. Use the window
lock switch to prevent unexpected
use of the power windows.
• To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent door lock activation, do not
leave children, people who require
the assistance of others or pets unattended in your vehicle. Additionally,
the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm day can quickly become high enough to cause a significant risk of injury or death to people
and pets.
The power windows operate when the ignition switch is placed in the ON position or
for a period of time after the ignition switch
is placed in the ACC or OFF position. If the
driver's or passenger's door is opened during this period of time, the power to the
windows is canceled.
2-50 Instruments and controls
LIC1329
1. Window lock button
2. Power door lock switch
3. Front passenger side window switch
4. Right rear passenger window switch
(Crew Cab models only)
5. Left rear passenger window switch
(Crew Cab models only)
6. Driver's side automatic switch
Driver's side power window switch
The driver's side control panel is equipped
with switches to open or close the front
and rear passenger windows.
WIC0260
LIC2663
LIC0410
Front passenger's power window
switch
Rear power window switch (Crew
Cab models only)
Automatic operation (if so
equipped)
The passenger's window switch operates
only the corresponding passenger's window. To open the window, push the switch
1 . To close the window,
and hold it down O
2 .
pull the switch up O
The rear power window switches open or
close only the corresponding passenger
window. To open the window, push the
1 . To close the
switch and hold it down O
2 .
window, push the switch up O
To fully open a window equipped with automatic operation, push the window
switch down to the second detent and release it; it need not be held. The window
automatically opens all the way. To stop
the window, lift the switch up while the window is opening.
Locking passengers' windows
When the window lock switch is depressed,
only the driver's side window can be
opened or closed. Push it again to cancel
the window lock function.
Instruments and controls 2-51
MOONROOF (if so equipped)
• Do not place objects through the
opened rear window. Do not use the
rear window as a cargo area passthrough. This may result in damage
to the rear window system or personal injury.
Squeeze the handles of the lever
2 .
slide the window open O
1 , then
O
LIC3488
REAR SLIDING WINDOW (if so
equipped)
WARNING
• You must ensure all occupants and
objects are free of the rear window
area prior to and during operation.
Failure to do so may result in injury
and/or damage to the rear window
system.
• The rear window is not designed to
carry long items through it.
2-52 Instruments and controls
WIC0882
Type A (if so equipped)
POWER MOONROOF
Sliding the moonroof
To fully open the moonroof, push the
1 .
switch toward DOWN/OPEN O
To fully close the moonroof, push the
2 .
switch toward UP/CLOSE O
To open or close the moonroof part way,
push the switch in any direction while the
moonroof is sliding to stop it in the desired
position.
Tilting the moonroof
LIC4422
Type B (if so equipped)
The moonroof will only operate when the
ignition switch is in the ON position. The
power moonroof is operational for about
45 seconds, even if the ignition switch is
placed in the ACC or OFF position. If the
driver's door or the front passenger's door
is opened during this period of about 45
seconds, power to the moonroof is canceled.
Close the moonroof by pushing the switch
2 . Release the switch,
toward UP/CLOSE O
then push the UP/CLOSE switch again to
tilt the moonroof up.
To tilt the moonroof down, push the switch
1 .
toward DOWN/OPEN O
Auto-reverse function (when
closing or tilting down the
moonroof)
The auto-reverse function can be activated when the moonroof is closed or
tilted down by automatic operation when
the ignition switch is placed in the ON position or for a period of time after the ignition switch is placed in the OFF position.
Depending on the environment or driving conditions, the auto-reverse function may be activated if an impact or
load similar to something being caught
in the moonroof occurs.
WARNING
There are some small distances immediately before the closed position
which cannot be detected. Make sure
that all passengers have their hands,
etc., inside the vehicle before closing
the moonroof.
When closing
If the control unit detects something
caught in the moonroof as it moves to the
front, the moonroof will immediately open
backward.
Instruments and controls 2-53
INTERIOR LIGHTS
When tilting down
If the control unit detects something
caught in the moonroof as it tilts down, the
moonroof will immediately tilt up.
If the auto-reverse function malfunctions
and repeats opening or tilting up the
moonroof, keep pushing the tilt down
switch within 5 seconds after it happens;
the moonroof will fully close gradually.
Make sure nothing is caught in the moonroof.
CAUTION
• Remove water drops, snow, ice or
sand from the moonroof before
opening.
• Do not place heavy objects on the
moonroof or surrounding area.
If the moonroof does not close
Have your moonroof checked and repaired. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
WARNING
• In an accident you could be thrown
from the vehicle through an open
moonroof. Always use seat belts and
child restraints.
• Do not allow anyone to stand up or
extend any portion of their body out
of the moonroof opening while the
vehicle is in motion or while the
moonroof is closing.
Sunshade
Open and close the sunshade by sliding it
forward or backward.
LIC0789
Type A (if so equipped)
The interior lights have a three-position
switch and operate regardless of ignition
switch position.
1 ,
When the switch is in the ON position O
the interior lights illuminate, regardless of
door position. The lights will go off after a
period of time unless the ignition switch is
in the ON position.
When the switch is in the O (DOOR) position
2 , the interior lights will stay on for a peO
riod of time when:
2-54 Instruments and controls
LIC0792
LIC0630
Type B (if so equipped)
• The doors are unlocked by the key fob, a
key or the power door lock switch while
all doors are closed and the ignition
switch is in the OFF position.
• The driver’s door is opened and then
closed while the key is removed from the
vehicle.
Type C (if so equipped)
The lights will turn off automatically after a
period of time while doors are open to prevent the battery from becoming discharged.
The lights will turn off while the timer is
activated when:
• The driver’s door is locked by the key fob,
a key, or the power door lock switch.
• The ignition switch is turned on.
3 ,
When the switch is in the OFF position O
the interior lights do not illuminate, regardless of door position.
CAUTION
LIC4383
MAP LIGHTS
To turn the map lights on, press the lenses.
To turn them off, press the lenses of the
lights again.
CAUTION
Do not use for extended periods of time
with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery.
Do not use for extended periods of time
with the engine stopped. This could result in a discharged battery.
Instruments and controls 2-55
HOMELINK® UNIVERSAL
TRANSCEIVER (if so equipped)
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver provides a convenient way to consolidate the
functions of up to three individual handheld transmitters into one built-in device.
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver:
• Will operate most radio frequency devices such as garage doors, gates, home
and office lighting, entry door locks and
security systems.
• Is powered by your vehicle's battery. No
separate batteries are required. If the vehicle's battery is discharged or is disconnected, HomeLink® will retain all programming.
When the HomeLink® Universal Transceiver is programmed, retain the original
transmitter for future programming procedures (Example: new vehicle purchases). Upon sale of the vehicle, the
programmed
HomeLink®
Universal
Transceiver buttons should be erased for
security purposes. For additional information,
refer
to
“Programming
HomeLink®” in this section.
2-56 Instruments and controls
WARNING
• Your vehicle's engine should be
turned off while programming the
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver. Do
not breathe exhaust gases; they contain colorless and odorless carbon
monoxide. Carbon monoxide is dangerous. It can cause unconsciousness or death.
• Do not use the HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver with any garage door
opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by federal
safety standards. (These standards
became effective for opener models
manufactured after April 1, 1982). A
garage door opener which cannot
detect an object in the path of a closing garage door and then automatically stop and reverse, does not meet
current federal safety standards. Using a garage door opener without
these features increases the risk of
serious injury or death.
• During the programming procedure
your garage door or security gate will
open and close (if the transmitter is
within range). Make sure that people
or objects are clear of the garage
door, gate, etc. that you are
programming.
PROGRAMMING HOMELINK®
If you have any questions or are having
difficulty programming your HomeLink®
buttons, refer to the HomeLink® web site at:
www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515.
NOTE:
Place the ignition switch in the ON position (without starting the engine) when
programming HomeLink®. It is also recommended that a new battery be placed
in the hand-held transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLink®
for quicker programming and accurate
transmission of the radio frequency.
LIC2365
LIC2366
1. Position the end of your hand-held
transmitter 1–3 in (2–8 cm) away from
the HomeLink® surface, keeping the
1 in view.
HomeLink® indicator light O
2. Using both hands, simultaneously press
and hold the desired HomeLink® button
and hand-held transmitter button. DO
NOT release until the HomeLink® indica1 flashes slowly and then raptor light O
idly. When the indicator light flashes rapidly, both buttons may be released. (The
rapid flashing indicates successful
programming.)
NOTE:
Some devices may require you to replace
Step 2 with the cycling procedure noted
in “Programming HomeLink® for Canadian customers and gate openers” in this
section.
3. Press and hold the programmed
HomeLink® button and observe the indicator light.
1
is solid/
• If the indicator light O
continuous, programming is complete and your device should activate
when the HomeLink® button is
pressed and released.
1 blinks rapidly
• If the indicator light O
for 2 seconds and then turns to a
solid/continuous light, continue
with Steps 4-6 for a rolling code device. A second person may make the
following steps easier. Use a ladder or
other device. Do not stand on your vehicle to perform the next steps.
4. At the receiver located on the garage
door opener motor in the garage, locate
the “learn” or “smart” button (the name
and color of the button may vary by
manufacturer but it is usually located
near where the hanging antenna wire is
attached to the unit). If there is difficulty
locating the button, reference the garage door opener’s manual.
5. Press and release the “learn” or “smart”
button.
Instruments and controls 2-57
NOTE:
Once the button is pressed, you have approximately 30 seconds to initiate the
next step.
6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press
and hold the trained HomeLink® button
for 2 seconds and release. Repeat the
“press/hold/release” sequence up to
three times to complete the training
process. HomeLink® should now activate your rolling code equipped device.
7. If you have any questions or are having
difficulty programming your HomeLink®
buttons, refer to the HomeLink® web site
at:
www.homelink.com
or
call
1-800-355-3515.
PROGRAMMING HOMELINK® FOR
CANADIAN CUSTOMERS AND GATE
OPENERS
Canadian radio-frequency laws require
transmitter signals to “time-out” (or quit)
after several seconds of transmission –
which may not be long enough for
HomeLink® to pick up the signal during
training. Similar to this Canadian law, some
U.S. gate operators are designed to “timeout” in the same manner.
2-58 Instruments and controls
If you live in Canada or you are having difficulties training a gate operator or garage
door opener by using the “Training” procedures, replace “Programming HomeLink®”
step 2 with the following:
NOTE:
When programming a garage door
opener, etc., unplug the device during
the “cycling” process to prevent possible
damage to the garage door opener
components.
1. For additional information, refer to “Programming HomeLink®” step 1 in this
section.
2. Using both hands, simultaneously press
and hold the desired HomeLink® button
and the hand-held transmitter button.
During training, your hand-held transmitter may automatically stop transmitting. Continue to press and hold the desired HomeLink® button while you press
and re-press (“cycle”) your hand-held
transmitter every 2 seconds until the
frequency signal has been learned. The
HomeLink® indicator light will flash
slowly and then rapidly after several
seconds upon successful training. DO
NOT release until the HomeLink® indicator light flashes slowly and then rapidly.
When the indicator light flashes rapidly,
both buttons may be released. The rapid
flashing indicates successful training.
Proceed
with
“Programming
HomeLink®” step 3 to complete.
If the device was unplugged during the
programming procedure, remember to
plug it back in when programming is
completed.
OPERATING THE HOMELINK®
UNIVERSAL TRANSCEIVER
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver, after
it is programmed, can be used to activate
the programmed device. To operate, simply press and release the appropriate programmed HomeLink® Universal Transceiver button. The amber indicator light will
illuminate while the signal is being transmitted.
For convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the device may also be used at any
time.
PROGRAMMING TROUBLEDIAGNOSIS
CLEARING THE PROGRAMMED
INFORMATION
If the HomeLink® does not quickly learn the
hand-held transmitter information:
• Replace the hand-held transmitter batteries with new batteries.
• Position the hand-held transmitter with
its battery area facing away from the
HomeLink® surface.
• Press and hold both the HomeLink® and
hand-held transmitter buttons without
interruption.
• Position the hand-held transmitter 1 - 3
inches (26 - 76 mm) away from the
HomeLink® surface. Hold the transmitter
in that position for up to 15 seconds. If
HomeLink® is not programmed within
that time, try holding the transmitter in
another position – keeping the indicator
light in view at all times.
The following procedure clears the programmed information from both buttons.
Individual buttons cannot be cleared. However, individual buttons can be reprogrammed. For additional information, refer
to “Reprogramming a single HomeLink®
button” in this section.
If you have any questions or are having
difficulty programming your HomeLink®
buttons, refer to the HomeLink® web site at:
www.homelink.com or call 1-800-355-3515.
REPROGRAMMING A SINGLE
HOMELINK® BUTTON
To clear all programming:
1. Press and hold the two outer HomeLink®
buttons until the indicator light begins to
flash in approximately 10 seconds. Do
not hold for longer than 20 seconds.
2. Release both buttons.
HomeLink® is now in the programming
mode and can be programmed at any
time beginning with “Programming
HomeLink®” - Step 1.
To reprogram a HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver button, complete the following:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink®
button. DO NOT release the button.
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without releasing the
HomeLink® button, proceed with “Programming HomeLink®” - Step 1.
For questions or comments, contact
HomeLink® at: www.homelink.com or
1–800–355–3515 (except Mexico).
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver button has now been reprogrammed. The
new device can be activated by pressing
the HomeLink® button that was just programmed. This procedure will not affect
any other programmed HomeLink® buttons.
IF YOUR VEHICLE IS STOLEN
If your vehicle is stolen, you should change
the codes of any non-rolling code device
that has been programmed into
HomeLink®. Consult the Owner's Manual of
each device or call the manufacturer or
dealer of those devices for additional information.
When your vehicle is recovered, you will
need to reprogram the HomeLink® Universal Transceiver with your new transmitter information.
Instruments and controls 2-59
FCC Notice:
For USA:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause interference, and (2) this
device must accept any interference received, including interference that may
cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry
Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
2-60 Instruments and controls
3 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-2
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Doors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4
Locking with key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Locking with inside lock knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-5
Locking with power door lock switch . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Rear doors (King Cab® models) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-6
Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
Child safety rear door lock
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-8
How to use the remote keyless entry
function . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9
Warning signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-11
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12
Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13
Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
Tilt operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16
Vanity mirrors (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Manual anti-glare rearview mirror
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17
Automatic anti-glare rearview mirror . . . . . . . . 3-18
Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19
Truck box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20
Bed extender (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-24
Tie down hooks (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25
KEYS
As many as four Intelligent Keys can be
registered and used with one vehicle. The
new keys must be registered prior to the
use with the Intelligent Key system and
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System of your
vehicle. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service. Since the
registration process requires erasing all
memory in the Intelligent Key components
when registering new keys, be sure to take
all Intelligent Keys that you have to the
NISSAN dealer.
LPD3123
1. Intelligent Key
2. Mechanical key
3. Master key
4. Key number plate
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
Your vehicle can only be driven with the
Intelligent Keys which are registered to
your vehicle’s Intelligent Key system components and NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer
System components.
A key number plate is supplied with your
keys. Record the key number and keep it in
a safe place (such as your wallet), not in the
vehicle. If you lose your keys, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
duplicates by using the key number.
NISSAN does not record key numbers so it
is very important to keep track of your key
number plate.
A key number is only necessary when you
have lost all keys and do not have one to
duplicate from. If you still have a key, it can
be duplicated without knowing the key
number.
Never leave the keys in the vehicle.
3-2 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
CAUTION
Listed below are conditions or occurrences which will damage the Intelligent Key:
• Do not allow the Intelligent Key,
which contains electrical components, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect the
system function.
• Do not drop the Intelligent Key.
• Do not strike the Intelligent Key
sharply against another object.
• Do not change or modify the Intelligent Key.
• Wetting may damage the Intelligent
Key. If the Intelligent Key gets wet,
immediately wipe until it is completely dry.
• Do not place the Intelligent Key for an
extended period in an area where
temperatures exceed 140°F (60°C).
• Do not attach the Intelligent Key with
a key holder that contains a magnet.
• Do not place the Intelligent Key near
equipment that produces a magnetic
field, such as a TV, audio equipment
and personal computers.
If an Intelligent Key is lost or stolen, NISSAN
recommends erasing the ID code of that
Intelligent Key from the vehicle. This may
prevent the unauthorized use of the Intelligent Key to operate the vehicle. For information regarding the erasing procedure, it
is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer.
CAUTION
Always carry the mechanical key installed in the Intelligent Key slot.
For additional information, refer to “Doors”
and “Truck box” in this section and “Storage”
in the “Instruments and controls” section of
this manual.
Valet hand-off
When you have to leave a key with a valet,
give them the Intelligent Key itself and keep
the mechanical and master keys with you
to protect your belongings.
SPA1951
Mechanical key
The Intelligent Key contains the mechanical key.
To remove the mechanical key, release the
lock knob on the back of the Intelligent Key.
To install the mechanical key, firmly insert it
into the Intelligent Key until the lock knob
returns to the lock position.
Use the mechanical key to lock or unlock
the driver's door, tailgate and glove box.
To prevent the glove box and tailgate from
being opened during valet hand-off, follow
the procedures below:
1. Remove the mechanical key from the
Intelligent Key.
2. Lock the glove box and tailgate with the
mechanical key.
3. Hand the Intelligent Key without the mechanical key to the valet, keep the mechanical and master keys with you.
For additional information, refer to ”Truck
box” in this section and Storage” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-3
DOORS
NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM KEYS
You can only drive your vehicle using the
Intelligent Keys which are registered to the
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System components in your vehicle.
The mechanical key can be used for all the
locks.
Never leave the keys in the vehicle.
Additional or replacement keys:
If you still have a key, the key number is not
necessary when you need extra NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys. Your existing
key can be duplicated without knowing the
key number. As many as four NISSAN Vehicle
Immobilizer System keys can be used with
one vehicle. You should bring all NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System keys that you have
to the NISSAN dealer for registration. This is
because the registration process will erase
the memory of all key codes previously registered into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer
System. After the registration process, these
components will only recognize keys coded
into the NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
during registration. Any key that is not given
to the dealer at the time of registration will
no longer be able to start your vehicle.
3-4 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
CAUTION
Do not allow the immobilizer system
key, which contains an electrical transponder, to come into contact with water or salt water. This could affect system function.
When the doors are locked using one of the
following methods, the doors cannot be
opened using the inside or outside door
handles. The doors must be unlocked to
open the doors.
WARNING
• Always have the doors locked while
driving. Along with the use of seat
belts, this provides greater safety in
the event of an accident by helping to
prevent persons from being thrown
from the vehicle. This also helps keep
children and others from unintentionally opening the doors, and will
help keep out intruders.
• Before opening any door, always look
for and avoid oncoming traffic.
• To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, including
entrapment in windows or inadvertent door lock activation, do not leave
children, people who require the assistance of others or pets unattended in
your vehicle. Additionally, the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a
warm day can quickly become high
enough to cause a significant risk of
injury or death to people and pets.
2 of
Turning the key 1 time toward the rear O
the vehicle unlocks that door. From that
3
position, returning the key to neutral O
(where the key can only be removed and
4
inserted) and turning it toward the rear O
again within 5 seconds unlocks all doors.
For additional information, refer to “Security
systems” in the “Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
LPD0240
Driver's side
LPD0298
Inside lock
LOCKING WITH KEY
LOCKING WITH INSIDE LOCK KNOB
The power door lock system allows you to
lock or unlock all doors at the same time
using the master or mechanical key.
To lock the door without the key, move the
1 ,
inside lock knob to the lock position O
then close the door.
1 of the
Turning the key toward the front O
vehicle locks all the doors and activates the
security system.
To unlock the door without the key, move
the inside lock knob to the unlock position
2 .
O
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-5
Lockout protection
When a door opens, the power door lock
switch is moved to the lock position and
the Intelligent key is left in the vehicle, all
doors will lock and then unlock automatically. This helps to prevent the keys from
being accidently locked inside the vehicle.
WPD0381
LOCKING WITH POWER DOOR
LOCK SWITCH
To lock all the doors without a key, push the
door lock switch (driver's or front passen1 . When
ger's side) to the lock position O
locking the door this way, be certain not to
leave the key inside the vehicle.
To unlock all the doors without a key, push
the door lock switch (driver's or front pas2 .
senger's side) to the unlock position O
3-6 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD0278
REAR DOORS (King Cab® models)
1. Open the driver's or passenger's door.
LPD0312
2. From the outside, pull the door handle
A toward you.
O
WPD0313
LPD3124
CHILD SAFETY REAR DOOR LOCK
(if so equipped)
3. Open the door to the desired position.
AUTOMATIC DOOR LOCKS
• All doors lock automatically when the vehicle speed reaches 15 mph (24 km/h).
• All doors unlock automatically when the
transmission is placed in the P (Park) position or when the ignition is switched to
the OFF position.
Child safety locks help prevent the rear
doors from being opened accidentally, especially when small children are in the vehicle.
The child safety lock levers are located on
the edge of the rear doors.
When the lever is in the LOCK position,
the door can be opened only from the
outside.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-7
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
WARNING
• Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those
who use a pacemaker should contact
the electric medical equipment
manufacturer for the possible influences before use.
• The Intelligent Key transmits radio
waves when the buttons are pressed.
The FAA advises the radio waves may
affect aircraft navigation and communication systems. Do not operate
the Intelligent Key while on an airplane. Make sure the buttons are not
operated unintentionally when the
unit is stored for a flight.
The Intelligent Key can operate all the door
locks using the remote control function. The
operating environment and/or conditions
may affect the Intelligent Key operation.
Be sure to read the following before using
the Intelligent Key.
CAUTION
• Be sure to carry the Intelligent Key
with you when operating the vehicle.
• Never leave the Intelligent Key in the
vehicle when you leave the vehicle.
The Intelligent Key is always communicating with the vehicle as it receives radio
waves. The Intelligent Key transmits weak
radio waves. Environmental conditions
may interfere with the operation of the Intelligent Key under the following operating
conditions:
• When operating near a location where
strong radio waves are transmitted, such
as a TV tower, power station and broadcasting station.
• When in possession of wireless equipment, such as a cellular telephone, transceiver, or a CB radio.
• When the Intelligent Key is in contact with
or covered by metallic materials.
• When any type of radio wave remote control is used nearby.
• When the Intelligent Key is placed near an
electric appliance such as a personal
computer.
• When the vehicle is parked near a parking
meter.
In such cases, correct the operating conditions before using the Intelligent Key function or use the mechanical key.
Although the life of the battery varies depending on the operating conditions, the
3-8 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
battery’s life is approximately two years. If
the battery is discharged, replace it with a
new one.
When the Intelligent Key battery is low, the
NISSAN Intelligent Key® warning light will
blink after the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position.
Since the Intelligent Key is continuously receiving radio waves, if the key is left near
equipment which transmits strong radio
waves, such as signals from a TV and personal computer, the battery life may become shorter.
When the battery is discharged, firmly apply
the foot brake and touch the ignition switch
with the Intelligent Key. Then push the ignition switch while depressing the brake pedal
within 10 seconds after the chime sound. For
additional information, refer to “Push-button
ignition switch” in the “Starting and driving”
section of this manual.
For additional information, refer to “Battery
replacement” in the “Do-it-yourself” section
of this manual.
As many as four Intelligent Keys can be
registered and used with one vehicle. For
information about the purchase and use of
additional Intelligent Keys, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer.
The remote keyless entry function may not
function under the following conditions:
• When the Intelligent Key is not within the
operational range.
• When the doors are open or not closed
securely.
• When the Intelligent Key battery is discharged.
CAUTION
1. Press the
button on the Intelligent
Key to unlock the driver’s door.
LPD3600
(lock) button
2.
(unlock) button
3.
(panic) button
HOW TO USE THE REMOTE
KEYLESS ENTRY FUNCTION
The remote keyless entry function can operate all door locks using the remote keyless function of the Intelligent Key. The remote keyless function can operate at a
distance of 99 ft (30 m) away from the vehicle. The operating distance depends
upon the conditions around the vehicle.
After locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure that the doors have
been securely locked by operating the
door handles. Failure to follow these instructions may result in inadvertently
unlocking the doors, which may decrease the safety and security of your
vehicle.
Unlocking doors
When locking the doors using the Intelligent Key, be sure not to leave the key
in the vehicle.
1.
WARNING
Locking doors
2. The hazard warning lights flash once.
1. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK
position.
button again within 5
3. Press the
seconds to unlock all doors.
All doors will be locked automatically unless one of the following operations is performed within 1 minute after pressing the
button:
• Opening any doors.
• Pushing the ignition switch.
2. Close all doors.
3. Press the
gent Key.
button on the Intelli-
4. The hazard indicator lights flash twice
and the horn beeps once.
5. All doors will be locked.
The interior lights will illuminate for a period
of time when a door is unlocked and the
interior lights switch is in the O (DOOR) position.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-9
The lights can be turned off without waiting
by performing one of the following operations:
• Placing the ignition switch in the ON position.
• Locking the doors with the Intelligent Key.
• Switching the interior lights switch to the
OFF position.
Using the panic alarm
Answer back horn feature
If you are near your vehicle and feel threatened, you may activate the panic alarm to
call attention by pressing and holding the
button on the Intelligent Key for longer than 0.5 seconds.
If desired, the answer back horn feature
can be deactivated using the Intelligent
Key. When it is deactivated and the
button is pressed, the hazard indicator
button is
lights flash twice. When the
pressed, neither the hazard indicator lights
nor the horn operates.
For additional information, refer to “Interior
lights” in the “Instruments and controls”
section in this manual.
The panic alarm stops when:
• It has run for a period of time.
• Any button is pressed on the Intelligent
Key.
• The request switch (if so equipped) on the
driver or passenger door is pushed and
the Intelligent Key is in range of the door
handle.
The panic alarm and headlights will stay on
for a period of time.
To deactivate:
and
butPress and hold the
tons for at least 2 seconds. The hazard
indicator lights will flash three times to confirm that the answer back horn feature has
been deactivated.
To activate:
and
butPress and hold the
tons for at least 2 seconds once more.
The hazard indicator lights will flash once
and the horn will sound once to confirm
that the horn beep feature has been reactivated.
Deactivating the horn beep feature does
not silence the horn if the alarm is triggered.
3-10 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
If the light does not blink, your battery may
be too weak to communicate to the vehicle. If this occurs, the battery may need to
be replaced. For additional information regarding the replacement of a battery, refer
to “Battery replacement” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
WARNING SIGNALS
LPD2836
Intelligent Key button operation
light
The light blinks only when you press any
button on the Intelligent Key. The light illumination only signifies that the key fob has
transmitted a signal. You may look and/or
listen to verify that the vehicle has performed the intended operation. The number of blinks identifies each registered key
(i.e. 1 blink = 1st key,...,4 blinks = 4th key) for
your own identification purposes.
To help prevent the vehicle from moving
unexpectedly by erroneous operation of
the Intelligent Key or to help prevent the
vehicle from being stolen, a chime or chirp
sounds from inside and outside the vehicle
and a warning is displayed in the instrument panel.
When a chime or beep sounds or a warning
is displayed, be sure to check the vehicle
and the Intelligent Key.
For additional information, refer to
“Troubleshooting guide” in this section and
“Warning lights, indicator lights and audible
reminders” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-11
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Verify the location of all Intelligent Keys that are programmed for the vehicle. If another Intelligent Key is in range or inside the vehicle, the
vehicle system may respond differently than expected.
Symptom
Possible Cause
Remedy
When pushing the ignition switch to
stop the engine
The Shift P (Park) warning light appears
The shift lever is not in the P (Park) poon the display and the inside warning
sition.
chime sounds continuously.
Move the shift lever to the P (Park) position.
When opening the driver's door to get
out of the vehicle
The door open warning light appears
on the display and the inside warning
chime sounds continuously.
Place the ignition switch in the ON position or close the driver’s door.
When closing the door after getting
out of the vehicle
The ignition switch is in the AUTO ACC
position.
The NISSAN Intelligent Key® warning
light appears on the display, the outThe Intelligent Key is not detected inside chime sounds three times and the
side of the vehicle.
inside warning chime sounds for approximately three seconds.
Place the ignition switch in the OFF
position.
The Shift P (Park) warning light appears The ignition switch is in the ACC or OFF
on the display and the inside and out- position and the shift lever is not in the Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
side chimes sound continuously.
P (Park) position.
When closing the door with the inside
lock knob turned to LOCK
When pushing the ignition switch to
start the engine
The outside chime sounds for approximately three seconds and all the doors The Intelligent Key is inside the vehicle.
unlock.
Carry the Intelligent Key with you.
The NISSAN Intelligent Key® warning
light appears on the display.
The battery charge is low.
Replace the battery with a new one.
For additional information, refer to
“Battery replacement” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
The NISSAN Intelligent Key® warning
light appears on the display .
The Intelligent Key is not detected inside of the vehicle.
Carry the registered Intelligent Key
with you.
3-12 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
HOOD
FUEL-FILLER DOOR
WARNING
• Make sure the hood is completely
closed and latched before driving.
Failure to do so could cause the hood
to fly open and result in an accident.
• If you see steam or smoke coming
from the engine compartment, to
avoid injury do not open the hood.
LPD0302
1 lo1. Pull the hood lock release handle O
cated below the driver's side instrument
panel. The hood will spring up slightly.
2
at the front of the
2. Push the lever O
hood to the side as illustrated with your
fingertips and raise the hood.
3. Insert the support rod into the slot on
3 .
the underside of the hood O
When closing the hood, return the hood rod
to its original position. Lower the hood approximately 12 in (30 cm) above the latch
and release it. This allows proper engagement of the hood latch.
LPD2698
FUEL-FILLER CAP
WARNING
• Gasoline is extremely flammable and
highly explosive under certain conditions. You could be burned or seriously injured if it is misused or mishandled. Always stop the engine and
do not smoke or allow open flames or
sparks near the vehicle when
refueling.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-13
• Do not attempt to top off the fuel
tank after the fuel pump nozzle
shuts off automatically. Continued
refueling may cause fuel overflow,
resulting in fuel spray and possibly a
fire.
• Use only an original equipment type
fuel-filler cap as a replacement. It has
a built-in safety valve needed for
proper operation of the fuel system
and emission control system. An incorrect cap can result in a serious
malfunction and possible injury. It
Malfunccould also cause the
tion Indicator Light (MIL) to come on.
• Never pour fuel into the throttle body
to attempt to start your vehicle.
• Do not fill a portable fuel container in
the vehicle or trailer. Static electricity
can cause an explosion of flammable
liquid, vapor or gas in any vehicle or
trailer. To reduce the risk of serious
injury or death when filling portable
fuel containers:
– Always place the container on the
ground when filling.
– Do not use electronic devices
when filling.
– Keep the pump nozzle in contact
with the container while you are
filling it.
– Use only approved portable fuel
containers for flammable liquid.
CAUTION
• Do not use a fuel containing more
than 15% ethanol in your vehicle. For
additional information, refer to “Fuel
recommendation” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section
of this manual.
• The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning will appear if the fuel-filler cap is not properly tightened. It may take a few driving trips for the message to be
displayed. Failure to tighten the fuelfiller cap properly after the LOOSE
FUEL CAP warning appears may
Malfunction Indicator
cause the
Light (MIL) to illuminate.
3-14 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
• Failure to tighten the fuel-filler cap
Malproperly may cause the
function Indicator Light (MIL) to illulight illuminates
minate. If the
because the fuel-filler cap is loose or
missing, tighten or install the cap and
continue to drive the vehicle. The
light should turn off after a few
light does not
driving trips. If the
turn off after a few driving trips, have
your vehicle inspected. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• For additional information, refer to
“Malfunction Indicator Light (MIL)” in
the “Instruments and controls” section in this manual.
• If fuel is spilled on the vehicle body,
flush it away with water to avoid
paint damage.
3. Press the loose fuel cap change/reset
A in the meter for about one
button O
second to turn off the LOOSE FUEL CAP
warning message after tightening the
fuel-filler cap.
For additional information, refer to “Meters
and gauges” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
LPD2699
To remove the fuel-filler cap:
1. Turn the fuel-filler cap counterclockwise
to remove.
LIC4378
LOOSE FUEL CAP warning
message
1. Insert the fuel-filler cap straight into the
fuel-filler tube.
The LOOSE FUEL CAP warning message
displays in the odometer when the fuelfiller cap is not tightened correctly after the
vehicle has been refueled. It may take a few
driving trips for the message to be displayed. To turn off the warning message,
perform the following:
2. Turn the fuel-filler cap clockwise until a
single click is heard.
1. Remove and install the fuel-filler cap as
described above as soon as possible.
2. Put the fuel-filler cap on the cap holder
1 while refueling.
O
To install the fuel-filler cap:
2. Tighten the fuel-filler cap until it clicks.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-15
STEERING WHEEL
SUN VISORS
LPD0304
• Do not adjust the steering wheel any
closer to you than is necessary for
proper steering operation and comfort. The driver’s air bag inflates with
great force. If you are unrestrained,
leaning forward, sitting sideways or
out of position in any way, you are at
greater risk of injury or death in a
crash. You may also receive serious
or fatal injuries from the air bag if you
are up against it when it inflates. Always sit back against the seatback
and as far away as practical from the
steering wheel. Always use the seat
belts.
TILT OPERATION
Pull the lock lever toward the driver and
hold it to adjust the steering wheel up or
down to the desired position.
Release the lock lever to lock the steering
wheel in place.
WARNING
• Do not adjust the steering wheel
while driving. You could lose control
of your vehicle and cause an
accident.
3-16 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
WPD0344
MIRRORS
1. To block glare from the front, swing
1 the main sun visor.
down O
2. To block glare from the side, remove the
main sun visor from the center mount
2 .
and swing the visor to the side O
3 the sun visor, slide in or out
3. To extend O
as needed (if so equipped).
CAUTION
• Do not store the sun visor before returning the extension to its original
position.
• Do not pull the extension sun visor
forcedly downward.
LPD2595
VANITY MIRRORS (if so equipped)
To access the vanity mirror, pull the sun
visor down and flip open the mirror cover.
WPD0126
MANUAL ANTI-GLARE REARVIEW
MIRROR (if so equipped)
1 to reduce glare
Use the night position O
from the headlights of vehicles behind you
at night.
Use the day position
daylight hours.
2
O
when driving in
WARNING
Use the night position only when necessary, because it reduces rear view
clarity.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-17
AUTOMATIC ANTI-GLARE
REARVIEW MIRROR
The inside mirror is designed so that it automatically dims during nighttime conditions and according to the intensity of the
headlights of the vehicle following you. The
automatic anti-glare feature is activated
when the ignition switch is in the ON position.
2 will illuminate when
The indicator light O
the automatic anti-glare feature is operating.
NOTE:
Do not hang any objects over the sen1 or apply glass cleaner to the sensors O
sors. Doing so will reduce the sensitivity
of the sensors, resulting in improper
operation.
LPD2505
LPD2419
Type A (if so equipped)
Type B (if so equipped)
With the ignition switch in the ON position,
button as described:
press the
• To turn off the anti-glare feature, press
button for 8 seconds.
and hold the
The indicator light will turn off.
• To turn on the anti-glare feature, press
button again for 8
and hold the
seconds. The indicator light will turn on.
With the ignition switch in the ON position,
button as described:
press the
• To turn off the anti-glare feature, press
button for 8 seconds.
and hold the
The indicator light will turn off.
• To turn on the anti-glare feature, press
button again for 8
and hold the
seconds. The indicator light will turn on.
For additional information about the com3
and compass features, refer to
pass O
“Compass and outside temperature display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
For additional information about the com3
and compass features, refer to
pass O
“Compass and outside temperature display” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
3-18 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
For additional information on HomeLink®
Universal Transceiver operation, refer to
the “HomeLink® Universal Transceiver” in
the “Instruments and controls” section of
this manual.
OUTSIDE MIRRORS
WARNING
• Objects viewed in the outside mirror
on the passenger side are closer than
they appear. Be careful when moving
to the right. Using only this mirror
could cause an accident. Use the inside mirror or glance over your
shoulder to properly judge distances
to other objects.
• Do not adjust the mirrors while driving. You could lose control of your vehicle and cause an accident.
LPD2825
LPD0237
Manual control type (if so
equipped)
Electric control type (if so
equipped)
The outside mirrors can be moved in any
direction for a better rear view.
The outside mirror remote control will operate only when the ignition switch is
placed in the ACC or ON position.
1 to select the right
Move the small switch O
2 to
or left mirror. Move the large switch O
adjust each mirror to the desired position.
1
to the center
Move the small switch O
(neutral) position to prevent accidentally
moving the mirror.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-19
TRUCK BOX
For additional information on proper truck
box loading, refer to “Vehicle loading information” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
WARNING
LPD0259
Foldable outside mirrors
Pull the outside mirror toward the door to
fold it.
Heated mirrors (if so equipped)
Some outside mirrors can be heated to
defog, defrost or de-ice for improved visibility. For additional information, refer to “Rear
window and outside mirror (if so equipped)
defroster switch” in the “Instruments and
controls” section of this manual.
LPD0270
TAILGATE
Opening the tailgate
Pull the tailgate handle upward and lower
the tailgate. The support cables hold the
tailgate open.
When closing the tailgate, make sure the
latches are securely locked.
Do not drive the vehicle with the tailgate
down, unless equipped with NISSAN's
Bed Extender (accessory) or equivalent
in the extended position.
3-20 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
• Never allow anyone to ride in the
cargo area or on the rear seat when it
is in the folded position. Use of these
areas by passengers without proper
restraints could result in serious injury or death in an accident or sudden stop.
• It is extremely dangerous to ride in a
cargo area inside a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are
more likely to be seriously injured or
killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in any
area of your vehicle that is not
equipped with seats and seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in
a seat and using a seat belt properly.
6. Take the tailgate plug from the glove box
and connect it to the tailgate wiring harness to avoid contamination which will
lead to malfunction of the rear camera.
7. Remove the tailgate. For additional information, refer to “Removing the tailgate”
in this section.
LPD2097
Disconnecting the rear camera
Before removing the tailgate disconnect
the rear camera by performing the following:
1. Open the tailgate to access the rear
1
located
camera connector bracket O
on the rear sill.
2 from
2. Remove the connector bracket O
the sill by pressing the locking tab inward, in the direction shown, while pulling the bracket apart.
3. Disconnect the chassis wiring harness
3
by pressing inward on the locking
O
tab, in the direction shown, while pulling
the connectors apart. Hold the connector firmly to prevent the connector in the
chassis harness from falling into the sill.
4. Use the supplied chassis plug and
bracket and connect them to the chassis wiring harness to avoid contamination to the terminals which will lead to
malfunction of the rear camera.
5. Insert the bracket back into the sill.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-21
2. Hold the tailgate at a 15 degree angle.
3. Pull the tailgate out from the right side
hinge.
4. Slide the tailgate out of the left side
hinge.
Installing the tailgate
1. Insert the tailgate into the left side hinge.
2. Hold the tailgate at a 15 degree angle
and insert into the right side hinge.
LPD2208
Removing the tailgate
3. Continue to hold the tailgate at a 15 degree angle and attach the tailgate support cables.
4. Close the tailgate securely.
1. Release the tailgate support cables.
CAUTION
• The tailgate is heavy. Two people
should remove or install it. Be careful
not to drop it during removal.
• After releasing the support cables,
do not let the tailgate rest on the
bumper.
3-22 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD2097
Connecting the rear camera
Before closing the tailgate reconnect the
rear camera by performing the following:
1. After attaching the rear tailgate to the
truck, keep the tailgate open and check
that the tailgate harness is not hanging
below the tailgate.
2 from
2. Remove the connector bracket O
the sill by pressing the locking tab inward, in the direction shown, while pulling the bracket apart.
3. Disconnect the chassis plug and
bracket from the chassis wiring harness
3 . Keep the connector and bracket in a
O
safe place such as the glove box.
LPD0272
Locking the tailgate
To lock the tailgate, turn the key toward the
1 . To unlock,
passenger side of the vehicle O
2 .
turn the key toward the driver side O
4. Disconnect the tailgate plug from the
tailgate wiring harness. Keep the tailgate plug in a safe place such as the
glove box.
5. Connect the tailgate wiring harness to
the chassis wiring harness.
6. Securely fix the rear camera connector
1 to the rear sill.
bracket O
7. Close the tailgate securely.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-23
BED EXTENDER (if so equipped)
CAUTION
• Do not overload the bed extender.
Maximum load on the open tailgate
is 200 lbs. (890N).
• Evenly distribute and properly secure
all cargo.
• Do not use the bed extender or tailgate to secure cargo.
LPD0480
Positioning the bed extender
To use the bed extender in the inward position perform the following:
1 toward the
1. Rotate the bed extender O
cab of the truck.
2. If necessary, remove tethers from the
tailgate latch.
3. Tighten the knobs to secure the extender into the desired position.
4. Close the tailgate.
5. Place cargo inside the bed extender in
the truck bed.
6. Properly secure the cargo.
3-24 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
LPD0479
To use the bed extender in the outward
position perform the following:
1. Open the tailgate.
2 away from
2. Rotate the bed extender O
the cab of the truck until the extender
sits on the tailgate.
3
into the tailgate
3. Lock the buckles O
latch on both sides.
The bed extender can be adjusted in the
outward position by moving the extender
along the rail.
NOTE:
WARNING
Use care when rotating extender, buckles may come in contact with the truck
bed railing.
Properly secure all cargo with ropes or
straps to help prevent it from sliding or
shifting. In a sudden stop or collision,
unsecured cargo could cause personal
injury.
Removing and installing the bed
extender
To remove or install the bed extender perform the following:
1. Open the tailgate.
2. Rotate the bed extender into a vertical
position and lift straight up (to remove)
or lower straight down (to install).
To store the bed extender in the front of the
truck when not in use perform the following:
1. Position the sliding brackets past the
center of the wheel well.
2. Re-install the extender into the brackets
(see above).
3. Rotate the extender to the inward
position.
4. Push the brackets forward until the extender comes in contact with the front
wall of the truck box.
LTI0102
TIE DOWN HOOKS (if so equipped)
For your convenience, tie down hooks are
placed at each corner of the truck box.
These may be used to help secure cargo
loaded into the truck box.
• The weight of the cargo load must be
evenly distributed over both the front and
the rear axles.
• All cargo should be securely fastened
with ropes or straps to prevent it from
shifting or sliding within the vehicle.
Pre-driving checks and adjustments 3-25
MEMO
3-26 Pre-driving checks and adjustments
4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and
voice recognition systems
Control panel buttons — models without
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
How to use the touch-screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5
MENU button . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7
How to use the
(brightness control) button . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
How to use the VOL (volume) knob /
(power) button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
PUSH
Selecting menu from launch bar . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-9
Control panel buttons — models with
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-10
How to use the touch-screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-11
How to use the BACK button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13
How to use the
button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
How to use the ON-OFF button/VOL
(volume) control knob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
How to use the CAMERA button . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15
RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16
RearView Monitor system operation . . . . . . . . . 4-17
How to read the displayed lines . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-17
Difference between predicted and
actual distances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18
Adjusting the screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-20
RearView Monitor system limitations . . . . . . . . 4-20
System maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21
Vents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Heater and air conditioner (manual)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-22
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23
Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24
Heater operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25
Air conditioner operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26
Air flow charts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27
Heater and air conditioner (automatic)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31
Automatic operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34
Manual operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
Operating tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35
Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-36
AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
Satellite radio reception (if so equipped) . . . . . 4-37
Audio operation precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-37
FM/AM radio (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-44
FM/AM/SAT radio with Compact Disc
(CD) player (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-49
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port (models without Navigation
System) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-55
USB (Universal Serial Bus) connection
port (models with Navigation System)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-58
iPod®* player operation without
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . .4-60
iPod®* player operation with Navigation
System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-63
Bluetooth® streaming audio without
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 4-66
Bluetooth® streaming audio with
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . 4-69
CD care and cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-70
Steering wheel switch for audio control . . . . . 4-71
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
NissanConnect® Mobile Apps (if so equipped) . . 4-72
Registering with NissanConnect®
Mobile Apps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
Connect Phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-72
Application download . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
Siri® Eyes Free (models without Navigation
System) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-73
Operating Siri® Eyes Free . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-75
Siri® Eyes Free (models with Navigation
System) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
Siri® Activation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-76
Operating Siri® Eyes Free . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77
Changing Siri® Eyes Free settings . . . . . . . . . . . 4-77
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-78
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-79
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
without Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . 4-79
Regulatory information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81
Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-81
Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-83
Control buttons . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-83
Connecting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-84
Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-85
Phone display screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-87
Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-88
Receiving a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-88
During a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-89
Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-89
Text messaging (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-89
Bluetooth® connections screen . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-93
Phone and text message settings . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System with
Navigation System (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-96
Regulatory information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-98
Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
Connecting procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
Vehicle phonebook . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-99
Making a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Receiving a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
During a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Ending a call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Text messaging (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-100
Bluetooth® settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-103
Phone settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-104
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-105
NISSAN Voice Recognition System
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106
Using the system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-106
System features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-107
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-108
Navigation System voice commands . . . . . . . 4-109
Audio system voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
Information voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
My Apps voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-109
Help voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-110
iPod®/iPhone® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-111
WARNING
• Positioning of the heating or air conditioning controls and display controls should not be done while driving in order that full attention may be
given to the driving operation.
• Do not disassemble or modify this
system. If you do, it may result in accidents, fire, or electrical shock.
• Do not use this system if you notice
any abnormality, such as a frozen
screen or lack of sound. Continued
use of the system may result in accident, fire or electric shock.
• In case you notice any foreign object
in the system hardware, spill liquid
on it, or notice smoke or smell coming from it, stop using the system immediately. Ignoring such conditions
may lead to accidents, fire or electrical shock. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for
servicing.
4-4 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS —
MODELS WITHOUT NAVIGATION
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
When you use this system, make sure the
engine is running.
If you use the system with the engine not
running for a long time, it will discharge
the battery, and the engine will not start.
Reference symbols:
“Example” — Words marked in quotes refer to
a key shown only on the display. These keys
can be selected by touching the screen.
HOW TO USE THE TOUCH-SCREEN
CAUTION
LHA4680
1.
MENU button
2.
button*
3. Display screen
4.
(brightness control) button
5. VOL (volume) knob / PUSH
(power)
button
* For additional information regarding the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
control button, refer to “Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System without Navigation
System” in this section.
• The glass display screen may break if
it is hit with a hard or sharp object. If
the glass screen breaks, do not touch
it. Doing so could result in an injury.
• To clean the display, never use a
rough cloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner
or any kind of solvent or paper towel
with a chemical cleaning agent. They
will scratch or deteriorate the panel.
• Do not splash any liquid such as water or car fragrance on the display.
Contact with liquid will cause the system to malfunction.
To help ensure safe driving, some functions
cannot be operated while driving.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-5
The on-screen functions that are not available while driving will be “grayed out” or
muted.
WARNING
• ALWAYS give your full attention to
driving.
• Avoid using vehicle features that
could distract you. If distracted, you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident.
LHA5318
Touch-screen operation
Menu Item
Result
” key to
Selecting the item
Touch an item to select. To select the “Phone” key, touch the “Phone” key on the screen. Touch the “
return to the previous screen.
Adjusting the item
Touch the “+” key or the “−” key to adjust the settings of an item. Touch the up arrow to scroll up the page one
item at a time. Touch the down arrow to scroll down the page one item at a time.
Inputting characters
Touch the number key. There are some options available when inputting characters.
123
Touch to manually enter numbers.
OK
Completes the character input.
4-6 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Touch-screen maintenance
If you clean the display screen, use a dry,
soft cloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use a small amount of neutral detergent with a soft cloth. Never spray the
screen with water or detergent. Dampen
the cloth first and then wipe the screen.
LHA5319
HOW TO USE THE
BUTTON
MENU
LHA5318
To select and/or adjust several functions,
features and modes that are available for
your vehicle:
1. Press the
MENU button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the desired item.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-7
Menu item
Settings
Result
Touch to change the following steps.
Connections
Touch this key to select either Bluetooth® phone, Bluetooth® audio or USB audio options. For additional information, refer to “USB connections screen” and “Bluetooth® connections screen” in this section.
Phone
For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System without Navigation System” in this
section.
Sound
For additional information, refer to “Audio system” in this section.
Volume & Beeps
For additional information, refer to “Volume & beeps” in this section.
Clock
Touch this key to adjust clock settings.
On-screen Clock
Touch to toggle ON or OFF the clock display on the upper right corner of the display screen.
Clock Format
Touch to set the clock to 12 hours or 24 hours formats.
Daylight Savings Time
Touch to adjusts the daylight saving time to ON or OFF.
Set Clock Manually
Touch to adjust the clock manually; then touch to change between AM and PM, the hour and the minutes.
System Voice
For additional information, refer to “Settings” in this section.
Camera
Touch this key to change the camera settings.
Others
Touch this key to select and/or adjust various functions of this system. A screen with additional options will
appear.
Display
Touch this key to adjust the appearance of the display. For additional information, refer to “Adjusting the
screen” in this section.
Language
Touch this key to change the language on the display.
OSS Licenses
Touch this key to display software licensing information.
Return All Settings To Default
Touch this key to return all settings to default and to clear the memory.
4-8 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
(brightness control) BUTTON
Touch the keys on the Launch Bar to display the corresponding menu screens.
To change the display brightness, press the
button. Pressing the button again will
change the display to the day or the night
display.
The following menu items are available on
the Launch Bar:
• AM
• FM
• USB/iPod
• Bluetooth
• AUX
• Settings
button for more
Press and hold the
than 2 seconds to turn the display off. Press
and hold the button again to turn the display on.
HOW TO USE THE VOL (volume)
KNOB / PUSH
(power)
BUTTON
Press the PUSH
(power) button to turn
audio function on and off. Turn the VOL
(volume) knob to adjust audio volume.
LHA4707
SELECTING MENU FROM LAUNCH
BAR
Various system functions can be accessed
by touching the items on the Launch Bar
1 which is displayed on most of the main
O
menu screens (the Launch Bar does not
appear on some screens such as settings
screens, camera screens, etc.)
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-9
CONTROL PANEL BUTTONS —
MODELS WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(if so equipped)
10. NAV button*
* For additional information, refer to the
separate NissanConnect® Owner's Manual
regarding the Navigation system control
buttons.
** For additional information, refer to the
“Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
with Navigation System” in this section.
When you use this system, make sure the
engine is running.
If you use the system with the engine not
running (ignition ON or ACC) for a long
time, it will discharge the battery, and
the engine will not start.
Reference symbols:
“Example” — Words marked in quotes refer
to a key shown only on the display. These
keys can be selected by touching the
screen.
LHA3138
1. MAP button*
6. BACK button
2. Display screen
7. ENTER/AUDIO button / TUNE knob
3.
button**
4.
button
5.
(brightness control) button
8. ON-OFF button/VOL (volume) control
knob
9. CAMERA button
4-10 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
HOW TO USE THE TOUCH-SCREEN
CAUTION
• The glass display screen may break if
it is hit with a hard or sharp object. If
the glass screen breaks, do not touch
it. Doing so could result in an injury.
• To clean the display, never use a
rough cloth, alcohol, benzine, thinner
or any kind of solvent or paper towel
with a chemical cleaning agent. They
will scratch or deteriorate the panel.
• Do not splash any liquid such as water or car fragrance on the display.
Contact with liquid will cause the system to malfunction.
To help ensure safe driving, some functions
cannot be operated while driving.
The on-screen functions that are not available while driving will be grayed out or
muted.
Park the vehicle in a safe location and then
operate the navigation system.
WARNING
• ALWAYS give your full attention to
driving.
• Avoid using vehicle features that
could distract you. If distracted, you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident.
LHA3748
Touch-screen operation
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-11
Menu Item
Result
Selecting the item
Touch an item to select . To select the “Audio” key, touch the “Audio” key on the screen. Press the BACK button to
return to the previous screen.
Adjusting the item
Touch the “+” key or the “−” key to adjust the settings of an item. Touch the down arrow to scroll down the page.
Touch the up arrow to scroll up the page.
Inputting characters
Touch the letter or number key. There are some options available when inputting characters.
123/ABC
Changes the available character set to numbers.
Space
Inserts a space.
Delete
Deletes the last inputted character with one touch. Touch and hold the “Delete” key to delete all of the characters.
OK
Completes the character input.
Touch-screen maintenance
If you clean the display screen, use a dry,
soft cloth. If additional cleaning is necessary, use a small amount of neutral detergent with a soft cloth. Never spray the
screen with water or detergent. Dampen
the cloth first and then wipe the screen.
4-12 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
HOW TO USE THE BACK BUTTON
Press the BACK button to return to the previous screen.
LHA2773
HOW TO USE THE
BUTTON
LHA3748
For additional information, refer to the
separate NissanConnect® Owner's Manual
regarding the “SiriusXM® Travel Link” and
“SiriusXM® Traffic” features.
For additional information, refer to
“NissanConnect® Mobile Apps” in this section.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN
Voice Recognition System” in this section.
To select and/or adjust several functions,
features and modes that are available for
your vehicle:
] button.
1. Press the [
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the desired item.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-13
Menu item
Audio
Result
For additional information, refer to “Audio system” in this section.
Navigation
For additional information, refer to the separate NissanConnect® Owner’s Manual.
Phone & Bluetooth
For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System with Navigation System” in this section.
System
Touch this key to select and/or adjust various functions of this system. A screen with additional options will appear.
Display
Touch this key to adjust the appearance of the display.
Brightness
Adjusts the brightness of the display.
Display Mode
Adjusts to fit the level of lighting in the vehicle. Touch key to cycle through options. “Day” and “Night” modes are
suited for the respective times of day while “Auto” controls the display automatically.
Scroll Direction
Adjusts the direction of the menu scroll. Choose to either move up or down.
Clock/Date
Touch this key to adjust the time and date.
Time Format
The clock can be set to 12 hours or 24 hours.
Date Format
Select from two possible formats for displaying the day, month, and year.
Clock Mode
Adjust the mode for the clock. “Auto” uses the system’s GPS to automatically maintain the time. “Manual” allows
you to set the clock using the “Set Clock Manually” key. Select a time zone using the “Time Zone” key.
Set Clock Manually
Adjust the clock manually, Touch the “+” or “-” keys to adjust the hours, minutes, day, month and year up or down.
“Clock Mode” must be set to manual for this option to be available.
Daylight Savings Time
Adjusts the daylight savings time on or off.
Time Zone
Language
Choose the applicable time zone from the list.
Touch this key to change the language on the display.
Camera Settings
Touch this key to change the camera settings.
Display Mode
Touch this key to select the touch-screen display mode (day, night, or automatic).
Brightness
Adjust touch-screen brightness.
Contrast
Adjust touch-screen contrast.
Color
Adjust touch-screen color.
4-14 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Menu item
Result
Temperature Unit
Touch this key to change the temperature unit being displayed (Fahrenheit or Celsius).
Touchscreen click
Toggles the touch-screen click feature on or off. When activated a click sound will be heard every time a key on
the screen is touched.
System Beeps
Toggle the system beep tones feature on or off. When activated, a beep sound will be heard when a pop-up mesbutton) is pressed and held for 2 seconds.
sage appears on the screen or a button on the unit (such as the
Return to Factory Settings/Clear
Memory
Touch this key to return all settings to default and to clear the memory.
Software Licenses
Touch this key to display software licensing information.
Minimize Voice Feedback
Touch this key to turn ON or OFF the control voice feedback.
System Software Version
Touch this key to display software version information.
Traffic
Touch this key display the traffic settings. For additional information, refer to the separate NissanConnect® Owner’s Manual.
SXM
Touch this key to display SXM status information. For additional information, refer to the “Audio System” in this
section.
BUTTON
To change the display brightness, press the
button. Pressing the button again will
change the display to auto or night display
mode.
If no operation is performed within 5 seconds, the display will return to the previous
display.
HOW TO USE THE ON-OFF
BUTTON/VOL (volume) CONTROL
KNOB
Press the ON-OFF button to turn audio
function on and off. Turn the volume control knob to adjust audio volume.
HOW TO USE THE CAMERA
BUTTON
For additional information, refer to “RearView Monitor” in this section.
button for more
Press and hold the
than 2 seconds to turn the display off. Press
the button again to turn the display on.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-15
REARVIEW MONITOR
LHA5768
1. CAMERA button (if so equipped)
WARNING
• Failure to follow the warnings and instructions for proper use of the RearView Monitor system could result in
serious injury or death.
• RearView Monitor is a convenience
feature and is not a substitute for
proper backing. Always turn and look
out the windows and check mirrors
to be sure that it is safe to move before operating the vehicle. Always
back up slowly.
4-16 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• The system is designed as an aid to
the driver in showing large stationary objects directly behind the vehicle, to help avoid damaging the
vehicle.
• The distance guide line and the vehicle width line should be used as a
reference only when the vehicle is on
a level paved surface. The distance
viewed on the monitor is for reference only and may be different than
the actual distance between the vehicle and displayed objects.
CAUTION
Do not scratch the camera lens when
cleaning dirt or snow from the front of
the camera.
The RearView Monitor system automatically shows a rear view of the vehicle when
the shift lever is shifted into the R (Reverse)
position. Press the CAMERA button (if so
equipped) while in the R (Reverse) position
to cycle through guideline options. The radio can still be heard while the RearView
Monitor is active.
LHA3671
To display the rear view, the RearView Monitor system uses a camera located next to
1 .
the tailgate handle O
REARVIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
OPERATION
With the ignition switch in the ON position,
move the shift lever to the R (Reverse) position to operate the RearView Monitor.
LHA4754
HOW TO READ THE DISPLAYED
LINES
Guiding lines which indicate the vehicle
width and distances to objects with referA are disence to the vehicle body line O
played on the monitor.
Distance guide lines
Indicate distances from the vehicle body.
1 : approx. 0.5 m (1.5 ft)
• Red line O
2 : approx. 1 m (3 ft)
• Yellow line O
3 : approx. 2 m (7 ft)
• Green line O
4
Vehicle width guide lines O
Indicate the vehicle width when backing up.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-17
DIFFERENCE BETWEEN PREDICTED
AND ACTUAL DISTANCES
The displayed guidelines and their locations on the ground are for approximate
reference only. Objects on uphill or downhill
surfaces or projecting objects will be actually located at distances different from
those displayed in the monitor relative to
the guidelines (refer to illustrations). When
in doubt, turn around and view the objects
as you are backing up, or park and exit the
vehicle to view the positioning of objects
behind the vehicle.
LHA5181
LHA5182
Backing up on a steep uphill
Backing up on a steep downhill
When backing up the vehicle up a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width
guide lines are shown closer than the actual
distance. Note that any object on the hill is
further than it appears on the monitor.
When backing up the vehicle down a hill, the
distance guide lines and the vehicle width
guide lines are shown farther than the actual
distance. Note that any object on the hill is
closer than it appears on the monitor.
4-18 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
if the object projects over the actual backing up course.
LHA4757
LHA5183
Backing up near a projecting
object
Backing up behind a projecting
object
The vehicle may seem to nearly clear the
object in the display. However, the vehicle
may hit the object if it projects over the
actual backing up course.
C is shown farther than the
The position O
B in the display. However, the poposition O
C is actually at the same distance as
sition O
A . The vehicle may hit the
the position O
A
object when backing up to the position O
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-19
button again to access
5. Press the
the Auto settings.
6. Turn the TUNE knob to adjust the setting
up or down.
• Do not adjust the display settings of the
RearView Monitor while the vehicle is
moving.
REARVIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
LIMITATIONS
WARNING
LHA3522
Models without Navigation System
ADJUSTING THE SCREEN
The procedure for adjusting the display
settings of the screen differs depending on
the type of screen present on the vehicle.
For vehicles without Navigation System
1. While on the main menu screen, touch
the “Settings” key.
2. Touch the “Camera” key.
3. Touch the “Brightness”, “Contrast”, “Tint”
“Color”, or “Black Level” key.
4. Adjust the item by touching the “+” or “-”
key on the touch-screen display.
LHA5033
Models with Navigation System
• Do not adjust the display settings of the
RearView Monitor while the vehicle is
moving.
For vehicles with Navigation System
1. Firmly apply the brake and place the
shift lever in R (Reverse)
2. Press the
panel.
button on the control
3. The screen will display the Night
settings.
4. Turn the TUNE knob to adjust the setting
up or down.
4-20 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Listed below are the system limitations
for RearView Monitor. Failure to operate the vehicle in accordance with
these system limitations could result in
serious injury or death.
• The system cannot completely eliminate blind spots and may not show
every object.
• Underneath the bumper and the corner areas of the bumper cannot be
viewed on the RearView Monitor because of its monitoring range limitation. The system will not show small
objects below the bumper, and may
not show objects close to the bumper or on the ground.
• Objects viewed in the RearView
Monitor differ from actual distance
because a wide-angle lens is used.
• Objects in the RearView Monitor will
appear visually opposite compared
to when viewed in the rearview and
outside mirrors.
• Use the displayed lines as a reference. The lines are highly affected by
the number of occupants, fuel level,
vehicle position, road conditions and
road grade.
• Make sure that the tailgate is securely closed when backing up.
• Do not put anything on the rearview
camera. The rearview camera is installed on the tailgate.
• When washing the vehicle with high
pressure water, be sure not to spray it
around the camera. Otherwise, water
may enter the camera unit causing
water condensation on the lens, a
malfunction, fire or an electric shock.
• Do not strike the camera. It is a precision instrument. Otherwise, it may
malfunction or cause damage resulting in a fire or an electric shock.
The following are operating limitations and
do not represent a system malfunction:
• When the temperature is extremely high
or low, the screen may not clearly display
objects.
• When strong light directly shines on the
camera, objects may not be displayed
clearly.
• Vertical lines may be seen in objects on
the screen. This is due to strong reflected
light from the bumper.
• The screen may flicker under fluorescent
light.
• The colors of objects on the RearView
Monitor may differ somewhat from the
actual color of objects.
• Objects on the monitor may not be clear
in a dark environment.
• There may be a delay when switching
between views.
• If dirt, rain or snow accumulate on the
camera, RearView Monitor may not display objects clearly. Clean the camera.
• Do not use wax on the camera lens. Wipe
off any wax with a clean cloth dampened
with a diluted mild cleaning agent, then
wipe with a dry cloth.
LHA3671
SYSTEM MAINTENANCE
CAUTION
• Do not use alcohol, benzine or thinner to clean the camera. This will
cause discoloration.
• Do not damage the camera as the
monitor screen may be adversely
affected.
If dirt, rain or snow accumulates on the cam1 , the RearView Monitor may not disera O
play objects clearly. Clean the camera by
wiping it with a cloth dampened with a diluted mild cleaning agent and then wiping it
with a dry cloth.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-21
VENTS
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER
(manual) (if so equipped)
WARNING
LHA4512
Adjust air flow direction for the vents directed at the driver's and passenger's side
1 , driver and passenger O
2 , or
windows O
3 by moving the vent slide and/or
center O
vent assemblies. Open or close the driver
and passenger vents by using the dial.
to open the
Move the dial toward the
to close them.
vents or toward the
4-22 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• The air conditioner cooling function
operates only when the engine is
running.
• Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle.
Pets should also not be left alone.
They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent
operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot,
sunny days, temperatures in a closed
vehicle could quickly become high
enough to cause severe or possibly
fatal injuries to people or animals.
• Do not use the recirculation mode for
long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.
NOTE:
• Odors from inside and outside the vehicle can build up in the air conditioner
unit. Odor can enter the passenger
compartment through the vents.
• When parking, set the heater and air
conditioner controls to turn off air recirculation to allow fresh air into the
passenger compartment. This should
help reduce odors inside the vehicle.
WHA1406
CONTROLS
Type A (if so equipped)
5. Temperature control dial
1.
Fan speed control dial
6. Max A/C button
2.
Front window defroster button
7. Air flow control buttons
3.
4.
Rear window defroster switch (if so
equipped)
8. A/C (air conditioner) button
Air recirculation button
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-23
Fan speed control dial
The
fan speed control dial turns the
fan on and off, and controls fan speed.
Air flow control buttons
The air flow control dial or buttons allow
you to select the air flow outlets.
MAX A/C
LHA3167
CONTROLS
Type B (if so equipped)
5. Temperature control dial
1.
Fan speed control dial
6. Max A/C button
2.
Front window defroster button
7. Air flow control buttons
3.
4.
Outside mirror defroster switch (if
so equipped)
8. A/C (air conditioner) button
Air recirculation button
4-24 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
— Air flows from center and side
vents with maximum cooling
(air conditioning).
— Air flows from center and side
vents.
— Air flows from center and side
vents and foot outlets.
— Air flows mainly from foot outlets.
— Air flows from defroster outlets and foot outlets.
— Air flows mainly from defroster outlets.
Temperature control dial
The temperature control dial allows you to
adjust the temperature of the outlet air. To
lower the temperature, turn the dial to the
left. To increase the temperature, turn the
dial to the right.
Air recirculation button
ON position (Indicator light on)
Interior air is recirculated inside the vehicle.
button to the ON position
Press the
when:
• driving on a dusty road.
• to prevent traffic fumes from entering
passenger compartment.
• for maximum cooling when using the air
conditioner.
Rear window or outside mirror
defroster switch (if so equipped)
For additional information about the rear
window or outside mirror defroster switch,
refer to “Rear window or outside mirror defroster switch.” in the “Instruments and
controls” section of this manual.
HEATER OPERATION
Heating
OFF position (Indicator light off)
Outside air is drawn into the passenger
compartment and distributed through the
selected outlet.
This mode is used to direct heated air to
the foot outlets. Some air also flows from
the defrost outlets.
Use the OFF position for normal heater or
air conditioner operation.
fan speed control dial to
2. Turn the
the desired position.
A/C (air conditioner) button
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle
and the hot position.
Start the engine, turn the
fan speed
control dial to the desired position and
button to turn on the air
press the
conditioner. To turn off the air conditioner,
button again.
press the
The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running.
1. Press the
air flow control button.
Ventilation
This mode directs outside air to the side
and center vents.
button to the OFF posi1. Press the
buttion. The indicator light on the
ton will go off.
2. Press the
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
3. Turn the
the desired position.
4. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
Defrosting or defogging
This mode directs the air to the defrost
outlets to defrost/defog the windows.
1. Press the
defrost/defog button.
fan speed control dial to
2. Turn the
the desired position.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle
and the hot position.
• To quickly remove ice or fog from the winfan speed control dial
dows, turn the
to the highest setting and the temperature control to the full HOT position.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-25
• When the
position is selected, the air
conditioner automatically turns on if the
outside temperature is more than 36°F
(2°C). This dehumidifies the air which
helps defog the windshield. The
mode automatically turns off, allowing
outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the
defogging performance. The recirculation mode cannot be activated in the
position.
Bi-level heating
The bi-level mode directs warmed air to
the side and center vents and to the front
and rear floor outlets.
button to the OFF posi1. Press the
buttion. The indicator light on the
ton will go off.
2. Press the
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
3. Turn the
the desired position.
4. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
Heating and defogging
Operating tips
This mode heats the interior and defogs
the windshield.
Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades
and air inlet in front of the windshield.
This improves heater operation.
1. Press the
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
2. Turn the
the desired position.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position between the middle
and the hot position.
position is selected, the
• When the
air conditioner automatically turns on if
the outside temperature is more than
air flow control
36°F (2°C). If the
button is selected for more than 1 minute,
the air conditioning system will continue
fan speed conto operate until the
trol dial is turned to OFF, the vehicle is
shut off, or the A/C button is used to turn
off the compressor even if the air flow
control dial is turned to a position other
position. This dehumidithan the
fies the air which helps defog the windmode automatically
shield. The
turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn
into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.
4-26 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
AIR CONDITIONER OPERATION
Start the engine, turn the
fan speed
control dial to the desired position, and
button to activate the air
press the
conditioner. When the air conditioner is on,
cooling and dehumidifying functions are
added to the heater operation.
The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running.
Cooling
This mode is used to cool and dehumidify
the air.
1. Press the
position.
2. Press the
button to the OFF
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
3. Turn the
the desired position.
4. Press the
button.
5. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
• For quick cooling when the outside tembutton to
perature is high, press the
the ON position. Be sure to return the
to the OFF position for normal coolbutton
ing. The indicator light on the
will go off. You may also select MAX A/C
for quick cooling.
Dehumidified heating
This mode is used to heat and dehumidify
the air.
1. Press the
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
2. Turn the
the desired position.
3. Press the
button on.
4. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
Dehumidified defogging
This mode is used to defog the windows
and dehumidify the air.
1. Press the
air flow control button.
fan speed control dial to
2. Turn the
the desired position.
or
are selected, the
• When the
air conditioner automatically turns on if
the outside temperature is more than 36°
F (2° C). This dehumidifies the air which
helps defog the windshield. The
mode automatically turns off, allowing
outside air to be drawn into the passenger compartment to further improve the
defogging performance.
• The air conditioner is always on in the
mode, regardless of whether the indicator light is on or off.
3. Turn the temperature control dial to the
desired position.
Operating tips
• Keep the windows and moonroof (if so
equipped) closed while the air conditioner is in operation.
• After parking in the sun, drive for two or
three minutes with the windows open to
vent hot air from the passenger compartment. Then, close the windows. This
allows the air conditioner to cool the interior more quickly.
• The air conditioning system should be
operated for approximately 10 minutes
at least once a month. This helps prevent damage to the system due to lack
of lubrication.
• A visible mist may be seen coming from
the ventilators in hot, humid conditions
as the air is cooled rapidly. This does not
indicate a malfunction.
• If the engine coolant temperature
gauge indicates engine coolant temperature over the normal range, turn
the air conditioner off. For additional
information, refer to “If your vehicle
overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.
AIR FLOW CHARTS
The following charts show the button and
dial positions for MAXIMUM AND QUICK
heating, cooling or defrosting. The air re) button should always
circulation (
be in the OFF position for heating and
defrosting.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-27
WHA0916
4-28 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
LHA4443
LHA4444
LHA4453
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-29
LHA4446
4-30 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
HEATER AND AIR CONDITIONER
(automatic) (if so equipped)
LHA2886
Type A (if so equipped)
1. Driver temperature control dial
Air recirculation button
7.
2. A/C (air conditioner) button
8. Passenger temperature control dial
3.
Front window defroster button
9. DUAL button
4.
Fan speed control dial
10. Air flow control buttons
5. OFF button
6.
11. AUTO button
Fresh air intake button
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-31
LHA2611
Type B (if so equipped)
1. Driver temperature control dial
Air recirculation button
7.
2. A/C (air conditioner) button
8. Passenger temperature control dial
3.
Front window defroster button
9. DUAL button
4.
Fan speed control dial
10. Air flow control buttons
5. OFF button
6.
11. AUTO button
Rear window defroster switch
4-32 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
WARNING
LHA3168
Type C (if so equipped)
1. Driver temperature control dial
Air recirculation button
7.
2. A/C (air conditioner) button
8. Passenger temperature control dial
3.
Front window defroster button
9. DUAL button
4.
Fan speed control dial
10. Air flow control buttons
5. OFF button
6.
11. AUTO button
• The air conditioner cooling function
operates only when the engine is
running.
• Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle.
Pets should also not be left alone.
They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent
operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot,
sunny days, temperatures in a closed
vehicle could quickly become high
enough to cause severe or possibly
fatal injuries to people or animals.
• Do not use the recirculation mode for
long periods as it may cause the interior air to become stale and the windows to fog up.
Start the engine and operate the controls
to activate the air conditioner.
Outside mirror defroster switch
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-33
NOTE:
• Odors from inside and outside the vehicle can build up in the air conditioner
unit. Odor can enter the passenger
compartment through the vents.
• When parking, set the heater and air
conditioner controls to turn off air recirculation to allow fresh air into the
passenger compartment. This should
help reduce odors inside the vehicle.
AUTOMATIC OPERATION
Cooling or heating (auto)
This mode may be normally used all year
round as the system automatically works
to keep a constant temperature. Air flow
distribution and fan speed are also controlled automatically.
1. Press the AUTO button on.
2. Turn the temperature dial to the left or
right to set the desired temperature.
Driver and passenger temperatures can
be set independently. Press DUAL to activate dual climate control functions.
Turn the passenger's side temperature
control dial to the left or right to set the
desired passenger's temperature.
• Adjust the temperature dial to about 75°F
(24°C) for normal operation.
• The temperature of the passenger compartment will be maintained automatically. Air flow distribution, fan speed and
A/C on/off are also controlled automatically.
• A visible mist may be seen coming from
the vents in hot, humid conditions as the
air is cooled rapidly. This does not indicate
a malfunction.
Heating (A/C OFF)
The air conditioner does not activate. When
you need to heat only, use this mode.
1. Press the AUTO button.
2. Turn the temperature control dial to set
the desired temperature.
• The temperature of the passenger compartment will be maintained automatically. Air flow distribution and fan speed
are also controlled automatically.
• Do not set the temperature lower than
the outside air temperature. Otherwise,
the system may not work properly.
• Not recommended if windows fog up.
4-34 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Dehumidified defrosting or
defogging
1. Push the
defroster control switch
to turn the system on. The indicator light
in the button will illuminate.
2. Turn the temperature dial to the left or
right to set the desired temperature.
• To quickly remove ice from the outside of
the windows, turn the manual fan control
to the maximum position.
• As soon as possible after the windshield
is clean, press the AUTO button to return
to the auto mode.
control is activated, the air
• When the
conditioner will automatically be turned
on at outside temperatures above 36°F
(2°C). If in defrost mode for more than 1
minute, the air conditioning system will
continue to operate until the fan control
is turned OFF, the vehicle is shut off or the
A/C button is used to turn off the compressor even if an air flow button other
is selected. This dehumidifies
than
the air which helps defog the windshield.
The air recirculation mode automatically
turns off, allowing outside air to be drawn
into the passenger compartment to further improve the defogging performance.
MANUAL OPERATION
Fan speed control
The air conditioner cooling function operates only when the engine is running.
Turn the
fan speed control dial to
manually control the fan speed.
Air flow control
Press the AUTO button to return to automatic control of the fan speed.
Air recirculation
Press the air recirculation button
to
recirculate interior air inside the vehicle.
Press the AUTO button to return to automatic mode.
The air recirculation cannot be activated
front
when the air conditioner is in the
defogging mode.
Fresh air intake (if so equipped)
Press the
fresh air intake button to
draw outside air into the passenger comindicator light on the
partment. The
button will come on.
A/C (air conditioner) button
Start the engine, turn the
fan speed
control dial to the desired position and
button to turn on the air
press the
conditioner. To turn off the air conditioner,
button again.
press the
Press the air flow control buttons to manually control air flow and select the air outlet:
— Air flows from center and side
vents.
— Air flows from center and side
vents and foot outlets.
— Air flows mainly from foot outlets.
— Air flows from defroster and foot
outlets.
— Air flows from defroster outlets.
LIC0515
To turn system off
OPERATING TIPS
Press the OFF button.
1 , located on the top
The sunload sensor O
center of the instrument panel, helps the
system maintain a constant temperature.
Do not put anything on or around this sensor.
• When the engine coolant temperature
and outside air temperature are low, the
air flow from the foot outlets may not
operate for a maximum of 150 seconds.
However, this is not a malfunction. After
the coolant temperature warms up, air
flow from the foot outlets will operate
normally.
Rear window or outside mirror
defroster switch (if so equipped)
For additional information, refer to “Rear
window or outside mirror defroster switch”
in the “Instruments and controls” section of
this manual.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-35
SERVICING AIR CONDITIONER
AUDIO SYSTEM
The air conditioner system in your NISSAN
vehicle is charged with a refrigerant designed with the environment in mind.
RADIO
This refrigerant does not harm the
earth's ozone layer.
Special charging equipment and lubricant
is required when servicing your NISSAN air
conditioner. Using improper refrigerants or
lubricants will cause severe damage to
your air conditioner system. For additional
information, refer to “Air conditioner system refrigerant and oil recommendations”
in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer to service your “environmentally
friendly” air conditioning system.
WARNING
The air conditioner system contains refrigerant under high pressure. To avoid
personal injury, any air conditioner service should be done only by an experienced technician with proper equipment.
With the ignition placed in the ACC or ON
(power) or
position, press the PUSH
ON•OFF button to turn the radio on. If you
listen to the radio with the engine not running, the ignition should be placed in the
ACC position.
Radio reception is affected by station signal strength, distance from radio transmitter, buildings, bridges, mountains and other
external influences. Intermittent changes
in reception quality normally are caused by
these external influences.
Using a cellular phone in or near the vehicle
may influence radio reception quality.
Radio reception
Your NISSAN radio system is equipped with
state-of-the-art electronic circuits to enhance radio reception. These circuits are
designed to extend reception range, and to
enhance the quality of that reception.
However, there are some general characteristics of both FM and AM radio signals
that can affect radio reception quality in a
moving vehicle, even when the finest
equipment is used. These characteristics
are completely normal in a given reception
area and do not indicate any malfunction
in your NISSAN radio system.
4-36 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Reception conditions will constantly
change because of vehicle movement.
Buildings, terrain, signal distance and interference from other vehicles can work
against ideal reception. Described below
are some of the factors that can affect your
radio reception.
Some cellular phones or other devices may
cause interference or a buzzing noise to
come from the audio system speakers.
Storing the device in a different location
may reduce or eliminate the noise.
FM RADIO RECEPTION
Range: FM range is normally limited to 25 –
30 mi (40 – 48 km), with monaural (single
channel) FM having slightly more range
than stereo FM. External influences may
sometimes interfere with FM station reception even if the FM station is within 25
mi (40 km). The strength of the FM signal is
directly related to the distance between
the transmitter and receiver. FM signals follow a line-of-sight path, exhibiting many of
the same characteristics as light. For example, they will reflect off objects.
Fade and drift: As your vehicle moves away
from a station transmitter, the signals will
tend to fade and/or drift.
Static and flutter: During signal interference from buildings, large hills or due to
antenna position (usually in conjunction
with increased distance from the station
transmitter), static or flutter can be heard.
This can be reduced by adjusting the treble
control to reduce treble response.
Multipath reception: Because of the reflective characteristics of FM signals, direct and
reflected signals reach the receiver at the
same time. The signals may cancel each
other, resulting in momentary flutter or loss
of sound.
AM RADIO RECEPTION
AM signals, because of their low frequency,
can bend around objects and skip along
the ground. In addition, the signals can be
bounced off the ionosphere and bent back
to earth. Because of these characteristics,
AM signals are also subject to interference
as they travel from transmitter to receiver.
Fading: Occurs while the vehicle is passing
through freeway underpasses or in areas
with many tall buildings. It can also occur for
several seconds during ionospheric turbulence even in areas where no obstacles exist.
SATELLITE RADIO RECEPTION (if so
equipped)
When the satellite radio is used for the first
time or the battery has been replaced, the
satellite radio may not work properly. This
is not a malfunction. Wait more than 10
minutes with satellite radio ON and the vehicle outside of any metal or large building
for satellite radio to receive all of the necessary data.
No satellite radio reception is available and
“NO SAT” is displayed when the SAT band
option is selected unless optional satellite
receiver and antenna are installed and a
SiriusXM® Satellite Radio service subscription is active. Satellite radio is not available
in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
Satellite radio performance may be affected if cargo carried on the roof blocks
the satellite radio signal.
If possible, do not put cargo over the satellite antenna.
A build up of ice on the satellite radio antenna can affect satellite radio performance. Remove the ice to restore satellite
radio reception.
LHA0099
AUDIO OPERATION PRECAUTIONS
Compact Disc (CD) player (if so
equipped)
Static: Caused by thunderstorms, electrical
power lines, electric signs and even traffic
lights.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-37
CAUTION
• Do not force a compact disc into the
CD insert slot. This could damage the
CD and/or CD player.
• Trying to load a CD with the CD door
closed could damage the CD and/or
CD player.
• Only one CD can be loaded into the
CD player at a time.
• Only use high quality 4.7 in (12 cm)
round discs that have the “COMPACT
disc DIGITAL AUDIO” logo on the disc or
packaging.
• During cold weather or rainy days, the
player may malfunction due to the humidity. If this occurs, remove the CD
and dehumidify or ventilate the player
completely.
• The player may skip while driving on
rough roads.
• The CD player sometimes cannot function when the compartment temperature is extremely high or low. Decrease/
increase the temperature before use.
• Do not expose the CD to direct sunlight.
• CDs that are in poor condition or are
dirty, scratched or covered with fingerprints may not work properly.
• The following CDs may not work properly:
– Copy Control Compact Discs (CCCD)
– Recordable Compact Discs (CD-R)
– Rewritable Compact Discs (CD-RW)
• Do not use the following CDs as they may
cause the CD player to malfunction:
– 3.1 in (8 cm) discs with an adapter
– CDs that are not round
– CDs with a paper label
– CDs that are warped, scratched, or
have abnormal edges
• This audio system can only play prerecorded CDs. It has no capability to record or burn CDs.
• If the CD cannot be played, one of the
following messages will be displayed.
CHECK DISC:
–– Confirm that the CD is inserted correctly (the label side is facing up, etc.).
–– Confirm that the CD is not bent or
warped and it is free of scratches.
PRESS EJECT:
This is an error due to excessive temperature inside the player. Remove the
CD by pressing the EJECT button. After
a short time, reinsert the CD. The CD
can be played when the temperature
of the player returns to normal.
4-38 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
UNPLAYABLE:
The file is unplayable in this audio system (only MP3 or WMA CD).
Compact disc with MP3 or WMA (if
so equipped)
Terms
• MP3 — MP3 is short for Moving Pictures
Experts Group Audio Layer 3. MP3 is the
most well-known compressed digital audio file format. This format allows for near
“CD quality” sound, but at a fraction of the
size of normal audio files. MP3 conversion
of an audio track from CD-ROM can reduce the file size by approximately a 10:1
ratio with virtually no perceptible loss in
quality. MP3 compression removes the
redundant and irrelevant parts of a
sound signal that the human ear doesn’t
hear.
• WMA — Windows Media Audio (WMA)* is a
compressed audio format created by Microsoft as an alternative to MP3. The WMA
codec offers greater file compression
than the MP3 codec, enabling storage of
more digital audio tracks in the same
amount of space when compared to
MP3s at the same level of quality.
• Bit rate — Bit rate denotes the number of
bits per second used by a digital music
file. The size and quality of a compressed
digital audio file is determined by the bit
rate used when encoding the file.
• Sampling frequency — Sampling frequency is the rate at which the samples
of a signal are converted from analog to
digital (A/D conversion) per second.
• Multisession — Multisession is one of the
methods for writing data to media. Writing data once to the media is called a
single session, and writing more than
once is called a multisession.
• ID3/WMA Tag — The ID3/WMA tag is the
part of the encoded MP3 or WMA file that
contains information about the digital
music file such as song title, artist, encoding bit rate, track time duration, etc. ID3
tag information is displayed on the Artist/
song title line on the display.
* Windows® and Windows Media® are registered trademarks and trademarks in the
United States of America and other countries of Microsoft Corporation of the USA.
• If there is a file in the top level of the disc,
“Root Folder” is displayed.
• The playback order is the order in which
the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in
the desired order.
WHA1078
Playback order chart
Playback order
Music playback order of a CD with MP3 or
WMA files is as illustrated.
• The names of folders not containing MP3
or WMA files are not shown in the display.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-39
Specification chart
Supported media
CD, CD-R, CD-RW
Supported file systems
MP3
Supported
versions*1
WMA
ISO9660 LEVEL1, ISO9660 LEVEL2, Apple ISO, Romeo, Joliet * ISO9660 Level 3 (packet writing) is not supported.
Version
MPEG1, MPEG2, MPEG2.5
Sampling
frequency
8 kHz - 48 kHz
Bit rate
8 kbps - 320 kbps, VBR
Version
WMA7, WMA8, WMA9
Sampling
frequency
32 kHz - 48 kHz
Bit rate
48 kbps - 192 kbps, VBR
Tag information
ID3 tag VER1.0, VER1.1, VER2.2, VER2.3 (MP3 only)
Folder levels
Folder levels: 8, Max folders: 255 (including root folder), Files: 512 (Max. 255 files for one folder)
Text character number limitation
128 characters
Displayable character codes*2
01: ASCII, 02: ISO-8859-1, 03: UNICODE (UTF-16 BOM Big Endian), 04: UNICODE (UTF-16 Non-BOM Big Endian),
05: UNICODE (UTF-8), 06: UNICODE (Non-UTF-16 BOM Little Endian)
*1 Files created with a combination of 48 kHz sampling frequency and 64 kbps bit rate cannot be played.
*2 Available codes depend on what kind of media, versions and information are going to be displayed.
4-40 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Troubleshooting guide
Symptom
Cause and Countermeasure
Check if the disc was inserted correctly.
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
Check if there is condensation inside the player. If there is, wait until the condensation is gone (about 1 hour) before using the player.
If there is a temperature increase error, the CD player will play correctly after it returns to the normal temperature.
Cannot play
If there is a mixture of music CD files (CD-DA data) and MP3/WMA files on a CD, only the music CD files (CD-DA data) will be played.
Files with extensions other than “.MP3”,“.WMA”, “.mp3” or “.wma” cannot be played. In addition, the character codes and number of characters for folder names and file names should be in compliance with the specifications.
Check if the finalization process, such as session close and disc close, is done for the disc.
Check if the disc is protected by copyright.
Poor sound quality
Check if the disc is scratched or dirty.
Bit rate may be too low.
It takes a relatively long
time before the music
starts playing.
If there are many folders or file levels on the MP3/WMA disc, or if it is a multisession disc, some time may be required before the music
starts playing.
Music cuts off or skips
The writing software and hardware combination might not match, or the writing speed, writing depth, writing width, etc., might not
match the specifications. Try using the slowest writing speed.
Skipping with high bit
rate files
Skipping may occur with large quantities of data, such as for high bit rate data.
Moves immediately to
When a non-MP3/WMA file has been given an extension of “.MP3”, “.WMA”, .“mp3”or “.wma”, or when play is prohibited by copyright prothe next song when playtection, there will be approximately 5 seconds of no sound and then the player will skip to the next song.
ing
Songs do not play back in The playback order is the order in which the files were written by the writing software. Therefore, the files might not play in the dethe desired order
sired order.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-41
USB (Universal Serial Bus)
connection port
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate
the USB device while driving. Doing so
can be a distraction. If distracted you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident or serious injury.
CAUTION
• Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port
may damage the port. Make sure
that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.
• Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.
• Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may damage
the port.
The vehicle is not equipped with a USB device. USB devices should be purchased
separately as necessary.
This system cannot be used to format USB
memory devices. To format a USB device,
use a personal computer.
In some jurisdictions, the USB device for the
front seats plays only sound without images for regulatory reasons, even when the
vehicle is parked.
This system supports various USB
memory devices, USB hard drives and
iPod® players. Some USB devices may not
be supported by this system.
• Partitioned USB devices may not play
correctly.
• Some characters used in other languages (Chinese, Japanese, etc.) may not
appear properly in the display. Using English language characters with a USB device is recommended.
General notes for USB use
• For additional information, refer to your
device manufacturer's owner information regarding the proper use and care of
the device.
4-42 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Notes for iPod® use
iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
• Improperly plugging in the iPod® may
cause a check mark to be displayed on
and off (flickering). Always make sure that
the iPod® is connected properly.
• An iPod® nano (1st Generation) may remain in fast forward or rewind mode if it is
connected during a seek operation. In
this case, please manually reset the
iPod®.
• An iPod® nano (2nd Generation) will continue to fast-forward or rewind if it is disconnected during a seek operation.
• An incorrect song title may appear when
the Play Mode is changed while using an
iPod® nano (2nd Generation).
• Audiobooks may not play in the same
order as they appear on an iPod®.
• Large video files cause slow responses in
an iPod®. The vehicle center display may
momentarily black out, but will soon recover.
• If an iPod® automatically selects large
video files while in the shuffle mode, the
vehicle center display may momentarily
black out, but will soon recover.
Bluetooth® streaming audio
• Some Bluetooth® audio devices may not
be recognized by the in-vehicle audio
system.
• It is necessary to set up the wireless connection
between
a
compatible
Bluetooth® audio device and the invehicle Bluetooth® module before using
the Bluetooth® audio.
• Operating procedure of the Bluetooth®
audio will vary depending on the devices.
Make sure how to operate your audio device before using it with this system.
• The Bluetooth® audio may be stopped
under the following conditions:
– Receiving a call on the Hands-Free
Phone System.
– Checking the connection to the
hands-free phone.
• Do not place the Bluetooth® audio device
in an area surrounded by metal or far
away from the in-vehicle Bluetooth®
module to prevent tone quality degradation and wireless connection disruption.
• While an audio device is connected
through the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the battery power of the device may
discharge quicker than usual.
• This system supports the Bluetooth® Audio Distribution Profile (A2DP, AVRCP).
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and
licensed to Visteon
and Bosch.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-43
Audio main operation
VOL (volume) knob / PUSH
(power) button
Place the ignition switch in the ON position
(power) button
and press the PUSH
while the system is off to call up the mode
(radio, AUX, Bluetooth® audio, USB or iPod®)
that was playing immediately before the
system was turned off.
To turn the system off, press the PUSH
(power) button.
Turn the VOL (volume) knob to adjust the
volume.
This vehicle may be equipped with Speed
Sensitive Volume. When this feature is active, the audio volume changes as the driving speed changes.
LHA4672
FM/AM RADIO (if so equipped)
4.
1.
(power)
5. VOL (volume) knob / PUSH
button
For additional information, refer to “Audio
operation precautions” regarding all operation precautions in this section.
MENU button
2. AUDIO button
3. Display screen
/
(SEEK/TRACK) buttons
4-44 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
MENU button
Press the
MENU button to show the
Menu screen. Touch the “Settings” key on
the display, then touch the “Sound” key.
Sound Settings
Bass
Adjusts the bass to the desired level.
Treble
Adjusts the treble to the desired level.
Balance
Adjusts the balance to the desired level. Balance adjusts the sound level between the left and right
speakers.
Fade
Adjusts the fade to the desired level. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear
speakers.
Speed Sensitive Volume
Adjusts the speed sensitive volume function, which increases the volume of the audio system as
the speed of the vehicle increases. Set to “OFF” to disable the feature. The higher the setting, the
more the volume increases in relation to vehicle speed.
Bass, treble, balance, fade and Speed Sensitive Volume can be adjusted by touching “-” or “+” keys.
AUDIO button
Push to display the audio screen. When this
button is pushed while the audio screen is
not displayed, the last audio source played
will play.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-45
5. Preset list
To listen to a preset station, touch the
corresponding station from the preset
list. If displayed, touch the “ <” or “ >” keys
to scroll the preset list.
AM radio operation
Press the
MENU button and touch the
“AM” key or press the AUDIO button and
select AM on the bottom of the Launch Bar
to bring up the AM display screen.
LHA4708
AM/FM radio screen
1. “AM Menu” / “FM Menu” key
Touch to display the radio menu screen.
2. “Direct Tune” (if so equipped)
Touch to manually enter a station.
3. Audio source indicator
Indicates the currently selected audio
source.
4. Reception information display
Reception information currently available such as frequency, station name,
etc. is displayed.
If another audio source is playing when the
“AM” key is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the
last radio station played will begin playing.
AM Menu
Touch the “AM Menu” key to display the AM
Menu screen options:
• SCAN: To scan tune the stations, touch
the “AM Menu” key on the radio screen
and then touch the “SCAN” key. The stations will be tuned from low to high frequencies and stop at each broadcasting
station for several seconds. Touching the
“SCAN” key again during this period of
several seconds will stop tuning and the
radio will remain tuned to that station.
4-46 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• Refresh: Touch the “Refresh” key to scan
and update the station list displayed on
the right side of the AM Menu screen.
(SEEK/TRACK) buttons
Press the
or
buttons to tune
from low to high or high to low frequencies
and to stop at the next broadcasting station.
1 to 6 station memory operations
Up to six stations can be registered in the
preset list.
1. Select the AM radio band.
2. Tune to the station you wish to store.
3. Touch and hold one of the preset numbers in the preset list.
The information such as frequency will be
displayed on the preset list.
To select and listen to the preset stations,
or
on the steering wheel
push
briefly or touch a preferred station on the
preset list on the radio screen.
FM radio operation
Press the
MENU button and touch the
“FM” key or press the AUDIO button and
select FM on the bottom of the Launch Bar
to bring up the FM display screen.
If another audio source is playing when the
“FM” key is pressed, the audio source playing will automatically be turned off and the
last radio station played will begin playing.
The FM stereo indicator (STEREO) is shown
on the screen during FM stereo reception.
When the stereo broadcast signal is weak,
the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception.
FM Menu
Touch the “FM Menu” key to display the FM
Menu screen options:
• SCAN: To scan tune the stations, touch
the “FM Menu” key on the radio screen
and then touch the “SCAN” key. The stations will be tuned from low to high frequencies and stop at each broadcasting
stations for several seconds. Touching
the “SCAN” key again during this period of
several seconds will stop tuning and the
radio will remain tuned to that station.
• Refresh: Touch the “Refresh” key to update the station list displayed on the right
side of the FM Menu screen.
• RDS Info: Radio station and song information can be displayed on the FM display
screen.
(SEEK/TRACK) buttons
Press the
or
buttons to tune
from low to high or high to low frequencies
and to stop at the next broadcasting station.
1 to 12 Station memory operations
Up to 12 stations can be registered in the
preset list.
1. Select the FM radio band.
2. Tune to the station you wish to store.
3. Touch and hold one of the preset numbers in the preset list.
Auxiliary (AUX) devices operation
Connecting auxiliary devices
Connect an AUX device into the AUX input
jack located on the center console below
the heater and air conditioner controls.
The AUX input jack accepts any standard
analog audio input such as from a portable
cassette player, CD player, MP3 player or
phone.
Insert a 1/8 in (3.5 mm) stereo mini plug in
the audio input jack. If a cable with a mono
plug is used, the audio output may not
function normally.
Activation and playing
Turn on the AUX device. Connect an AUX
cable to the AUX device and the AUX input
jack. Select AUX mode from the audio
source menu screen or by pressing the
Source button on the steering wheel.
The information such as frequency will be
displayed on the preset list.
To select and listen to the preset stations,
or
on the steering wheel
push
briefly or touch a preferred station on the
preset list on the radio screen.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-47
Additional features
For additional information, refer to “iPod®
player operation without Navigation System” in this section.
For additional information, refer to “USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port
(models without Navigation System)” in this
section.
For additional information, refer to
“Bluetooth® streaming audio without Navigation System” in this section.
LHA4709
AUX screen
• Audio source indicator
Indicates that the AUX source is currently
playing.
• “Volume Setting” keys
Touch one of the keys to select the sound
output gain from Low, Medium and High.
• AUX from Launch Bar
Touch to change from another source to
AUX.
4-48 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Microsoft (WMA) Obligation of
Labeling
Additional Obligation of Labeling
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft
Corporation and third parties. Use or distribution of such technology outside of this
product is prohibited without a license
from Microsoft or an authorized Microsoft
subsidiary and third parties.
7. AUDIO button / TUNE knob
8. Display screen
9. ON-OFF button / VOL (volume) control
knob
10. CD button
11. SXM button*
*No satellite radio reception is available
when the SXM button is pressed to access
satellite radio stations unless optional satellite receiver and antenna are installed
and an SiriusXM® Satellite Radio service
subscription is active. Satellite radio is not
available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
For additional information, refer to “Audio
operation precautions” regarding all operation precautions in this section.
LHA2895
FM/AM/SAT RADIO WITH
COMPACT DISC (CD) PLAYER (if so
equipped)
1.
CD eject button
2. FM-AM button
3. AUX button
4. CD insert slot
5.
Backward seek button and
Forward seek button
6. BACK button
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-49
Audio main operation
ON-OFF button / VOL (volume) control
knob
Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON
position and press the ON-OFF button
while the system is off to call up the mode
(radio, CD, AUX, Bluetooth® audio, USB or
iPod®) that was playing immediately before
the system was turned off.
To turn the system off, press the ON-OFF
button.
Turn the VOL (volume) control knob to adjust the volume.
This vehicle may be equipped with Speed
Sensitive Volume. When this feature is active, the audio volume changes as the driving speed changes.
Audio settings
1. Press the [
] button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “Audio” key.
Use the touch-screen to adjust the following items to the desired setting:
Audio
Bass
Adjusts the bass to the desired level.
Treble
Adjusts the treble to the desired level.
Balance
Adjusts the balance to the desired level. Balance adjusts the sound level between the left and right speakers.
Fade
Adjusts the fade to the desired level. Fade adjusts the sound level between the front and rear speakers.
Speed Sensitive Vol.
Adjusts the speed sensitive volume function, which increases the volume of the audio system as the
speed of the vehicle increases. Set to “ 0 ” to disable the feature. The higher the setting, the more the volume increases in relation to vehicle speed.
AUX Volume Level
Controls the volume level of incoming sound when an auxiliary device is connected to the system. Available options are Low (Quiet), Medium, and High (Loud).
Bass, treble, balance and fade can also be adjusted by pressing the AUDIO button and turning the TUNE knob to select the item to adjust.
When the desired item is shown on the display, turn the tuning to adjust and then press the AUDIO button until the display returns to the
main audio screen. If the button is not pressed for approximately 10 seconds, the radio or CD display will automatically reappear.
4-50 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
SXM settings
To view the SXM settings:
SXM band select
Tuning with the touch-screen
1. Press the [
Pressing the SXM button will change the
band as follows:
When in AM or FM mode, the radio can be
tuned using the touch-screen. To bring up
the visual tuner, touch the “Tune” key on the
lower right corner of the screen. A screen
appears with a bar running from low frequencies on the left to high frequencies on
the right. Touch the screen at the location
of the frequency you wish to tune and the
station will change to that frequency. To
return to the regular radio display screen,
touch the “OK” key.
] button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “SXM” key.
SXM1* → SXM2* → SXM3* → SXM1* (satellite,
if so equipped)
The signal strength, activation status and
other information are displayed on the
screen.
When the SXM button is pressed while the
ignition switch is in the ACC or ON position, the
radio will come on at the last station played.
FM/AM/SAT radio operation
The last station played will also come on
when the ON-OFF button is pressed to turn
the radio on.
FM·AM button
Press the FM·AM button to change the
band as follows:
AM →P1→ FM1 →FM→P2
If another audio source is playing when the
FM·AM button is pressed, the audio source
playing will automatically be turned off and
the last radio station played will begin playing.
The FM stereo indicator (STEREO) is shown
on the screen during FM stereo reception.
When the stereo broadcast signal is weak,
the radio automatically changes from stereo to monaural reception.
*When the SXM button is pressed, the satellite radio mode will be skipped unless an
optional satellite receiver and antenna are
installed and a SiriusXM® Satellite Radio
service subscription is active. Satellite radio
is not available in Alaska, Hawaii and Guam.
If a compact disc is playing when the SXM
button is pressed, the compact disc will
automatically be turned off and the last
radio station played will come on.
While the radio is in SXM mode, the operation can be controlled through the touchscreen. Touch the “Categories” key to display a list of categories. Touch a category
displayed on the list to display options
within that category.
Tuning with the TUNE knob
The radio can also be manually tuned using the TUNE knob. When in FM or AM mode,
turn the TUNE knob to the left for lower
frequencies or to the right for higher frequencies. When in SXM mode, turn the
TUNE knob to change the channel.
SEEK tuning
When in FM or AM mode, press the
or
seek buttons to tune from low to high
or high to low frequencies and to stop at
the next broadcasting station.
or
When in SXM mode, press the
seek buttons to change the category.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-51
3. The channel indicator will then come on
and the sound will resume. Programming is now complete.
4. Other buttons can be set in the same
manner.
If the battery cable is disconnected or if the
fuse opens, the radio memory will be canceled. In that case, reset the desired stations.
Presets can also be selected by touching
the desired preset number on the screen.
LHA2899
1 to 6 Station memory operations
Twelve stations can be set for the FM band
(six for FM1, six for FM2) and six stations can
be set for the AM band. Eighteen stations
can be set for the SXM band (six for SXM1, six
for SXM2 & six SXM3).
1. Choose the radio band AM, FM1 or FM2
using the FM·AM select button or choose
the radio band SXM1, SXM2 & SXM3 using
the SXM button.
2. Tune to the desired station using
manual or seek tuning. Press and hold
any of the desired station memory buttons (1 – 6) until a beep sound is heard.
4-52 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
LHA3085
Smart Favorites Preset Setup (if
so equipped)
The Smart Favorites feature allows the
user to designate presets, within the SXM1,
SXM2 and SXM3 bands, as their Smart Favorites. When any of the Smart Favorite
presets are selected, the current track on
that station will play from the beginning of
the song.
To program a Smart Favorite preset:
1. Press the SXM button.
2. Touch the “Setup” key.
3. Touch the “Tune Start” key to activate
(ON) or deactivate (OFF) Smart Favorites.
REPLAY
To replay a track from the
”
beginning, press the “
key. The user can continue
” key to
to press the “
replay previous songs, but
can only go back as far as
the system permits. The
system will warn the user
when they cannot skip any
further back by displaying
“At the End” in the bottom
left corner of the screen.
SKIP
To skip a track, press the “
” key. “Live” will appear
in the bottom left corner of
the screen indicating the
difference from play time to
live audio.
PAUSE
To pause a track, press the “
” key.
REWIND/
FAST
FORWARD
To rewind/ fast forward a
” or “
track, hold the “
” key.
4. Touch the “Add Preset” key to select an
available preset.
For additional information, refer to “1 to 6
station memory operations” in this section
regarding preset memory options.
NOTE:
• Smart Favorites will start functioning
only after the audio unit is turned on for
a few minutes.
• Tune Start is supported for music channels only.
LHA3087
Replay Screen
The Replay Screen gives the user the ability
to replay, skip, pause or rewind the currently aired track.
When the “Replay” key is touched, the Replay Screen is prompted.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-53
Compact Disc (CD) player
operation
If the radio is already operating, it automatically turns off and the compact disc begins
to play.
CD button
When the CD button is pressed with the
system off and the compact disc loaded,
the system will turn on and the compact
disc will start to play.
When the CD button is pressed with a compact disc loaded and the radio playing, the
radio will automatically be turned off and
the compact disc will start to play.
CD/MP3 display mode
Menu item
While listening to a CD or an MP3/WMA CD, certain text may be displayed (when a CD encoded with
text is being used). Depending on how the CD or MP3/WMA CD is encoded, the text is displayed listing the artist, album and song title. There are other keys displayed on the screen when a CD is
playing:
CD/MP3 display mode
Random/Mix
Touch the “Random” key to apply a random play pattern to the CD. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching “Random” or alternates between Random Folder, and Random All. This text will appear on the
display. To cancel Random/Mix mode, touch the “Random” or “Mix” key until the key is no longer
highlighted.
Repeat
Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat play pattern to the CD. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching
“Repeat” alternates between repeating the current song and repeating the current folder. This text
will appear on the display. To cancel Repeat mode, touch the “Repeat” key until the key is no longer
highlighted
Browse
Touch the “Browse” key to display the titles on the CD in list format. Touch the title of a song in the
list to begin playing that song. If an MP3 CD is playing, touching the “Browse” key will also list the
folders on the disc. Follow the procedure for selecting a song with the touch-screen to choose a
folder.
4-54 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
SEEK (Reverse or Fast
Forward) buttons
Press and hold the
or
seek buttons for 1.5 seconds while the compact disc
is playing to reverse or fast forward the
track being played. The compact disc plays
at an increased speed while reversing or
fast forwarding. When the button is released, the compact disc returns to normal
play speed.
SEEK buttons
seek button while a CD or
Press the
MP3/WMA CD is playing to return to the
beginning of the current track. Press the
seek button several times to skip
backward several tracks.
seek button while a CD or
Press the
MP3/WMA CD is playing to advance one
seek button several
track. Press the
times to skip forward several tracks. If the
last track on a CD is skipped, the first track
on the disc is played. If the last track in a
folder of an MP3/WMA CD is skipped, the
first track of the next folder is played.
AUX button
The AUX IN audio input port accepts any
standard analog audio input such as from
a portable cassette tape/CD player, MP3
player or a laptop computer. Press the AUX
button to play a compatible device
plugged into the AUX IN port.
CD EJECT button
When the
CD EJECT button is pressed
with a compact disc loaded, the compact
disc will eject and the last source will be
played.
If the disc is not removed within 10 seconds,
the disc will reload.
Additional features
For additional information, refer to “iPod®
player operation with Navigation System”
in this section.
For additional information, refer to “USB
(Universal Serial Bus) connection port
(models with Navigation System)” in this
section.
For additional information, refer to
“Bluetooth® streaming audio with Navigation System” in this section.
LHA4319
USB (Universal Serial Bus)
CONNECTION PORT (models
without Navigation System) (if so
equipped)
Connecting a device to the USB
connection port
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate
the USB device while driving. Doing so
can be a distraction. If distracted you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident or serious injury.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-55
CAUTION
• To avoid damage and loss of function
when using a USB device, note the
following precautions.
• Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port
may damage the port. Make sure
that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.
• Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.
• Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may damage
the port.
The USB port is located on the center console beneath the heater and air conditioner controls. Insert the USB device into
the connection port.
When a compatible storage device is
plugged into the connection port, compatible audio files on the storage device can be
played through the vehicle's audio system.
The port is illuminated for better visibility
when the headlight switch is in the ON position.
For additional information, refer to your device manufacturer's owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
4-56 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
LHA4711
USB connections screen
Press the
MENU button and touch the
“Connections” key or touch the “Settings”
key and touch the “Connections” key to
change USB settings.
• Auto Change Source
Touch “ON” or “OFF” to change the audio
source settings for USB memory devices
or an iPod® connected through a USB
cable.
5. Play time and progress bar
The play time of the track is displayed.
The bar indicates the progress in playing
a track.
USB operation keys
Touch to control USB playback functions.
Keys
Description
Each time “
” key is
touched, the repeat mode
changes.
LHA4710
USB screen
Touch to return to the beginning of the current track.
Touch again to select the
previous track. Touch and
hold to rewind the current
track.
1. “USB Menu” key
Touch to switch to the USB Menu screen.
Touch to play the track.
2. Track information
Track information such as the song
name, artist name and album name are
displayed.
Touch to select the next
track. Touch and hold to
fast-forward the track.
3. Audio source indicator
Indicates the currently selected audio
source.
4. USB operation keys
Touch to control
functions
USB
Touch to pause the track.
Each time “
” key is
touched, the random mode
changes.
USB memory device player
operation
Activation and playing
Connecting the USB memory device into
the port will start playing the USB memory.
USB memory device can also be played by
touching the “USB” key on the Menu screen
or by touching USB on the Launch Bar.
To pause playing the USB memory device
” key. To resume playing,
touch the “
” key.
touch the “
Skipping tracks
To skip the tracks, push the
or
buttons on the control panel or touch the “
” or “
” keys on the screen repeatedly until the preferred track is selected.
NOTE:
Depending on the condition, skipping to
the previous track may require pushing
the button or touching the key twice.
Pushing the button or touching the key
once may only restart the current track
from the beginning.
playback
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-57
Fast-forwarding/rewinding
USB menu
To rewind or fast-forward the track, push
or
buttons on the
and hold the
”
control panel or touch and hold the “
” keys on the screen.
or “
Touch the “USB Menu” key on the USB
screen to display the USB Menu screen.
Changing play mode
Repeat mode
“Now Playing” key Touch to display the USB
screen.
“Folder List” key
Touch to display the folder list.
Touch an item on the list to
select the folder. The subfolder or track list will be displayed. Select a sub-folder or
track from the list.
“Album Artwork”
Touch to run on/off the album
artwork display on the USB
screen.
Touch the “
” key on the USB screen to
change the repeat mode.
The following modes are available:
No text displayed: Repeat off
All: Repeat all
LHA4319
1 Folder: Repeat folder/sub-folder
1 Track: Repeat track
Random mode
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
change the random mode as follows:
No text displayed: Random off
Random: Random play
All: Repeat all
USB (Universal Serial Bus)
CONNECTION PORT (models with
Navigation System) (if so
equipped)
Connecting a device to the USB
connection port
WARNING
1 Folder: Repeat folder/sub-folder
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate
the USB device while driving. Doing so
can be a distraction. If distracted you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident or serious injury.
4-58 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
CAUTION
• Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port
may damage the port. Make sure
that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.
• Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.
• Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may damage
the port.
For additional information, refer to your device manufacturer’s owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
The USB port is located on the instrument
panel. Insert the USB device into the instrument panel.
When a compatible storage device is
plugged into the connection port, compatible audio files on the storage device can be
played through the vehicle's audio system.
Audio file operation
AUX (auxiliary) button
Place the ignition switch in the ON or ACC
position and press the AUX button to
switch to the USB input mode. If another
audio source is playing and a USB connection port device is inserted, press the AUX
button until the center display changes to
the USB memory mode.
If the system has been turned off while the
USB memory was playing, press the ONOFF button to restart the USB memory.
LHA4006
Play information
Information about the audio files being
played is shown on the display screen of
the vehicle's audio system. Touch “Browse”
to display the list of folders and files on the
USB device. Touch the name of a song on
the screen to begin playing that song.
Seeking buttons
Press the
seeking button while an
audio file on the USB device is playing to
return to the beginning of the current track.
seeking button several
Press the
times to skip backward several tracks.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-59
Press the
seeking button while an
audio file on the USB device is playing to
seeking
advance one track. Press the
button several times to skip forward several tracks. If the last track in a folder on the
USB device is skipped, the first track of the
next folder is played.
Random and repeat play mode
While files on a USB device are playing, the
play pattern can be altered so that songs
are repeated or played randomly.
Repeat
Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat
play pattern to the USB device. When the
Repeat mode is active, the text on the “Repeat” key will illuminate and the text “Repeat Track” appears. By touching the “Repeat” key once more, the text “Repeat
Folder” appears. To cancel Repeat mode,
touch the “Repeat” key until no text is illuminated.
Random
Touch the “Random” key to apply a random
play pattern to the USB device. When the
Random mode is active, the text “Random”
on the key will illuminate and the text “Random Folder” appears. By touching the “Random” key once more, the text “Random All”
appears. To cancel Random mode, touch
the “Random” key until no text is illuminated.
LHA4319
iPod®* PLAYER OPERATION
WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
Connecting iPod®
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect, or operate
the USB device while driving. Doing so
can be a distraction. If distracted you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident or serious injury.
4-60 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
CAUTION
• Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port
may damage the port. Make sure
that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.
• Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.
• Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may damage
the port.
For additional information, refer to your device manufacturer’s owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
To connect an iPod® to the vehicle so that
the iPod® can be controlled with the audio
system controls and display screen, use
the USB connection port located on the
center console below the heater and air
conditioner controls. Connect the iPod®specific end of the cable to the iPod® and
the USB end of the cable to the USB connection port on the vehicle. If your iPod®
supports charging via a USB connection, its
battery will be charged while connected to
the vehicle with the ignition switch in the
ON position. The port is illuminated for better visibility when the headlight switch is in
the ON position.
While connected to the vehicle, the iPod®
can only be operated by the vehicle audio
controls.
To disconnect the iPod® from the vehicle,
remove the USB end of the cable from the
USB connection port on the vehicle, then
remove the cable from the iPod®.
* iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Compatibility
The following models are compatible:
• iPod® Classic 5th generation (firmware
version 1.3.0 or later)
• iPod® Classic 6th generation (firmware
version 2.0.1 or later)
• iPod® Classic 7th generation (firmware
version 2.0.4 or later)
• iPod® Touch 2nd generation (firmware
version 4.2.1 or later)*
• iPod® Touch 3rd generation (firmware
version 5.1 or later)
• iPod® Touch 4th generation (firmware
version 5.1 or later)
• iPod® nano - 1st generation (firmware
version 1.3.1 or later)
• iPod® nano - 2nd generation (firmware
version 1.1.3 or later)
• iPod® nano - 3rd generation (firmware
version 1.1.3 or later)
• iPod® nano - 4th generation (firmware
version 1.0.4 or later)
• iPod® nano - 5th generation (firmware
version 1.0.2 or later)
• iPod® nano - 6th generation (firmware
version 1.1 or later)
• iPhone® 3G (firmware version 4.2.1 or later)
• iPhone® 3GS (firmware version 5.1 or later)
• iPhone® 4 (firmware version 5.1 or later)
• iPhone® 4S (firmware version 5.1 or later)
* Some features of this iPod® may not be
fully functional.
Make sure that your iPod® firmware is updated to the version indicated above.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-61
5. iPod® operation keys
Touch to control iPod®
functions
playback
6. Play time and progress bar
The play time of the track is displayed.
The bar indicates the progress in playing
a track.
iPod® operation keys
Touch to control iPod® playback functions.
Keys
LHA4724
iPod screen
1. “iPod Menu” key
Touch to switch to the iPod Menu screen.
2. Track information
Track information such as the song
name, artist name and album name are
displayed.
3. Audio source indicator
Indicates the currently selected audio
source.
4. Album artwork
An image of the album artwork is displayed when available if the setting is
turned on.
Description
Each time “
” key is
touched, the repeat mode
changes.
Touch to return to the beginning of the current track.
Touch again to select the
previous track. Touch and
hold to rewind the current
track.
Touch to play the track.
Touch to pause the track.
Touch to select the next
track. Touch and hold to
fast-forward the track.
Each time “
” key is
touched, the random mode
changes.
4-62 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
iPod® memory device player
operation
Activation and playing
Connecting the iPod® to the vehicle via USB
cable will activate the iPod® mode.
The iPod® can also be played by touching
the “iPod” key on the Menu screen or by
touching iPod on the Launch Bar.
Skipping tracks
To skip the tracks, push the
or
buttons on the control panel or touch the “
” or “
” keys on the screen repeatedly until the preferred track is selected.
NOTE:
Depending on the condition, skipping to
the previous track may require pushing
the button or touching the key twice.
Pushing the button or touching the key
once may only restart the current track
from the beginning.
Fast-forwarding/rewinding
To rewind or fast-forward the track, push
or
buttons on the
and hold the
”
control panel or touch and hold the “
” keys on the screen,
or “
Changing play mode
iPod® Menu
Repeat mode
Touch the “iPod Menu” key on the iPod®
screen to display the iPod® Menu screen.
Touch the “
” key on the iPod® screen
to change the repeat mode. The following
modes are available.
No text displayed: Repeat off
“Now Playing” key Touch to display the USB
screen.
Random mode
“Folder List” key (if Touch to display the folder list.
so equipped)
Touch an item on the list to
select the folder. The subfolder or track list will be displayed. Select a sub-folder or
track from the list.
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
change the random mode as follows.
“Album Artwork”
key
Touch to run on/off the album
artwork display on the USB
screen.
No text displayed: Random off
“Playlists” key
Songs: Random play
“Artists” key
Touch to display the list according to the selected item.
All: Repeat all
One: Repeat track
“Albums” key
“Songs” key
LHA4319
iPod®* PLAYER OPERATION WITH
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
“Podcasts” key
Connecting iPod®
“Genres” key
“Composers” key
“Audiobooks” key
“iTunes Radio”
key
WARNING
Do not connect, disconnect or operate
the USB device while driving. Doing so
can be a distraction. If distracted you
could lose control of your vehicle and
cause an accident or serious injury.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-63
CAUTION
• Do not force the USB device into the
USB port. Inserting the USB device
tilted or up-side-down into the port
may damage the port. Make sure
that the USB device is connected correctly into the USB port.
• Do not grab the USB port cover (if so
equipped) when pulling the USB device out of the port. This could damage the port and the cover.
• Do not leave the USB cable in a place
where it can be pulled unintentionally. Pulling the cable may damage
the port.
For additional information, refer to your device manufacturer’s owner information regarding the proper use and care of the
device.
To connect an iPod® to the vehicle so that
the iPod® can be controlled with the audio
system controls and display screen, use
the USB port located on the instrument
panel. Connect the iPod®-specific end of
the cable to the iPod® and the USB end of
the cable to the USB port on the vehicle. If
your iPod® supports charging via a USB
connection, its battery will be charged
while connected to the vehicle with the ignition switch in the ACC or ON position.
While connected to the vehicle, the iPod®
can only be operated by the vehicle audio
controls.
To disconnect the iPod® from the vehicle,
remove the USB end of the cable from the
USB port on the vehicle, then remove the
cable from the iPod®.
* iPod® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries.
Compatibility
The following models are compatible:
• iPod® Classic 5th generation (firmware
version 1.3.0 or later)
• iPod® Classic 6th generation (firmware
version 2.0.1 or later)
• iPod® Classic 7th generation (firmware
version 2.0.4 or later)
• iPod® Touch 2nd generation (firmware
version 4.2.1 or later)*
• iPod® Touch 3rd generation (firmware
version 5.1 or later)
• iPod® Touch 4th generation (firmware
version 5.1 or later)
• iPod® nano - 1st generation (firmware
version 1.3.1 or later)
4-64 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• iPod® nano - 2nd generation (firmware
version 1.1.3 or later)
• iPod® nano - 3rd generation (firmware
version 1.1.3 or later)
• iPod® nano - 4th generation (firmware
version 1.0.4 or later)
• iPod® nano - 5th generation (firmware
version 1.0.2 or later)
• iPod® nano - 6th generation (firmware
version 1.1 or later)
• iPhone® 3G (firmware version 4.2.1 or later)
• iPhone® 3GS (firmware version 5.1 or later)
• iPhone® 4 (firmware version 5.1 or later)
• iPhone® 4S (firmware version 5.1 or later)
* Some features of this iPod® may not be
fully functional.
Make sure that your iPod® firmware is updated to the version indicated above.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Artists
Albums
Genres
Songs
Composers
Audiobooks
Podcasts
Shuffle and repeat play mode
While the iPod® is playing, the play pattern
can be altered so that songs are repeated
or played randomly.
LHA4007
LHA2907
Audio main operation
Interface
Place the ignition switch in the ACC or ON
position. Press the AUX button repeatedly
to switch to the iPod® mode.
The interface for iPod® operation shown on
the vehicle's audio system display screen is
similar to the iPod® interface. Use the
touch-screen, BACK button or the scrolling
knob to navigate the menus on the screen.
If the system has been turned off while the
iPod® was playing, pressing the ON·OFF
button will start the iPod®.
AUX button
When the AUX button is pressed with the
system off and the iPod® connected, the
system will turn on. If another audio source
is playing and the iPod® is connected, press
the AUX button repeatedly until the center
display changes to the iPod® mode.
When the iPod® is playing, touch the “Menu”
key to bring up the iPod® interface.
Depending on the iPod® model, the following items may be available on the menu list
screen. For additional information, refer to
the iPod® Owner's Manual regarding each
menu item.
• Playlists
Shuffle
Touch the “Shuffle” key to apply a random
play pattern to the iPod®. When the Shuffle
mode is active, the text is illuminated and
will display “Shuffle songs” text above the
“Shuffle” key. To cancel Shuffle mode, touch
the “Shuffle” key again until the text is no
longer illuminated.
Repeat
Touch the “Repeat” key to apply a repeat
play pattern to the iPod®. When the repeat
mode is active, the text is illuminated and
will display “Repeat song” text above the
“Repeat” key. To cancel Repeat mode, touch
the “Repeat” key again until the text is no
longer illuminated.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-65
BLUETOOTH® STREAMING AUDIO
WITHOUT NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
SEEK buttons
Press the SEEK button
or
backward or forward one track.
to skip
If you have a compatible Bluetooth® audio
device that is capable of playing audio files,
the device can be connected to the vehicle's audio system so that the audio files on
the device play through the vehicle's
speakers.
or
Press and hold the SEEK button
for 1.5 seconds while a track is playing
to reverse or fast forward the track being
played. The track plays at an increased
speed while reversing or fast forwarding.
When the button is released, the track returns to normal play speed.
LHA2279
Scrolling menus
While navigating long lists of artists, albums or songs in the music menu, it is
possible to scroll the list by the first character in the name. To activate character indexing, touch and hold the “A-Z” key in the
upper right corner of the screen. Turn the
TUNE knob to choose the number or letter
to jump to in the list and then press the
ENTER/AUDIO button.
If no character is selected after a few seconds, the display returns to normal.
4-66 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Connecting procedure
2. Touch the “Connections” key on the
screen.
NOTE:
3. In the Bluetooth tab, touch the “Add New”
key to connect a phone.
The connecting procedure must be performed when the vehicle is stationary. If
the vehicle starts moving during the procedure, the procedure will be canceled.
To connect a phone to the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System:
4. When a compatible phone is found a
message with a PIN appears on the
screen.
5. Verify the PIN is correct and accept the
connection.
Manual Connecting Procedure
1. Press the
trol panel.
MENU button on the conLHA4726
Menu Item
Result
Bluetooth
Allows user to switch Bluetooth® on and off. Bluetooth® must be turned on in order to connect a device.
ON
Turns Bluetooth® functionality on. To turn off, touch the “ON” key again. The indicator light will go off.
Favorite (Connection first)
Allows user to toggle “Phone” and “Audio” favorite settings on and off.
PIN
Allows user to customize the PIN to a four digit number.
Automatic Connecting Procedure
If no phone is connected to the system,
button on the
press and hold the
steering wheel for less than 1.5 seconds.
After the prompt, speak “Add Phone”, the
system will announce “transferring to the
add phone settings menu”. The system will
start the pairing procedure. When a compatible phone is found, a message with a
PIN appears on the screen. Operate the
Bluetooth® phone to complete the connection process. For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® connections
screen” in this section.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-67
4. Bluetooth® audio operation keys
Touch to control Bluetooth® audio playback functions
5. Play time and progress bar
The play time of the track is displayed.
The bar indicates the progress in playing
a track.
Bluetooth® operation keys
Touch to control Bluetooth® playback
functions.
Keys
LHA4727
Bluetooth® screen
1. “BT Menu” key
Depending on the Bluetooth® version
supported by the connected device, either the “BT Menu” key or “Connections”
key is displayed.
2. Track information
Track information such as the song
name, artist name and album name are
displayed.
3. Audio source indicator
Indicates the currently selected audio
source.
Description
Each time “
” key is
touched, the repeat mode
changes.
Touch to return to the beginning of the current track.
Touch again to select the
previous track. Touch and
hold to rewind the current
track.
Touch to play the track.
Bluetooth® audio operation
The ability to pause, change tracks, fast
forward, rewind, randomize and repeat
music may be different between devices.
Some or all of these functions may not be
supported on each device.
NOTE:
Depending on the Bluetooth® audio device that is connected, it may not be possible to perform audio operations or a delay may occur before music is played back.
Activation and playing
A Bluetooth® audio device can be played by
touching the “Bluetooth” key on the Menu
screen or by touching Bluetooth on the
Launch Bar.
To pause playing the Bluetooth® audio,
” key. Touch the “
” key
touch the “
to resume playing.
Touch to pause the track.
Changing folders
Touch to select the next
track. Touch and hold to
fast-forward the track.
To change folders, touch the “BT Menu” key.
” key is
Each time “
touched, the random mode
changes.
To fast-forward or rewind the track, push
or
buttons on the
and hold the
” or “
”
control panel or touch the “
keys on the screen.
4-68 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Fast-forwarding/rewinding
Changing play mode
NOTE:
Repeat mode
Depending on the connected device, the
“BT Menu” key may not be displayed.
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
change the repeat mode.
Random mode
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
change the random mode.
NOTE:
Available repeat/random modes change
depending on the connected device.
BT Menu
BLUETOOTH® STREAMING AUDIO
WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
If you have a compatible Bluetooth® audio
device that is capable of playing audio files,
the device can be connected to the vehicle's audio system so that the audio files on
the device play through the vehicle's
speakers.
LHA2773
Touch the “BT Menu” key on the Bluetooth®
audio screen to display the Bluetooth® audio menu screen.
The following items are available.
Connecting Bluetooth® audio
To connect your Bluetooth® audio device
to the vehicle, follow the procedure below:
1. Press the [
“Now Playing” key
Touch to display the
Bluetooth® audio screen.
“Current List” key (if so A list of track in the curequipped)*
rently selected folder is displayed.
“Connections” key
Touch to display the connections screen.
“Folder List” key*
Touch to display the folder
list. Touch an item on the
list to select the folder.
] button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “Phone & Bluetooth” key.
*: displayed only when available.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-69
Audio main operation
To switch to the Bluetooth® audio mode,
press the AUX button repeatedly until the
Bluetooth® audio mode is displayed on the
screen.
The controls for the Bluetooth® audio are
displayed on the screen.
LHA2844
LHA0049
4. Touch the “Connect New Device” key.
CD CARE AND CLEANING
5. The system acknowledges the command and asks you to initiate connecting from the phone handset.
• Handle a CD by its edges. Do not bend the
disc. Never touch the surface of the disc.
• Always place the discs in the storage
case when they are not being used.
• To clean a disc, wipe the surface from the
center to the outer edge using a clean,
soft cloth. Do not wipe the disc using a
circular motion.
• Do not use a conventional record cleaner
or alcohol intended for industrial use.
• A new disc may be rough on the inner and
outer edges. Remove the rough edges by
rubbing the inner and outer edges with the
side of a pen or pencil as illustrated.
NOTE:
The connecting procedure of the cellular
phone varies according to each cellular
phone model. For additional information, refer to the cellular phone owner’s
manual.
You
can
also
visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for instructions on connecting NISSAN recommended cellular phones.
4-70 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
MODE select switch
Push the MODE select switch to change
the mode in the following sequence:
AM →P1→ FM1 → FM2→ P2→ (SXM1 → SXM2
→ SXM3 (satellite radio, if so equipped)) →
CD* (if so equipped) → USB/iPod®* →
Bluetooth® Audio* → AUX* → AM→P1.
* These modes are only available when
compatible media storage is inserted into
the device or connected to the system.
Volume control switch
LHA2559
STEERING WHEEL SWITCH FOR
AUDIO CONTROL
The audio system can be operated using
the controls on the steering wheel.
1. Volume control switch
2. MODE select switch
3. Tuning switch
Push the volume control switch to increase
or decrease the volume.
Tuning switch
While the display is showing a map or audio
screen, tilt the Tuning switch upward or
downward to select a station, track, CD or
folder. For most audio sources, tilting the
switch up/down for more than 1.5 seconds
provides a different function than a tilting
up/down for less than 1.5 seconds.
AM and FM
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the preset station.
• Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
seek up or down to the next station.
SXM (if so equipped)
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the preset station.
• Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
go to the next or previous channel.
iPod®
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
CD (if so equipped)
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
• Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the folder number
(if playing compressed audio files).
USB
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the track number.
• Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
increase or decrease the folder number.
Bluetooth® Audio
• Tilt up/down for less than 1.5 seconds to
skip ahead or back to the next song.
• Tilt up/down for more than 1.5 seconds to
reverse or fast forward the current song.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-71
NISSANCONNECT® MOBILE APPS (if
so equipped)
ANTENNA
The antenna cannot be shortened, but can
be removed. When you need to remove the
antenna, turn the antenna rod counterclockwise.
To install the antenna rod, turn the antenna
rod clockwise and hand tighten.
CAUTION
• Always properly tighten the antenna
rod during installation or the antenna rod may break during vehicle
operation.
• Be sure that the antenna is removed
before the vehicle enters an automatic car wash.
Your vehicle may be equipped with
NissanConnect® Mobile Apps, allowing you
to control various compatible smartphone
applications through the vehicle’s display
screen. A basic package is included for a
period of time form the original in-service
date of the vehicle. For more details about
your Mobile Apps trial, please visit
www.nissanusa.com/connect/faq#apps&-features.
CONNECT PHONE
NOTE:
Apple iPhones® require the phone to be
plugged in via USB for NissanConnect®
Mobile Apps to function.
For Android phones, NissanConnect®
Mobile Apps requires the phone to be
paired via Bluetooth®.
A compatible smartphone and registration is required to use mobile applications or to access connected features of
certain vehicle applications.
REGISTERING WITH
NISSANCONNECT® MOBILE APPS
To use the Smartphone Integration feature, it
is necessary for the user to register. In order
to register, visit the NissanConnect® Mobile
Apps
website,
www.nissanusa.com/
connect/ or www.nissan.ca/en/connect or
www.nissan.ca/fr/connect and sign up or
create an account through the prompts on
the NissanConnect® Mobile Apps. Once registered, download the NissanConnect® Mobile Apps from your compatible phone’s application download source and then log into
the application. If you already have an account created through the App, please log in.
4-72 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
To use this feature, a compatible smartphone must be connected via Bluetooth®
or USB to the vehicle. For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System with Navigation System” in
this section.
NOTE:
SIRI® EYES FREE (models without
Navigation System) (if so equipped)
APPLICATION DOWNLOAD
Once connected, the NissanConnect® App
will search your phone to determine which
compatible applications are currently installed. The user will then choose which
apps they want to bring into their vehicle
from the list of apps within the “Manage My
Apps” section of the NissanConnect® App
on their smartphone. The vehicle will then
download the in-vehicle interface for each
of these compatible applications. Once
downloaded, the user can access their selected smartphone applications through
the vehicle touch-screen. For additional information, refer to www.nissanusa.com/
connect or www.nissan.ca/en/connect or
www.nissan.ca/fr/connect regarding application availability.
Apple Siri® Eyes Free personal assistant
can be accessed from the vehicle. Siri Eyes
Free can be accessed in Siri Eyes Free
mode to reduce user distraction. In this
mode, Siri Eyes Free is available for interaction by voice control. After connecting a
compatible Apple device by using
Bluetooth®, Siri Eyes Free can be activated
button on the steering
from the
wheel.
Siri® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered
in the U.S. and other countries.
• Some Siri Eyes Free functions, such as
displaying pictures or opening apps, may
not be available while driving.
• For getting best results, always update
your device to the latest software version.
• Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible. Close the windows to eliminate
the surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent
the system from recognizing the voice
commands correctly.
• For functions that can be used in Siri Eyes
Free, please refer to the Apple website.
REQUIREMENTS
Siri® is only available on the iPhone® 4S or
later. Devices released before iPhone® 4S
are not supported by the Siri® Eyes Free
system. Visit www.apple.com/ios/siri for
details about device compatibility.
Siri must be enabled on the phone. Please
check phone settings.
If the device has a lock screen, Siri must be
accessible from the lock screen. Please
check phone settings.
For best results, always update your device
to the latest software version.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-73
Example 1 – Playing music
1. Push
seconds.
button for more than 1.5
2. Say “Play (artist name, song name, etc.)”.
3. Your vehicle will automatically change to
Bluetooth® Audio or iPod® mode* when
the music starts playing. Mode selection
is determined by the phone.
* If the iPhone® is also connected with the
USB cable.
LHA2589
OPERATING SIRI® EYES FREE
1. Push
seconds.
button for more than 1.5
2. Speak your command and then listen to
the Siri® Eyes Free reply.
After starting Siri Eyes Free, push the
button again within 5 seconds of the end of
the Siri Eyes Free announcement to extend
the session.
If the audio track does not start playing
automatically after Siri Eyes Free ends, try
changing the track or audio source to resume playback.
NOTE:
For best results, use the native music
app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or
other 3rd party music apps may vary and
is controlled by the iPhone®.
4-74 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Example 2 – Replying to text messages
1. If a compatible iPhone® is connected
and “Show Notifications” of the iPhone®
settings is enabled, the vehicle will display a notification for new incoming text
messages.
2. After reading the message, push or
button to reply
push and hold the
using Siri Eyes Free.
3. After a beep sounds, say “Text message”
or a similar command to reply using Siri
Eyes Free.
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Symptom
Cannot access Siri Eyes
Free from switch on the
steering wheel
Audio Source does not
change automatically to
iPod® or Bluetooth® Audio mode
Cause and Countermeasure
Check if a Bluetooth® connection is established between the iPhone® and the system.
Check if Siri is enabled on the device. On your phone, go to Siri setting.
Check that Siri can be accessed from the device lock screen. This can be set in the settings menu of your phone.
For best results, use the native Music app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or other 3rd party
music apps may vary.
For best results, play media already stored on your device. Streaming music or playback from cloud storage may degrade performance.
Switch the source manually by pressing the AUX or MEDIA button on the vehicle audio system or the SOURCE select switch on the
steering wheel.
Play, pause, next track,
previous track or play
timer does not work
For best results, use the native Music app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or other 3rd party
music apps may vary and is controlled by the device.
Cannot hear any music/
audio being played back
from a connected
iPhone®
Check that the audio source is set to Bluetooth® Audio or iPod® mode. A USB connection is required for iPod® mode.
Cannot receive text mesCheck if “Send Notifications” is enabled on your phone. On the phone, go to Bluetooth® settings. Find the device name, like “My Car”.
sage notifications on the
Press the INFO button. Turn on “Show Notifications”.
vehicle audio system
Cannot reply to text mesAfter receiving an incoming text message, follow on-screen guidance. Push the
sage notifications by Siri
seconds for Siri Eyes Free. After Siri Eyes Free starts, say “Text Message”.
Eyes Free
button on the steering wheel for more than 1.5
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-75
SIRI® EYES FREE (models with
Navigation System) (if so equipped)
Apple Siri® Eyes Free personal assistant
can be accessed from the vehicle. Siri Eyes
Free can be accessed in Siri Eyes Free
mode to reduce user distraction. In this
mode, Siri Eyes Free is available for interaction by voice control. After connecting a
compatible Apple device by using
Bluetooth®, Siri Eyes Free can be activated
button on the steering
from the
wheel.
Siri® is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered
in the U.S. and other countries.
• Some Siri Eyes Free functions, such as
displaying pictures or opening apps, may
not be available while driving.
• For best results, always update your device to the latest software version.
• Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible. Close the windows to eliminate
the surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent
the system from recognizing the voice
commands correctly.
• For functions that can be used in Siri Eyes
Free, please refer to the Apple website.
REQUIREMENTS
Siri® is only available on the iPhone® 4S or
later. Devices released before iPhone® 4S
are not supported by the Siri® Eyes Free
system. Visit www.apple.com/ios/siri for
details about device compatibility.
Siri must be enabled on the phone. Please
check phone settings.
If the device has a lock screen, Siri must be
accessible from the lock screen. Please
check phone settings.
For best results, always update your device
to the latest software version.
4-76 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
LHA2589
SIRI® ACTIVATION
Siri® Eyes Free function can be activated by
button on the steering
pushing
wheel for more than 1.5 seconds.
1. Connect a Siri Eyes Free enabled
iPhone® to the vehicle. For additional information, refer to “Connecting procedure” in this section.
2. After the Bluetooth® connection is esbuttablished, push and hold the
ton to activate the Siri Eyes Free
function.
OPERATING SIRI® EYES FREE
1. Push or push and hold the
NOTE:
button.
2. Speak your command and then listen to
the Siri Eyes Free reply.
After starting Siri Eyes Free, push the
button again within 5 seconds of the end of
the Siri Eyes Free announcement to extend
the session.
Example 1 – Playing music
1. Push or push and hold the
button.
2. Say “Play (artist name, song name, etc.)”.
3. Your vehicle will automatically change to
Bluetooth® Audio or iPod® mode* when
the music starts playing. Mode selection
is determined by the phone.
* If the iPhone® is also connected with the
USB cable.
For best results, use the native music
app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or
other 3rd party music apps may vary and
is controlled by the iPhone®.
CHANGING SIRI® EYES FREE
SETTINGS
Settings for Siri® Eyes Free can be found in
the Bluetooth® settings menu. For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® settings” in this section.
Example 2 – Replying to text messages
1. Press the [
1. If a compatible iPhone® is connected
and “Show Notifications” of the iPhone®
settings is enabled, the vehicle will display a notification for new incoming text
messages.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
2. After reading the message, push or
button to reply
push and hold the
using Siri Eyes Free.
] button.
3. Touch the “Phone & Bluetooth” key.
4. Touch the “Phone settings” key.
5. Select “Short Press” or “Long Press” to set
the activation.
3. After a beep sounds, say “Text message”
or a similar command to reply using Siri
Eyes Free.
If the audio track does not start playing
automatically after Siri Eyes Free ends, try
changing the track or audio source to resume playback.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-77
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
Symptom
Cannot access Siri Eyes
Free from switch on the
steering wheel
Audio Source does not
change automatically to
iPod® or Bluetooth® Audio mode
Cause and Countermeasure
Check if a Bluetooth® connection is established between the iPhone® and the system.
Check if Siri is enabled on the device. On your phone, go to Siri setting.
Check that Siri can be accessed from the device lock screen. This can be set in the settings menu of your phone.
For best results, use the native Music app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or other 3rd party
music apps may vary.
For best results, play media already stored on your device. Streaming music or playback from cloud storage may degrade performance.
Switch the source manually by pressing the AUX or MEDIA button on the vehicle audio system or the SOURCE select switch on the
steering wheel.
Play, pause, next track,
previous track or play
timer does not work
For best results, use the native Music app. Performance of music control function while using Podcasts, Audiobook or other 3rd party
music apps may vary and is controlled by the device.
Cannot hear any music/
audio being played back
from a connected
iPhone®
Check that the audio source is set to Bluetooth® Audio or iPod® mode. A USB connection is required for iPod® mode.
Cannot hear map turnby-turn direction guidance from a connected
iPhone®
Check that the audio source is set to Bluetooth® Audio or iPod® mode. A USB connection is required for iPod® mode.
Cannot receive text mesCheck if “Send Notifications” is enabled on your phone. On the phone, go to Bluetooth® settings. Find the device name, like “My Car”.
sage notifications on the
Press the info button. Turn on “Show Notifications”.
vehicle audio system
Cannot reply to text mesAfter receiving an incoming text message, follow on-screen guidance. Push or push and hold the
sage notifications by Siri
for Siri Eyes Free. After Siri Eyes Free starts, say “Text Message”.
Eyes Free
4-78 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
button on the steering wheel
CAR PHONE OR CB RADIO
When installing a CB, ham radio or car
phone in your vehicle, be sure to observe
the following precautions; otherwise, the
new equipment may adversely affect the
engine control system and other electronic
parts.
WARNING
• A cellular phone should not be used
for any purpose while driving so full
attention may be given to vehicle operation. Some jurisdictions prohibit
the use of cellular phones while
driving.
• If you must make a call while your
vehicle is in motion, the hands free
cellular phone operational mode (if
so equipped) is highly recommended. Exercise extreme caution at
all times so full attention may be
given to vehicle operation.
• If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to
a safe location and stop your vehicle.
BLUETOOTH® HANDS-FREE PHONE
SYSTEM WITHOUT NAVIGATION
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
CAUTION
• Keep the antenna as far away as possible from the electronic control
modules.
• Keep the antenna wire more than 8 in
(20 cm) away from the electronic
control system harnesses. Do not
route the antenna wire next to any
harness.
• Adjust the antenna standing-wave
ratio as recommended by the
manufacturer.
• Connect the ground wire from the CB
radio chassis to the body.
• For additional information, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer.
• Do not ground electrical accessories
directly to the battery terminal. Doing so will bypass the variable voltage control system and the vehicle
battery may not charge completely.
For additional information, refer to
“Variable voltage control system” in
the “Do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
• Use electrical accessories with the
engine running to avoid discharging
the vehicle battery.
WARNING
• Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to
use a phone while driving, exercise
extreme caution at all times so full
attention may be given to vehicle
operation.
• If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to
a safe location and stop your vehicle.
CAUTION
To avoid discharging the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the
engine.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-79
the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with the previously connected cellular phone turned on and carried in the vehicle.
NOTE:
Some devices require the user to accept
connections to other Bluetooth® devices. If your phone does not connect automatic ally to the system, consult the
phone's owner's manual for details on
device operation.
You can connect up to five different
Bluetooth® cellular phones to the invehicle phone module. However, you can
talk on only one cellular phone at a time.
LHA4813
Your NISSAN is equipped with the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System. If
you have a compatible Bluetooth® enabled
cellular phone, you can set up the wireless
connection between your cellular phone
and the in-vehicle phone module. With
Bluetooth® wireless technology, you can
make or receive a hands-free telephone
call with your cellular phone in the vehicle.
Once your cellular phone is connected to
the in-vehicle phone module, no other
phone connecting procedure is required.
Your phone is automatically connected
with the in-vehicle phone module when
4-80 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Before using the Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System, refer to the following notes.
• Set up the wireless connection between
a compatible cellular phone and the invehicle phone module before using the
hands-free phone system.
• Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular
phones may not be recognized or work
properly.
Please
visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and connecting instructions.
• You will not be able to use a hands-free
phone under the following conditions:
– Your vehicle is outside of the cellular
service area.
– Your vehicle is in an area where it is
difficult to receive a cellular signal; such
as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a
mountainous area.
– Your cellular phone is locked to prevent
it from being dialed.
• When the radio wave condition is not
ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may
be difficult to hear the other person's
voice during a call.
• Do not place the cellular phone in an area
surrounded by metal or far away from
the in-vehicle phone module to prevent
tone quality degradation and wireless
connection disruption.
• While a cellular phone is connected
through the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular
phone may discharge quicker than usual.
The Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones.
• For additional information, you can visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for troubleshooting help.
• Some cellular phones or other devices
may cause interference or a buzzing noise
to come from the audio system speakers.
Storing the device in a different location
may reduce or eliminate the noise.
• For additional information, refer to the
cellular phone owner's manual regarding
the telephone charges, cellular phone
antenna and body, etc.
cept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
– This Class B digital apparatus meets all
requirements
of
the
Canadian
Interference-Causing Equipment Regulations.
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and
licensed to
Panasonic.
REGULATORY INFORMATION
FCC Regulatory information
– CAUTION: To maintain compliance with
FCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only
the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments
could damage the transmitter and may
violate FCC regulations.
– Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1) This device may not cause interfer1.
ence and
2) this device must accept any interfer2.
ence, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the
device.
IC Regulatory information
– Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must ac-
USING THE SYSTEM
The system allows hands-free operation of
the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
If the vehicle is in motion, some commands
may not be available so full attention may
be given to vehicle operation.
Initialization
When the ignition switch is placed in the ON
position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized, which takes a few seconds. If the
button is pressed before the initialization
completes, the system will announce
“There is no phone connected” and will not
react to voice commands.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-81
Operating tips
Giving voice commands
To get the best performance out of the
NISSAN Voice Recognition System, observe
the following:
• Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible. Keep all vents pointed away
from the microphone and close the windows to eliminate surrounding noises
(traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.),
which may prevent the system from recognizing voice commands correctly.
• Wait until the tone sounds before speaking a command. Otherwise, the command will not be received properly.
• Start speaking a command within 5 seconds after the tone sounds.
• Speak in a natural voice without pausing
between words.
• For calling contacts by name, please say
both the first and last name of the contact for better recognition.
To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition,
button located on the
press the
steering wheel for less than 1.5 seconds.
After the tone sounds, speak a command.
The command given is picked up by the
microphone, and voice feedback is given
when the command is accepted.
• If a command is not recognized, the system announces, “Please say or select a
command from the displayed list.” Make
sure the command is said exactly as
prompted by the system and repeat the
command in a clear voice.
• If you want to go back to the previous
command, you can say “Go back” any
time the system is waiting for a response.
• You can cancel a command when the
system is waiting for a response by saying, “Cancel” or “Quit.” The system announces “Exit” and ends the Voice Recognition session. You can also press and
button on the steering
hold the
wheel for 1.5 seconds at any time to end
the Voice Recognition session. Whenever
the Voice Recognition session is canceled, a double beep is played to indicate
you have exited the system.
4-82 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• If you want to adjust the volume of the
voice feedback, push the (+ or -) volume
control switches on the steering wheel
while being provided with feedback. You
can also use the radio volume control
knob.
Voice Prompt Interrupt
In most cases you can interrupt the voice
feedback to speak the next command by
button on the steering
pressing the
wheel. After interrupting the system, wait
for a beep before speaking your command.
One Shot Call (if so equipped)
To use the system faster, you may speak
the second level commands with the main
menu command on the main menu. For
button and after
example, press the
the tone say, “Call Redial”.
You can use the
button to
interrupt the system feedback
and give a command at once.
If an iPhone® is connected, Siri®
can be accessed by pressing the
button for more than two
seconds. For additional information, refer to “Siri® Eyes Free” in this
section.
PHONE BUTTON
To answer an incoming call or to
end a call press the
button.
LHA4723
LHA2561
INDICATORS
CONTROL BUTTONS
When a cellular phone is connected through
the Bluetooth® wireless connection, indica1 for the phone and text messaging are
tors O
displayed on the top of the screen.
The control buttons for the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System are located on
the steering wheel.
Indicator
Description
Indicates there are unread received
messages.
Indicates the Bluetooth® device
that is currently connected.
Indicates the strength of the signal
the Bluetooth® device is receiving.
Indicates the amount of remaining
Bluetooth® device battery.
To reject a call press and hold the
button.
VOICE COMMAND BUTTON
Press and hold the
button
for less than 1.5 seconds to initiate the Voice Recognition session.
To exit the Voice Recognition sesfor
sion press and hold the
more than 1.5 seconds. For additional information, refer to “Voice
prompt interrupt” in this section.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-83
CONNECTING PROCEDURE
2. Touch the “Connections” key on the
screen.
NOTE:
3. In the Bluetooth tab, touch the “Add New”
key to connect a phone.
The connecting procedure must be performed when the vehicle is stationary. If
the vehicle starts moving during the procedure, the procedure will be canceled.
To connect a phone to the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System:
4. When a compatible phone is found a
message with a PIN appears on the
screen.
5. Verify the PIN is correct and accept the
connection.
Manual Connecting Procedure
1. Press the
trol panel.
MENU button on the conLHA4726
Menu Item
6. To access the Bluetooth® settings menu
” key on the Connections
touch the “
screen. The following options are
available:
Result
Bluetooth
Allows user to switch Bluetooth® on and off. Bluetooth® must be turned on in order to connect a device.
ON
Turns Bluetooth® functionality on. To turn off, touch the “ON” key again. The indicator light will go off.
Favorite (Connection first)
Allows user to toggle “Phone” and “Audio” favorite settings on and off.
PIN
Allows user to customize the PIN to a four digit number.
4-84 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
NOTE:
VOICE COMMANDS
“Call
”
Some cellular phones may require you to
accept certain permissions in order to
enable features on your Bluetooth® system. During the Bluetooth® pairing process, please check your cellular phone’s
display for a pop-up with the request to
grant phonebook access.
Granting phonebook access permission
will allow your contacts to be downloaded to the vehicle’s Bluetooth® system. A pop-up may display on your cellular phone stating that the Bluetooth®
system would like to access your contacts and call history. Please select “Allow” or Yes” to grant this permission.
Voice commands can be used to operate
the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
button to bring up the
Press the
phone command menu. The commands
available are:
• Call
• Dial
• Recent Calls
• Read/Send Text (if so equipped)
• Siri® (if so equipped)
• Voice Assistant (if so equipped)
• Phonebook
• Quick Dial
• Redial
• Select Phone
• Add Phone
• Call Mobile
• Call Home
• Call Office
• Call Main
• Call Other
• Settings
Speak this command to make a call to a
contact that is stored in the phonebook.
Say “Call” followed by a phonebook name to
initiate a call. If the system does not recognize the name it will display a list of similar
names. After the prompt, speak or touch
an item number from the displayed list to
place the call.
Automatic Connecting Procedure
If no phone is connected to the system,
button on the
press and hold the
steering wheel for less than 1.5 seconds.
After the prompt, speak “Add Phone”, the
system will announce “transferring to the
add phone settings menu”. The system will
start the pairing procedure. When a compatible phone is found, a message with a
PIN appears on the screen. Operate the
Bluetooth® phone to complete the connection process. For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth® connections
screen” in this section.
“Dial ”
Speak this command to make a call with a
spoken phone number. After the prompt,
say “Dial” followed by a 7 to 10 digit phone
number. The system will repeat the number back. Say “Dial” to initiate the call or
“Correction” to re-enter the phone number.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-85
“Recent Calls”
The following commands are available under “Recent Calls”:
• Incoming Calls
Speak this command to list the last 20 incoming calls to the vehicle. If the call is from
an entry in the phonebook, the name will
be displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of the incoming call will be displayed.
When prompted, speak or touch the item
number on the screen to place the call.
Touch the “Next” key to move through the
list of incoming calls.
• Outgoing Calls
Speak this command to list the last 20
outgoing calls from the vehicle. If the call
was to an entry in the phonebook, the
name will be displayed. Otherwise, the
phone number of the outgoing call will be
displayed.
When prompted, speak or touch the item
number on the screen to place the call.
Touch the “Next” key to move through the
list of outgoing calls.
• Missed Calls
Speak this command to list the last 20
missed calls to the vehicle. If the call is from
an entry in the phonebook, the name will
be displayed. Otherwise, the phone number of the missed call will be displayed.
When prompted, speak or touch the item
number on the screen to place the call.
Touch the “Next” key to move through the
list of missed calls.
“Read Text/Send Text” (if so
equipped)
Speak this command to access text messaging functions. For additional information,
refer to “Text messaging” in this section.
“Phonebook through voice
command”
Speak “Phonebook” to view a list of quick
steps to access entries stored in the
phonebook. Commands are organized by
the phone number type selected in the cellular device. For additional information, refer to the cellular phone’s owner’s manual.
The following commands are available:
•
• Main
• Home
4-86 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• Mobile
• Office
• Other
For additional information on manually selecting phonebook entries, refer to “Making
a call” in this section.
“Quick dial”
Speak this command to access the Quick
dial menu. After the prompt, speak or select an item number on the displayed list to
place the call. For additional information,
refer to “Making a call” in this section.
“Redial”
Speak this command to call the last number dialed. After the prompt, say “Redial” to
dial the number of the last outgoing call.
The system will display “Redialing ”. The name of the phonebook entry will be displayed if it is available, otherwise the number being redialed will be
displayed.
“Select Phone”
Speak this command to access the Connections menu. For additional information,
refer to “Bluetooth® connections screen” in
this section.
“Add Phone”
Speak this command to access the Connections menu. For additional information,
refer to “Bluetooth® connections screen” in
this section.
“Settings”
Speak this command to access the System Voice settings menu. The system will
exit Voice Recognition mode. Touch one of
the following options on the screen to
change the settings.
• Beep Only for Opening Prompt
By touching the “ON” key, the indicator
light will illuminate, the system voice will
turn off and only a tone will sound when
the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System is activated. To turn the system voice
back on, touch the “ON” key again, the
indicator light will turn off.
• Best Match List
When the system doesn't recognize a
phonebook name or dial number, it will
provide a list of similar sounding results.
To turn this off, touch the “ON” key, the
indicator light will turn off. To turn on,
touch the “ON” key again, the indicator
light will turn on.
LHA4705
PHONE DISPLAY SCREEN
The Phone screen can be displayed by
button on the control
pressing the
panel.
The following options are displayed:
• Quick Dial
Displays the Quick Dial screen. For additional information, refer to “Quick dial” in
this section.
• Phonebook
Displays the Phonebook screen. For additional information, refer to “Making a call”
in this section.
• Call History
Displays the Call History screen. For additional information, refer to “Making a call”
in this section.
• Dial Number
Displays the Dial Number screen. For additional information, refer to “Making a
call” in this section.
• Text Message
Displays the received message screen.
For additional information, refer to “Text
messaging” in this section.
• Connections
Displays the Connections screen. For additional information, refer to “Bluetooth®
connections screen” in this section.
• Volume
Displays the volume adjustment screen.
For additional information, refer to “Volume & beeps” in this section.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-87
MAKING A CALL
Quick Dial
Voice tag
To make a call press the
button on the
control panel. Touch an option from menu
screen:
• Phonebook
Select a person and the phone number
you wish to call from the phonebook.
Depending on the device, the phonebook
will be downloaded from the cellular
phone automatically when it is connected. If the automatic download does
not take place, the phone number must
be transferred to the hands-free phone
system from the cellular phone prior to
using this method. For additional information, refer to “Phone and text message
settings” in this section.
• Call History
Select a phonebook name or phone
number from the recent incoming, outgoing or missed calls tabs. Touch a
phonebook name or phone number
listed to initiate the call.
• Dial Number
Enter the phone number manually using
the keypad displayed on the screen.
Touch the “OK” key on the screen to initiate the call.
Quick Dial entries can be used to quickly
make a call. The system allows up to 20
entries to be stored. To set up a quick dial
button on the control panel.
press the
Touch the “Quick Dial” key to display a list of
quick dial entries. Touch the “Edit” key to
edit current entries or touch the “Add New”
key to make a new entry. Two methods are
given to create a quick dial entry:
• Touch the “Copy from Call History” key to
save a phone number from the Incoming,
Outgoing or Missed call history lists. Select the person or phone number from
the menu to be added. A registration
menu will display the Entry #, phone number, phone number type stored in the cellular phone and Voice Tag. Touch the “OK”
key.
• Touch the “Copy from Phonebook” key to
save a number from the phonebook. Use
the scroll keys on the side to move up and
down through the menu. Select a person
to be added. A menu will display the Entry
#, phone number, phone number type
stored in the cellular phone and Voice
Tag. Touch the “OK” key.
A voice tag can be recorded for each of the
registered Quick Dial numbers and can be
used to dial the number by speaking it. On
the Quick Dial registration screen, touch
the “Voice Tag” key. Select a relationship
from the list or create a new voice tag. To
record a new voice tag touch the “Customize” key on the screen then touch the “Store”
key. Speak a name after the prompt, the
new tag will be stored. To edit or create a
new voice tag touch the “Customize” key
again. Touch the “Play” key to play the recorded voice tag, touch the “Restore” key to
edit the voice tag or “Delete” to delete the
current voice tag.
For additional options to make a call, refer
to “Voice commands” in this section.
4-88 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
RECEIVING A CALL
When a call is received by the phone connected to the vehicle’s Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System, the call information is
displayed on the control panel display.
button on the steering
Press the
Answer” key on
wheel or touch the “
the screen to accept the call. To reject the
Decline” key on the
call touch the “
screen.
If the user is not able to answer the call
right away, touch the “Hold Call” key displayed on the screen. A message will be
played for the caller: “I’m not able to take a
call right now.” The user may then accept
the call when available or reject the call.
To reject a call, press and hold the
button on the steering wheel.
DURING A CALL
While a call is active the following options
will appear on the control panel display:
• Mute
Touch this key to mute or unmute the
system.
• Dial Number
Touch this key to dial digits during the
phone call.
• Use Handset
Touch this key to transfer the call to the
handset. To transfer the call back from
the handset to the Bluetooth® HandsbutFree Phone System, press the
ton on the control panel then select the
“Transfer Hands-free” key on the screen.
• Switch Call
This option will only be available when a
second call is active.
If supported by the phone, the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
allows for call waiting functionality. If a
call is received while another call is already active, a message will be displayed
button on
on the screen. Press the
the steering wheel or touch the “
Answer” key on screen to accept the inDecline” key
coming call. Touch the “
on the screen to reject the second call.
button
While a call is active, press the
on the steering wheel to access additional
options. Speak one of the following commands:
• “Send Digits”
Speak this command followed by the digits to enter digits during the phone call.
• “Switch call”
Speak this command to hold the second
call and switch back to the original call.
TEXT MESSAGING (if so equipped)
WARNING
• Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict the use of “Text-to-Speech”.
Check local regulations before using
this feature.
• Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict the use of some of the applications and features, such as social
networking and texting. Check local
regulations for any requirements.
• Use the text messaging feature after
stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use the feature
while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may
be given to vehicle operation.
• If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while using
the text messaging feature, pull off
the road to a safe location and stop
your vehicle.
ENDING A CALL
button
To end an active call, press the
on the steering wheel or touch the “
Hang up” key on the screen.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-89
NOTE:
This feature is automatically disabled if
the connected device does not support
the Message Access Profile (MAP). For
additional information, refer to the
phone’s owner’s manual for details and
instructions.
NOTE:
Many phones may require special permission to enable text messaging. Check
the phone’s screen during Bluetooth®
pairing. For some phones, you may need
to enable ‘Notifications’ in the phone’s
Bluetooth® menu for text messages to
appear on the headunit. For additional
information, refer to your phone’s owner’s manual. Text message integration
requires that the phone support MAP
(Message Access Profile) for both receiving and sending text messages. Some
phones may not support all text messaging features. Please refer to
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for compatibility information, as well as your device’s owner’s manual.
The system allows for the sending and receiving of text messages through the vehicle interface.
The availability of the text message function may vary depending on the cellular
phone.
When the cellular phone connected to the
vehicle receives a text message, a notification will appear on the control panel display. To check the message, touch the
“Read” key. Touch the “Ignore” key to save
the message to be checked later.
Access text messaging through the vehicles Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone or
through the vehicles control panel.
Text messaging using Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System (if so
equipped)
Sending a text message (if so equipped)
1. Press and hold the
button on the
steering wheel for less than 1.5 seconds.
2. Say “Send Text” after the tone.
3. The system will provide a list of available
commands in order to determine the
recipient of the text message. Choose
from the following:
• Phonebook
• Quick Dial
• Incoming Calls
4-90 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• Outgoing Calls
• Missed Calls
• Dial
4. Once a recipient is chosen, the system
prompts for which message to send.
Nine predefined messages are available
as well as three custom messages. To
choose one of the predefined messages, speak one of the following after
the tone:
• “Driving, can't text”
• “Call me”
• “On my way”
• “Running late”
• “Okay”
• “Yes”
• “No”
• “Where are you?”
• “When?”
To send one of the custom messages, say
“Custom Messages”. If more than one custom message is stored, the system will
prompt for the number of the desired custom message. For additional information
on setting and managing custom text
messages, refer to “Phone and text message settings” in this section.
Reading a received text message
Siri® Eyes Free (if so equipped)
Received message screen
1. Press and hold the
button on the
steering wheel for less than 1.5 seconds.
If a connected phone is equipped with Siri®,
it can also be used to create custom messages that are sent through the phone. For
additional information, refer to “Siri® Eyes
Free (models without Navigation System)”
in this section.
Touching the “Read” key on the incoming
message notification screen or selecting a
message from the message list will show
the details of the received message on the
display.
2. Say “Read Text” after the tone.
The display will show a list of 20 messages
with the sender and delivery time. Touch
the “Next” key on the screen to view all messages. To view a text message press the
button on the steering wheel and
speak the number item list on the screen.
The following options will be available:
• Play
Speak this command to have the system
say the message.
• Reply
Speak this command to send a text message response to the sender of the text
message.
• Call
Speak this command to call the sender.
• Previous
Speak this command to move to the previous text message (if available).
• Next
Speak this command to move to the next
text message (if available).
NOTE:
Text messages are only displayed if the
vehicle speed is less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
NOTE:
For Apple iPhones®, text messages can
only be sent through Siri.
Text messaging using the control
panel
Display received message list
1. Press the
panel.
button on the control
2. Touch the “Text Message” key on the
screen
3. Touch an item on the list to read or reply
to the message.
Available actions:
• Prev.
Touch this key to read the previous message.
• Next
Touch this key to read the next message.
• Play/Stop
Touch the “Play” key to have the handsfree phone system read out the received
message. Touch the “Stop” key to stop
reading.
• Call
If the sender of the message is registered
in the phonebook, touch the “Call” key to
make a call to the sender.
• Reply
A reply message can be selected from
the predefined list or by a custom message.
Up to 100 messages can be stored in the
message list.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-91
Sending a text message (if so equipped)
This function may not be supported depending on the cellular phone.
1. Press the
panel.
button on the control
2. Touch the “Text Message” key on the
screen.
3. Touch the “Create Message” key on the
screen.
The following items are available:
Available item
To
Select Text
Send
Action
Enter Number by Keypad
Enter the phone number of the recipient using the keypad. Touch the “OK” key to confirm.
Quick Dial
Select a recipient from the quick dial list.
Phonebook
Select a recipient from the phonebook.
Call History
Select a recipient/phone number from call history.
Fixed
Touch to display a list of predefined text messages.
Customized
Touch to display a list of custom text messages. Custom text can be created or edited from the setting
menu. For additional information, refer to “Phone and text message settings” in this section.
Touch to send the message.
4-92 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Touch the “Connections” key on the screen
then select the Bluetooth tab.
The paired phone will be added to the list
on the Bluetooth® connections screen.
Touching the name of another device on
the list will switch the connected device.
“
” (back) key
Touch the “
” key to go back to the
previous screen.
Connecting Bluetooth®
LHA4716
BLUETOOTH® CONNECTIONS
SCREEN
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
“
” (back) key
Bluetooth tab
Connections screen
“Add New” key
“
” (settings) key
“
” (info) key
“
” (Bluetooth® Audio connection) key
“
” (Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone
System connection) key
Access the Connections screen to change
settings and view Bluetooth® information.
To access the Connections screen press
MENU button on the control panel.
the
For additional information on connecting a
cellular phone or device to the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System, refer to “Connecting procedure” in this section.
NOTE:
Some cellular phones or other devices
may cause interference or a buzzing
noise to come from the audio system
speakers. Storing the device in a different location may reduce or eliminate the
noise.
Bluetooth tab
This tab will display up to 6 Bluetooth® devices. If 6 devices are already connected,
one of the devices must be deleted before
another device can be connected.
“Add New” key
Touch the key on the screen to connect a
new Bluetooth® device. For additional information, refer to “Connecting procedure”
in this section.
“
” (Bluetooth® settings) key
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
display a list of options.
• Bluetooth
Touch this key to turn the Bluetooth®
connection on or off
• Favorite (Connection first)
Touch this key to change which device
will be connected first when multiple devices are connected to the vehicle.
” key on or off to make the
Turn the “
device a favorite connection.
” key on or off to make the
Turn the “
device a favorite connection.
• Pin
Touch this key to customize the PIN code.
Input a four digit number then touch the
“OK” key. The new PIN will be set.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-93
“
” (info) key
Touch the “
” key on the screen to
display the information of the cellular
phone or to delete the device.
Touch the “Delete” key to remove a paired
device then select “Yes” when a message
appears.
“
” (Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System connection) key
“
” (Bluetooth® Audio
connection) key
A list of connected devices will be displayed
” key next to
on the screen. Touch the “
the name to connect a device to
Bluetooth® Audio. If the device is listed as a
favorite, a star will appear on the icon.
Touch the key again to disconnect the device. The device will not be removed from
the list. For additional information on re(info) key” in
moving a device, refer to “
this section.
A list of connected devices will be displayed
” key next to
on the screen. Touch the “
the name to connect a device to the
Hands-Free Phone System. If the phone is
listed as a favorite, a star will appear on the
icon. Touch the key again to disconnect the
device. The device will not be removed
from the list. For additional information on
(info) key”
removing a device, refer to “
in this section.
4-94 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
LHA4721
PHONE AND TEXT MESSAGE
SETTINGS
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System settings can be changed according to the user’s preference. To access the “Phone” setMENU button on
tings menu press the
the control panel. Touch the “Settings” key
then touch the “Phone” key.
The following options are available:
Menu Item
Result
Quick Dial
Edit
Delete All
Deletes all of the stored phone numbers in quick dial.
Phonebook
Download Entire Phonebook
All the phone numbers that are stored in a phonebook in the cellular phone that is connected to the vehicle are
downloaded at once. For additional information, refer to the cellular phone’s owner’s manual.
Text Message
Notifications
Automatic Hold
Entries in the Quick Dial can be edited. For additional information, refer to “Quick dial” in this section.
Auto Downloaded
Turns on/off automatic downloading of the phonebook when a new phone is connected.
Text Message
Turns the text messaging function on/off.
Text Message Ringtone
Turn the incoming message sound on/off.
Signature
Turns the signature setting for the outgoing text message on/off.
Auto Reply
Turns the automatic text message reply function on/off.
Auto Reply Text Message
Select the text message to be used for the automatic reply. Choose from a list of predefined messages or create a custom message.
Edit Custom Text
Create or edits a customized text message reply. To set a custom message, touch the “Add New” key. Select a
message from the recent text log. Touch the “OK” key to set the message or the “Select” key to choose a different message. Up to three custom messages can be set. To delete a message select the custom message and
touch the “Delete” key.
Driver Only
When this item is turned on, incoming call notification is displayed only on the handset.
Vehicle Ringtone
Turns the vehicle ringtone on/off.
When this item turns on, an incoming call will be put on hold automatically.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-95
BLUETOOTH® HANDS-FREE PHONE
SYSTEM WITH NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(if so equipped)
Volume & beeps
There are several methods to customize
the volume settings.
Volume & Beeps
The Volume & Beeps screen can be found
MENU button on the
by pressing the
control panel, touching the “Settings” key
on the screen and selecting “Volume &
Beeps”. To adjust the volume of the following options, touch the “–” and “+” keys on the
screen.
The available settings are:
• Ringtone
Adjust the volume level of the ringtone of
incoming calls.
• Outgoing Call
Adjust the volume level of the outgoing
calls.
• Voice Prompt Vol.
Adjust the volume level of the system
voice.
• Text-to-speech Vol.
Adjust the volume of the replay voice for
text messaging.
• Button Beeps
Turns on/off the button beep sounds and
alarm for prohibited operations.
Volume Settings
The Volume settings screen can be found
button on the control
by pressing the
panel then touching the “Volume” key on
the screen. To adjust the volume of the
following options, touch the “–” and “+” keys
on the screen.
The available settings are:
• Ringtone
Adjust the volume level of the ringtone of
incoming calls.
• Outgoing Call
Adjust the volume level of the outgoing
calls.
4-96 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
WARNING
• Use a phone after stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to
use a phone while driving, exercise
extreme caution at all times so full
attention may be given to vehicle
operation.
• If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while talking on the phone, pull off the road to
a safe location and stop your vehicle.
CAUTION
To avoid discharging the vehicle battery, use a phone after starting the
engine.
the ignition switch is placed in the ON position with the connected cellular phone
turned on and carried in the vehicle.
You can register up to five different
Bluetooth® cellular phones to the invehicle phone module. However, you can
talk on only one cellular phone at a time.
NISSAN Voice Recognition system supports the phone commands, so dialing a
phone number using your voice is possible.
For additional information, refer to “NISSAN
Voice Recognition System” in this section.
LHA3144
Your NISSAN is equipped with the
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System. If
you have a compatible Bluetooth® enabled
cellular phone, you can set up the wireless
connection between your cellular phone
and the in-vehicle phone module. With
Bluetooth® wireless technology, you can
make or receive a hands-free telephone
call with your cellular phone in the vehicle.
Once your cellular phone is connected to
the in-vehicle phone module, no other
phone connecting procedure is required.
Your phone is automatically connected
with the in-vehicle phone module when
Before using the Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System, refer to the following notes.
• Set up the wireless connection between
a cellular phone and the in-vehicle phone
module before using the hands-free
phone system.
• Some Bluetooth® enabled cellular
phones may not be recognized by the
in-vehicle phone module. Please visit
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for a recommended phone list and connecting instructions.
• You will not be able to use a hands-free
phone under the following conditions:
– Your vehicle is outside of the cellular
service area.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-97
•
•
•
•
– Your vehicle is in an area where it is
difficult to receive cellular signal; such
as in a tunnel, in an underground parking garage, near a tall building or in a
mountainous area.
– Your cellular phone is locked to prevent
it from being dialed.
When the radio wave condition is not
ideal or ambient sound is too loud, it may
be difficult to hear the other person's
voice during a call.
Immediately after the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position, it may be impossible to receive a call for a short period
of time.
Do not place the cellular phone in an area
surrounded by metal or far away from
the in-vehicle phone module to prevent
tone quality degradation and wireless
connection disruption.
While a cellular phone is connected
through the Bluetooth® wireless connection, the battery power of the cellular
phone may discharge quicker than usual.
The Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System cannot charge cellular phones.
• If the hands-free phone system seems to
be malfunctioning, refer to “Troubleshooting guide” in this section. You can
also visit www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for troubleshooting help.
• Some cellular phones or other devices
may cause interference or a buzzing
noise to come from the audio system
speakers. Storing the device in a different
location may reduce or eliminate the
noise.
• Refer to the cellular phone owner's
manual
regarding
the
telephone
charges, cellular phone antenna and
body, etc.
• The signal strength display on the monitor will not coincide with the signal
strength display of some cellular phones.
REGULATORY INFORMATION
FCC Regulatory information
– CAUTION: To maintain compliance with
FCC’s RF exposure guidelines, use only
the supplied antenna. Unauthorized antenna, modification, or attachments
could damage the transmitter and may
violate FCC regulations.
4-98 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
– Operation is subject to the following two
conditions:
1) This device may not cause interfer1.
ence and
2) this device must accept any interfer2.
ence, including interference that may
cause undesired operation of the
device.
IC Regulatory information
– Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
– This Class B digital apparatus meets all
requirements
of
the
Canadian
Interference-Causing Equipment Regulations.
BLUETOOTH® is a
trademark owned by
Bluetooth SIG, Inc. and
licensed to Bosch.
VOICE COMMANDS
5. Initiate the connecting process from the
handset. The system will display the message: “Confirm on your Bluetooth device
that the PIN XXXXXX is displayed”. If the PIN
is displayed on your Bluetooth® device, select “Pair” to complete the pairing process.
For additional information, refer to the
Bluetooth® device's owner's manual.
You can use voice commands to operate
various Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System features using the NISSAN Voice Recognition system. For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Voice Recognition
System” in this section.
Voice Prompt Interrupt
While using the Voice Recognition system,
the system voice can be interrupted to allow the user to speak commands. While
the system is speaking, press the
button on the steering wheel. The system
voice will stop and a tone will be heard.
After the tone, speak desired command
(displayed on the touch-screen).
One Shot Call (if so equipped)
To use the system faster, you may speak
the second level commands with the main
menu command on the main menu. For
button and after
example, press the
the tone say, “Call Redial”.
VEHICLE PHONEBOOK
To access the vehicle phonebook:
1. Press the
panel.
LHA2773
CONNECTING PROCEDURE
NOTE:
The connecting procedure must be performed when the vehicle is stationary. If
the vehicle starts moving during the procedure, the procedure will be canceled.
1. Press the [
panel.
] button on the control
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “Phone & Bluetooth” key.
4. Touch the “Connect New Device” key.
button on the control
2. Touch the “Phonebook” key.
3. Choose the desired entry from the displayed list.
4. The number of the entry will be displayed on the screen. Touch the number
to initiate dialing.
NOTE:
To scroll quickly through the list, touch
the “A-Z” key in the upper right corner of
the screen. Turn the TUNE knob to
choose a letter or number and then
press the ENTER/AUDIO button. The list
will move to the first entry that begins
with that number or letter.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-99
MAKING A CALL
To make a call, follow the procedure below:
1. Press the
button on the control
panel. The “Phone” screen will appear on
the display.
To reject the incoming call, either:
button on the steering
• Press the
wheel, or
icon on the screen.
• Touch the
DURING A CALL
2. Select one of the following options to
make a call:
• “Phonebook”: Select the name from an
entry stored in the vehicle phonebook.
• “Call Lists”: Select the name from the incoming, outgoing or missed.
• “Redial”: Dial the last outgoing call from
the vehicle.
”: Input the phone number manually
• “
using a keypad displayed on the screen.
For additional information, refer to “How
to use the touch-screen” in this section.
While a call is active, the following options
are available on the screen:
• “Handset”
Select this option to switch control of the
phone call over to the handset.
• “Mute Mic.”
Select this option to mute the microphone. Select again to unmute the microphone.
icon
• Phone
Select to end the phone call.
RECEIVING A CALL
To end a phone call, select the phone
icon on the screen or press the
button
on the steering wheel.
When a call is placed to the connected
phone, the display will change to phone
mode.
ENDING A CALL
To accept the incoming call, either:
button on the steering
• Press the
wheel, or
icon on the screen.
• Touch the
4-100 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
TEXT MESSAGING (if so equipped)
WARNING
• Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict the use of “Text-to-Speech”.
Check local regulations before using
this feature.
• Laws in some jurisdictions may restrict the use of some of the applications and features, such as social
networking and texting. Check local
regulations for any requirements.
• Use the text messaging feature after
stopping your vehicle in a safe location. If you have to use the feature
while driving, exercise extreme caution at all times so full attention may
be given to vehicle operation.
• If you are unable to devote full attention to vehicle operation while using
the text messaging feature, pull off
the road to a safe location and stop
your vehicle.
NOTE:
This feature is automatically disabled if
the connected device does not support
the Message Access Profile (MAP). For
additional information, refer to the
phone’s owner’s manual for details and
instructions.
NOTE:
Many phones may require special permission to enable text messaging. Check
the phone’s screen during Bluetooth®
pairing. For some phones, you may need
to enable ‘Notifications’ in the phone’s
Bluetooth® menu for text messages to
appear on the headunit. For additional
information, refer to your phone’s owner’s manual. Text message integration
requires that the phone support MAP
(Message Access Profile) for both receiving and sending text messages. Some
phones may not support all text messaging features. For additional information,
please
refer
to
www.nissanusa.com/bluetooth
or
www.nissan.ca/bluetooth for compatibility information, as well as your device’s owner’s manual.
The system allows for the sending and receiving of text messages through the vehicle interface.
Sending a text message:
1. Press the
wheel.
button on the steering
2. Say “Phone” after the tone.
3. Say “Send Text” after the tone.
4. The system will provide a list of available
commands in order to determine the
recipient of the text message. Choose
from the following:
• To (a name)
• Enter Number
• Missed Calls
• Incoming Calls
• Outgoing Calls
For additional information about these options, refer to “Voice commands” in this
section.
5. Once a recipient is chosen, the system
prompts for which message to send.
Nine predefined messages are available
as well as three custom messages. To
choose one of the predefined messages, speak one of the following after
the tone:
• “Driving, can't text”
• “Call me”
• “On my way”
• “Running late”
• “Okay”
• “Yes”
• “No”
• “Where are you?”
• “When?”
• “Custom Messages”
To send one of the custom messages, say
“Custom Messages”. If more than one custom message is stored, the system will
prompt for the number of the desired custom message. For additional information
on setting and managing custom text
messages, refer to “Bluetooth® settings” in
this section.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-101
Reading a received text message:
1. Press the
wheel.
button on the steering
2. Say “Phone” after the tone.
3. Say “Read Text” after the tone.
The text message, sender and delivery
time are shown on the screen. Use the
buttons to scroll through all text messages if more than one are available. Press
button to exit the text message
the
button to access
screen. Press the
the following options for replying to the text
message:
• Call Back
Speak this command to call the sender of
the text message using the Bluetooth®
Hands-Free Phone System.
• Send Text
Speak this command to send a text message response to the sender of the text
message.
• Read Text
Speak this command to read the text
message again.
• Previous Text
Speak this command to move to the previous text message (if available).
• Next Text
Speak this command to move to the next
text message (if available).
4-102 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
Siri® Eyes Free (if so equipped)
If a connected phone is equipped with Siri®,
it can also be used to create custom messages that are sent through the phone. For
additional information, refer to “Siri® Eyes
Free (models with Navigation System)” in
this section.
NOTE:
Text messages are only displayed if the
vehicle speed is less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
NOTE:
For Apple iPhones®, text messages can
only be sent through Siri.
BLUETOOTH® SETTINGS
To access the phone settings:
1. Press the [
] button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “Phone & Bluetooth” key.
LHA2844
Menu Item
Phone Settings
Result
For additional information, refer to “Phone settings” in this section.
Connect New Device
Select to connect a new Bluetooth® device to the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
Select Connected Device
Select to choose a Bluetooth® device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
Replace Connected Device
Select to replace a Bluetooth® device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
Delete Connected Device
Select to delete a Bluetooth® device from a list of those devices connected to the Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System.
Bluetooth
Select to toggle Bluetooth® on and off.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-103
PHONE SETTINGS
To access the phone settings:
1. Press the [
] button.
2. Touch the “Settings” key.
3. Touch the “Phone & Bluetooth” key.
4. Touch the “Phone Settings” key and adjust the following settings as desired:
• Start Siri® by:
Touch “Short Press” or “Long Press” to set
how Siri® is operated on the steering
wheel.
• Sort Phonebook By:
Touch “First Name” or “Last Name” to
choose how phonebook entries are alphabetically displayed on the screen.
• Use Phonebook From:
Touch “Handset” to use the phone's
phonebook. Touch “SIM” to use the
phonebook on the SIM card. Select “Both”
to use both sources.
• Download Phonebook Now:
Touch to download the phonebook to
the vehicle from the chosen source.
• Record Name for Phonebook Entry:
Touch to record a name for a phonebook
entry for use with the NISSAN Voice Recognition System.
• Phone Notifications for:
Notifications may be displayed on the
center display screen.
• Text Messaging (if so equipped):
Touch to toggle the text message functionality on or off.
• Show Incoming Text for:
Text notifications may be displayed on
the center display screen. Touch “Off” to
turn off all text notifications.
• Auto Reply:
Touch to toggle the auto reply functionality on or off.
4-104 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• Auto Reply Message:
Touch to indicate preferred message to
be sent when “Auto Reply” function is activated.
• Use Vehicle's Signature:
Touch to toggle on or off the addition of
the vehicle signature to outgoing messages.
• Custom Text Messages:
Touch this option to select a custom
message to edit. There are 4 customer
message slots available.
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
The system should respond correctly to all
voice commands without difficulty. If problems are encountered, try the following solutions.
Where the solutions are listed by number,
try each solution in turn, starting with number 1, until the problem is resolved.
Symptom
Solution
1. Ensure that the command is valid. For additional information, refer to “NISSAN Voice Recognition System” in this section.
2. Ensure that the command is spoken after the tone.
System fails to interpret the command correctly.
3. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level in
the vehicle.
4. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, windows open or defroster on).
NOTE: If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that the voice commands will not be recognized.
5. If more than one command was said at a time, try saying the commands separately.
The system consistently selects the wrong entry from
the phone book.
1. Ensure that the phone book entry name requested matches what was originally stored. For additional
information, refer to “Vehicle phonebook” in this section.
2. Replace one of the names being confused with a new name.
3. Please speak both first and last name of contact to improve recognition accuracy.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-105
NISSAN VOICE RECOGNITION
SYSTEM (if so equipped)
The NISSAN Voice Recognition System allows hands-free operation of the systems
equipped on this vehicle, such as the
phone and navigation systems.
To operate NISSAN Voice Recognition,
button located on the
press the
steering wheel. When prompted, speak the
command for the system you wish to activate. The command given is picked up by
the microphone and performed when it is
properly recognized. NISSAN Voice Recognition will provide a voice response as well
as a message in the center display to inform you of the command results.
LHA2589
USING THE SYSTEM
Giving voice commands
Initialization
1. Press the
When the ignition switch is in the ON position, NISSAN Voice Recognition is initialized,
which takes a few seconds. When completed, the system is ready to accept voice
button is pressed
commands. If the
before the initialization completes, the system will announce: “Voice Recognition System not ready. Please wait.”
2. The system announces: “Please say a
category like phone or a command like
points of interest followed by a brand
name”. A list of available commands is
then spoken by the system.
button.
3. After the tone sounds and the face icon
on the display changes, speak a command. Available commands are discussed in this section.
4-106 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
4. Voice and display feedback are provided
when the command is accepted.
• If the command is not recognized, the
system announces: “Command not recognized”. Repeat the command in a clear
voice.
• If you want to cancel the command or go
back to the previous menu of combutton. The sysmands, press the
tem will announce: “Canceling Voice Recognition” or “Go back” depending on the
current menu level.
• If you want to adjust the volume of the
voice feedback, use the volume control
switches on the steering wheel or the
volume knob on the control panel.
• The voice command screen can also be
accessed using the control panel display:
] button.
1) Press the [
1.
2) Touch the “Voice Commands” key.
2.
Operating tips
How to say numbers
To get the best performance out of NISSAN
Voice Recognition, observe the following:
• Keep the interior of the vehicle as quiet as
possible. Close the windows to eliminate
the surrounding noises (traffic noises, vibration sounds, etc.), which may prevent
the system from recognizing the voice
commands correctly.
• Wait until a tone sounds before speaking
a command. Otherwise, the command
will not be received properly.
• Start speaking a command within 3.5
seconds after the tone sounds.
• Speak in a natural voice without pausing
between words.
NISSAN Voice Recognition requires a certain way to speak numbers in voice commands. Refer to the following examples.
General rule: Either “zero” or “oh” can be
used for “0”.
Phone numbers
LHA4373
SYSTEM FEATURES
NISSAN Voice Recognition can activate the
following systems:
• Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
• Navigation
• Audio
• Information
• My Apps
• Help
Speak phone numbers according to the
following example. For 1-800-662-6200, say
dial number and then speak the phone
number in any of the following formats:
• “one eight oh oh six six two six two oh oh”
• “one eight hundred six six two six two oh
oh”
• “one eight zero zero six six two six two oh
oh”
For the best voice recognition phone dialing results, say phone numbers as single
digits. Also, full numbers can only be spoken for “800”. For example, you cannot say
555-6000 as “five five five six thousand”.
For additional information, refer to the
separate NissanConnect® Owner’s Manual.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-107
BLUETOOTH® HANDS-FREE
PHONE SYSTEM VOICE
COMMANDS
To access the Bluetooth® Hands-Free
Phone System voice commands:
button.
1. Press the
2. Say “Call” and then a name in the vehicle
phonebook to call that entry. Otherwise,
say “Phone” to access various phone
commands.
If the Bluetooth® has been set to “Off”, the
system announces: “Bluetooth® is off.
Would you like to turn Bluetooth® on?”
If no phone is connected to the system and
the vehicle is stationary, the system announces: “There is no phone connected.
Would you like to connect a phone now?”
Say “Yes” to connect a phone. All further
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
voice commands are only available if a
phone is connected.
If a phone is connected and Bluetooth® is
set to “On”, the following voice commands
are available:
• Call (a name)
Speak the name of the contact in which
you are trying to call. System will confirm
correct contact. Say “Dial” to initiate dialing.
• Dial Number
Allows for up to 24 digits to be dialed.
After the number is entered, say “Dial” to
initiate dialing. Say “Correction” to correct the number entered. Say “Go Back”
to return to the main menu.
• List Phonebook
Starting with the first alphabetical entry
in the vehicle phonebook, the system
prompts for an additional command.
Say “Dial” to call the number of the
phonebook entry. Say “Send Text” to
send a text message to the number of
the phonebook entry. Say “Next Entry” to
skip to the next alphabetical entry in the
vehicle phonebook, where the same options will then be available.
• Recent Calls
The system prompts for an additional
command. Say “Missed Calls”, “Incoming
Calls” or “Outgoing Calls” to display a list
of such calls on the screen.
Speak the number of the entry displayed
on the screen to dial that number or say
“Next Page” to view entries on the next
page (if available).
4-108 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
• Redial
Redials the last called number.
• Read Text
Reads an incoming text message.
• Send Text
Sends a text message.
• Select Phone
The system replies “Please use manual
controls to continue”. Use manual controls to change the active phone from
among the listed phones connected to
the vehicle.
• Siri (if so equipped)
The system replies “starting Siri”. For additional information, refer to “Siri® Eyes
Free (models with Navigation System)” in
this section.
For additional information, refer to
“Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
with Navigation System” in this section.
NAVIGATION SYSTEM VOICE
COMMANDS
The following voice commands are available for the navigation system:
• Street Address (address)
• Points of Interest (name)
• POI by Category
• Home
• Address Book
• Previous Destinations
• Enter Address in Steps
• Cancel Route
For additional information, refer to the
separate NissanConnect® Owner’s Manual.
AUDIO SYSTEM VOICE COMMANDS
To access the audio system voice commands:
1. Press the
button.
2. Say “Audio”
• Tune AM (number)
Allows user to tune directly to a desired
AM frequency
• Tune FM (number)
Allows user to tune directly to a desired
FM frequency
• SXM channel (number)
Allows user to tune directly to a desired
SXM station (if so equipped)
• CD Track (number)
Allows user to select track to be played
• Play Song (name)
Allows user to select song name to be
played
• Play Artist (name)
Allows user to select artist to be played
• Play Album (name)
Allows user to select album name to be
played
For additional information, refer to “Audio
system” in this section.
INFORMATION VOICE COMMANDS
The following voice commands are available for the information functions of the
navigation system:
• Traffic
• Fuel Prices
• Stocks
• Movie Listings
• Current Weather
• Weather Map
• 5 — day Forecast
• 6 — hour Forecast
For additional information, refer to the
separate NissanConnect® Owner’s Manual.
MY APPS VOICE COMMANDS
Many Apps can be accessed using this
voice command. For additional information, refer to “NissanConnect® Mobile Apps”
in this section.
3. Speak a command from the following
available commands:
• Play (AM, FM, etc.)
Allows user to select radio band
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-109
HELP VOICE COMMANDS
TROUBLESHOOTING GUIDE
The following voice commands can be
spoken to have the system provide instructions and tips for using the NISSAN
Voice Recognition System.
• List Commands
• What Can I Say?
• General Help
• Go Back
• Quit
• Exit
The system should respond correctly to all
voice commands without difficulty. If problems are encountered, follow the solutions
given in this guide for the appropriate error.
Where the solutions are listed by number,
try each solution in turn, starting with number one, until the problem is resolved.
Symptom/error message
Solution
1. Ensure that the command format is valid. Use the “List Commands” or “What Can I Say?” command under the “Help”
menu.
The system responds “Command
2. Speak clearly without pausing between words and at a level appropriate to the ambient noise level.
Not Recognized” or the system fails
3. Ensure that the ambient noise level is not excessive (for example, with the windows open or the defroster on).
to recognize the command corNOTE:
rectly.
If it is too noisy to use the phone, it is likely that voice commands will not be recognized.
4. If optional words of the command have been omitted, then the command should be tried with these in place.
4-110 Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems
iPod®/IPHONE®
“Made for iPod”, “Made for iPhone” and
“Made for iPad” mean that an electronic
accessory has been designed to connect
specifically to iPod, iPhone or iPad, respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance standards. Apple is not responsible for the
operation of this device or its compliance
with safety and regulatory standards.
Please note that the use of this accessory
with iPod, iPhone or iPad may affect wireless performance.
iPad, iPhone, iPod classic, iPod nano, iPod
shuffle and iPod touch are trademarks of
Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries. Lightning is a trademark of
Apple Inc.
Monitor, climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems 4-111
5 Starting and driving
Precautions when starting and driving . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2
Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3
On-pavement and off-road driving
precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Avoiding collision and rollover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6
Off-road recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Rapid air pressure loss . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7
Drinking alcohol/drugs and driving . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Driving safety precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8
Push-button ignition switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10
Operating range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-11
Push-button ignition switch positions . . . . . . . .5-11
Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery
discharge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System . . . . . . . . . 5-13
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
Starting the engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13
Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Automatic transmission (A/T) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-14
Parking brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Precautions on cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19
Cruise control operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20
Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
Fuel efficient driving tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21
Increasing fuel economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
Using 4–Wheel Drive (4WD)
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23
Transfer case shifting procedures . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29
Parking/parking on hills . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-31
Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32
Brake precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-33
Active Brake Limited Slip (ABLS) system . . . . . . . . 5-34
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system . . . . . . . . . 5-35
Brake force distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-36
Hill descent control system (if so equipped) . . . . 5-37
Hill start assist system (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 5-38
Rear Sonar System (RSS) (if so equipped) . . . . . . . 5-39
Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Freeing a frozen door lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Antifreeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Draining of coolant water . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Tire equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Special winter equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Driving on snow or ice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-40
Engine block heater (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . 5-41
PRECAUTIONS WHEN STARTING AND
DRIVING
WARNING
• Do not leave children or adults who
would normally require the assistance of others alone in your vehicle.
Pets should also not be left alone.
They could accidentally injure themselves or others through inadvertent
operation of the vehicle. Also, on hot,
sunny days, temperatures in a closed
vehicle could quickly become high
enough to cause severe or possibly
fatal injuries to people or animals.
• Properly secure all cargo with ropes
or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo
higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured
cargo could cause personal injury.
EXHAUST GAS (carbon monoxide)
WARNING
• Do not breathe exhaust gases; they
contain colorless and odorless carbon monoxide. Carbon monoxide is
dangerous. It can cause unconsciousness or death.
5-2 Starting and driving
• If you suspect that exhaust fumes
are entering the vehicle, drive with all
windows fully open, and have the vehicle inspected immediately.
• Do not run the engine in closed
spaces such as a garage.
• Do not park the vehicle with the engine running for any extended length
of time.
• Keep the rear vent windows, liftgates, doors and trunk lids (if so
equipped) closed while driving, otherwise exhaust gases could be
drawn into the passenger compartment. If you must drive with one of
these open, follow these precautions:
1. Open all the windows.
air recirculation but2. Set the
ton to off and the fan control dial
to high to circulate the air.
• If electrical wiring or other cable connections must pass to a trailer
through the seal on the liftgate or the
body, follow the manufacturer's recommendation to prevent carbon
monoxide entry into the vehicle.
• The exhaust system and body should
be inspected by a qualified mechanic
whenever:
a. The vehicle is raised for service.
b. You suspect that exhaust fumes
are entering into the passenger
compartment.
c. You notice a change in the sound
of the exhaust system.
d. You have had an accident involving damage to the exhaust system, underbody, or rear of the
vehicle.
• If a special body, camper, or other
equipment is added for recreational
or other usage, follow the manufacturer's recommendation to prevent
carbon monoxide entry into the vehicle. Do not occupy these areas
while the engine is running even if
the vehicle is parked. Some recreational vehicle appliances such as
stoves, refrigerators, heaters, etc.
may also generate carbon monoxide.
THREE-WAY CATALYST
The three-way catalyst is an emission control device installed in the exhaust system.
Exhaust gases in the three-way catalyst
are burned at high temperatures to help
reduce pollutants.
WARNING
• The exhaust gas and the exhaust
system are very hot. Keep people,
animals or flammable materials
away from the exhaust system
components.
• Do not stop or park the vehicle over
flammable materials such as dry
grass, waste paper or rags. They may
ignite and cause a fire.
CAUTION
• Do not use leaded gasoline. Deposits
from leaded gasoline will seriously
reduce the three-way catalyst's ability to help reduce exhaust pollutants.
• Keep your engine tuned up. Malfunctions in the ignition, fuel injection, or
electrical systems can cause overrich
fuel flow into the three-way catalyst,
causing it to overheat. Do not keep
driving if the engine misfires, or if noticeable loss of performance or other
unusual operating conditions are detected. Have the vehicle inspected
promptly. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
• Avoid driving with an extremely low
fuel level. Running out of fuel could
cause the engine to misfire, damaging the three-way catalyst.
• Do not race the engine while warming it up.
• Do not push or tow your vehicle to
start the engine.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM (TPMS)
Each tire, including the spare (if provided),
should be checked monthly when cold and
inflated to the inflation pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on
the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure
label. (If your vehicle has tires of a different
size than the size indicated on the vehicle
placard or tire inflation pressure label, you
should determine the proper tire inflation
pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle
has been equipped with a Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) that illuminates
a low tire pressure telltale when one or
more of your tires is significantly underinflated. Accordingly, when the low tire
pressure telltale illuminates, you should
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire causes the tire to overheat and
can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also
reduces fuel efficiency and tire tread life,
and may affect the vehicle’s handling and
stopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire maintenance, and it is
the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a
TPMS malfunction indicator to indicate
when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.
When the system detects a malfunction,
Starting and driving 5-3
the telltale will flash for approximately 1
minute and then remain continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as
the malfunction exists. When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system
may not be able to detect or signal low tire
pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that
prevent the TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction
telltale after replacing one or more tires or
wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels
allow the TPMS to continue to function
properly.
Additional information:
• When replacing a wheel without the
TPMS such as the spare tire, the TPMS
does not monitor the tire pressure of the
spare tire.
• The TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is driven at speeds above 16 mph (25
km/h). Also, this system may not detect a
sudden drop in tire pressure (for example,
a flat tire while driving).
5-4 Starting and driving
• The low tire pressure warning light does
not automatically turn off when the tire
pressure of your tires are adjusted. After
the tires are inflated to the recommended pressure, the vehicle must be
driven at speeds above 16 mph (25 km/h)
to activate the TPMS and turn off the low
tire pressure warning light. Use a tire
pressure gauge to check the tire pressure.
• The CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning
message is displayed in the odometer
when the low tire pressure warning light
is illuminated and low tire pressure is detected. The CHECK TIRE PRES warning
message turns off when the low tire pressure warning light turns off. The low tire
pressure warning light remains illuminated until the tires are inflated to the
recommended COLD tire pressure. The
CHECK TIRE PRES warning message is
displayed each time the ignition switch is
placed in the ON position as long as the
low tire pressure warning light remains
illuminated. For additional information,
refer to “Check tire pressure warning
message” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
• The CHECK TIRE PRES warning is not displayed if the low tire pressure warning
light illuminates to indicate a TPMS malfunction.
• The CHECK TIRE PRES warning appears
each time the ignition switch is placed in
the ON position as long as the low tire
pressure warning light remains illuminated.
• Tire pressure rises and falls depending on
the heat caused by the vehicle’s operation and the outside temperature. Do not
reduce the tire pressure after driving because the tire pressure rises after driving.
Low outside temperature can lower the
temperature of the air inside the tire
which can cause a lower tire inflation
pressure. This may cause the low tire
pressure warning light to illuminate. If the
warning light illuminates, check the tire
pressure for all four tires.
• The Tire and Loading Information label is
located in the driver's door opening.
For additional information, refer to “Low tire
pressure warning light” in the “Instruments
and controls” section and “Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “In case of
emergency” section of this manual.
WARNING
• Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those
who use a pacemaker should contact
the electric medical equipment
manufacturer for the possible influences before use.
• If the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt
braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull
off the road to a safe location and
stop the vehicle as soon as possible.
Driving with under-inflated tires may
permanently damage the tires and
increase the likelihood of tire failure.
Serious vehicle damage could occur
and may lead to an accident and
could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all
four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to
the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading
Information label to turn the low tire
pressure warning light off. If you have
a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire
as soon as possible. For additional
information, refer to “Flat tire” in the
“In case of emergency” section of this
manual for changing a flat tire.
• When replacing a wheel without the
TPMS such as the spare tire, when a
spare tire is mounted or a wheel is
replaced, the TPMS will not function
and the low tire pressure warning
light will flash for approximately 1
minute. The light will remain on after
1 minute. Have your tires replaced
and/or TPMS system reset as soon as
possible. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
• Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the
TPMS.
• Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol
tire sealant into the tires, as this may
cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors.
CAUTION
Some devices and transmitters may temporarily interfere with the operation of the
TPMS and cause the low tire pressure
warning light to illuminate.
Some examples are:
• Facilities or electric devices using similar
radio frequencies are near the vehicle.
• If a transmitter set to similar frequencies
is being used in or near the vehicle.
• If a computer (or similar equipment) or a
DC/AC converter is being used in or near
the vehicle.
The low tire pressure warning light may
illuminate in the following cases:
• If the vehicle is equipped with a wheel and
tire without TPMS.
• If the TPMS has been replaced and the ID
has not been registered.
• If the wheel is not originally specified by
NISSAN.
Do not place metalized film or any
metal parts (antenna, etc.) on the windows. This may cause poor reception of
the signals from the tire pressure sensors, and the TPMS will not function
properly.
Starting and driving 5-5
FCC Notice:
For USA:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
NOTE:
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void
the user's authority to operate the
equipment.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry
Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
ON-PAVEMENT AND OFF-ROAD
DRIVING PRECAUTIONS
Utility vehicles have a significantly
higher rollover rate than other types of
vehicles.
They have higher ground clearance than
passenger cars to make them capable of
performing in a variety of on-pavement
and off-road applications. This gives them
a higher center of gravity than ordinary vehicles. An advantage of higher ground
clearance is a better view of the road, allowing you to anticipate problems. However,
they are not designed for cornering at the
same speeds as conventional 2-Wheel
Drive vehicles any more than low-slung
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road conditions. If at all
possible, avoid sharp turns at high speeds.
As with other vehicles of this type, failure to
operate this vehicle correctly may result in
loss of control or vehicle rollover. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantly more likely to die than a person
wearing a seat belt.
For additional information, refer to “Driving
safety precautions” in this section.
5-6 Starting and driving
AVOIDING COLLISION AND
ROLLOVER
WARNING
Failure to operate this vehicle in a safe
and prudent manner may result in loss
of control or an accident.
Be alert and drive defensively at all times.
Obey all traffic regulations. Avoid excessive
speed, high speed cornering, or sudden
steering maneuvers, because these driving
practices could cause you to lose control of
your vehicle.
As with any vehicle, loss of control could
result in a collision with other vehicles or
objects or cause the vehicle to roll over,
particularly if the loss of control causes
the vehicle to slide sideways.
Be attentive at all times, and avoid driving
when tired. Never drive when under the influence of alcohol or drugs (including prescription or over-the-counter drugs which
may cause drowsiness). Always wear your
seat belt as outlined in the “Safety – Seats,
seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual, and also instruct your passengers to do so.
Seat belts help reduce the risk of injury in
collisions and rollovers. In a rollover crash,
an unbelted person is significantly more
likely to die than a person wearing a seat
belt..
OFF-ROAD RECOVERY
While driving, the right side or left side
wheels may unintentionally leave the road
surface. If this occurs, maintain control of
the vehicle by following the procedure below. Please note that this procedure is only
a general guide. The vehicle must be driven
as appropriate based on the conditions of
the vehicle, road and traffic.
1. Remain calm and do not overreact.
2. Do not apply the brakes.
3. Maintain a firm grip on the steering
wheel with both hands and try to hold a
straight course.
4. When appropriate, slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the
vehicle.
5. If there is nothing in the way, steer the
vehicle to follow the road while vehicle
speed is reduced. Do not attempt to
drive the vehicle back onto the road surface until vehicle speed is reduced.
6. When it is safe to do so, gradually turn
the steering wheel until both tires return
to the road surface. When all tires are on
the road surface, steer the vehicle to
stay in the appropriate driving lane.
• If you decide that it is not safe to return
the vehicle to the road surface based
on vehicle, road or traffic conditions,
gradually slow the vehicle to a stop in
a safe place off the road.
RAPID AIR PRESSURE LOSS
Rapid air pressure loss or a “blow-out” can
occur if the tire is punctured or is damaged
due to hitting a curb or pothole. Rapid air
pressure loss can also be caused by driving
on under-inflated tires.
Rapid air pressure loss can affect the handling and stability of the vehicle, especially
at highway speeds.
Help prevent rapid air pressure loss by
maintaining the correct air pressure and
visually inspecting the tires for wear and
damage. For additional information, refer
to “Wheels and tires” in the “Do-it-yourself”
section of this manual. If a tire rapidly loses
air pressure or “blows-out” while driving,
maintain control of the vehicle by following
the procedure below. Please note that this
procedure is only a general guide. The ve-
hicle must be driven as appropriate based
on the conditions of the vehicle, road and
traffic.
WARNING
The following actions can increase the
chance of losing control of the vehicle if
there is a sudden loss of tire air pressure. Losing control of the vehicle may
cause a collision and result in personal
injury.
• The vehicle generally moves or pulls
in the direction of the flat tire.
• Do not rapidly apply the brakes.
• Do not rapidly release the accelerator
pedal.
• Do not rapidly turn the steering
wheel.
1. Remain calm and do not overreact.
2. Maintain a firm grip on the steering
wheel with both hands and try to hold a
straight course.
3. When appropriate, slowly release the accelerator pedal to gradually slow the
vehicle.
Starting and driving 5-7
4. Gradually steer the vehicle to a safe location off the road and away from traffic
if possible.
5. Lightly apply the brake pedal to gradually stop the vehicle.
6. Turn on the hazard warning flashers and
contact a roadside emergency service
to change the tire. For additional information, refer to “Changing a flat tire” in
the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
DRINKING ALCOHOL/DRUGS AND
DRIVING
WARNING
Never drive under the influence of alcohol or drugs. Alcohol in the bloodstream reduces coordination, delays
reaction time and impairs judgement.
Driving after drinking alcohol increases
the likelihood of being involved in an
accident injuring yourself and others.
Additionally, if you are injured in an accident, alcohol can increase the severity of the injury.
5-8 Starting and driving
NISSAN is committed to safe driving. However, you must choose not to drive under
the influence of alcohol. Every year thousands of people are injured or killed in
alcohol-related collisions. Although the local laws vary on what is considered to be
legally intoxicated, the fact is that alcohol
affects all people differently and most
people underestimate the effects of alcohol.
Remember, drinking and driving don't mix!
That is true for drugs (over-the-counter,
prescription) and illegal drugs, too. Don't
drive if your ability to operate your vehicle is
impaired by alcohol, drugs, or some other
physical condition.
DRIVING SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
Your NISSAN is designed for both normal
and off-road use. However, avoid driving in
deep water or mud as your NISSAN is
mainly designed for leisure use, unlike a
conventional off-road vehicle.
Remember that 2-Wheel Drive models are
less capable than 4–Wheel Drive (4WD)
models for rough road driving and extrication when stuck in deep snow or mud, or
the like.
Please observe the following precautions:
WARNING
• Drive carefully when off the road and
avoid dangerous areas. Every person
who drives or rides in this vehicle
should be seated with their seat belt
fastened. This will keep you and your
passengers in position when driving
over rough terrain.
• Do not drive across steep slopes. Instead drive either straight up or
straight down the slopes. Off-road
vehicles can tip over sideways much
more easily than they can forward or
backward.
• Many hills are too steep for any vehicle. If you drive up them, you may
stall. If you drive down them, you may
not be able to control your speed. If
you drive across them, you may roll
over.
• Do not shift gears while driving on
downhill grades as this could cause
loss of control of the vehicle.
• Stay alert when driving to the top of a
hill. At the top there could be a dropoff or other hazard that could cause
an accident.
• If your engine stalls or you cannot
make it to the top of a steep hill,
never attempt to turn around. Your
vehicle could tip or roll over. Always
back straight down in R (Reverse)
gear. Never back down in N (Neutral),
using only the brake, as this could
cause loss of control.
• Heavy braking going down a hill
could cause your brakes to overheat
and fade, resulting in loss of control
and an accident. Apply brakes lightly
and use a low gear to control your
speed. Use the hill descent control
feature (if so equipped).
• Unsecured cargo can be thrown
around when driving over rough terrain. Properly secure all cargo so it
will not be thrown forward and cause
injury to you or your passengers.
• To avoid raising the center of gravity
excessively, do not exceed the rated
capacity of the roof rack (if so
equipped) and evenly distribute the
load. Secure heavy loads in the cargo
area as far forward and as low as
possible. Do not equip the vehicle
with tires larger than specified in this
manual. This could cause your vehicle to roll over.
• Do not grip the inside or spokes of
the steering wheel when driving offroad. The steering wheel could move
suddenly and injure your hands. Instead drive with your fingers and
thumbs on the outside of the rim.
• Before operating the vehicle, ensure
that the driver and all passengers
have their seat belts fastened.
• Always drive with the floor mats in
place as the floor may become hot.
• Lower your speed when encountering strong crosswinds. With a higher
center of gravity, your NISSAN is more
affected by strong side winds. Slower
speeds ensure better vehicle control.
• Do not drive beyond the performance capability of the tires, even
with 4WD engaged (if so equipped).
• For 4WD equipped vehicles, do not
attempt to raise two wheels off the
ground and shift the transmission to
any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result
in drivetrain damage or unexpected
vehicle movement which could result
in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
• Do not attempt to test a 4WD
equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment
even if the other two wheels are
raised off the ground. Make sure you
inform test facility personnel that
your vehicle is equipped with 4WD
before it is placed on a dynamometer. Using the wrong test equipment
may result in drivetrain damage or
unexpected
vehicle
movement
which could result in serious vehicle
damage or personal injury.
• Accelerating quickly, sharp steering
maneuvers or sudden braking may
cause loss of control.
• If at all possible, avoid sharp turning
maneuvers, particularly at high
speeds. Your NISSAN 4WD vehicle has
a higher center of gravity than a passenger car. The vehicle is not designed for cornering at the same
speeds as passenger cars. Failure to
operate this vehicle correctly could
result in loss of control and/or a rollover accident.
Starting and driving 5-9
PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
• Always use tires of the same type,
size, brand, construction (bias, biasbelted, or radial), and tread pattern
on all four wheels. Install tire chains
on the rear wheels when driving on
slippery roads and drive carefully.
• Be sure to check the brakes immediately after driving in mud or water.
For additional information, refer to
“Wet brakes” in this section.
• Avoid parking your vehicle on steep
hills. If you get out of the vehicle and
it rolls forward, backward or sideways, you could be injured.
• Whenever you drive off-road through
sand, mud or water as deep as the
wheel hub, more frequent maintenance may be required. For additional information, refer to “Maintenance under severe operating
conditions” in the “Maintenance and
schedules” section of this manual.
5-10 Starting and driving
When the ignition switch is pushed without
depressing the brake pedal, the ignition
switch position will illuminate as follows:
Push center:
• Once to change to ACC.
• Two times to change to ON.
• Three times to return to OFF.
The ignition switch will automatically return to the LOCK position when any door is
either opened or closed with the switch in
the OFF position.
LSD3828
WARNING
Do not operate the push-button ignition switch while driving the vehicle except in an emergency. (The engine will
stop when the ignition switch is pushed
three consecutive times in quick succession or the ignition switch is pushed
and held for more than 2 seconds.) If
the engine stops while the vehicle is
being driven, this could lead to a crash
and serious injury.
The shift lever can be moved from the P
(Park) position if the ignition switch is in
the ON position and the brake pedal is
depressed.
If the battery of the vehicle is discharged,
the ignition switch cannot be moved
from the LOCK position.
Some indicators and warnings for operation are displayed in the meter. For additional information, refer to “Warning lights,
indicator lights and audible reminders” in
the “Instruments and controls” section of
this manual.
The operating range of the engine start
1 .
function is inside of the vehicle O
• The luggage area is not included in the
operating range, but the Intelligent Key
may function.
• If the Intelligent Key is placed on the instrument panel or inside the glove box,
storage bin or door pocket, the Intelligent
Key may not function.
• If the Intelligent Key is placed near the
door or window outside the vehicle, the
Intelligent Key may function.
LSD3854
PUSH-BUTTON IGNITION SWITCH
POSITIONS
OPERATING RANGE
LOCK (Normal parking position)
The Intelligent Key functions can only be
used when the Intelligent Key is within the
specified operating range.
The ignition switch can only be locked in
this position.
When the Intelligent Key battery is almost
discharged or strong radio waves are present near the operating location, the Intelligent Key system’s operating range becomes
narrower and may not function properly.
If the Intelligent Key is within the operating
range, it is possible for anyone, even someone who does not carry the Intelligent Key,
to push the ignition switch to start the engine.
The ignition switch will be unlocked when it
is pushed to the ON position while carrying
the Intelligent Key.
The ignition switch will lock when any door
is opened or closed with the ignition
switched off.
ON (Normal operating position)
This position turns on the ignition system
and electrical accessories.
ON has a battery saver feature that will turn
the ignition switch to the OFF position, if the
vehicle is not running, after some time under the following conditions:
• All doors are closed.
• The shift lever is in P (Park).
The battery saver feature will be canceled if
any of the following occur:
• Any door is opened.
• The shift lever is moved out of the P (Park)
position.
• The ignition switch changes position.
CAUTION
Do not leave the vehicle with the ignition switch in the AUTO ACC or ON position when the engine is not running for
an extended period. This can discharge
the battery.
OFF
The ignition switch is in the OFF position
when the engine is turned off using the
ignition switch. No lights will illuminate on
the ignition switch.
Starting and driving 5-11
AUTO ACC:
3. Touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent Key as illustrated. (A chime will
sound.)
With the vehicle in the P (Park) position, the
Intelligent Key with you, and the ignition
switch placed from the ON to the OFF position, the radio can still be used for a period
of time, or until the driver’s door is opened.
After step 3 is performed, when the ignition switch is pushed without depressing the brake pedal, the ignition switch
position will change to the ACC position.
After a period of time, functions such as
radio, navigation, and Bluetooth® HandsFree Phone System may be restarted by
pressing the “ON-OFF button/VOLUME
control knob” or the key fob unlock button.
For additional information, refer to “Monitor,
climate, audio, phone and voice recognition systems” in this manual.
EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF
To shut off the engine in an emergency
situation while driving, perform the following procedure:
• Rapidly push the ignition switch three
consecutive times in less than 1.5 seconds, or
• Push and hold the ignition switch for
more than 2 seconds.
4. Push the ignition switch while depressing the brake pedal within 10 seconds
after the chime sounds. The engine will
start.
NOTE:
SSD0860
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
BATTERY DISCHARGE
If the battery of the NISSAN Intelligent Key®
is discharged or environmental conditions
interfere with the Intelligent Key operation,
start the engine according to the following
procedure:
1. Place the shift lever in the P (Park)
position.
2. Firmly apply the foot brake.
5-12 Starting and driving
• When the ignition switch is pushed to
the ACC or ON position or the engine is
started by the above procedure, the Intelligent Key battery discharge warning light appears in the meter even
when the Intelligent Key is inside the
vehicle. This is not a malfunction. To
turn off the Intelligent Key battery discharge warning light, touch the ignition switch with the Intelligent Key
again.
• If the Intelligent Key battery discharge
warning light appears, replace the battery as soon as possible. For additional
information, refer to “Battery replacement” in the “Do-it-yourself” section of
this manual.
NISSAN VEHICLE IMMOBILIZER
SYSTEM
The NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
will not allow the engine to start without
the use of the registered key.
If the engine fails to start using a registered
key (for example, when interference is
caused by another registered key, an automated toll road device or automatic payment device on the key ring), restart the
engine using the following procedures:
1. Leave the ignition switch in the ON position for approximately 5 seconds.
2. Place the ignition switch in the OFF or
LOCK position, and wait approximately
10 seconds.
3. Repeat steps 1 and 2.
4. Restart the engine while holding the device (which may have caused the interference) separate from the registered
key.
If the no start condition re-occurs, NISSAN
recommends placing the registered key on
a separate key ring to avoid interference
from other devices.
BEFORE STARTING THE ENGINE
STARTING THE ENGINE
• Make sure the area around the vehicle is
clear.
• Check fluid levels such as engine oil, coolant, brake, and windshield-washer fluid
as frequently as possible, or at least
whenever you refuel.
• Check that all windows and lights are
clean.
• Visually inspect tires for their appearance
and condition. Also check tires for proper
inflation.
• Check that all doors are closed.
• Position seat and adjust head restraints/
headrests.
• Adjust inside and outside mirrors.
• Fasten the seat belt and ask all passengers to do likewise.
• Check the operation of warning lights
when the ignition switch is placed in the
ON position. For additional information,
refer to “Warning lights, indicator lights
and audible reminders” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
1. Apply the parking brake.
2. Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). P (Park) is recommended.
The starter is designed not to operate
unless the shift lever is in either P
(Park) or N (Neutral).
3. Push the ignition switch to the ON position. Depress the brake pedal and push
the ignition switch to start the engine.
To start the engine immediately, push
and release the ignition switch while depressing the brake pedal with the ignition switch in any position.
• If the engine is very hard to start in
extremely cold weather or when restarting, depress the accelerator
pedal a little (approximately 1/3 to the
floor) and while holding, crank the engine. Release the accelerator pedal
when the engine starts.
• If the engine is very hard to start because it is flooded, depress the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor
and hold it. Push the ignition switch to
the ON position to start cranking the
engine. After 5 or 6 seconds, stop
cranking by pushing the ignition
switch to the LOCK position. After
Starting and driving 5-13
DRIVING THE VEHICLE
cranking the engine, release the accelerator pedal. Crank the engine with
your foot off the accelerator pedal by
depressing the brake pedal and pushing the ignition switch to start the engine. If the engine starts, but fails to
run, repeat the above procedure.
CAUTION
Do not operate the starter for more
than 15 seconds at a time. If the engine
does not start, push the ignition switch
to the OFF position and wait 10 seconds
before cranking again, otherwise the
starter could be damaged.
4. Warm-up
Allow the engine to idle for at least 30
seconds after starting. Do not race the
engine while warming it up. Drive at a
moderate speed for a short distance
first, especially in cold weather. In cold
weather, keep the engine running for a
minimum of 2 to 3 minutes before shutting it off. Starting and stopping the engine over a short period of time may
make the vehicle more difficult to start.
5. To stop the engine, move the shift lever
to the P (Park) position and push the
ignition switch to the OFF position.
5-14 Starting and driving
In preparation for the next engine start, the
engine may have a slightly delayed shutoff
after placing the ignition switch in the OFF
position, depending on the driving conditions.
NOTE:
Care should be taken to avoid situations that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start
conditions such as:
1. Installation or extended use of electronic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not
running (phone chargers, GPS, DVD
players, etc.).
2. The vehicle is not driven regularly
and/or only driven short distances.
In these cases, the battery may need to
be charged to maintain battery health.
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION (A/T)
WARNING
• Do not depress the accelerator pedal
while shifting from P (Park) or N (Neutral) to R (Reverse), D (Drive). Always
depress the brake pedal until shifting
is completed. Failure to do so could
cause you to lose control and have an
accident.
• Cold engine idle speed is high, so use
caution when shifting into a forward
or reverse gear before the engine has
warmed up.
• Never shift to either the P (Park) or R
(Reverse) position while the vehicle is
moving forward and P (Park) or D
(Drive) position while the vehicle is
reversing. This could cause an accident or damage the transmission.
• Do not downshift abruptly on slippery roads. This may cause a loss of
control.
• Except in an emergency, do not shift
to the N (Neutral) position while driving. Coasting with the transmission
in the N (Neutral) position may cause
serious damage to the transmission.
CAUTION
• To avoid possible damage to your vehicle, when stopping the vehicle on
an uphill grade, do not hold the vehicle by depressing the accelerator
pedal. The foot brake should be used
for this purpose.
The A/T in your vehicle is electronically controlled to produce maximum power and
smooth operation.
The recommended operating procedures
for this transmission are shown on the following pages. Follow these procedures for
maximum vehicle performance and driving enjoyment.
The automatic transmission is designed
so the foot brake pedal MUST be depressed before shifting from P (Park) to
any drive position while the ignition
switch is in the ON position.
The shift lever cannot be moved out of
the P (Park) position and into any of the
other gear positions if the ignition
switch is placed in the LOCK or OFF position.
The shift lever may not be moved out of
the P (Park) position and into any of the
other gear positions if the ignition
switch is placed in the ON position, but
the engine is not running and the outside temperature is extremely low.
LSD3853
Shifting
To move the shift lever:
Starting the vehicle
1. After starting the engine, fully depress
the foot brake pedal before moving the
shift lever out of the P (Park) position.
2. Keep the foot brake pedal depressed
and move the shift lever into a driving
gear.
A while depressing
Press the button O
the brake pedal
A to shift
Press the button O
Shift without depressing the brake
pedal
3. Release the foot brake, then gradually
start the vehicle in motion.
Starting and driving 5-15
P (Park)
Shifting
After starting the engine, fully depress the
brake pedal and move the shift lever out of
the P (Park) position.
WARNING
Apply the parking brake if the shift lever is in any position while the engine is
not running. Failure to do so could
cause the vehicle to move unexpectedly or roll away and result in serious
personal injury or property damage.
If the ignition switch is placed in the OFF
position for any reason while the vehicle is
in N (Neutral), or any D (Drive) position, the
ignition switch cannot be placed in the
LOCK position. Move the shift lever to the P
(Park) position, then the ignition switch can
be placed in the LOCK position.
R (Reverse)
CAUTION
CAUTION
To prevent transmission damage, use
the P (Park) position only when the vehicle is completely stopped.
To prevent transmission damage, use
the R (Reverse) position only when the
vehicle is completely stopped.
Use the P (Park) shift lever position when
the vehicle is parked or when starting the
engine. Make sure the vehicle is completely
stopped.
Use the R (Reverse) position to back up. Make
sure the vehicle is completely stopped before selecting the R (Reverse) position. The
brake pedal must be depressed to move
the shift lever from P (Park), N (Neutral) or
any drive position to R (Reverse).
The brake pedal should be depressed to
move the shift lever from N (Neutral) or
any drive position to P (Park).
The P (Park) position is automatically engaged if you switch off the ignition.
Apply the parking brake. When parking on a
hill, apply the parking brake first, then move
the shift lever into the P (Park) position.
N (Neutral)
Neither forward nor reverse gear is engaged.
The engine can be started in this position.
You may shift to N (Neutral) and restart a
stalled engine while the vehicle is moving.
D (Drive)
Use this position for all normal forward
driving.
5-16 Starting and driving
Shift ranges up or down one by one as
follows:
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5 ↔ M6 ↔ M7 ↔
M8 ↔ M9 ↔ D
M9 (Ninth)
Use this position for all normal forward
driving at highway speeds.
M6 (Sixth)
Use this position for all normal forward
driving at highway speeds.
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5 ↔ M6
M6 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter
M5 (Fifth)
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5 ↔ M6 ↔ M7 ↔
M8 ↔ M9
For driving up or down long slopes where
engine braking would be advantageous.
M9 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
Shift ranges up or down one by one as
follows:
M8 (Eighth)
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5
Use this position for all normal forward
driving at highway speeds.
M5 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
Move the shift lever sideways toward the
manual shift gate to activate the manual
shift mode, then select “+” or “-” to shift up or
down. Shift ranges can be selected manually.
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5 ↔ M6 ↔ M7 ↔
M8
M4 (Fourth)
In the manual shift mode, the shift range is
displayed on the position indicator in the
meter. After moving the shift lever to the
manual shift gate, the position indicator
varies depending on the gear position and
vehicle speed.
M7 (Seventh)
Shift ranges up or down one by one as
follows:
Use this position for all normal forward
driving at highway speeds.
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3 ↔ M4 ↔ M5 ↔ M6 ↔ M7
M4 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
LSD3855
Manual shift mode
M8 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
Use for hill climbing or engine braking on
downhill grades.
M7 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
Starting and driving 5-17
M3 (Third)
Use for hill climbing or engine braking on
downhill grades.
Shift ranges up or down one by one as
follows:
M1 ↔ M2 ↔ M3
M3 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
M2 (Second)
Use for hill climbing or engine braking on
downhill grades.
Shift ranges up or down one by one as
follows:
M1 ↔ M2
M2 will be displayed on the position indicator in the meter.
M1 (First)
Use this position when climbing steep hills
slowly or driving slowly through deep snow,
sand or mud, or for maximum engine braking on steep downhill grades.
M1 will be displayed on the position indicator on the meter.
5-18 Starting and driving
• Remember not to drive at high speeds for
extended periods of time in lower than
M4 range. This reduces fuel economy.
When shifting up
Move the shift lever to the + (up) side. (Shifts
to higher range.)
When shifting down
Move the shift lever to the − (down) side.
(Shifts to lower range.)
• The transmission will automatically
downshift the gears. (For example, if you
select the 3rd range, the transmission will
shift down between the 3rd and 1st
gears.)
• Moving the shift lever rapidly to the same
side twice will shift the ranges in succession.
When canceling the manual shift mode
Return the shift lever to the D (Drive) position to return the transmission to the normal driving mode.
• In the manual shift mode, the transmission may not shift to the selected
gear immediately because of vehicle
speed. The transmission will upshift or
downshift
when
vehicle
speed
matches the programmed transmission shift points. This helps maintain
driving performance and reduces the
chance of vehicle damage or loss of
control.
• In the manual shift mode, the transmission will not upshift to a higher
gear than is manually selected. When
the vehicle speed decreases, the transmission automatically shifts down and
shifts to 1st gear before the vehicle
comes to a stop.
Accelerator downshift
— in D (Drive) position —
For passing or hill climbing, depress the
accelerator pedal to the floor. This shifts
the transmission down into a lower gear,
depending on the vehicle speed.
PARKING BRAKE
CRUISE CONTROL
WARNING
• Be sure the parking brake is fully released before driving. Failure to do so
can cause brake failure and lead to
an accident.
• Do not release the parking brake
from outside the vehicle.
• Do not use the shift lever in place of
the parking brake. When parking, be
sure the parking brake is fully
engaged.
• To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not
leave children, people who require
the assistance of others or pets unattended in your vehicle. Additionally,
the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm day can quickly become high enough to cause a significant risk of injury or death to people
and pets.
LSD2755
LSD2753
To engage: Pull the parking brake lever up
A .
O
PRECAUTIONS ON CRUISE
CONTROL
To release:
1. ACCEL•RES switch
1. Firmly apply the foot brake.
2. COAST•SET switch
2. Move the shift lever to the P (Park)
position.
3. CANCEL switch
3. While pulling up on the parking brake
B and
lever slightly, press the button O
lower the lever completely.
4. Before driving, be sure the brake warning light goes out.
4. ON•OFF switch
• If the cruise control system malfunctions,
it cancels automatically. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel then
blinks to warn the driver.
Starting and driving 5-19
• If the SET indicator light blinks, turn the
ON•OFF switch off and have the system
checked. It is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer for this service.
• The SET indicator light may blink when
the ON•OFF switch is turned on while
pushing the ACCEL•RES, COAST•SET, or
CANCEL switch (located on the steering
wheel). To properly set the cruise control
system, use the following procedures.
WARNING
Do not use the cruise control when driving under the following conditions:
• When it is not possible to keep the
vehicle at a set speed.
• In heavy traffic or in traffic that varies
in speed.
• On winding or hilly roads.
• On slippery roads (rain, snow, ice,
etc.).
• In very windy areas.
Doing so could cause a loss of vehicle
control and result in an accident.
5-20 Starting and driving
CRUISE CONTROL OPERATIONS
The cruise control allows driving at a speed
between 25 - 89 mph (40 - 144 km/h) without keeping your foot on the accelerator
pedal.
To turn on the cruise control, push the
ON•OFF switch. The CRUISE indicator light
in the instrument panel comes on.
To set cruising speed, accelerate the vehicle to the desired speed, push the COAST•SET switch and release it. The SET indicator light in the instrument panel comes on.
Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.
Your vehicle maintains the set speed.
• To pass another vehicle, depress the accelerator pedal. When you release the
pedal, the vehicle returns to the previously set speed.
• The vehicle may not maintain the set
speed when going up or down steep hills.
If this happens, drive without the cruise
control.
To cancel the preset speed, use one of the
following three methods:
• Push the CANCEL switch; the SET indicator light in the instrument panel goes out.
• Tap the brake pedal; the SET indicator
light goes out.
• Turn the ON•OFF switch off. Both the
CRUISE indicator light and SET indicator
light in the instrument panel go out.
The cruise control is automatically canceled and the SET indicator light in the instrument panel goes out if:
• The vehicle slows down more than 8 mph
(13 km/h) below the set speed.
• Move the shift lever to N (Neutral).
To reset at a faster cruising speed, use
one of the following three methods:
• Depress the accelerator pedal. When the
vehicle attains the desired speed, push
and release the COAST•SET switch.
• Push and hold the ACCEL•RES switch.
When the vehicle attains the speed you
desire, release the switch.
• Push and release the ACCEL•RES switch.
Each time you do this, the set speed increases by about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
To reset at a slower cruising speed, use
one of the following three methods:
• Lightly tap the brake pedal. When the vehicle attains the desired speed, push the
COAST•SET switch and release it.
• Push and hold the COAST•SET switch. Release the switch when the vehicle slows
to the desired speed.
BREAK-IN SCHEDULE
• Push and release the COAST•SET switch.
Each time you do this, the set speed decreases by about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
To resume the preset speed, push and
release the ACCEL•RES switch. The vehicle
returns to the last set cruising speed when
the vehicle speed is over 25 mph (40 km/h).
CAUTION
During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km),
follow these recommendations to obtain maximum engine performance
and ensure the future reliability and
economy of your new vehicle. Failure to
follow these recommendations may
result in shortened engine life and reduced engine performance.
• Avoid driving for long periods at constant
speed, either fast or slow, and do not run
the engine over 4,000 rpm.
• Do not accelerate at full throttle in any
gear.
• Avoid quick starts.
• Avoid hard braking as much as possible.
• Do not tow a trailer for the first 500 miles
(805 kilometers). Your engine, axle or
other parts could be damaged.
FUEL EFFICIENT DRIVING TIPS
Follow these easy-to-use Fuel Efficient
Driving Tips to help you achieve the most
fuel economy from your vehicle.
1. Use Smooth Accelerator and Brake
Pedal Application
• Avoid rapid starts and stops.
• Use smooth, gentle accelerator and
brake application whenever possible.
• Maintain constant speed while commuting and coast whenever possible.
2. Maintain Constant Speed
• Look ahead to try and anticipate and
minimize stops.
• Synchronizing your speed with traffic
lights allows you to reduce your number of stops.
• Maintaining a steady speed can minimize red light stops and improve fuel
efficiency.
Starting and driving 5-21
3. Use Air Conditioning (A/C) at Higher
Vehicle Speeds
• Below 40 mph (64 km/h), it is more
efficient to open windows to cool the
vehicle due to reduced engine load.
• Above 40 mph (64 km/h), it is more
efficient to use A/C to cool the vehicle
due to increased aerodynamic drag.
• Recirculating the cool air in the cabin
when the A/C is on reduces cooling
load.
4. Drive at Economical Speeds and
Distances
• Observing the speed limit and not exceeding 60 mph (97 km/h) (where legally allowed) can improve fuel efficiency due to reduced aerodynamic
drag.
• Maintaining a safe following distance
behind other vehicles reduces unnecessary braking.
• Safely monitoring traffic to anticipate
changes in speed permits reduced
braking and smooth acceleration
changes.
• Select a gear range suitable to road
conditions.
5-22 Starting and driving
5. Use Cruise Control
• Using cruise control during highway
driving helps maintain a steady speed.
• Cruise control is particularly effective
in providing fuel savings when driving
on flat terrains.
6. Plan for the Shortest Route
• Utilize a map or navigation system to
determine the best route to save time.
7. Avoid Idling
• Shutting off your engine when safe for
stops exceeding 30–60 seconds saves
fuel and reduces emissions.
8. Buy an Automated Pass for Toll Roads
• Automated passes permit drivers to
use special lanes to maintain cruising
speed through the toll and avoid stopping and starting.
9. Winter Warm Up
• Limit idling time to minimize impact to
fuel economy.
• Vehicles typically need no more than
30 seconds of idling at start-up to effectively circulate the engine oil before
driving.
• Your vehicle will reach its ideal operating temperature more quickly while
driving versus idling.
10. Keeping your Vehicle Cool
• Park your vehicle in a covered parking
area or in the shade whenever possible.
• When entering a hot vehicle, opening
the windows will help to reduce the
inside temperature faster, resulting in
reduced demand on your A/C system.
INCREASING FUEL ECONOMY
• Keep your engine tuned up.
• Follow the recommended scheduled
maintenance.
• Keep the tires inflated to the correct pressure. Low tire pressure increases tire
wear and lowers fuel economy.
• Keep the wheels in correct alignment. Improper alignment increases tire wear and
lowers fuel economy.
, use 4H
• For vehicles equipped with
or 4L position only when necessary.
4-Wheel Drive operation lowers fuel
economy.
• Use the recommended viscosity engine
oil. For additional information, refer to “Engine oil and oil filter recommendations” in
the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
USING 4–WHEEL DRIVE (4WD)
(if so equipped)
WARNING
• For 4WD equipped vehicles, do not
attempt to raise two wheels off the
ground and shift the transmission to
any drive or reverse position with the
engine running. Doing so may result
in drivetrain damage or unexpected
vehicle movement which could result
in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
• Do not attempt to test a 4WD
equipped vehicle on a 2-wheel dynamometer (such as the dynamometers used by some states for emissions testing), or similar equipment
even if the other two wheels are
raised off the ground. Make sure you
inform test facility personnel that
your vehicle is equipped with 4WD
before it is placed on a dynamometer. Using the wrong test equipment
may result in drivetrain damage or
unexpected
vehicle
movement
which could result in serious vehicle
damage or personal injury.
CAUTION
• Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or
4LO position on dry hard surface
roads. Driving on dry, hard surfaces in
4H or 4LO may cause unnecessary
noise, tire wear and increased fuel
consumption.
If the 4WD warning light turns on
when you are driving on dry hard surface roads:
– In the 4H position, shift the 4WD
shift switch to 2–Wheel Drive
(2WD).
– In the 4LO position for automatic
transmission vehicles, stop the
vehicle and shift the shift lever to
the N (Neutral) position with the
brake pedal depressed and shift
the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.
• If the warning light is still on after the
above operation, have your vehicle
checked as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
Starting and driving 5-23
TRANSFER CASE SHIFTING PROCEDURES
The part-time 4WD system provides three positions (2WD, 4H and 4LO), so you can select the desired drive mode according to the driving
conditions.
2WD or 4WD shift procedure:
4WD Shift
Switch Position
Wheels Driven
4WD shift
Indicator Light
Transfer 4LO
position
Use Conditions
Rear wheels
For driving on dry, paved roads
(Economy drive)
4 wheels
For driving on rocky, sandy or snowcovered roads
N (Neutral)
*1
May blink
N (Neutral) disengages the automatic transmission (A/T) mechanical
parking lock, which will allow the vehicle to roll. Do not leave the transfer
shift position in N (Neutral).*2
The 4LO indicator blinks when shifting between 4H and 4LO
Illuminated
For use when maximum power and
traction is required (for example, on
steep grades or rocky, sandy, muddy
roads)
2WD
4H
4LO
4 wheels
5-24 Starting and driving
4WD Shift Procedure
Move the 4WD switch.
2WD <—> 4H
4WD shift indicator light will indicate
transfer shift position engaged.
Shifting between the 2WD and 4H
drive modes can be done while driving. The indicator will change when
the drive mode is changed. Shifting
between the 2WD and 4H modes
must be performed at speed below
100 km/h (60 mph).
1. Stop the vehicle.
2. Move the shift lever to the N (Neutral) position with the brake pedal
depressed.
3. Depress and turn the 4WD shift
switch to 4LO or 4H with the
brake pedal depressed.
THE TRANSFER CASE DOES NOT ENGAGE BETWEEN 4H AND 4LO (OR
4LO TO 4H) UNLESS YOU HAVE FIRST
STOPPED THE VEHICLE, DEPRESSED
THE BRAKE PEDAL AND MOVED THE
SHIFT LEVER TO N (NEUTRAL) FOR
A/T VEHICLES. *3
*1: Before moving the shift lever from N (Neutral), wait until the transfer 4LO position indicator light stays on steady. This indicates that the 4WD shift procedure
is completed and the transfer gear is correctly set in the 4LO position. If the vehicle is shifted into gear before the indicator is on steady, the transfer gear
may grind, not engage correctly or stay in the neutral position.
- If the 4WD warning light illuminates, perform the following procedure to return the transfer case to correct operating condition.
1. Turn off the engine by placing the ignition switch in the OFF position.
2. Start the engine.
- Check that the 4WD warning light turns off. If the 4WD warning light illuminates, have the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
3. Apply the parking brake, depress the brake pedal and move the shift lever to N (Neutral) position.
4. With the brake pedal depressed, move the 4WD shift switch to the desired mode.
- Be sure to wait until the transfer gear change completes before shifting the shift lever from the N (Neutral) position.
*2: While changing in and out of 4LO, the ignition switch must be in the ON position and the vehicle's engine must be running for a shift to take place and for
the indicator lights (4WD shift and 4LO position indicator) to be operable. Otherwise, the shift will not take place and no indicator lights will be on or flashing.
*3: Make sure the transfer 4LO position indicator light turns on when you shift the 4WD shift switch to 4LO. The
indicator light will also turn on when 4LO
is selected. For additional information, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system” in this section.
When the 4LO position is selected, the VDC system is disabled and the VDC off indicator light illuminates, refer to “Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) off indicator
light” in the “Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
Starting and driving 5-25
The transfer case 4WD shift switch is used
to select either 2WD or 4WD depending on
the driving conditions. There are three
types of drive modes available, 2WD, 4H and
4LO.
The 4WD shift switch electronically controls
the transfer case operation. Rotate the
switch to move between each mode, 2WD,
4H and 4LO.
To change into or out of 4LO, the vehicle
MUST be stationary, move the shift lever
to N (Neutral), and depress the brake
pedal. The switch must be depressed
and turned when changing into or out of
4LO.
WARNING
• When parking, apply the parking
brake before stopping the engine
and make sure that the 4WD shift indicator light is on and the ATP warning light goes off. Otherwise, the vehicle could unexpectedly move even
if the A/T is in the P (Park) position.
5-26 Starting and driving
• The transfer 4LO position indicator
light must stop blinking and remain
illuminated or turn off before shifting
the transmission into gear. If the shift
lever is shifted from the N (Neutral)
position to any other gear when the
transfer 4LO position indicator light
is blinking, the vehicle may move
unexpectedly.
CAUTION
• Never shift the 4WD shift switch between 4LO and 4H while driving.
• The 4H position provides greater
traction. Avoid excessive speed, as it
will cause increased fuel consumption and higher oil temperatures, and
could damage drivetrain components. Speeds over 62 mph (100
km/h) in 4H is not recommended.
• The 4LO position provides maximum
power and traction. Avoid raising vehicle speed excessively, as the maximum speed is approximately 31 mph
(50 km/h).
• When driving straight, shift the 4WD
shift switch to the 2WD or 4H position.
Do not move the 4WD shift switch
when making a turn or reversing.
• Do not shift the 4WD shift switch (between 2WD and 4H) while driving on
steep downhill grades. Use the engine brake and low gears 2 (Second
gear) or 1 (Low gear), for engine
braking.
• Do not operate the 4WD shift switch
(between 2WD and 4H) with the rear
wheels spinning.
• Do not drive on dry hard surface
roads in the 4H or 4LO position. Driving on dry hard surfaces in 4H or 4LO
may cause unnecessary noise and
tire wear. NISSAN recommends driving in the 2WD position under these
conditions.
• The 4WD transfer case may not be
shifted between 4H and 4LO at low
ambient temperatures and the
transfer 4LO position indicator light
may blink even when the 4WD shift
switch is shifted. After driving for a
while you can change the 4WD transfer case between 4H and 4LO.
When driving on rough roads:
• Set the 4WD shift switch to 4H or 4LO.
• Drive carefully according to the road surface conditions.
When the vehicle is stuck:
• Set the 4WD shift switch to 4H or 4LO.
• Use the Electronic Locking Rear Differential (E-Lock) system (if so equipped). Turn
the switch ON while the vehicle is stationary and apply the throttle to try to free the
vehicle.
• If it is difficult to free the vehicle, rock the
vehicle back and forth between R (Reverse) and D (Drive) gears.
• If the vehicle is stuck deep in mud, place
stones or wooden blocks under the tires.
Then try the recovery procedures above.
Tire chains may be effective.
CAUTION
• Do not spin the tires excessively. Tires
will sink deep into the mud, making it
difficult to free the vehicle.
• Avoid shifting gears with the engine
running at high speeds as this may
cause malfunction.
• When the vehicle is stopped after making a turn, you may feel a slight jolt
after the shift lever is moved to N (Neutral) or P (Park). This occurs because the
transfer clutch is released and not because of a malfunction.
CAUTION
LSD0145
4WD shift switch operations
• Shift the 4WD shift switch to either the
2WD, 4H or 4LO position, depending on
driving conditions.
• If the 4WD shift switch is operated
while making a turn, accelerating or
decelerating or if the ignition switch is
placed in the OFF position while in the
4H or 4LO position, you may feel a jolt.
This is not abnormal.
• When driving straight, shift the 4WD
shift switch to the 2WD or 4H position. Do not move the 4WD shift
switch when making a turn or
reversing.
• Do not shift the 4WD shift switch
while driving on steep downhill
grades. Use the engine brake and low
automatic transmission gears (M1 or
M2) for engine braking.
• Do not operate the 4WD shift switch
with the rear wheels spinning.
• Before placing the 4WD shift switch
in the 4H position from 2WD, ensure
the vehicle speed is less than 62 mph
(100 km/h). Failure to do so can damage the 4WD system.
• Never shift the 4WD shift switch between 4LO and 4H while driving.
Starting and driving 5-27
• If the 4WD warning light comes on, the
4WD shift indicator light goes out.
CAUTION
LSD0147
4WD shift indicator light
If the 4WD shift indicator light indication changes to 2WD when the 4WD
shift switch is shifted to the 4H position
at low ambient temperatures, the 2WD
mode may be being engaged due to
malfunctioning drive system. If the indicator does not return to normal and
the 4WD warning light comes on, have
the system checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
4WD warning light
Warning light
Comes on or
blinks when:
Comes on
There is a malfunction in the
4–Wheel Drive
system
Blinks slowly
The difference
in wheel rotation is large
The 4WD shift indicator light is located in
the odometer display.
The 4WD warning light is located in the meter.
The light should turn off within 1 second
after placing the ignition switch in the ON
position.
The 4WD warning light comes on when the
ignition switch is placed in the ON position.
It turns off soon after the engine is started.
While the engine is running, the 4WD shift
indicator light will illuminate the position
selected by the 4WD shift switch.
• The 4WD shift indicator light may blink
while shifting from one drive mode to
the other. When the shifting is completed, the 4WD shift indicator light will
come on.
If any malfunction occurs in the 4WD system when the ignition switch is ON, the
warning light will either remain illuminated
or blink.
5-28 Starting and driving
ELECTRONIC LOCKING REAR
DIFFERENTIAL (E-Lock) SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
If the 4WD warning light comes on, the 4WD
shift indicator light goes out.
A large difference between the diameters
of front and rear wheels will make the
warning light blink slowly (about once per 1
second). Change the 4WD shift switch into
2WD and do not drive fast.
CAUTION
• If the warning light comes on or
blinks slowly during operation, have
your vehicle checked as soon as possible. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
• Shifting between 4H and 4LO is not
recommended when the 4WD warning light turns on.
• When the warning light comes on,
the 2WD mode may be engaged even
if the 4WD shift switch is in 4H. Be
especially careful when driving. If
corresponding parts are malfunctioning, the 4WD mode will not be engaged even if the 4WD shift switch is
shifted.
• Do not drive the vehicle in the 4H or
4LO position on dry hard surface
roads. Driving on dry, hard surfaces in
4H or 4LO may cause unnecessary
noise, tire wear and increased fuel
consumption.
If the 4WD warning light turns on
when you are driving on dry hard surface roads:
– In the 4H position, shift the 4WD
shift switch to 2WD.
– In the 4LO position for automatic
transmission vehicles, stop the
vehicle and shift the shift lever to
the N (Neutral) position with the
brake pedal depressed and shift
the 4WD shift switch to 2WD.
• If the warning light is still on after the
above operation, have your vehicle
checked as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• The transfer case may be damaged if
you continue driving with the warning light blinking.
The E-Lock system can provide additional
traction and should only be used when a
vehicle has become or is becoming stuck.
This system operates by electronically
“locking” the two rear drive wheels together, allowing them to turn at the same
speed. The system is used when it is not
possible to free a stuck vehicle even when
using the 4LO position (4-Wheel Drive vehicles).
When added traction is required, activate
the E-Lock system by pushing the switch
ON. For additional information, refer to
“Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system switch” in the “Instruments and
controls” section of this manual. Once the
system fully engages, the indicator light in
the instrument panel will remain on. When
the system is activated, both rear wheels
will engage, providing added traction.
The rear wheels may momentarily slip or
move to engage the system, and the system will only engage up to approximately 4
mph (7 km/h). Once the vehicle is free, the
system should be turned off and driving
resumed.
Starting and driving 5-29
The Anti-Lock Braking (ABS) system is disabled and the ABS light illuminates when
the E-Lock system is on. Also, the Vehicle
Dynamic Control (VDC) system is disabled
indicator light illuminates
and the
when the E-Lock system is on.
WARNING
• Never leave the E-Lock system on
when driving on paved or hardsurfaced roads. Turning the vehicle
may result in the rear wheels slipping
and result in an accident and personal injury. After using the E-Lock
system to free the vehicle, turn the
system off.
• Use the E-Lock system only when
freeing a stuck vehicle. Try the 4LO
position before using the E-Lock system. Never use the E-Lock system on
a slippery road surface such as snow
or ice surface. Using the E-Lock system when driving in these road conditions may cause unexpected
movement of the vehicle during engine braking, accelerating or turning,
which may result in an accident and
serious personal injury.
5-30 Starting and driving
CAUTION
• After using the E-Lock system, turn
the switch OFF to prevent possible
damage to driveline components
from extended use.
• Do not drive the vehicle at speeds
faster than 12 mph (20 km/h) when
the system is engaged. Doing so
could
damage
drivetrain
components.
• Do not turn on the E-Lock system
while the tires are spinning. Doing so
could
damage
drivetrain
components.
PARKING/PARKING ON HILLS
day can quickly become high enough to
cause a significant risk of injury or
death to people and pets.
1. Firmly apply the parking brake.
2. Move the shift lever to the P (Park)
position.
WSD0050
WARNING
• Do not stop or park the vehicle over
flammable materials such as dry
grass, waste paper or rags. They may
ignite and cause a fire.
• Safe parking procedures require that
both the parking brake be set and the
transmission placed into P (Park). Failure to do so could cause the vehicle to
move unexpectedly or roll away and result in an accident. Make sure the shift
lever has been pushed as far forward as
it can go and cannot be moved without
depressing the foot brake pedal.
• Never leave the engine running while
the vehicle is unattended.
• Do not leave children unattended inside the vehicle. They could unknowingly activate switches or controls or
make the vehicle move. Unattended
children could become involved in
serious accidents.
• To help avoid risk of injury or death
through unintended operation of the
vehicle and/or its systems, do not leave
children, people who require the assistance of others or pets unattended in
your vehicle. Additionally, the temperature inside a closed vehicle on a warm
3. To help prevent the vehicle from rolling
into traffic when parked on an incline, it
is a good practice to turn the wheels as
illustrated.
A :
• HEADED DOWNHILL WITH CURB O
Turn the wheels into the curb and move
the vehicle forward until the curb side
wheel gently touches the curb.
B :
• HEADED UPHILL WITH CURB O
Turn the wheels away from the curb and
move the vehicle back until the curb side
wheel gently touches the curb.
• HEADED UPHILL OR DOWNHILL, NO CURB
C :
O
Turn the wheels toward the side of the
road so the vehicle will move away from
the center of the road if it moves.
4. Place the ignition switch in the LOCK
position.
Starting and driving 5-31
POWER STEERING
BRAKE SYSTEM
The power assisted steering uses a hydraulic pump, driven by the engine, to assist steering.
The brake system has two separate hydraulic circuits. If one circuit malfunctions,
you will still have braking at two wheels.
If the engine stops or the drive belt breaks,
you will still have control of the vehicle.
However, much greater steering effort is
needed, especially in sharp turns and at
low speeds.
BRAKE PRECAUTIONS
WARNING
If the engine is not running or is turned
off while driving, the power assist for
the steering will not work. Steering will
be harder to operate.
Using the brakes
Avoid resting your foot on the brake pedal
while driving. This will overheat the brakes,
wear out the brake pads faster, and reduce
gas mileage.
To help reduce brake wear and to prevent
the brakes from overheating, reduce speed
and downshift to a lower gear before going
down a slope or long grade. Overheated
brakes may reduce braking performance
and could result in loss of vehicle control.
WARNING
• While driving on a slippery surface, be
careful when braking, accelerating or
downshifting. Abrupt braking or accelerating could cause the wheels to
skid and result in an accident.
• If the engine is not running or is
turned off while driving, the power
assist for the brakes will not work.
Braking will be harder.
5-32 Starting and driving
Wet brakes
When the vehicle is washed or driven
through water, the brakes may get wet. As
a result, your braking distance will be longer and the vehicle may pull to one side
during braking.
To dry the brakes, drive the vehicle at a safe
speed while lightly pressing the brake
pedal to heat up the brakes. Do this until
the brakes return to normal. Avoid driving
the vehicle at high speeds until the brakes
function correctly.
Parking brake break-in
Break in the parking brake shoes whenever
the stopping effect of the parking brake is
weakened or whenever the parking brake
shoes and/or drums/rotors are replaced,
in order to assure the best braking performance.
This procedure is described in the vehicle
service manual. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
ANTI-LOCK BRAKING SYSTEM (ABS)
WARNING
• The ABS is a sophisticated device, but
it cannot prevent accidents resulting
from careless or dangerous driving
techniques. It can help maintain vehicle control during braking on slippery surfaces. Remember that stopping distances on slippery surfaces
will be longer than on normal surfaces even with ABS. Stopping distances may also be longer on rough,
gravel or snow covered roads, or if
you are using tire chains. Always
maintain a safe distance from the vehicle in front of you. Ultimately, the
driver is responsible for safety.
• Tire type and condition may also affect braking effectiveness.
– When replacing tires, install the
specified size of tires on all four
wheels.
– When installing a spare tire, make
sure that it is the proper size and
type as specified on the Tire and
Loading Information label. For additional information, refer to “Tire
and Loading Information label” in
the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
– For additional information, refer
to “Wheels and tires” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
The ABS controls the brakes so the wheels
do not lock during hard braking or when
braking on slippery surfaces. The system
detects the rotation speed at each wheel
and varies the brake fluid pressure to prevent each wheel from locking and sliding.
By preventing each wheel from locking, the
system helps the driver maintain steering
control and helps to minimize swerving
and spinning on slippery surfaces.
Using the system
Depress the brake pedal and hold it down.
Depress the brake pedal with firm steady
pressure, but do not pump the brakes. The
Anti-lock Braking System will operate to
prevent the wheels from locking up. Steer
the vehicle to avoid obstacles.
WARNING
Do not pump the brake pedal. Doing so
may result in increased stopping distances.
Self-test feature
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) includes electronic sensors, electric pumps,
hydraulic solenoids and a computer. The
computer has a built-in diagnostic feature
that tests the system each time you start
the engine and move the vehicle at a low
speed in forward or reverse. When the selftest occurs, you may hear a “clunk” noise
and/or feel a pulsation in the brake pedal.
This is normal and does not indicate a malfunction. If the computer senses a malfunction, it switches the ABS off and illuminates the ABS warning light on the
instrument panel. The brake system then
operates normally but without anti-lock
assistance.
If the ABS warning light illuminates during
the self-test or while driving, have the vehicle checked. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
Starting and driving 5-33
ACTIVE BRAKE LIMITED SLIP (ABLS)
SYSTEM
Normal operation
The Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) operates at speeds above 3 - 6 mph (5 - 10
km/h). The speed varies according to road
conditions.
When the ABS senses that one or more
wheels are close to locking up, the actuator
rapidly applies and releases hydraulic pressure. This action is similar to pumping the
brakes very quickly. You may feel a pulsation in the brake pedal and hear a noise
from under the hood or feel a vibration
from the actuator when it is operating. This
is normal and indicates that the ABS is operating properly. However, the pulsation
may indicate that road conditions are hazardous and extra care is required while
driving.
5-34 Starting and driving
• The ABLS system uses automatic braking to transfer power from a slipping drive
wheel to the wheel on the same axle with
more traction. The ABLS system applies
braking to the slipping wheel, which helps
redirect power to the other wheel.
• On 4–Wheel Drive models the ABLS system operates in both 4H and 4LO modes.
If 4WD mode is engaged, the ABLS system operates for both drive axles. On
2–Wheel Drive vehicles, the ABLS system
operates on the drive axle only.
• The ABLS system is always on. In some
conditions, the system may automatically turn the ABLS system off. If the system is automatically turned off, normal
brake function will continue. ABLS will
function even when the Vehicle Dynamic
Control system is turned off.
• The ABLS does not operate if both wheels
on a drive axle are slipping.
WARNING
• The ABLS system helps provide increased traction, but will not prevent
accidents due to abrupt steering operation or by careless driving or dangerous driving practices. Reduce vehicle speed and be especially careful
when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces. Always drive carefully.
• Do not modify the vehicle’s suspension. If suspension parts such as
shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are
not NISSAN approved for your vehicle
or are extremely deteriorated, the
ABLS system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling performance, and the
slip indicator light may illuminate.
• If brake related parts such as brake
pads, rotors and calipers are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the ABLS system
may not operate properly and the slip
indicator light may illuminate.
• If wheels or tires other than the NISSAN
recommended ones are used, the ABLS
system may not operate properly and
the slip indicator light may illuminate.
VEHICLE DYNAMIC CONTROL (VDC)
SYSTEM
The VDC system uses various sensors to
monitor driver inputs and vehicle motion.
Under certain driving conditions, the VDC
system helps to perform the following
functions:
• Controls brake pressure to reduce wheel
slip on one slipping drive wheel so power
is transferred to a non-slipping drive
wheel on the same axle.
• Controls brake pressure and engine output to reduce drive wheel slip based on
vehicle speed (traction control function).
• If the 4WD transfer case is shifted into 4LO
indicator light will come on and
the
the VDC system will be turned off. For
additional information, refer to “Using
4–Wheel Drive (4WD)” in this section.
• Controls brake pressure at individual
wheels and engine output to help the
driver maintain control of the vehicle in
the following conditions:
– Understeer (vehicle tends to not follow
the steered path despite increased
steering input)
– Oversteer (vehicle tends to spin due to
certain road or driving conditions)
The VDC system can help the driver to
maintain control of the vehicle, but it cannot prevent loss of vehicle control in all driving situations.
When the VDC system operates, the
indicator light in the instrument panel
flashes so note the following:
• The road may be slippery or the system
may determine some action is required
to help keep the vehicle on the steered
path.
• You may feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal and hear a noise or vibration from
under the hood. This is normal and indicates that the VDC system is working
properly.
• Adjust your speed and driving to the road
conditions.
For additional information, refer to “Slip indicator light” and ”Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) OFF indicator light” in the ”Instruments and controls” section of this manual.
When the VDC OFF switch is used to turn off
the system, the VDC system still operates
to prevent one drive wheel from slipping by
transferring power to a non-slipping drive
indicator light flashes if this
wheel. The
occurs. All other VDC functions are off and
indicator light will not flash.
the
The VDC system is automatically reset to
on when the ignition switch is placed in the
OFF position then back to the ON position.
The computer has a built-in diagnostic feature that tests the system each time you
start the engine and move the vehicle forward or in reverse at a slow speed. When
the self-test occurs, you may hear a clunk
noise and/or feel a pulsation in the brake
pedal. This is normal and is not an indication of a malfunction.
If a malfunction occurs in the system, the
indicator light will come on in the instrument panel. The VDC system automatically turns off when these indicator
lights are off.
The VDC OFF switch is used to turn off the
indicator light illumiVDC system. The
nates to indicate the VDC system is off.
Starting and driving 5-35
WARNING
• The VDC system is designed to help
the driver maintain stability but does
not prevent accidents due to abrupt
steering operation at high speeds or
by careless or dangerous driving
techniques. Reduce vehicle speed
and be especially careful when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces and always drive carefully.
• Do not modify the vehicle's suspension. If suspension parts such as
shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are
not NISSAN recommended for your
vehicle or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling performance,
indicator light may flash
and the
indicator light may
or the
illuminate.
• If brake related parts such as brake
pads, rotors and calipers are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly and
and
indicator
both the
lights may illuminate.
5-36 Starting and driving
• If engine control related parts are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, both the
and
indicator lights may
illuminate.
• When driving on extremely inclined
surfaces such as higher banked corners, the VDC system may not operindicator
ate properly and the
indicator
light may flash or the
light may illuminate. Do not drive on
these types of roads.
• When driving on an unstable surface
such as a turntable, ferry, elevator or
indicator light may
ramp, the
indicator light may
flash or the
illuminate. This is not a malfunction.
Restart the engine after driving onto
a stable surface.
• If wheels or tires other than the
NISSAN recommended ones are
used, the VDC system may not operindicator
ate properly and the
indicator
light may flash or the
light may illuminate.
• The VDC system is not a substitute
for winter tires or tire chains on a
snow covered road.
BRAKE FORCE DISTRIBUTION
During braking while driving through turns,
the system optimizes the distribution of
force to each of the four wheels depending
on the radius of the turn.
WARNING
• The VDC system is designed to help
the driver maintain stability but does
not prevent accidents due to abrupt
steering operation at high speeds or
by careless or dangerous driving
techniques. Reduce vehicle speed
and be especially careful when driving and cornering on slippery surfaces and always drive carefully.
• Do not modify the vehicle's suspension. If suspension parts such as
shock absorbers, struts, springs, stabilizer bars, bushings and wheels are
not NISSAN recommended for your
vehicle or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly. This could adversely affect vehicle handling performance,
indicator light may flash
and the
indicator light may
or the
illuminate.
HILL DESCENT CONTROL SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
• If brake related parts such as brake
pads, rotors and calipers are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, the VDC system may not operate properly and
and the
indicator
both the
lights may illuminate.
• If engine control related parts are not
NISSAN recommended or are extremely deteriorated, both the
indicator lights may
and
illuminate.
• When driving on extremely inclined
surfaces such as higher banked corners, the VDC system may not operindicator
ate properly and the
indicator
light may flash or the
light may illuminate. Do not drive on
these types of roads.
• When driving on an unstable surface
such as a turntable, ferry, elevator or
indicator light may
ramp, the
indicator light may
flash or the
illuminate. This is not a malfunction.
Restart the engine after driving onto
a stable surface.
• If wheels or tires other than the
NISSAN recommended ones are
used, the VDC system may not operindicator
ate properly and the
indicator
light may flash or the
light may illuminate.
• The VDC system is not a substitute
for winter tires or tire chains on a
snow covered road.
WARNING
• Never rely solely on the hill descent
control system to control vehicle
speed when driving on steep downhill grades. Always drive carefully and
attentively when using the hill descent control system and decelerate
the vehicle speed by depressing the
brake pedal if necessary. Be especially careful when driving on frozen,
muddy or extremely steep downhill
roads. Failure to control vehicle
speed may result in a loss of control
of the vehicle and possible serious
injury or death.
• The hill descent control may not control the vehicle speed on a hill under
all load or road conditions. Always be
prepared to depress the brake pedal
to control vehicle speed. Failure to do
so may result in a collision or serious
personal injury.
The hill descent control system helps
maintain vehicle speed when driving under
15-21 mph (25-35 km/h) on steeper downhill grades. Hill descent control is useful
when engine braking alone in 4H or 4L cannot control vehicle speed. Hill descent control applies the vehicle brakes to control
Starting and driving 5-37
HILL START ASSIST SYSTEM (if so
equipped)
vehicle speed allowing the driver to concentrate on steering while reducing the
burden of brake and accelerator operation.
• When additional braking is required on
steep downhill roads, activate the hill descent control system by pushing the
switch on. For additional information, refer to “Hill descent control switch” in the
“Instruments and controls” section of this
manual.
• Once the system is activated, the indicator light will remain on in the instrument
panel. For additional information, refer to
“Hill descent control system ON indicator
light” in the “Instruments and controls”
section of this manual.
If the accelerator or brake pedal is depressed while the hill descent control system is on, the system will stop operating
temporarily. As soon as the accelerator or
brake pedal is released, the hill descent
control system begins to function again if
the hill descent control operating conditions are fulfilled.
For the best results, when descending
steep downhill grades, the hill descent control switch should be on and the shift lever
in 2 (Second gear) or 1 (Low gear) for engine
braking.
5-38 Starting and driving
WARNING
• Never rely solely on the hill start assist system to prevent the vehicle
from moving backward on a hill. Always drive carefully and attentively.
Depress the brake pedal when the
vehicle is stopped on a steep hill. Be
especially careful when stopped on a
hill on frozen or muddy roads. Failure
to prevent the vehicle from rolling
backwards may result in a loss of
control of the vehicle and possible
serious injury or death.
• The hill start assist system is not designed to hold the vehicle at a standstill on a hill. Depress the brake pedal
when the vehicle is stopped on a
steep hill. Failure to do so may cause
the vehicle to roll backwards and
may result in a collision or serious
personal injury.
• The hill start assist may not prevent
the vehicle from rolling backwards
on a hill under all load or road conditions. Always be prepared to depress
the brake pedal to prevent the vehicle from rolling backwards. Failure
to do so may result in a collision or
serious personal injury.
When the vehicle is stopped on a hill, the hill
start assist system automatically keeps
the brakes applied. This helps prevents the
vehicle from rolling backward in the time it
takes the driver to release the brake pedal
and apply the accelerator.
Hill start assist will operate automatically
under the following conditions:
• The shift lever is moved to a forward or
reverse gear.
• The vehicle is stopped completely on a
hill by applying the brake.
The maximum holding time is 2 seconds.
After 2 seconds the vehicle will begin to roll
back and hill start assist will stop operating
completely.
Hill start assist will not operate when the
shift lever is moved to N (Neutral) or P (Park)
or on a flat and level road.
REAR SONAR SYSTEM (RSS) (if so
equipped)
• The system is designed as an aid to
the driver in detecting large stationary objects to help avoid damaging
the vehicle. The system will not detect small objects below the bumper,
and may not detect objects close to
the bumper or on the ground.
• If your vehicle sustains damage to
the rear bumper fascia, leaving it
misaligned or bent, the sensing zone
may be altered causing inaccurate
measurement of obstacles or false
alarms.
WSD0103
WARNING
• Always turn and look back before
backing up. The RSS is not a substitute for proper backing procedures.
• Read and understand the limitations
of the RSS as contained in this section. Inclement weather may affect
the function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false
activation.
• This system is not designed to prevent contact with small or moving
objects.
The RSS sounds a tone to warn the driver of
obstacles near the rear bumper when the
shift lever is in R (Reverse). The system may
not detect objects at speeds above 3 mph
(5 km/h) and may not detect certain angular or moving objects.
The RSS detects obstacles up to 5.9 ft (1.8
m) from the rear bumper with a decreased
coverage area at the outer corners of the
bumper (refer to the illustration for approximate zone coverage areas). As you move
closer to the obstacle, the rate of the tone
increases. When the obstacle is less than 10
in (25.0 cm) away, the tone will sound continuously. If the RSS detects a stationary or
receding object further than 10 in (25.0 cm)
from the side of the vehicle, the tone will
sound for only 3 seconds. Once the system
detects an object approaching, the tone
will sound again.
The RSS automatically turns on when the
shift lever is placed in R (Reverse) and the
ignition is ON. The RSS OFF switch on the
instrument panel allows the driver to turn
the RSS on and off. To turn the RSS off, the
ignition must be on, and the shift lever in R
(Reverse). An indicator light on the switch
will illuminate when the system is turned
off. If the indicator light illuminates when
the RSS is not turned off, it may indicate a
malfunction in the RSS.
Keep the RSS sensors (located on the rear
bumper fascia) free from snow, ice and
large accumulations of dirt (do not clean
the sensors with sharp objects). If the sensors are covered, it will affect the accuracy
of the RSS.
Starting and driving 5-39
COLD WEATHER DRIVING
FREEING A FROZEN DOOR LOCK
TIRE EQUIPMENT
SPECIAL WINTER EQUIPMENT
To prevent a door lock from freezing, apply
de-icer through the key hole. If the lock
becomes frozen, heat the key before inserting it into the key hole or use the remote keyless entry key fob (if so equipped).
1. SUMMER tires have a tread designed to
provide superior performance on dry
pavement. However, the performance of
these tires will be substantially reduced
in snowy and icy conditions. If you operate your vehicle on snowy or icy roads,
NISSAN recommends the use of MUD &
SNOW or ALL SEASON TIRES on all four
wheels. It is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer for the tire type, size,
speed rating and availability information.
It is recommended that the following items
be carried in the vehicle during winter:
• A scraper and stiff-bristled brush to remove ice and snow from the windows
and wiper blades.
• A sturdy, flat board to be placed under the
jack to give it firm support.
• A shovel to dig the vehicle out of snowdrifts.
• Extra washer fluid to refill the windshieldwasher fluid reservoir.
ANTIFREEZE
In the winter when it is anticipated that the
temperature will drop below 32°F (0°C),
check the antifreeze to assure proper winter protection. For additional information,
refer to “Engine cooling system” in the “Doit-yourself” section of this manual.
BATTERY
If the battery is not fully charged during extremely cold weather conditions, the battery
fluid may freeze and damage the battery. To
maintain maximum efficiency, the battery
should be checked regularly. For additional
information, refer to “Battery” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
DRAINING OF COOLANT WATER
If the vehicle is to be left outside without
antifreeze, drain the cooling system, including the engine block. Refill before operating
the vehicle. For additional information, refer
to “Changing engine coolant” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
5-40 Starting and driving
2. For additional traction on icy roads,
studded tires may be used. However,
some U.S. states and Canadian provinces prohibit their use. Check local,
state and provincial laws before installing studded tires.
Skid and traction capabilities of studded
snow tires on wet or dry surfaces may be
poorer than that of non-studded snow
tires.
3. Tire chains may be used. For additional
information, refer to “Tire chains” in the
“Do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
DRIVING ON SNOW OR ICE
WARNING
• Wet ice (32°F, 0°C and freezing rain),
very cold snow or ice can be slick and
very hard to drive on. The vehicle will
have much less traction or “grip” under these conditions. Try to avoid
driving on wet ice until the road is
salted or sanded.
• Whatever the condition, drive with
caution. Accelerate and slow down
with care. If accelerating or downshifting too fast, the drive wheels will
lose even more traction.
• Allow more stopping distance under
these conditions. Braking should be
started sooner than on dry
pavement.
• Allow greater following distances on
slippery roads.
• Watch for slippery spots (glare ice).
These may appear on an otherwise
clear road in shaded areas. If a patch
of ice is seen ahead, brake before
reaching it. Try not to brake while on
the ice, and avoid any sudden steering maneuvers.
• Do not use the cruise control on slippery roads.
• Snow can trap dangerous exhaust
gases under your vehicle. Keep snow
clear of the exhaust pipe and from
around your vehicle.
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (if so
equipped)
To use the engine block heater:
Engine block heaters are used to assist
with cold temperature starting.
2. Open the hood and unwrap the engine
block heater cord.
The engine block heater should be used
when the outside temperature is 20°F (-7°C)
or lower.
3. Plug the engine block heater cord into a
grounded 3-wire, 3-pronged extension
cord.
WARNING
• Do not use your engine block heater
with an ungrounded electrical system or a 2-pronged adapter. You can
be seriously injured by an electrical
shock if you use an ungrounded
connection.
• Disconnect and properly store the
engine block heater cord before
starting the engine. Damage to the
cord could result in an electrical
shock and can cause serious injury.
• Use a heavy-duty 3-wire, 3-pronged
extension cord rated for at least 10 A.
Plug the extension cord into a
Ground Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded 110-VAC outlet.
Failure to use the proper extension
cord or a grounded outlet can result
in a fire or electrical shock and cause
serious personal injury.
1. Turn the engine off.
4. Plug the extension cord into a Ground
Fault Interrupt (GFI) protected, grounded
110-volt AC (VAC) outlet.
5. The engine block heater must be
plugged in for at least 2–4 hours, depending on outside temperatures, to
properly warm the engine coolant. Use
an appropriate timer to turn the engine
block heater on.
6. Before starting the engine, unplug and
properly store the cord to keep it away
from moving parts.
Starting and driving 5-41
MEMO
5-42 Starting and driving
6 In case of emergency
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
First aid kit (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-2
Emergency engine shut off . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3
Changing a flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-11
Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13
Towing your vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14
Towing recommended by NISSAN . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15
Vehicle recovery (freeing a stuck
vehicle) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16
HAZARD WARNING FLASHER SWITCH
FIRST AID KIT (if so equipped)
• Turn signals do not work when the
hazard warning flasher lights are on.
The flashers will operate with the ignition
switch placed in any position.
Some jurisdictions may prohibit the use
of the hazard warning flasher switch
while driving.
LIC0394
LTI2502
Push the switch on to warn other drivers
when you must stop or park under emergency conditions. All turn signal lights flash.
Crew Cab model
For Crew Cab model, lift up the rear bench
seat and remove the net to remove the first
aid kit. For additional information, refer to
“Folding the rear bench seat up” in the
“Safety — Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
WARNING
• If stopping for an emergency, be sure
to move the vehicle well off the road.
• Do not use the hazard warning flashers while moving on the highway unless unusual circumstances force
you to drive so slowly that your vehicle might become a hazard to other
traffic.
6-2 In case of emergency
EMERGENCY ENGINE SHUT OFF
FLAT TIRE
To shut off the engine in an emergency
situation while driving, perform the following procedure:
– Rapidly push the push-button ignition
switch three consecutive times in less
than 1.5 seconds, or
– Push and hold the push-button ignition
switch for more than 2 seconds.
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING
SYSTEM (TPMS)
This vehicle is equipped with TPMS. It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the
spare. When the low tire pressure warning
light is lit, and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed in the
odometer, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated. If the vehicle is being driven with low tire pressure, the TPMS
will activate and warn you of it by the low
tire pressure warning light. This system will
activate only when the vehicle is driven at
speeds above 16 mph (25 km/h). For additional information, refer to “Warning lights,
indicator lights and audible reminders” in
the “Instruments and Controls” section,
and “Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)” in the “Starting and driving” section
of this manual.
WARNING
• Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those
who use a pacemaker should contact
the electric medical equipment
manufacturer for the possible influences before use.
• If the low tire pressure warning light
illuminates while driving, avoid sudden steering maneuvers or abrupt
braking, reduce vehicle speed, pull
off the road to a safe location and
stop the vehicle as soon as possible.
Driving with under-inflated tires may
permanently damage the tires and
increase the likelihood of tire failure.
Serious vehicle damage could occur
and may lead to an accident and
could result in serious personal injury. Check the tire pressure for all
four tires. Adjust the tire pressure to
the recommended COLD tire pressure shown on the Tire and Loading
Information label to turn the low tire
pressure warning light OFF. If the
light still illuminates while driving after adjusting the tire pressure, a tire
may be flat or the TPMS may be malfunctioning. If you have a flat tire, replace it with a spare tire as soon as
possible. If no tire is flat and all tires
are properly inflated, have the vehicle checked. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
In case of emergency 6-3
• When replacing a wheel without the
TPMS such as the spare tire, the TPMS
will not function and the low tire
pressure warning light will flash for
approximately 1 minute. The light will
remain on after 1 minute. Have your
tires replaced and/or TPMS system
reset as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for these services.
• Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the
TPMS.
• Do not inject any tire liquid or aerosol
tire sealant into the tires, as this may
cause a malfunction of the tire pressure sensors.
CHANGING A FLAT TIRE
If you have a flat tire, follow the instructions
below:
3. Park on a level surface and apply the
parking brake. Move the shift lever to P
(Park).
4. Turn off the engine.
5. Raise the hood to warn other traffic and
to signal professional road assistance
personnel that you need assistance.
6. Have all passengers get out of the vehicle and stand in a safe place, away
from traffic and clear of the vehicle.
WARNING
• Make sure the parking brake is securely applied and the shift lever is
shifted into P (Park).
• Never change tires when the vehicle
is on a slope, ice or slippery areas.
This is hazardous.
• Never change tires if oncoming traffic is close to your vehicle. Wait for
professional road assistance.
LCE2142
A. Blocks
B. Flat tire
Blocking wheels
Place suitable blocks at both the front and
back of the wheel diagonally opposite the
flat tire to prevent the vehicle from moving
when it is jacked up.
Stopping the vehicle
1. Safely move the vehicle off the road and
away from traffic.
2. Turn on the hazard warning flashers.
6-4 In case of emergency
WARNING
Be sure to block the wheel as the vehicle may move and result in personal
injury.
LCE0109
Getting the spare tire and tools
(King Cab® models)
The tool storage compartment is located
between the two rear jump seats.
1. Turn the knob from the lock to the unlock position and remove the lid from the
tool storage compartment.
LCE0110
LCE2164
2. Release the strap to remove the tool
bag.
3. Collapse the jack to remove it from the
storage location by inserting the wheel
nut wrench into the jack screw at the top
of the jack as shown. Turn the wheel-nut
wrench counterclockwise as shown until the jack screw becomes loose. Then
loosen the jack with your fingers until it
becomes free.
4. Remove the jack.
5. To reinstall the jack and tools, reverse
steps 1 to 4.
In case of emergency 6-5
LCE2159
Getting the spare tire and tools
(Crew Cab models)
The tools and tool bag are located behind
the rear bench seat.
1. Remove the head restraints/headrests
and fold the rear bench seat down. For
additional information, refer to “Folding
the rear bench seat down ” in the “Safety–
Seats, seat belts and supplemental restraint system” section of this manual.
2. Remove the tool bag and locate the
wheel-nut wrench.
6-6 In case of emergency
LCE2165
3. Collapse the jack to remove it from the
storage location by inserting the wheelnut wrench into the jack screw as shown
and turning the wheel-nut wrench towards you until the jack becomes loose.
Then loosen the jack screw with your
fingers until it is free.
4. Remove the jack from behind the seat.
5. To reinstall the jack and tools, reverse
steps 1 to 4.
WCE0070
Getting the spare tire and tools
(All models)
1. Seat the T-shaped end of the jacking rod
into the T-shaped opening of the spare
tire winch. Apply pressure to keep the
jacking rod engaged in the spare tire
winch and turn the jacking rod counterclockwise to lower the spare tire.
CAUTION
• Be sure to center the spare tire suspending plate on the wheel and then
lift the spare tire.
• Failure to use the spacer may allow
the chain to get stuck on the wheel
nut holes.
2. Once the spare tire is completely lowered, reach under the vehicle, remove
the retainer chain, and carefully slide the
tire from under the rear of the vehicle.
LCE2022
3. To reinstall the wheel, remove the center
cap and insert the tire chain through the
wheel. Be sure the rubber spacer is centered on the wheel before lifting. Use the
assembled jacking rod to slowly rotate
the winch clockwise to raise the wheel
to the vehicle.
NOTE:
Inspect the spacer every six years and
replace as necessary. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
In case of emergency 6-7
To remove the wheel cap, remove the
wheel nuts after the jack is securely supporting the vehicle and the tire clears the
ground.
For additional information, refer to “Jacking
up vehicle and removing the damaged tire”
in this section.
Take care not to scratch the wheel cap or
wheel surface.
Jacking up vehicle and removing
the damaged tire
LCE2367
Removing bolt-on wheel caps (if
so equipped)
CAUTION
Do not use your hands to pry off wheel
caps or wheel covers. Doing so could
result in personal injury.
1 is only attached with the
The wheel cap O
wheel nuts and is separate from the wheel
2 .
O
6-8 In case of emergency
WARNING
• Never get under the vehicle while it is
supported only by the jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle,
support it with safety stands.
• Use only the jack provided with your
vehicle to lift the vehicle. Do not use
the jack provided with your vehicle
on other vehicles. The jack is designed for lifting only your vehicle
during a tire change.
• Use the correct jack-up points. Never
use any other part of the vehicle for
jack support.
• Never jack up the vehicle more than
necessary.
• Never use blocks on or under the
jack.
• Do not start or run the engine while
vehicle is on the jack. It may cause
the vehicle to move. This is especially
true for vehicles with limited slip
differentials.
• Do not allow passengers to stay in
the vehicle while it is on the jack.
• Never run the engine with a wheel(s)
off the ground. It may cause the vehicle to move.
2. Place the jack directly under the jack-up
point as illustrated so the top of the jack
contacts the vehicle at the jack-up point.
Align the jack head under the arrow
stamped on the side of the frame or rear
as shown.
The jack should be used on firm and
level ground.
WCE0152
Always refer to the illustration for the correct placement and jack-up points for your
specific vehicle model and jack type.
Carefully read the caution label attached
to the jack body and the following instructions.
1. Loosen each wheel nut 1 or 2 turns by
turning counterclockwise with the wheel
nut wrench. Do not remove the wheel
nuts until the tire is off the ground.
In case of emergency 6-9
4. Lower the vehicle slowly until the tire
touches the ground. Then, with the
wheel nut wrench, tighten the wheel
nuts securely in the sequence illustrated
1 ,O
2 ,O
3 ,O
4 ,O
5 ,O
6 ). Lower the vehicle
(O
completely .
WARNING
WCE0063
Installing the spare tire
The spare tire is designed for emergency
use. For additional information, refer to
“Wheels and tires” in the “Do-it-yourself”
section of this manual.
LCE0087
3. Install the assembled jacking rod into
the jack as shown.
4. To lift the vehicle, securely hold the jacking lever and rod. Carefully raise the vehicle until the tire clears the ground.
5. Remove the wheel nuts and then remove the tire.
6-10 In case of emergency
1. Clean any mud or dirt from the surface
between the wheel and hub.
2. Carefully put the spare tire on and
tighten the wheel nuts finger tight.
3. With the wheel nut wrench, tighten
wheel nuts alternately and evenly in the
1 ,O
2 ,O
3 ,O
4 ,O
5 ,O
6 )
sequence illustrated (O
until they are tight.
• Incorrect wheel nuts or improperly
tightened wheel nuts can cause the
wheel to become loose or come off.
This could cause an accident.
• Do not use oil or grease on the wheel
studs or nuts. This could cause the
nuts to become loose.
• Retighten the wheel nuts when the
vehicle has been driven for 620 miles
(1,000 km) (also in cases of a flat tire,
etc.).
As soon as possible, tighten the wheel
nuts to the specified torque with a
torque wrench.
Wheel nut tightening torque:
98 ft-lb (133 N·m)
JUMP STARTING
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to
specification at all times. It is recommended that wheel nuts be tightened to
specifications at each lubrication interval.
Adjust tire pressure to the COLD pressure.
COLD pressure: After vehicle has been
parked for 3 hours or more or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km).
COLD tire pressures are shown on the
Tire and Loading Information label located in the driver's door opening.
5. Securely store the jacking equipment in
the vehicle and the flat tire under the
vehicle. For additional information about
storing the flat tire, refer to “Getting the
spare tire and tools” in this section.
WARNING
• Always make sure that the spare tire
and jacking equipment are properly
secured after use. Such items can become dangerous projectiles in an accident or sudden stop.
• The spare tire is designed for emergency use. For additional information,
refer to “Wheels and tires” in the “Doit-yourself” section of this manual.
To start your engine with a booster battery,
the instructions and precautions below
must be followed.
WARNING
• If done incorrectly, jump starting can
lead to a battery explosion, resulting
in severe injury or death. It could also
damage your vehicle.
• Explosive hydrogen gas is always
present in the vicinity of the battery.
Keep all sparks and flames away
from the battery.
• Do not allow battery fluid to come
into contact with eyes, skin, clothing
or painted surfaces. Battery fluid is a
corrosive sulfuric acid solution which
can cause severe burns. If the fluid
should come into contact with anything, immediately flush the contacted area with water.
• Keep battery out of the reach of
children.
• The booster battery must be rated at
12 volts. Use of an improperly rated
battery can damage your vehicle.
• Whenever working on or near a battery, always wear suitable eye protectors (for example, goggles or industrial safety spectacles) and
remove rings, metal bands, or any
other jewelry. Do not lean over the
battery when jump starting.
• Do not attempt to jump start a frozen
battery. It could explode and cause
serious injury.
• The automatic engine cooling fan (if
so equipped) may come on at any
time without warning, even if the ignition switch is in the OFF position
and the engine is not running. To
avoid injury, keep hands and other
objects away from it.
In case of emergency 6-11
4. Start the engine of the booster vehicle
and let it run for a few minutes.
5. Keep the engine speed of the booster
vehicle at about 2,000 rpm and start the
engine of the vehicle being jump
started.
CAUTION
Do not keep the starter motor engaged
for more than 10 seconds. If the engine
does not start right away, place the ignition switch in the OFF position and
wait 3 to 4 seconds before trying again.
LCE2223
WARNING
Always follow the instructions below.
Failure to do so could result in damage
to the charging system and cause personal injury.
1. If the booster battery is in another vehicle, position the 2 vehicles to bring their
batteries near each other.
Do not allow the two vehicles to touch.
2. Apply the parking brake. Move the shift
lever to P (Park). Switch off all unnecessary electrical systems (lights, heater, air
conditioner, etc.).
6-12 In case of emergency
3. Connect the jumper cables in the seA ,O
B ,O
C ,O
D ).
quence illustrated (O
CAUTION
• Always connect positive (+) to positive (+) and negative (−) to body
ground (for example, strut mounting
bolt, engine lift bracket, etc.) — not to
the battery.
• Make sure the jumper cables do not
touch moving parts in the engine
compartment and that the cable
clamps do not contact any other
metal.
6. After starting the engine, carefully disconnect the negative cable and then the
positive cable.
PUSH STARTING
CAUTION
• Do not push start this vehicle. The
three-way
catalyst
may
be
damaged.
• Automatic transmission models cannot be push-started or tow-started.
Attempting to do so may cause
transmission damage.
IF YOUR VEHICLE OVERHEATS
WARNING
• Do not continue to drive if your vehicle overheats. Doing so could cause
engine damage or a vehicle fire.
• To avoid the danger of being scalded,
never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap while the engine is still
hot. When the radiator or coolant reservoir cap is removed, pressurized
hot water will spurt out, possibly
causing serious injury.
• Do not open the hood if steam is
coming out.
If your vehicle is overheating (indicated by
an extremely high temperature gauge
reading), or if you feel a lack of engine
power, detect abnormal noise, etc. take the
following steps.
1. Move the vehicle safely off the road, apply the parking brake and move the shift
lever to P (Park).
Do not stop the engine.
2. Turn off the air conditioner. Open all the
windows, move the heater or air conditioner temperature control to maximum
hot and fan control to high speed.
3. Get out of the vehicle. Look and listen for
steam or coolant escaping from the radiator before opening the hood. If steam
or coolant is escaping, turn off the engine. Do not open the hood further until
no steam or coolant can be seen.
4. Open the engine hood.
WARNING
If steam or water is coming from the
engine, stand clear to prevent getting
burned.
5. Visually check drive belts for damage or
looseness. Also check if the cooling fan
is running. The radiator hoses and radiator should not leak water. If coolant is
leaking, the water pump belt is missing
or loose, or the cooling fan does not run,
stop the engine.
WARNING
Be careful not to allow your hands, hair,
jewelry or clothing to come into contact with, or get caught in, engine belts
or the engine cooling fan. The engine
cooling fan can start at any time.
In case of emergency 6-13
TOWING YOUR VEHICLE
6. After the engine cools down, check the
coolant level in the engine coolant reservoir tank with the engine running. Add
coolant to the engine coolant reservoir
tank if necessary. Have your vehicle repaired. It is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer for this service.
When towing your vehicle, all jurisdictional
and local regulations for towing must be
followed. Incorrect towing equipment
could damage your vehicle. Towing instructions are available from a NISSAN
dealer. Local service operators are generally familiar with the applicable laws and
procedures for towing. To assure proper
towing and to prevent accidental damage
to your vehicle, NISSAN recommends having a service operator tow your vehicle. It is
advisable to have the service operator
carefully read the following precautions:
WARNING
• Never ride in a vehicle that is being
towed.
• Never get under your vehicle after it
has been lifted by a tow truck.
6-14 In case of emergency
CAUTION
• When towing, make sure that the
transmission, axles, steering system
and powertrain are in working condition. Use dollies or flatbed if any of
the listed systems are not working.
• Always attach safety chains before
towing.
For additional information, refer to “Flat
towing — 4WD with automatic transmission,” “Flat towing — 2WD with automatic
transmission” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
TOWING RECOMMENDED BY
NISSAN
NISSAN recommends towing your vehicle
based upon the type of drivetrain. For additional information, refer to the diagrams in
this section to ensure that your vehicle is
properly towed.
LCE2141
Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) models
with automatic transmission
NISSAN recommends that towing dollies
be used when towing your vehicle or place
the vehicle on a flatbed truck as illustrated.
NOTE:
If the battery is completely drained the
transmission will not manually shift to
other positions.
CAUTION
Never tow 4WD models equipped with
an automatic transmission with any of
the wheels on the ground as this may
cause serious and expensive damage
to the transfer case and transmission.
In case of emergency 6-15
– Place the ignition switch in the
OFF position and secure the steering wheel in a straight-ahead position with a rope or similar device. Never secure the steering
wheel by placing the ignition
switch in the LOCK position. This
may cause damage to the steering lock mechanism (for models
with a steering lock mechanism).
NOTE:
LCE2311
Two-Wheel Drive models with
automatic transmission
NISSAN recommends that your vehicle be
towed with the driving (rear) wheels off the
ground or place the vehicle on a flatbed
truck as illustrated.
6-16 In case of emergency
CAUTION
• Never tow automatic transmission
models with the rear wheels on the
ground or four wheels on the ground
(forward or backward), as this may
cause serious and expensive damage to the transmission. If it is necessary to tow the vehicle with the front
wheels raised always use towing dollies under the rear wheels.
• When towing automatic transmission models with the front wheels on
the ground or on towing dollies:
If the battery is completely drained the
transmission will not manually shift to
other positions.
VEHICLE RECOVERY (freeing a
stuck vehicle)
WARNING
To avoid vehicle damage, serious personal injury or death when recovering a
stuck vehicle:
• Contact a professional towing service to recover the vehicle if you have
any questions regarding the recovery procedure.
• Tow chains or cables must be attached only to main structural members of the vehicle.
• Do not use the vehicle tie-downs to
tow or free a stuck vehicle.
• Only use devices specifically designed for vehicle recovery and follow the manufacturer's instructions.
• Always pull the recovery device
straight out from the front of the vehicle. Never pull at an angle.
• Route recovery devices so they do
not touch any part of the vehicle except the attachment point.
If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud,
etc., use a tow strap or other device designed specifically for vehicle recovery. Always follow the manufacturer's instructions for the recovery device.
Rocking a stuck vehicle
WARNING
• Stand clear of a stuck vehicle.
• Do not spin your tires at high speed.
This could cause them to explode
and result in serious injury. Parts of
your vehicle could also overheat and
be damaged.
If your vehicle is stuck in sand, snow, mud,
etc., use the following procedure:
1. Turn off the Vehicle Dynamic Control
(VDC) system.
2. Make sure the area in front and behind
the vehicle is clear of obstructions.
4. Slowly rock the vehicle forward and
backward.
• Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and D (Drive).
• Apply the accelerator as little as possible to maintain the rocking motion.
• Release the accelerator pedal before
shifting between R (Reverse) and D
(Drive).
• Do not spin the tires above 34 mph (55
km/h).
5. If the vehicle cannot be freed after a few
tries, contact a professional towing service to remove the vehicle.
3. Turn the steering wheel right and left to
clear an area around the front tires.
In case of emergency 6-17
MEMO
6-18 In case of emergency
7 Appearance and care
Cleaning exterior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Washing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Waxing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Removing spots . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Underbody . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Glass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Aluminum alloy wheels (if so equipped) . . . . . . .
Chrome parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Tire dressings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Cleaning interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
7-2
7-2
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-3
7-4
7-4
Air fresheners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Power moonroof (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Floor mats (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Most common factors contributing to
vehicle corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Environmental factors influence the
rate of corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Protect your vehicle from corrosion . . . . . . . . . .
7-4
7-5
7-5
7-6
7-7
7-7
7-7
7-7
CLEANING EXTERIOR
In order to maintain the appearance of
your vehicle, it is important to take proper
care of it.
To protect the paint surfaces, wash your
vehicle as soon as you can:
• After a rainfall to prevent possible damage from acid rain.
• After driving on coastal roads.
• When contaminants such as soot, bird
droppings, tree sap, metal particles or
bugs get on the paint surface.
• When dust or mud builds up on the surface.
Whenever possible, store or park your vehicle inside a garage or in a covered area.
When it is necessary to park outside, park in
a shady area or protect the vehicle with a
body cover.
Be careful not to scratch the paint surface when putting on or removing the
body cover.
WASHING
Wash dirt off with a wet sponge and plenty
of water. Clean the vehicle thoroughly using a mild soap, a special vehicle soap or
general purpose dishwashing liquid mixed
with clean, lukewarm (never hot) water.
7-2 Appearance and care
CAUTION
• Do not concentrate water spray directly on the sonar sensors (if so
equipped) on the bumper as this will
result in damage to the sensors. Do
not use pressure washers capable of
spraying water over 1,200 psi (8,274
kPa) to wash your vehicle. Use of
high-pressure washers over 1,200 psi
(8,274 kPa) can result in damage to or
removal of paint or graphics. Avoid
using a high-pressure washer closer
than 12 inches (30 cm) to the vehicle.
Always use a wide-angle nozzle only,
keep the nozzle moving and do not
concentrate the water spray on any
one area.
• Do not use car washes that use acid
in the detergent. Some car washes,
especially brushless ones, use some
acid for cleaning. The acid may react
with some plastic vehicle components, causing them to crack. This
could affect their appearance, and
also could cause them not to function properly. Always check with your
car wash to confirm that acid is not
used.
• Do not wash the vehicle with strong
household soap, strong chemical detergents, gasoline or solvents.
• Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight or while the vehicle body is hot,
as the surface may become
water-spotted.
• Avoid using tight-napped or rough
cloths, such as washing mitts. Care
must be taken when removing
caked-on dirt or other foreign substances so the paint surface is not
scratched or damaged.
Rinse the vehicle thoroughly with plenty of
clean water.
Inside edges, seams and folds on the
doors, hatches and hood are particularly
vulnerable to the effects of road salt. Therefore, these areas must be cleaned regularly.
Take care that the drain holes in the lower
edge of the door are open. Spray water
under the body and in the wheel wells to
loosen the dirt and wash away road salt.
A damp chamois can be used to dry the
vehicle to avoid water spots.
WAXING
UNDERBODY
Regular waxing protects the paint surface
and helps retain new vehicle appearance.
Polishing is recommended to remove
built-up wax residue and to avoid a weathered appearance before re-applying wax.
In areas where road salt is used in winter, it
is necessary to clean the underbody regularly in order to prevent dirt and salt from
building up and causing the acceleration of
corrosion on the underbody and suspension. Before the winter period and again in
the spring, the underseal must be checked
and, if necessary, re-treated.
A NISSAN dealer can assist you in choosing
the proper product.
• Wax your vehicle only after a thorough
washing. Follow the instructions supplied
with the wax.
• Do not use a wax containing any abrasives, cutting compounds or cleaners
that may damage the vehicle finish.
Machine compounding or aggressive polishing on a base coat/clear coat paint finish may dull the finish or leave swirl marks.
REMOVING SPOTS
Remove tar and oil spots, industrial dust,
insects, and tree sap as quickly as possible
from the surface of the paint to avoid lasting damage or staining. Special cleaning
products are available at a NISSAN dealer
or any automotive accessory store. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for these products.
GLASS
Use glass cleaner to remove smoke and
dust film from the glass surfaces. It is normal for glass to become coated with a film
after the vehicle is parked in the hot sun.
Glass cleaner and a soft cloth will easily
remove this film.
CAUTION
When cleaning the inside of the windows, do not use sharp-edged tools,
abrasive cleaners or chlorine-based
disinfectant cleaners. They could damage the electrical conductors, radio antenna elements or rear window defroster elements.
ALUMINUM ALLOY WHEELS (if so
equipped)
Wash the wheels regularly with a sponge
dampened in a mild soap solution, especially during winter months in areas where
road salt is used. If not removed, road salt
can discolor the wheels.
CAUTION
Follow the directions below to avoid
staining or discoloring the wheels:
• Do not use a cleaner that uses strong
acid or alkali contents to clean the
wheels.
• Do not apply wheel cleaners to the
wheels when they are hot. The wheel
temperature should be the same as
ambient temperature.
• Rinse the wheel to completely remove the cleaner within 15 minutes
after the cleaner is applied.
CHROME PARTS
Clean all chrome parts regularly with a
non-abrasive chrome polish to maintain
the finish.
Appearance and care 7-3
CLEANING INTERIOR
TIRE DRESSINGS
NISSAN does not recommend the use of
tire dressings. Tire manufacturers apply a
coating to the tires to help reduce discoloration of the rubber. If a tire dressing is applied to the tires, it may react with the coating and form a compound. This compound
may come off the tire while driving and
stain the vehicle paint.
If you choose to use a tire dressing, take the
following precautions:
• Use a water-based tire dressing. The
coating on the tire dissolves more easily
than with an oil-based tire dressing.
• Apply a light coat of tire dressing to help
prevent it from entering the tire tread/
grooves (where it would be difficult to remove).
• Wipe off excess tire dressing using a dry
towel. Make sure the tire dressing is completely removed from the tire tread/
grooves.
• Allow the tire dressing to dry as recommended by the tire dressing manufacturer.
7-4 Appearance and care
Occasionally remove loose dust from the
interior trim, plastic parts and seats using a
vacuum cleaner or soft bristled brush. Wipe
the vinyl and leather (if so equipped) surfaces with a clean, soft cloth dampened in
mild soap solution, then wipe clean with a
dry, soft cloth.
Regular care and cleaning is required in
order to maintain the appearance of the
leather (if so equipped).
Before using any fabric protector, read the
manufacturer's recommendations. Some
fabric protectors contain chemicals that
may stain or bleach the seat material.
Use a cloth dampened only with water to
clean the meter and gauge lens.
WARNING
Do not use water or acidic cleaners (hot
steam cleaners) on the seat. This can
damage the seat or occupant classification sensor. This can also affect the
operation of the air bag system and result in serious personal injury.
CAUTION
• Never use benzine, thinner or any
similar material.
• Small dirt particles can be abrasive
and damaging to leather surfaces
and should be removed promptly. Do
not use saddle soap, car waxes, polishes, oils, cleaning fluids, solvents,
detergents
or
ammonia-based
cleaners as they may damage the
leather's natural finish.
• Never use fabric protectors unless
recommended by the manufacturer.
• Do not use glass or plastic cleaner on
meter or gauge lens covers. It may
damage the lens cover.
AIR FRESHENERS
Most air fresheners use a solvent that
could affect the vehicle interior. If you use
an air freshener, take the following precautions:
• Hanging-type air fresheners can cause
permanent discoloration when they contact vehicle interior surfaces. Place the air
freshener in a location that allows it to
hang free and not contact an interior surface.
• Liquid-type air fresheners typically clip on
the vents. These products can cause immediate damage and discoloration
when spilled on interior surfaces.
Carefully read and follow the manufacturer's instructions before using the air fresheners.
POWER MOONROOF (if so
equipped)
The sunshade is made from a tricot material.
• Clean water based stains by patting
the surface with a clean soft cloth
dampened in warm water. Press a
clean dry cloth onto the surface to
remove as much dampness as possible and then let air dry.
• Clean oil based stains by patting the
surface with a clean soft cloth dampened in warm water. Press a clean dry
cloth onto the surface to remove as
much dampness as possible and
then let air dry.
CAUTION
To help prevent damaging the moonroof while cleaning:
• Do not rub the material with a cloth.
Doing so can damage the surface of
the material or cause a stain to
spread.
• Never use benzine, thinner or any
similar chemical to clean the sunshade. This may discolor the moonroof and damage the surface.
LAI2085
FLOOR MATS (if so equipped)
WARNING
To avoid potential pedal interference
that may result in a collision, injury or
death:
• NEVER place a floor mat on top of
another floor mat in the driver front
position or install them upside down
or backwards.
• Use only Genuine NISSAN floor mats,
or equivalent floor mats, that are
specifically designed for use in your
vehicle model and model year.
Appearance and care 7-5
• Properly position the mats in the
floorwell using the floor mat positioning hook. For additional information, refer to "Floor mat installation"
in this section.
• Make sure the floor mat does not interfere with pedal operation.
• Periodically check the floor mats to
make sure they are properly
installed.
• After cleaning the vehicle interior,
check the floor mats to make sure
they are properly installed.
The use of Genuine NISSAN floor mats can
extend the life of your vehicle carpet and
make it easier to clean the interior. Mats
should be maintained with regular cleaning and replaced if they become excessively worn.
Floor mat installation
Your vehicle is equipped with floor mat positioning hook(s). The number and shape of
the floor mat positioning hooks for each
seating position varies depending on the
vehicle.
7-6 Appearance and care
When installing Genuine NISSAN floor mats,
follow the installation instructions provided
with the mat and the following:
1. With the ignition in the OFF position, the
shift lever in P (Park) position and with
the parking brake fully applied, position
the floor mat in the floorwell so that the
floor mat grommet holes are aligned
with the hook(s).
2. Secure the grommet holes into the
hook(s) and ensure that the floor mat is
properly positioned.
3. Make sure the floor mat does not interfere with pedal operation. With the ignition still in the OFF position, the shift lever in the P (Park) position and with the
parking brake applied, fully apply and release all pedals. The floor mat must not
interfere with pedal operation or prevent
the pedal from returning to its normal
position.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for details about installing the floor
mats in your vehicle.
LAI2042
Positioning hooks
The illustration shows the location of the
floor mat positioning hooks.
SEAT BELTS
The seat belts can be cleaned by wiping
them with a sponge dampened in a mild
soap solution. Allow the belts to dry completely in the shade before using them. For
additional information, refer to “Seat belt
maintenance” in the “Safety—Seats, seat
belts and supplemental restraint system”
section of this manual.
CORROSION PROTECTION
WARNING
Do not allow wet seat belts to roll up in
the retractor. NEVER use bleach, dye or
chemical solvents to clean the seat
belts, since these materials may severely weaken the seat belt webbing.
MOST COMMON FACTORS
CONTRIBUTING TO VEHICLE
CORROSION
Most vehicle corrosion is caused by:
• The accumulation of moisture-retaining
dirt and debris in body panel sections,
cavities, and other areas.
• Damage to paint and other protective
coatings caused by gravel and stone
chips or minor traffic collisions.
ENVIRONMENTAL FACTORS
INFLUENCE THE RATE OF
CORROSION
Moisture
Accumulation of sand, dirt and water on
the vehicle body underside can accelerate
corrosion. Wet floor coverings will not dry
completely inside the vehicle and should
be removed for drying to avoid floor panel
corrosion.
Temperature
High temperatures accelerate the rate of
corrosion to those parts which are not well
ventilated.
Air pollution
Industrial pollution, the presence of salt in
the air in coastal areas, or heavy road salt
use accelerates the corrosion process.
Road salt also accelerates the disintegration of paint surfaces.
PROTECT YOUR VEHICLE FROM
CORROSION
• Wash and wax your vehicle often to keep
the vehicle clean.
• Always check for minor damage to the
paint and repair it as soon as possible.
• Keep drain holes at the bottom of the
doors open to avoid water accumulation.
• Check the underbody for accumulation
of sand, dirt or salt. If present, wash with
water as soon as possible.
Relative humidity
Corrosion will be accelerated in areas of
high relative humidity, especially those areas where the temperatures stay above
freezing and where atmospheric pollution
exists and road salt is used.
Appearance and care 7-7
CAUTION
• NEVER remove dirt, sand or other debris from the passenger compartment by washing it out with a hose.
Remove dirt with a vacuum cleaner
or broom.
• Never allow water or other liquids to
come in contact with electronic components inside the vehicle as this
may damage them.
Chemicals used for road surface de-icing
are extremely corrosive. They accelerate
corrosion and deterioration of underbody
components such as the exhaust system,
fuel and brake lines, brake cables, floor pan
and fenders.
In winter, the underbody must be
cleaned periodically.
For additional protection against rust and
corrosion, which may be required in some
areas, it is recommended that you consult
a NISSAN dealer.
7-8 Appearance and care
8 Do-it-yourself
Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2
Engine compartment check locations . . . . . . . . . . . 8-3
Engine cooling system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4
Checking engine coolant level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Changing engine oil and oil filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6
Automatic Transmission Fluid (ATF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
Power Steering Fluid (PSF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Windshield-washer fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir . . . . . . . . . . . 8-12
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14
Variable voltage control system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15
Spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16
Replacing spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16
Air cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17
In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17
Windshield wiper blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-18
Replacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-19
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-20
Engine compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-21
Passenger compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-22
Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-24
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-24
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-26
Fog lights (if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-27
Exterior and interior lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-30
Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-30
Tire labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-33
Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-36
Tire chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-37
Changing wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-38
MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS
When performing any inspection or maintenance work on your vehicle, always take
care to prevent serious accidental injury to
yourself or damage to the vehicle. The following are general precautions which
should be closely observed.
WARNING
• Park the vehicle on a level surface,
apply the parking brake securely and
block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving. Move the shift lever to P (Park).
• Be sure the ignition switch is in the
OFF or LOCK position when performing any parts replacement or repairs.
• If you must work with the engine running, keep your hands, clothing, hair
and tools away from moving fans,
belts and any other moving parts.
• It is advisable to secure or remove
any loose clothing and remove any
jewelry, such as rings, watches, etc.
before working on your vehicle.
• Always wear eye protection whenever you work on your vehicle.
• If you must run the engine in an enclosed space such as a garage, be
sure there is proper ventilation for
exhaust gases to escape.
8-2 Do-it-yourself
• Never get under the vehicle while it is
supported only by a jack. If it is necessary to work under the vehicle,
support it with safety stands.
• Keep smoking materials, flame and
sparks away from the fuel tank and
battery.
• On gasoline engine models, the fuel
filter or fuel lines should be serviced
because the fuel lines are under high
pressure even when the engine is off.
It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
CAUTION
• Do not work under the hood while
the engine is hot. Turn the engine off
and wait until it cools down.
• Avoid contact with used engine oil and
coolant. Improperly disposed engine
oil, engine coolant and/or other vehicle fluids can damage the environment. Always conform to local regulations for disposal of vehicle fluid.
• Never leave the engine or the transmission related component harness
connector disconnected while the ignition switch is in the ON position.
• Never connect or disconnect the battery or any transistorized component while the ignition switch is in
the ON position.
This “Do-it-yourself” section gives instructions regarding only those items which are
relatively easy for an owner to perform.
A Genuine NISSAN service manual is also
available. For additional information, refer
to “Owner's Manual/Service Manual order
information” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
NISSAN recommends the use of Genuine
NISSAN parts or equivalent. The use of parts
that do not meet or exceed NISSAN specifications, can cause damage to your vehicle, and
have an effect on your warranty coverage. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
parts department who can provide information on the proper parts for your vehicle.
You should be aware that incomplete or
improper servicing may result in operating
difficulties or excessive emissions, and
could affect warranty coverage. If in doubt
about any servicing, it is recommended
that you have it done by a NISSAN dealer.
NOTE:
If the battery is dead the transmission will
not manually shift into other positions.
ENGINE COMPARTMENT CHECK
LOCATIONS
VQ38DD engine
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Windshield-washer fluid reservoir
Fuse/Fusible link box
Fuse/Fusible link box
Fuse box
Engine oil filler cap
Engine oil dipstick
Brake fluid reservoir
Air cleaner
Drive belt location
Power steering fluid reservoir
Radiator cap
Battery
Engine coolant reservoir
LDI3520
Do-it-yourself 8-3
ENGINE COOLING SYSTEM
The engine cooling system is filled at the
factory with a pre-diluted mixture of 50%
Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/
Coolant (blue) and 50% water to provide
year-round antifreeze and coolant protection. The antifreeze solution contains rust
and corrosion inhibitors. Additional engine
cooling system additives are not necessary.
WARNING
• Never remove the radiator or coolant
reservoir cap when the engine is hot.
Wait until the engine and radiator
cool down. Serious burns could be
caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator. For additional
information on precautions, refer to
“If your vehicle overheats” in the “In
case of emergency” section of this
manual.
• The radiator and coolant reservoir
are equipped with a pressure type radiator cap. To prevent engine damage, use only a Genuine NISSAN radiator cap.
8-4 Do-it-yourself
CAUTION
• Never use any cooling system additives such as radiator sealer. Additives may clog the cooling system
and cause damage to the engine,
transmission and/or cooling system.
• When adding or replacing coolant, be
sure to use only Genuine NISSAN
Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue)
or equivalent. Genuine NISSAN Long
Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is prediluted to provide antifreeze protection to -34° F (-37° C). If additional
freeze protection is needed due to
weather where you operate your vehicle, add Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) concentrate following the directions on the
container. If an equivalent coolant
other than Genuine NISSAN Long Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) is used, follow the coolant manufacturer’s instructions to maintain minimum antifreeze protection to -34° F (-37° C).
The use of other types of coolant solutions other than Genuine NISSAN
Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue)
or equivalent may damage the engine cooling system.
• The life expectancy of the factory-fill
coolant is 105,000 miles (168,000 km)
or 7 years. Mixing any other type of
coolant other than Genuine NISSAN
Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue)
(or equivalent coolant), including
Genuine
NISSAN
Long
Life
Antifreeze/Coolant (green), or the
use of non-distilled water may reduce the life expectancy of the
factory-fill coolant. For additional information, refer to the "Maintenance
and schedules" section of this
manual.
This vehicle contains Genuine NISSAN Long
Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue). The life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant is
105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 7 years. Mixing
any other type of coolant or the use of
non-distilled water will reduce the life expectancy of the factory-fill coolant. For additional information, refer to the "Maintenance and schedules" section of this
manual.
If the cooling system frequently requires
coolant, it is recommended that you visit
a NISSAN dealer for this service.
LDI2831
CHECKING ENGINE COOLANT
LEVEL
Check the coolant level in the reservoir
when the engine is cold. If the coolant
B , add coolant
level is below the MIN level O
A . If the reservoir is empty,
to the MAX level O
check the coolant level in the radiator
when the engine is cold. If there is insufficient coolant in the radiator, fill the radiator
with coolant up to the filler opening and
also add it to the reservoir up to the MAX
A .
level O
For additional information on the location
of the engine coolant reservoir, refer to “Engine compartment check locations” in this
section.
CHANGING ENGINE COOLANT
WARNING
• To avoid the danger of being scalded,
never change the coolant when the
engine is hot.
• Never remove the radiator or engine
coolant reservoir cap when the engine is hot. Serious burns could be
caused by high pressure fluid escaping from the radiator.
• Avoid direct skin contact with used
coolant. If skin contact is made, wash
thoroughly with soap or hand
cleaner as soon as possible.
• Keep coolant out of the reach of children and pets.
Engine coolant must be disposed of properly. Check your local regulations.
A NISSAN dealer can change the engine
coolant. The service procedure can be
found in the NISSAN Service Manual.
Improper servicing can result in reduced
heater performance and engine overheating.
Do-it-yourself 8-5
ENGINE OIL
CAUTION
Oil level should be checked regularly.
Operating the engine with an insufficient amount of oil can damage the engine, and such damage is not covered
by warranty.
CHANGING ENGINE OIL AND OIL
FILTER
For additional information on engine oil
and oil filter change, refer to the instructions outlined in this section.
LDI3521
CHECKING ENGINE OIL LEVEL
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and
apply the parking brake.
2. Start the engine and let it idle until it
reaches operating temperature.
3. Turn off the engine. Wait more than 10
minutes for the oil to drain back into
the oil pan.
4. Remove the dipstick and wipe it clean.
Reinsert it all the way.
8-6 Do-it-yourself
LDI0371
5. Remove the dipstick again and check
the oil level. It should be between the H
B . This is the
(High) and L (Low) marks O
normal operating oil level range. If the oil
A , relevel is below the L (Low) mark O
move the oil filler cap and pour recommended oil through the opening. Do not
C .
overfill O
6. Recheck oil level with the dipstick.
It is normal to add some oil between oil
maintenance intervals or during the
break-in period, depending on the severity of operating conditions.
Vehicle set-up
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface and
apply the parking brake.
2. Run the engine until it reaches operating
temperature.
3. Turn the engine off and wait for 15
minutes.
4. Raise and support the vehicle using a
suitable floor jack and safety jack
stands.
• Place the safety jack stands under the
vehicle jack-up points.
• A suitable adapter should be attached to
the jack stand saddle.
CAUTION
Make sure the correct lifting and support points are used to avoid vehicle
damage.
LDI3524
O
1
Oil filler cap
LDI3361
O
2
Oil drain plug
Do-it-yourself 8-7
LDI3363
O
3
Oil filter
LDI3368
O
4
Plate
LDI3366
Removal of under-engine
protectors (if so equipped)
A and plate.
1. Remove bolts O
Engine oil and filter
1. Place a large drain pan under the drain
plug and oil filter.
2. Remove the oil filler cap.
3. Remove the drain plug with a wrench by
turning it counterclockwise and completely drain the oil.
8-8 Do-it-yourself
CAUTION
Be careful not to burn yourself, as the
engine oil is hot.
WARNING
• Prolonged and repeated contact
with used engine oil may cause skin
cancer.
• Try to avoid direct skin contact with
used oil. If skin contact is made, wash
thoroughly with soap or hand
cleaner as soon as possible.
• Keep used engine oil out of reach of
children.
• The dipstick must be inserted in
place to prevent oil spillage from the
dipstick hole when filling the engine
with oil.
6. Coat the gasket on the new filter with
clean engine oil.
It is recommended that you use a Genuine NISSAN oil filter or equivalent, visit
your NISSAN dealer parts department
for proper part.
7. Screw in the oil filter clockwise until a
slight resistance is felt, then tighten additionally more than 2/3 turn.
Oil filter tightening torque:
11 to 15 ft-lb (15.0 to 21.0 N·m)
4. Loosen the oil filter with an oil filter
wrench by turning it counterclockwise.
Remove the oil filter by turning it by
hand.
8. Clean and re-install the drain plug with a
new washer. Securely tighten the drain
plug with a wrench. Do not use excessive force.
5. Wipe the engine oil filter mounting surface with a clean rag.
Drain plug tightening torque:
22 to 29 ft-lb (29.4 to 39.2 N·m)
CAUTION
Be sure to remove any old gasket material remaining on the sealing surface
of the engine. Failure to do so could
lead to an oil leak and engine damage.
9. Refill the engine with the recommended
oil through the oil filler opening, and install the oil filler cap securely.
CAUTION
Do not spill fluids on engine cover. This
could damage the engine cover. If fluids are spilled, immediately clean surface with a neutral detergent. Do not
use an organic solvent such as brake
cleaner.
For additional information about drain and
refill capacity, refer to “Recommended
fluids/lubricants and capacities” in the
“Technical and consumer information” section of this manual. The drain and refill capacity depends on the oil temperature and
drain time. Use these specifications for reference only. Always use the dipstick to determine the proper amount of oil in the
engine.
10. Start the engine and check for leakage
around the drain plug and the oil filter.
Correct as required. Turn the engine off
and wait more than 15 minutes. Check
the oil level with the dipstick. Add engine oil if necessary.
Do-it-yourself 8-9
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION FLUID
(ATF)
After the operation
1. Reinstall engine protectors in reverse order of removal.
2. Lower the vehicle carefully to the
ground.
• Dispose of waste oil and filter properly.
• Check your local regulations.
When checking or replacement is required,
it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
CAUTION
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine
NISSAN Matic P ATF. Do not mix with
other fluids.
• Do not use CVT fluid or manual transmission fluid in this transmission.
Damage caused by the use of fluids
other than as recommended is not
covered under NISSAN’s New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
• Using fluids that are not equivalent
to Genuine NISSAN Matic P ATF may
also damage the transmission. Damage caused by the use of fluids other
than as recommended is not covered
under NISSAN’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
The specified automatic transmission fluid
is also described on caution labels located
in the engine compartment.
8-10 Do-it-yourself
POWER STEERING FLUID (PSF)
LDI3077
Check the power steering fluid level when
the engine is stopped.
The fluid level should be between the COLD
MAX line and the COLD MIN line on the
power steering fluid reservoir at cold fluid
temperatures of 32° - 86°F (0° - 30°C) or at
the HOT MAX line on the power steering
fluid reservoir at hot fluid temperatures of
122° - 176°F (50° - 80°C).
BRAKE FLUID
If the fluid is cold and is at or below the
COLD MIN line, add Genuine NISSAN PSF-II
or equivalent to the COLD MAX line. If the
fluid is hot and below the HOT MAX line, add
Genuine NISSAN PSF-II or equivalent to the
HOT MAX line. Remove the cap and fill
through the opening.
CAUTION
• DO NOT OVERFILL.
• Do not reuse power steering fluid.
• Recommended fluid is Genuine
NISSAN PSF-II or equivalent
For additional brake fluid specification information, refer to “Recommended fluids/
lubricants and capacities” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section of this
manual.
WARNING
• Use only new fluid from a sealed container. Old, inferior or contaminated
fluid may damage the brake system.
The use of improper fluids can damage the brake system and affect the
vehicle's stopping ability.
• Clean the filler cap before removing.
• Brake fluid is poisonous and should
be stored carefully in marked containers out of reach of children.
CAUTION
Do not spill the fluid on any painted surfaces. This will damage the paint. If fluid
is spilled, immediately wash the surface with water.
LDI3526
BRAKE FLUID
Check the brake fluid level in the reservoir. If
B or the
the fluid level is below the MIN line O
brake warning light comes on, add Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid or
A .
equivalent DOT 3 fluid up to the MAX line O
If fluid must be added frequently, the system should be checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Do-it-yourself 8-11
WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID
To fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir,
lift the cap off the reservoir and pour the
windshield-washer fluid into the reservoir
opening.
Add a washer solvent to the washer for
better cleaning. In the winter season, add a
windshield-washer antifreeze. Follow the
manufacturer's instructions for the mixture ratio.
Refill the reservoir more frequently when
driving conditions require an increased
amount of windshield-washer fluid.
LDI3136
WINDSHIELD-WASHER FLUID
RESERVOIR
Fill the windshield-washer fluid reservoir
periodically. Add windshield-washer fluid
when the low windshield-washer fluid
warning light (if so equipped) comes on.
8-12 Do-it-yourself
Recommended fluid is Genuine NISSAN
Windshield-Washer Concentrate Cleaner &
Antifreeze or equivalent.
CAUTION
• Do not substitute engine antifreeze
coolant for windshield-washer solution. This may result in damage to the
paint.
• Do not fill the windshield-washer
reservoir with washer fluid concentrates at full strength. Some methyl
alcohol based washer fluid concentrates may permanently stain the
grille if spilled while filling the
windshield-washer reservoir.
• Pre-mix washer fluid concentrates
with water to the manufacturer's
recommended levels before pouring
the fluid into the windshield-washer
reservoir. Do not use the windshieldwasher reservoir to mix the washer
fluid concentrate and water.
BATTERY
Caution symbols for battery
WARNING
1
O
No smoking, No exposed flames, No
Sparks
Do not expose the battery to electrical sparks, flames or smoking. Hydrogen gas generated by the
battery is explosive. Explosive gases can cause blindness or injury.
2
O
Shield eyes
Handle the battery cautiously. Always wear eye protection glasses to protect against explosion or
battery acid.
3
O
Keep away from children
Never allow children to handle the battery. Keep the battery out of the reach of children.
4
O
Battery acid
Do not allow battery fluid to contact your skin, eyes, fabrics, or painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid can
cause blindness or severe burns. After handling the battery or battery cap, do not touch or rub
your eyes. Thoroughly wash your hands. If the acid contacts your eyes, skin or clothing, immediately flush with water for at least 15 minutes and seek medical attention. Battery fluid is acid. If the
battery fluid gets into your eyes or onto your skin, it could cause loss of your eyesight or burns.
5
O
Note operating instructions
Before handling the battery, read this instruction carefully to ensure correct and safe handling.
6
O
Explosive gas
Hydrogen gas generated by battery fluid is explosive. Explosive gases can cause blindness or
injury.
• If the battery is labeled “do not open” it is
maintenance free and battery fluid
should not be checked. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer or
a qualified specialist workshop to confirm the battery’s performance.
• Keep the battery surface clean and dry.
Clean the battery with a solution of baking soda and water.
• Make certain the terminal connections
are clean and securely tightened.
• If the vehicle is not to be used for 30 days
or longer, disconnect the negative (-) battery terminal cable to prevent discharge.
Do-it-yourself 8-13
NOTE:
Care should be taken to avoid situations
that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions
such as:
1. Installation or extended use of electronic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD
players, etc.)
2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or
only driven short distances.
In these cases, the battery may need to
be charged to maintain battery health.
8-14 Do-it-yourself
WARNING
• Do not expose the battery to flames,
an electrical spark or a cigarette. Hydrogen gas generated by the battery
is explosive. Explosive gases can
cause blindness or injury. Do not allow battery fluid to contact your skin,
eyes, fabrics or painted surfaces. Sulfuric acid can cause blindness or injury. After touching a battery or battery cap, do not touch or rub your
eyes. Thoroughly wash your hands. If
the acid contacts your eyes, skin or
clothing, immediately flush with water for at least 15 minutes and seek
medical attention.
• When working on or near a battery,
always wear suitable eye protection
and remove all jewelry.
• Battery posts, terminals and related
accessories contain lead and lead
compounds. Wash hands after
handling.
• Keep battery out of the reach of
children.
• Do not tip the battery.
LDI3302
NOTE:
Do not try to open the top of the battery.
This battery is not equipped with removable vent caps.
JUMP STARTING
If jump starting is necessary, refer to “Jump
starting” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual. If the engine does not
start by jump starting, the battery may
have to be replaced. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this
service.
VARIABLE VOLTAGE CONTROL
SYSTEM
DRIVE BELT
NOTE:
If the battery is dead the transmission
will not manually shift into other
positions.
Your vehicle is equipped with a variable
voltage control system. This system measures the amount of electrical discharge
from the battery and controls voltage generated by the generator.
LDI3525
CAUTION
• Do not ground accessories directly to
the battery terminal. Doing so will
bypass the variable voltage control
system and the vehicle battery may
not charge completely.
• Use electrical accessories with the
engine running to avoid discharging
the vehicle battery.
A is located near the
The current sensor O
battery along the negative battery cable. If
you add electrical accessories to your vehicle, be sure to ground them to a suitable
body ground such as the frame or engine
block area.
LDI3500
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Power steering fluid pump pulley
Air conditioner compressor pulley
Crankshaft pulley
Automatic belt tensioner pulley
Generator pulley
WARNING
Be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF
or LOCK position before servicing drive
belt. The engine could rotate unexpectedly.
Do-it-yourself 8-15
SPARK PLUGS
1. Visually inspect the belt for signs of unusual wear, cuts, fraying or looseness. If
the belt is in poor condition or is loose,
have it replaced or adjusted. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer
for this service.
If replacement is required, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
2. Have the belt checked regularly for condition and tension in accordance with
the maintenance schedule found in the
"Maintenance and schedules" section of
this manual.
SDI1895
REPLACING SPARK PLUGS
Iridium-tipped spark plugs
It is not necessary to replace iridiumA spark plugs as frequently as contipped O
ventional type spark plugs because they
last much longer. Follow the maintenance
log shown in the "Maintenance and schedules" section of this manual. Do not service
iridium-tipped spark plugs by cleaning or
regapping.
• Always replace spark plugs with recommended or equivalent ones.
8-16 Do-it-yourself
AIR CLEANER
WARNING
LDI3523
The dry paper type filter element may be
cleaned and reused. Replace it according
to the maintenance log shown in the
"Maintenance and schedules" section of
this manual. When replacing the filter, wipe
the inside of the air cleaner filter housing
and the cover with a damp cloth.
To remove the VQ38DD air cleaner filter:
1
䊊
Unlatch the clips and remove the air
cleaner cover. Remove the air cleaner
filter.
• Operating the engine with the air
cleaner removed can cause you or
others to be burned. The air cleaner
not only cleans the air, it stops the
flame if the engine backfires. If it isn't
there, and the engine backfires, you
could be burned. Do not drive with
the air cleaner removed, and be careful when working on the engine with
the air cleaner removed.
• Never pour fuel into the throttle body
or attempt to start the engine with
the air cleaner removed. Doing so
could result in serious injury.
LDI0442
IN-CABIN MICROFILTER
The in-cabin microfilter restricts the entry
of airborne dust and pollen particles and
reduces some objectionable outside
odors. The filter is located behind the glove
box. For additional information on change
intervals, refer to the "Maintenance and
schedules" section of this manual.
To replace the filter, perform the following
procedure:
1. Open the glove box and press in on the
sides so that it will open completely allowing it to hang by the cord.
Do-it-yourself 8-17
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
6. Replace the filter cover. The cover will
click into place under the tab.
7. Install the glove box door.
CLEANING
If your windshield is not clear after using
the windshield-washer or if a wiper blade
chatters when running, wax or other material may be on the blade or windshield.
Clean the outside of the windshield with a
washer solution or a mild detergent. Your
windshield is clean if beads do not form
when rinsing with clear water.
LDI2047
1 .
2. Gently lift up on the tab O
3. Pull the filter cover toward you and then
2 .
down O
3 .
4. Remove the old filter O
NOTE:
The filter is marked with air flow arrows.
The end of the filter with the arrow
should face the rear of the vehicle. The
arrows should face downward.
5. Insert the new filter into the housing and
slide it over to the right.
8-18 Do-it-yourself
Clean each blade by wiping it with a cloth
soaked in a washer solution or a mild detergent. Then rinse the blades with clear
water. If your windshield is still not clear
after cleaning the blades and using the
wiper, replace the blades.
CAUTION
Worn windshield wiper blades can
damage the windshield and impair
driver vision.
CAUTION
• After wiper blade replacement, return the wiper arm to its original position; otherwise it may be damaged
when the hood is opened.
• Make sure the wiper blades contact
the glass; otherwise the arms may be
damaged from wind pressure.
• Worn windshield wiper blades can
damage the windshield and impair
driver vision.
LDI2725
REPLACING
Replace the wiper blades if they are worn.
1. Lift the wiper arm away from the
windshield.
A , and
2. Push and hold the release tab O
B the
then move the wiper blade down O
wiper arm to remove.
3. Remove the wiper blade.
4. Insert the new wiper blade onto the
wiper arm until it clicks into place.
LDI3120
If you wax the surface of the hood, be careful not to let wax get into the windshieldwasher nozzle . This may cause clogging or
improper windshield-washer operation. If
wax gets into the nozzle, remove it with a
1 .
needle or small pin O
Do-it-yourself 8-19
BRAKES
FUSES
If the brakes do not operate properly, have
the brakes checked. It is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
Self-adjusting brakes
Your vehicle is equipped with self-adjusting
brakes.
The front and rear disc-type brakes selfadjust every time the brake pedal is applied.
Under some driving or climate conditions,
occasional brake squeak, squeal or other
noise may be heard. Occasional brake
noise during light to moderate stops is normal and does not affect the function or
performance of the brake system.
Proper brake inspection intervals should
be followed. For additional information regarding brake inspections, refer to the appropriate maintenance schedule information in the "Maintenance and schedules"
section of this manual.
WARNING
Have your brake system checked if the
brake pedal height does not return to
normal. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for this service.
Brake pad wear indicators
The disc brake pads on your vehicle have
audible wear indicators. When a brake pad
requires replacement, a high pitched
scraping or screeching sound will be heard
when the vehicle is in motion. The noise will
be heard whether or not the brake pedal is
depressed. Have the brakes checked as
soon as possible if the wear indicator
sound is heard.
8-20 Do-it-yourself
LDI0455
A
is
Two types of fuses are used. Type O
used in the fuse boxes in the engine comB is used in the passenger
partment. Type O
compartment fuse box.
A fuses are provided as spare fuses.
Type O
They are stored in the passenger compartment fuse box.
A fuses can be installed in the engine
Type O
compartment and passenger compartment fuse boxes.
3. Remove the fuse box cover by pushing
the tab and lifting the cover up.
4. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller.
The fuse puller is located in the center of
the fuse block in the passenger
compartment.
LDI0457
A fuse is used to replace a type O
B
If a type O
A fuse will not be level with
fuse, the type O
the fuse pocket as shown in the illustration.
This will not affect the performance of the
fuse. Make sure the fuse is installed in the
fuse box securely.
B fuses cannot be installed in the
Type O
A
underhood fuse boxes. Only use type O
fuses in the underhood fuse boxes.
LDI2838
ENGINE COMPARTMENT
WARNING
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower
amperage rating than that specified on
the fuse box cover. This could damage
the electrical system or electronic control units or cause a fire.
NOTE:
If any electrical equipment does not come
on, check for an open fuse.
Your vehicle may not be equipped with
all fuses listed on the fuse label.
1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF.
2. Open the engine hood.
Do-it-yourself 8-21
Fusible links
If the electrical equipment does not operate and fuses are in good condition, check
the fusible links. If any of these fusible links
are melted, replace with only Genuine
NISSAN parts.
LDI2826
5. If the fuse is open
B .
new fuse O
A , replace it with a
O
6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
LDI2839
PASSENGER COMPARTMENT
WARNING
Never use a fuse of a higher or lower
amperage rating than that specified on
the fuse box cover. This could damage
the electrical system or electronic control units or cause a fire.
If any electrical equipment does not operate, check for an open fuse.
1. Be sure the ignition switch and the headlight switch are OFF.
2. Pull the fuse box cover to remove.
3. Remove the fuse with the fuse puller.
8-22 Do-it-yourself
How to replace the extended storage
switch:
1. To remove the extended storage switch,
be sure the ignition switch is in the OFF
or LOCK position.
2. Be sure the headlight switch is in the
OFF position.
3. Remove the fuse box cover.
A found on each
4. Pinch the locking tabs O
side of the storage switch.
LDI0456
A , replace it with an
4. If the fuse is open O
B .
equivalent good fuse O
5. Reverse step 2 to reinstall fuse box cover.
6. If a new fuse also opens, have the electrical system checked and repaired. It is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
NOTE:
Your vehicle may not be equipped with
all fuses listed on the fuse label.
LDI2736
5. Pull the storage switch straight out from
B .
the fuse box O
Extended storage switch
If any electrical equipment does not operate, remove the extended storage switch
and check for an open fuse.
NOTE:
The extended storage switch is used for
long term vehicle storage. Even if the extended storage switch is broken it is not
necessary to replace it. Replace only the
open fuse in the switch with a new fuse.
Do-it-yourself 8-23
BATTERY REPLACEMENT
Replace the battery in the Intelligent Key as
follows:
CAUTION
Be careful not to allow children to swallow the battery or removed parts.
1. Remove the mechanical key from the
Intelligent Key.
A
2. Insert a small flathead screwdriver O
B of the corner and twist it
into the slit O
to separate the upper part from the
lower part. Place a cloth over the screwdriver to protect the casing.
LDI2001
NISSAN INTELLIGENT KEY®
8-24 Do-it-yourself
3. Replace the battery with a new one.
Recommended battery: CR2032 or
equivalent.
• Do not touch the internal circuit and
electric terminals as doing so could
cause a malfunction.
• Hold the battery by the edges. Holding
the battery across the contact points
will seriously deplete the storage capacity.
• Make sure that the + side faces the
bottom of the lower part.
4. Close the lid securely as illustrated with
C and O
D .
O
5. Operate the buttons to check the
operation.
If you need assistance with replacement, it
is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
FCC Notice:
For USA:
This device complies with Part 15 of the
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device
may not cause harmful interference, and
(2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference
that may cause undesired operation.
Note:
Changes or modifications not expressly
approved by the party responsible for
compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment.
For Canada:
This device complies with Industry
Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two
conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference that may cause undesired operation of the device.
LDI2637
Do-it-yourself 8-25
LIGHTS
HEADLIGHTS
The headlight is a semi-sealed beam type
which uses a replaceable headlight (halogen) bulb. A bulb can be replaced from inside the engine compartment without removing the headlight assembly.
CAUTION
• High pressure halogen gas is sealed
inside the halogen bulb. The bulb
may break if the glass envelope is
scratched or the bulb is dropped.
• When handling the bulb, do not touch
the glass envelope.
• DO NOT TOUCH THE BULB WITH BARE
HANDS.
• Use the same number and wattage
as shown in the chart.
• Do not leave the bulb out of the headlight reflector for a long period of
time as dust, moisture and smoke
may enter the headlight body and affect the performance of the
headlight.
• Aiming is not necessary after replacing the bulb. When aiming adjustment is necessary, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
8-26 Do-it-yourself
Fog may temporarily form inside the lens
of the exterior lights in the rain or in a car
wash. A temperature difference between
the inside and the outside of the lens
causes the fog. This is not a malfunction. If
large drops of water collect inside the lens,
it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for servicing.
WDI0294
Removing the headlight bulb
1. Open the hood.
2. Disconnect the negative (-) battery cable.
3. Disconnect the electrical connector
from the rear end of the bulb.
A counter4. Turn the bulb retaining ring O
clockwise until it is free from the headlight reflector and then remove it.
5. Carefully remove the headlight bulb. Do
B when
not shake or rotate the bulb O
removing it.
Replacing the headlight bulb
1. Insert the bulb.
DO NOT TOUCH THE BULB WITH BARE
HANDS.
2. Install and tighten the bulb retainer.
• Be sure the lip of the bulb socket contacts the headlight body.
3. Push the electrical connector into the
bulb plastic base until it snaps and
stops.
4. Connect the negative (-) battery cable.
5. Close the hood.
FOG LIGHTS (if so equipped)
For additional information on fog light bulb
replacement, refer to the instructions outlined in this section.
• Do not leave the bulb out of the fog
light for a long period of time as dust,
moisture and smoke may enter the
fog light body and affect the performance of the fog light.
Replacing the fog light bulb
If fog light bulb replacement is required, it is
recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
CAUTION
• High pressure halogen gas is sealed
inside the halogen bulb. The bulb
may break if the glass envelope is
scratched or the bulb is dropped.
• When handling the bulb, do not touch
the glass envelope.
• Use the same number and wattage
as originally installed as shown in the
chart.
Do-it-yourself 8-27
EXTERIOR AND INTERIOR LIGHTS
Item
Wattage (W)
Bulb No.*
High/Low/Daytime running lights (if so
equipped)
60/55
HB5
Turn/Park
28/8
W28/8W
3.8
194
Fog lights (if so equipped)*
55
H11
Map light
8
—
Room light*
8
—
Vanity mirror light (if so equipped)*
2.1
—
12.8
912
27
3156AK
Stop/Tail
27/7
3157K
Back-up
16
921
5
W5W
Headlight assembly
Side marker
High-mounted stop light/Cargo light*
LDI0713
Rear combination light
Turn
License plate light
* It is recommended that you visit an NISSAN retailer for replacement.
Always check with the Parts Department at a NISSAN dealer for the latest parts
information.
8-28 Do-it-yourself
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Map light
Room light
High-mounted stop light/Cargo light
License plate light
Rear combination light
Fog light (if so equipped)
Headlight assembly/Daytime running
light
LDI0478
1
Use a cloth O
Map light
to protect the housing.
WDI0300
Rear combination light
WDI0306
Replacement procedures
All other lights are either type A, B, C or D.
When replacing a bulb, first remove the lens
and/or cover using a cloth and suitable tool.
: Indicates bulb removal
: Indicates bulb installation
Do-it-yourself 8-29
WHEELS AND TIRES
To replace the license plate light:
1. Apply force as shown in image to remove tension that locks bulb assembly
to the bumper.
2. Pivot bulb assembly away from bumper
to release fully.
3. Rotate the bulb retainer as shown in the
image.
4. Pull the bulb out to remove and replace.
*Left side assembly is shown. Right side
assembly is mirror.
If you have a flat tire, refer to “Flat tire” in
the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
TIRE PRESSURE
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)
WARNING
Radio waves could adversely affect
electric medical equipment. Those who
use a pacemaker should contact the
electric medical equipment manufacturer for the possible influences before
use.
This vehicle is equipped with TPMS. It monitors tire pressure of all tires except the
spare. When the low tire pressure warning
light is lit and the CHECK TIRE PRES (pressure) warning message is displayed in the
odometer, one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
LDI3134
License plate light
8-30 Do-it-yourself
TPMS will activate only when the vehicle is
driven at speeds above 16 mph (25 km/h).
Also, this system may not detect a sudden
drop in tire pressure (for example, a flat tire
while driving).
The tire pressures should be checked
when the tires are cold. The tires are considered COLD after the vehicle has been
parked for 3 or more hours, or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate speeds.
For additional information, refer to “Low tire
pressure warning light” in the “Instruments
and controls” section, “Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)” in the “Starting and
driving” section, and “Flat tire” in the “In case
of emergency” section of this manual.
Incorrect tire pressure, including under
inflation, may adversely affect tire life
and vehicle handling.
Tire inflation pressure
Check the tire pressures (including the
spare) often and always prior to long distance trips. The recommended tire pressure specifications are shown on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label or the
Tire and Loading Information label under
the “Cold Tire Pressure” heading. The Tire
and Loading Information label is affixed to
the driver side center pillar. Tire pressures
should be checked regularly because:
• Most tires naturally lose air over time.
• Tires can lose air suddenly when driven
over potholes or other objects or if the
vehicle strikes a curb while parking.
WARNING
• Before taking a long trip, or whenever you heavily load your vehicle,
use a tire pressure gauge to ensure
that the tire pressures are at the
specified level.
• For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety
Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty
Information Booklet.
• Improperly inflated tires can fail suddenly and cause an accident.
• The Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) is located on the F.M.V.S.S./
C.M.V.S.S. certification label. The vehicle weight capacity is indicated on
the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not load your vehicle beyond
this capacity. Overloading your vehicle may result in reduced tire life,
unsafe operating conditions due to
premature tire failure, or unfavorable
handling characteristics and could
also lead to a serious accident. Loading beyond the specified capacity
may also result in failure of other vehicle components.
Do-it-yourself 8-31
5
䊊
6
䊊
LDI2007
Tire and Loading Information label
1 Seating capacity: The maximum
䊊
number of occupants that can
be seated in the vehicle.
2
䊊
3
䊊
Vehicle load limit: Refer to “Vehicle loading information” in the
“Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
Original tire size: The size of the
tires originally installed on the vehicle at the factory.
8-32 Do-it-yourself
4
䊊
Cold tire pressure: Inflate the tires
to this pressure when the tires are
cold. Tires are considered COLD
after the vehicle has been parked
for 3 or more hours, or driven less
than 1 mile (1.6 km) at moderate
speeds. The recommended cold
tire inflation is set by the manufacturer to provide the best balance of tire wear, vehicle handling,
driveability, tire noise, etc., up to
the vehicle's GVWR.
Tire size: Refer to “Tire labeling” in
this section.
Spare tire size.
4. Read the tire pressure on the gauge
stem and compare to the specification
shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. label or
the Tire and Loading Information label.
5. Add air to the tire as needed. If too much
air is added, press the core of the valve
stem briefly with the tip of the gauge
stem to release pressure. Recheck the
pressure and add or release air as
needed.
6. Install the valve stem cap.
LDI0393
Checking tire pressure
7. Check the pressure of all other tires, including the spare.
Size
1. Remove the valve stem cap from the tire.
2. Press the pressure gauge squarely onto
the valve stem. Do not press too hard or
force the valve stem sideways, or air will
escape. If the hissing sound of air escaping from the tire is heard while checking
the pressure, reposition the gauge to
eliminate this leakage.
3. Remove the gauge.
Front and Rear
Original Tire:
P265/70R16
P265/75R16
P265/60R18
Spare Tire:
P265/70R16
P265/75R16
P265/60R18
P265/60R18
Cold Tire Inflation Pressure
240 kPa, 35 PSI
Size:
Full Size
Full Size
P265/70R16
Full Size
WDI0394
Example
TIRE LABELING
Federal law requires tire manufacturers to place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires.
This information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of the tire and also provides the
Tire Identification Number (TIN) for
safety standard certification. The TIN
can be used to identify the tire in
case of a recall.
Do-it-yourself 8-33
6. Two- or three-digit number (95):
This number is the tire's load index. It is a measurement of how
much weight each tire can support. You may not find this information on all tires because it is
not required by law.
7. H: Tire speed rating. You should
not drive the vehicle faster than
the tire speed rating.
WDI0395
Example
1
O
Tire size (example: P215/65R15
95H)
1. P: The “P” indicates the tire is designed for passenger vehicles (not
all tires have this information).
2. Three-digit number (215): This
number gives the width in millimeters of the tire from sidewall
edge to sidewall edge.
8-34 Do-it-yourself
3. Two-digit number (65): This number, known as the aspect ratio,
gives the tire's ratio of height to
width.
4. R: The “R” stands for radial.
5. Two-digit number (15): This number is the wheel or rim diameter in
inches.
3 Tire ply composition and material
O
The number of layers or plies of
rubber-coated fabric in the tire. Tire
manufacturers also must indicate
the materials in the tire, which include steel, nylon, polyester and others.
4
O
Maximum permissible inflation
pressure
LDI2786
Example
O TIN (Tire Identification Number)
for a new tire (example: DOT XX XX
XXX XXXX)
2
1. DOT: Abbreviation for the “Department Of Transportation”. The
symbol can be placed above, below or to the left or right of the Tire
Identification Number.
2. Two-digit code: Manufacturer's
identification mark.
3. Two-digit code: Tire size.
4. Three-digit code: Tire type code
(Optional).
5. Four numbers represent the
week and year the tire was built.
For example, the numbers 3103
means the 31st week of 2003. If
these numbers are missing then
look on the other sidewall of the
tire.
This number is the greatest amount
of air pressure that should be put in
the tire. Do not exceed the maximum
permissible inflation pressure.
5 Maximum load rating
O
This number indicates the maximum load in kilograms and pounds
that can be carried by the tire. When
replacing the tires on the vehicle, always use a tire that has the same
load rating as the factory installed
tire.
Do-it-yourself 8-35
6 Term of “tubeless” or “tube type”
O
Indicates whether the tire requires
an inner tube (“tube type”) or not
(“tubeless”).
7 The word “radial”
O
The word “radial” is shown if the tire
has radial structure.
8 Manufacturer or brand name
O
Manufacturer or brand name is
shown.
Other Tire-related Terminology
In addition to the many terms that
are defined throughout this section,
Intended Outboard Sidewall is (1) the
sidewall that contains a whitewall,
bears white lettering or bears
manufacturer, brand, and/or model
name molding that is higher or
deeper than the same molding on
the other sidewall of the tire, or (2)
the outward facing sidewall of an
asymmetrical tire that has a particu8-36 Do-it-yourself
lar side that must always face outward when mounted on a vehicle.
TYPES OF TIRES
WARNING
• When changing or replacing tires, be
sure all four tires are of the same type
(i.e., Summer, All Season or Snow)
and construction. A NISSAN dealer
may be able to help you with information about tire type, size, speed
rating and availability.
• Replacement tires may have a lower
speed rating than the factory
equipped tires, and may not match
the potential maximum vehicle
speed. Never exceed the maximum
speed rating of the tire.
• Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the low
tire pressure warning system.
• Always use tires of the same type,
size, brand, construction and tread
pattern on all four wheels. Failure to
do so may result in a circumference
difference between tires on the front
and rear axles which can cause the
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system to malfunction resulting in personal injury or death, excessive tire
wear and may damage the transmission and differential gears.
• For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety
Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty
Information Booklet.
All season tires
NISSAN specifies All Season tires on some
models to provide good performance all
year, including snowy and icy road conditions. All Season tires are identified by ALL
SEASON and/or M&S on the tire sidewall.
Snow tires have better snow traction than
All Season tires and may be more appropriate in some areas.
Summer tires
NISSAN specifies summer tires on some
models to provide superior performance
on dry roads. Summer tire performance is
substantially reduced in snow and ice.
Summer tires do not have the tire traction
rating “M&S” on the tire sidewall.
If you plan to operate your vehicle in snowy
or icy conditions, NISSAN recommends the
use of SNOW tires or ALL SEASON tires on all
four wheels.
Snow tires
If snow tires are needed, it is necessary to
select tires equivalent in size and load rating to the original equipment tires. If you do
not, it can adversely affect the safety and
handling of your vehicle.
Generally, snow tires have lower speed ratings than factory equipped tires and may
not match the potential maximum vehicle
speed. Never exceed the maximum speed
rating of the tire.
If you install snow tires, they must be the
same size, brand, construction and tread
pattern on all four wheels.
For additional traction on icy roads, studded tires may be used. However, some U.S.
states and Canadian provinces prohibit
their use. Check local, state and provincial
laws before installing studded tires. Skid
and traction capabilities of studded snow
tires on wet or dry surfaces may be poorer
than that of non-studded snow tires.
must be secured or removed to prevent
the possibility of whipping action damage
to the fenders or underbody. If possible,
avoid fully loading your vehicle when using
tire chains. In addition, drive at a reduced
speed. Otherwise, your vehicle may be
damaged and/or vehicle handling and
performance may be adversely affected.
TIRE CHAINS
Tire chains must be installed only on the
rear wheels and not on the front wheels.
Use of tire chains may be prohibited according to location. Check the local laws
before installing tire chains. When installing
tire chains, make sure they are the proper
size for the tires on your vehicle and are
installed according to the chain manufacturer's suggestions. Use only SAE class “S”
chains. Class “S” chains are used on vehicles with restricted tire to vehicle clearance. Vehicles that can use Class “S” chains
are designed to meet the minimum clearances between the tire and the closest vehicle suspension or body component required to accommodate the use of a
winter traction device (tire chains or
cables). The minimum clearances are determined using the factory equipped tire
size. Other types may damage your vehicle.
Use chain tensioners when recommended
by the tire chain manufacturer to ensure a
tight fit. Loose end links of the tire chain
Do not use tire chains on dry roads. Driving
with chains in such conditions can cause
damage to the various mechanisms of the
vehicle due to some overstress.
Use only the 2WD range when driving on
clear paved roads.
Do-it-yourself 8-37
Wheel nut tightening torque:
98 ft-lb (133 ft-lb)
The wheel nuts must be kept tightened to specifications at all times.
It is recommended that wheel nuts
be tightened to specification at
each tire rotation interval.
WARNING
WDI0258
CHANGING WHEELS AND TIRES
Tire rotation
NISSAN recommends rotating the
tires every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
For additional information on tire replacing procedures, refer to “Flat tire”
in the “In case of emergency” section
in this manual.
As soon as possible, tighten the
wheel nuts to the specified torque
with a torque wrench.
8-38 Do-it-yourself
• After rotating the tires, check
and adjust the tire pressure.
• Retighten the wheel nuts when
the vehicle has been driven for
600 miles (1,000 km) (also in
cases of a flat tire, etc.).
• Do not include the spare tire in
the tire rotation.
• For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information”
(US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty
Information Booklet.
WDI0259
Tire wear and damage
1. Wear indicator
2. Location mark
WARNING
• Tires should be periodically inspected for wear, cracking,
bulging or objects caught in
the tread. If excessive wear,
cracks, bulging or deep cuts
are found, the tire(s) should be
replaced.
• The original tires have built-in
tread wear indicators. When
the wear indicators are visible,
the tire(s) should be replaced.
• Tires degrade with age and
use. Have tires, including the
spare, over 6 years old checked
by a qualified technician because some tire damage may
not be obvious. Replace the
tires as necessary to prevent
tire failure and possible personal injury.
• Improper service of the spare
tire may result in serious personal injury. If it is necessary to
repair the spare tire, it is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service.
• For additional information regarding tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information”
(US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty
Information Booklet.
Replacing wheels and tires
When replacing a tire, use the same size,
tread design, speed rating and load carrying capacity as originally equipped. For additional information, refer to “Wheels and
tires” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
WARNING
• The use of tires other than those recommended or the mixed use of tires
of different brands, construction
(bias, bias-belted or radial), or tread
patterns can adversely affect the
ride, braking, handling, Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system, ground
clearance, body-to-tire clearance,
tire chain clearance, speedometer
calibration, headlight aim and bumper height. Some of these effects
may lead to accidents and could result in serious personal injury.
• If your vehicle was originally
equipped with four tires that were
the same size and you are only replacing two of the four tires, install
the new tires on the rear axle. Placing
new tires on the front axle may cause
loss of vehicle control in some driving
conditions and cause an accident
and personal injury.
Do-it-yourself 8-39
• If the wheels are changed for any
reason, always replace with wheels
which have the same off-set dimension. Wheels of a different off-set
could cause premature tire wear, degrade vehicle handling characteristics, affect the VDC system and/or interference with the brake discs. Such
interference can lead to decreased
braking efficiency and/or early brake
pad wear. For additional information
on wheel off-set dimensions, refer to
“Wheels and tires” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section
of this manual.
• When replacing a wheel without the
TPMS such as the spare tire, the TPMS
will not function and the low tire
pressure warning light will flash for
approximately 1 minute. The light will
remain on after 1 minute. Have your
tires replaced and/or TPMS system
reset as soon as possible. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service.
• Replacing tires with those not originally specified by NISSAN could affect the proper operation of the
TPMS.
8-40 Do-it-yourself
• The TPMS sensor may be damaged if
it is not handled correctly. Be careful
when handling the TPMS sensor.
• When replacing the TPMS sensor, the
ID registration may be required. It is
recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for ID registration.
• Do not use a valve stem cap that is
not specified by NISSAN. The valve
stem cap may become stuck.
• Be sure that the valve stem caps are
correctly fitted. Otherwise the valve
may be clogged up with dirt and
cause a malfunction or loss of
pressure.
• Do not install a damaged or deformed wheel or tire even if it has
been repaired. Such wheels or tires
could have structural damage and
could fail without warning.
• The use of retread tires is not
recommended.
• For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety
Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty
Information Booklet.
Four-wheel drive models
CAUTION
Always use tires of the same type, size,
brand, construction (bias, bias-belted
or radial), and tread pattern on all four
wheels. Failure to do so may result in a
circumference difference between tires
on the front and rear axles which will
cause excessive tire wear and may
damage the transmission, transfer
case and differential gears.
If excessive tire wear is found, it is recommended that all four tires be replaced with
tires of the same size, brand, construction
and tread pattern. The tire pressure and
wheel alignment should also be checked
and corrected as necessary. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Wheel balance
Unbalanced wheels may affect vehicle
handling and tire life. Even with regular use,
wheels can get out of balance. Therefore,
they should be balanced as required.
Wheel balance service should be performed with the wheels off the vehicle.
Spin balancing the wheels on the vehicle
could lead to mechanical damage.
• For additional information regarding
tires, refer to “Important Tire Safety Information” (US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in the Warranty Information Booklet.
Care of wheels
• Wash the wheels when washing the vehicle to maintain their appearance.
• Clean the inner side of the wheels when
the wheel is changed or the underside of
the vehicle is washed.
• Do not use abrasive cleaners when
washing the wheels.
• Inspect wheel rims regularly for dents or
corrosion. Such damage may cause loss
of pressure or poor seal at the tire bead.
• NISSAN recommends waxing the road
wheels to protect against road salt in areas where it is used during winter.
Spare tire (FULL SIZE TEMPORARY
USE ONLY spare tire)
When replacing a wheel without the TPMS
such as the spare tire, the TPMS will not
function.
Your vehicle may be equipped with a full
size spare that is a different size or brand
than the tires originally installed on the vehicle. This full size spare tire is intended for
temporary use only and should be replaced at the first opportunity.
Observe the following precautions if the
FULL SIZE TEMPORARY USE ONLY spare tire
must be used. Otherwise, your vehicle
could be damaged or involved in an accident:
WARNING
To help reduce the risk of a crash which
may result in personal injury or death:
• The TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire
should be used for emergency use
only. It should be replaced with the
standard tire at the first opportunity
to avoid possible tire or differential
damage.
• Drive carefully while the TEMPORARY
FULL SIZE spare tire is installed. Avoid
sharp turns and abrupt braking while
driving. The vehicle driving performance may be affected when driving
on wet or snow covered roads.
• When the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE
spare tire is installed, the Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) will normally not
be affected.
• When the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE
spare tire is installed, the following
systems may not work correctly:
– Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS)
• Periodically check the TEMPORARY
FULL SIZE spare tire inflation pressure. Always keep the TEMPORARY
FULL SIZE spare tire inflated to the
pressure specification shown on the
Tire and Loading Information label.
• With the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare
tire installed do not drive the vehicle
at speeds faster than 50 mph (80
km/h).
Do-it-yourself 8-41
• When driving on roads covered with
snow or ice, the TEMPORARY FULL
SIZE spare tire should be used on the
front wheels and the original tire
used on the rear wheels. Use tire
chains only on the drive wheels.
• Do not use the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE
spare tire on other vehicles.
• Do not use more than one TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire at the same
time.
• Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire is installed.
8-42 Do-it-yourself
CAUTION
• Do not use tire chains on a TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire. Tire chains
will not fit properly and may cause
damage to the vehicle.
• Use of the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE
spare tire on a vehicle that has tires
larger than were originally equipped
can affect the 4WD System. This may
result in a circumference difference
between tires on front and rear axles
which can cause the 4WD system to
automatically place the vehicle in
2WD and flash the 4WD light. When
the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire
is replaced with a tire that matches
all other tires on the vehicle, and all
tires are properly inflated the 4WD
system will operate normally.
9 Maintenance and schedules
Maintenance requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Scheduled maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Where to go for service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Explanation of general maintenance
items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-2
Explanation of scheduled maintenance items . . . 9-5
Emission control system maintenance: . . . . . . 9-5
Chassis and body maintenance: . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-6
Maintenance schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Additional maintenance items for
severe operating conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Standard maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Standard maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-7
Maintenance under severe operating
conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Severe driving conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9-10
Maintenance log . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-11
MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS
Some day-to-day and regular maintenance is essential to maintain your vehicle
good mechanical condition, as well as its
emissions and engine performance.
It is the owner's responsibility to make sure
that the scheduled maintenance, as well as
general maintenance, is performed.
As the vehicle owner, you are the only one
who can ensure that your vehicle receives
proper maintenance. You are a vital link in
the maintenance chain.
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE
The maintenance items listed in this section are required to be serviced at regular
intervals. However under severe driving
conditions, additional or more frequent
maintenance will be required.
WHERE TO GO FOR SERVICE
During the normal day-to-day operation of
the vehicle, general maintenance should
be performed regularly as prescribed in
this section. If you detect any unusual
sounds, vibrations or smells, be sure to
check for the cause or have it checked
promptly. In addition, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer if you think
that repairs are required.
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
If maintenance service is required or your
vehicle appears to malfunction, have the
systems checked and serviced. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
General maintenance includes those items
which should be checked during normal
day-to-day operation. They are essential
for proper vehicle operation. It is your responsibility to perform these procedures
regularly as prescribed.
NISSAN technicians are well-trained specialists and are kept up-to-date with the
latest service information through technical bulletins, service tips and training programs. They are fully qualified to work on
NISSAN vehicles before work begins.
EXPLANATION OF GENERAL
MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Performing general maintenance checks
requires minimal mechanical skill and only
a few general automotive tools.
If your vehicle is involved in a collision, it is
recommended that you ask your NISSAN
dealer where the nearest NISSAN Certified
Collision Center is located, or go to http://
collision.nissanusa.com.
Outside the vehicle
You can be confident that a NISSAN dealer's service department can perform the
service needed to meet the maintenance
requirements on your vehicle.
Doors and engine hood: Check that the
doors and engine hood operate properly.
Also ensure that all latches lock securely.
Lubricate hinges, latches, latch pins, rollers
and links if necessary. Make sure that the
These checks or inspections can be done
by yourself, a qualified technician or, if you
prefer, a NISSAN dealer.
9-2 Maintenance and schedules
When performing any checks or maintenance work, closely observe the “Maintenance precautions” in the “Do-it-yourself”
section of this manual.
Additional information on the following
items with “ * ” is found in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
The maintenance items listed here should
be performed from time to time, unless
otherwise specified.
secondary latch keeps the hood from
opening when the primary latch is released.
When driving in areas using road salt or
other corrosive materials, check lubrication frequently.
Lights*: Clean the headlights on a regular
basis. Make sure that the headlights, stop
lights, tail lights, turn signal lights, and other
lights are all operating properly and installed securely. Also check headlight aim.
Road wheel nuts (lug nuts)*: When checking the tires, make sure no wheel nuts are
missing, and check for any loose wheel
nuts. Tighten if necessary.
Tire rotation*: Tires should be rotated every 7,500 miles (12,000 km).
Tires*: Check the pressure with a gauge
often and always prior to long distance
trips. If necessary, adjust the pressure in all
tires, including the spare, to the pressure
specified. Check carefully for damage, cuts
or excessive wear.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
transmitter components: Replace the
TPMS transmitter grommet seal, valve core
and cap when the tires are replaced due to
wear or age.
Wheel alignment and balance: If the vehicle should pull to either side while driving
on a straight and level road, or if you detect
uneven or abnormal tire wear, there may
be a need for wheel alignment. If the steering wheel or seat vibrates at normal highway speeds, wheel balancing may be
needed.
For additional information regarding tires,
refer to “Important Tire Safety Information”
(US) or “Tire Safety Information” (Canada) in
the Warranty Information Booklet.
Windshield: Clean the windshield on a
regular basis. Check the windshield at least
every six months for cracks or other damage. Have a damaged windshield repaired
by a qualified repair facility. It is recommended that you have a damaged windshield repaired by a NISSAN dealer, or a
NISSAN Certified Collision Center. To locate
a collision center in your area, refer to
http://collision.nissanusa.com.
Windshield wiper blades*: Check for
cracks or wear if they do not wipe properly.
Inside the vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should
be checked on a regular basis, such as
when performing scheduled maintenance,
cleaning the vehicle, etc.
Accelerator pedal: Check the pedal for
smooth operation and make sure the pedal
does not catch or require uneven effort.
Keep the floor mat away from the pedal.
Automatic transmission P (Park) mechanism: On a fairly steep hill check that the
vehicle is held securely with the shift lever
in the P (Park) position without applying any
brakes.
Brake pedal: Check the pedal for smooth
operation. If the brake pedal suddenly goes
down further than normal, the pedal feels
spongy or the vehicle seems to take longer
to stop, have your vehicle checked immediately. It is recommended that you visit a
NISSAN dealer for this service. Keep the
floor mat away from the pedal.
Brakes: Check that the brakes do not pull
the vehicle to one side when applied.
Parking brake: Check the parking brake
operation regularly. The vehicle should be
securely held on a fairly steep hill with only
the parking brake applied. If the parking
Maintenance and schedules 9-3
brake needs adjustment, it is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
this service.
Seats: Check seat position controls such as
seat adjusters, seatback recliner, etc., to ensure they operate smoothly and all latches
lock securely in every position. Check that the
head restraints/headrests move up and
down smoothly and the locks (if so equipped)
hold securely in all latched positions.
Under the hood and vehicle
The maintenance items listed here should
be checked periodically (for example, each
time you check the engine oil or refuel).
Engine coolant level*: Check the coolant
level when the engine is cold.
Engine drive belts*: Make sure the drive
belts are not frayed, worn, cracked or oily.
Battery (for maintenance free batteries)*: This vehicle is equipped with a sealed
maintenance free battery. It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN dealer for
service.
Engine oil level*: Check the level after
parking the vehicle on a level spot and
turning off the engine. Wait more than 15
minutes for the oil to drain back into the oil
pan.
Seat belts: Check that all parts of the seat
belt system (for example, buckles, anchors,
adjusters and retractors) operate properly
and smoothly, and are installed securely.
Check the belt webbing for cuts, fraying,
wear or damage.
NOTE:
Steering wheel: Check for changes in the
steering system, such as excessive free
play, hard steering or strange noises.
1. Installation or extended use of electronic accessories that consume battery power when the engine is not running (Phone chargers, GPS, DVD
players, etc.).
Exhaust system: Make sure there are no
loose supports, cracks or holes. If the
sound of the exhaust seems unusual or
there is a smell of exhaust fumes, immediately have the exhaust system inspected. It
is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer for this service. For additional information, refer to “Exhaust gas (carbon monoxide)” in the “Starting and driving” section
of this manual.
Warning lights and chimes: Make sure all
warning lights and chimes are operating
properly.
Windshield defroster: Check that the air
comes out of the defroster outlets properly
and in sufficient quantity when operating
the heater or air conditioner.
Windshield wiper and washer*: Check
that the wipers and washer operate properly and that the wipers do not streak.
9-4 Maintenance and schedules
Care should be taken to avoid situations
that can lead to potential battery discharge and potential no-start conditions
such as:
2. Vehicle is not driven regularly and/or
only driven short distances.
In these cases, the battery may need to
be charged to maintain battery health.
Brake fluid level*: Make sure that the fluid
level is between the MAX and MIN lines on
the reservoir.
Fluid leaks: Check under the vehicle for
fuel, oil, water or other fluid leaks after the
vehicle has been parked for a while. Water
dripping from the air conditioner after use
is normal. If you should notice any leaks or if
fuel fumes are evident, check for the cause
and have it corrected immediately.
EXPLANATION OF SCHEDULED
MAINTENANCE ITEMS
Power steering fluid level* and lines:
Check the level when the fluid is cold, with
the engine off. Check the lines for proper
attachment, leaks, cracks, etc.
Radiator and hoses: Check the front of the
radiator and clean off any dirt, insects,
leaves, etc., that may have accumulated.
Make sure the hoses have no cracks, deformation, rot or loose connections.
Underbody: The underbody is frequently
exposed to corrosive substances such as
those used on icy roads or to control dust. It
is very important to remove these substances, otherwise rust may form on the
floor pan, frame, fuel lines and around the
exhaust system. At the end of winter, the
underbody should be thoroughly flushed
with plain water, being careful to clean
those areas where mud and dirt may accumulate. For additional information, refer to
the “Appearance and care” section of this
manual.
Windshield-washer fluid*: Check that
there is adequate fluid in the reservoir.
The following descriptions are provided to
give you a better understanding of the
scheduled maintenance items that should
be regularly checked or replaced. The
maintenance schedule indicates at which
mileage/time intervals each item requires
service.
In addition to scheduled maintenance,
your vehicle requires that some items be
checked during normal day-to-day operation. For additional information, refer to
“General maintenance” in this section.
Items marked with “*” are recommended
by NISSAN for reliable vehicle operation.
You are not required to perform maintenance on these items in order to maintain
the warranties which come with your
NISSAN. Other maintenance items and intervals are required.
When applicable, additional information
can be found in the “Do-it-yourself” section
of this manual.
NOTE:
NISSAN does not advocate the use of
non-OEM approved aftermarket flushing systems and strongly advises
against performing these services on a
NISSAN product. Many of the aftermarket flushing systems use non-OEM approved chemicals or solvents, the use of
which has not been validated by NISSAN.
For recommended fuel, lubricants, fluids,
grease, and refrigerant, refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
MAINTENANCE:
Drive belts*: Check engine drive belts for
wear, fraying or cracking and for proper
tension. Replace any damaged drive belts.
Engine air filter: Replace at specified intervals. When driving for prolonged periods in
dusty conditions, check/replace the filter
more frequently.
Maintenance and schedules 9-5
Engine coolant*: Replace coolant at the
specified interval. When adding or replacing
coolant, be sure to use only Genuine NISSAN
Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or
equivalent with the proper mixture. (For additional information on the proper mixture
for your area, refer to “Engine cooling system”
in the “Do-it-yourself” section of this manual.)
CHASSIS AND BODY
MAINTENANCE:
NOTE: Mixing any other type of coolant
or the use of non-distilled water may reduce the recommended service interval
of the coolant.
Brake pads and rotors: Check for wear,
deterioration and fluid leaks. Replace any
deteriorated or damaged parts immediately.
Engine oil and oil filter: Replace engine oil
and oil filter at the specified intervals. For
recommended oil grade and viscosity refer
to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and
capacities” in the “Technical and consumer
information” section of this manual.
Exhaust system: Visually inspect the exhaust pipes, muffler and hangers for leaks,
cracks, deterioration, and damage. Tighten
connections or replace parts as necessary.
Evaporative emissions control vapor
lines*: Check vapor lines for leaks or looseness. Tighten connections or replace parts
as necessary.
In-cabin microfilter: Replace at specified
intervals. When driving for prolonged periods in dusty conditions, replace the filter
more frequently.
Fuel lines*: Check the fuel hoses, piping
and connections for leaks, looseness, or
deterioration. Tighten connections or replace parts as necessary.
Steering gear and linkage, axle and suspension parts, drive shaft boots: Check
for damage, looseness, and leakage of oil
or grease. Under severe driving conditions,
inspect more frequently.
Spark plugs: Replace at specified intervals.
Install new plugs of the same type as originally equipped.
9-6 Maintenance and schedules
Brake lines and cables: Visually inspect for
proper installation. Check for chafing,
cracks, deterioration, and signs of leaking.
Replace any deteriorated or damaged
parts immediately.
Propeller shaft(s):Check for damage,
looseness, and grease leakage.
Tire rotation: Tires should be rotated every
7,500 miles (12,000 km). When rotating tires,
check for damage and uneven wear. Replace if necessary.
Transmission fluid/oil, differential oil: Visually inspect for signs of leakage at specified intervals.
Off-road maintenance: Check the following items frequently whenever you drive
off-road through deep sand, mud or water:
• Brake pads and rotors
• Brake linings and drums
• Brake lines and hoses
• Differential, transmission and transfer
case oil
• Steering linkage
• Propeller shaft(s) and front drive shafts
• Engine air filter
• Clutch housing drain (AWD only)
MAINTENANCE SCHEDULES
To help ensure smooth, safe and economical driving, NISSAN provides two maintenance schedules that may be used, depending upon the conditions in which you
usually drive. These schedules contain
both distance and time intervals, up to
120,000 miles (192,000 km)/96 months. For
most people, the odometer reading will indicate when service is needed. However, if
you drive very little, your vehicle should be
serviced at the regular time intervals
shown in the schedule.
STANDARD MAINTENANCE
• Repeated short trips of less than 10 miles
(16 km) with outside temperatures remaining below freezing.
• Operating in hot weather in stop-and-go
“rush hour” traffic.
• Extensive idling and/or low speed driving
for long distances, such as police, taxi or
door-to-door delivery use.
• Driving in dusty conditions.
• Driving on rough, muddy or salt spread
roads.
• Towing a trailer, using a camper or using a
car-top carrier.
After 120,000 miles (192,000 km)/96
months, continue maintenance at the
same mileage/time intervals.
NOTE:
ADDITIONAL MAINTENANCE ITEMS
FOR SEVERE OPERATING
CONDITIONS
For vehicles operated in Canada, both
standard and severe maintenance items
should be performed at every interval.
The following tables show the standard
maintenance schedule. Depending upon
weather and atmospheric conditions,
varying road surfaces, individual driving
habits and vehicle usage, additional or
more frequent maintenance may be required.
After 120,000 miles (192,000 km)/96
months, continue maintenance at the
same mileage/time intervals.
Additional maintenance items for severe
operating conditions should be performed on vehicles that are driven under
especially demanding conditions. Additional maintenance items should be performed if you primarily operate your vehicle
under the following conditions:
• Repeated short trips of less than 5 miles
(8 km).
Maintenance and schedules 9-7
STANDARD MAINTENANCE
Abbreviations: I = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary, R = Replace, L = Lubricate
MAINTENANCE OPERATION
Perform at number of miles, kilometers or months,
whichever comes first.
Miles x 1,000
(km x 1,000)
Months
Air cleaner filter
Automatic transmission fluid
Brake fluid夝
Brake lines and cables
Brake pads and rotors夝
Drive belts
Engine coolant*
Engine oil & oil filter夝
EVAP vapor lines & fuel lines
Exhaust system夝
Fuel filter
In-cabin microfilter
Intake & exhaust valve clearance
Intelligent Key battery
Propeller shaft & drive shaft boots (4WD models)夝
Propeller shaft grease (4WD models)
Spark plugs
Steering gear and linkage, axle & suspension parts夝
Tire rotation
Transfer fluid & differential gear oil
NOTE (1)
NOTE (2)(3)
9-8 Maintenance and schedules
7.5
(12)
6
15 22.5 30
(24) (36) (48)
12
18
24
R
I
I
R
I
I
I
I
45
(72)
36
R
R
NOTE (4)
NOTE (5)(6)
R
R
R
R
I*
I
MAINTENANCE INTERVAL
52.5 60 67.5 75 82.5 90 97.5 105 112.5 120
(84) (96) (108) (120) (132) (144) (156) (168) (180) (192)
42
48
54
60
66
72
78
84
90
96
R
R
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
R
R
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I
I*
I*
I*
I*
I*
37.5
(60)
30
R
R
I*
I
R
R
R
R
I*
I
R
R
R
R
I*
I
NOTE (7)
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
NOTE (8)
I
I
L
I
L
NOTE (9)
I
NOTE (10)
NOTE (11)
I
I
R
R
R
I
I
I
I
L
L
L
L
Replace every 105,000 miles (168,000 km)
I
I
I
I
I
I
R
I
L
I
L
I
I
I
NOTE:
Maintenance items with “夝” should be performed more frequently according to the “Maintenance under severe driving conditions”.
(1) If operating mainly in dusty conditions, more frequent maintenance may be required.
(2) Request the dealer to inspect the fluid deterioration data using a CONSULT. If the deterioration data is more than 77000, replace the AT fluid.
(3) If using under severe conditions such as towing a trailer, using a car-top carrier, or driving on rough or muddy roads, change (not just inspect) oil at every
30,000 miles (48,000 km) or 24 months. NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Matic P automatic transmission fluid. Using automatic transmission
fluid that is not equivalent to Genuine NISSAN Matic P may damage the transmission or impact transmission durability. Damage caused by the use of fluid
other than as recommended is not covered under the NISSAN New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
(4) After 60,000 miles (96,000 km) or 48 months, inspect every 15,000 miles (24,000 km) or 12 months. Replace the drive belts if found damaged.
(5) First replacement interval is 105,000 miles (168,000 km) or 84 months. After first replacement, replace every 75,000 miles (120,000 km) or 60 months.
(6) Use only Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue) or equivalent with proper mixture ratio of 50% antifreeze and 50% demineralized or distilled
water. Mixing any other type of coolant or the use of non-distilled water may reduce the life expectancy of the factory fill coolant.
(7) Periodic maintenance is not required.
(8) Periodic maintenance is not required. However, if valve noise increased, inspect valve clearance.
(9) Replace spark plug when the plug gap exceeds 0.053 in (1.35 mm) even if within specified replacement mileage.
(10) For additional information on tire rotation, refer to “General maintenance” in the section.
(11) If towing a trailer, using a car-top carrier or driving on rough or muddy roads, change (not just inspect) oil at every 20,000 miles (32,000 km) or 24 months.
* Maintenance items and intervals with “*” are recommended by NISSAN for reliable vehicle operation. The owner need not perform such maintenance in
order to maintain the emission warranty or manufacturer recall liability. Other maintenance items and intervals are required.
Maintenance and schedules 9-9
MAINTENANCE UNDER SEVERE
OPERATING CONDITIONS
The maintenance intervals shown on the
preceding pages are for normal operating
conditions. If the vehicle is mainly operated
under severe driving conditions as shown
below, more frequent maintenance must
be performed on the following items as
shown in the table.
SEVERE DRIVING CONDITIONS
• Repeated short trips of less than 5 miles
(8 km).
• Repeated short trips of less than 10 miles
(16 km) with outside temperatures remaining below freezing.
• Operating in hot weather in stop-and-go
“rush hour” traffic.
• Extensive idling and/or low speed driving
for long distance, such as police, taxi or
door-to-door delivery use.
• Driving in dusty conditions.
• Driving on rough, muddy or salt spread
roads.
• Towing a trailer, using a camper or a cartop carrier.
Maintenance operation: Inspect = Inspect and correct or replace as necessary.
Maintenance item
Brake fluid
Maintenance operation
Maintenance interval
Replace
Every 10,000 miles (16,000 km) or 12 months
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months
Brake pads & rotors
Inspect
Engine oil and oil filter
Replace
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months
Exhaust system
Inspect
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months
Propeller shaft & drive shaft boots (4WD models)
Inspect
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months
Steering gear & linkage, axle & suspension parts
Inspect
Every 5,000 miles (8,000 km) or 6 months
9-10 Maintenance and schedules
MAINTENANCE LOG
7,500 Miles (12,000 km) or 6 Months
15,000 Miles (24,000 km) or 12 Months
22,500 Miles (36,000 km) or 18 Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
30,000 Miles (48,000 km) or 24 Months
37,500 Miles (60,000 km) or 30 Months
45,000 Miles (72,000 km) or 36 Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
52,500 Miles (84,000 km) or 42 Months
60,000 Miles (96,000 km) or 48 Months
67,500 Miles (108,000 km) or 54 Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
Maintenance and schedules 9-11
75,000 Miles (120,000 km) or 60 Months
82,500 Miles (132,000 km) or 66 Months
90,000 Miles (144,000 km) or 72 Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
97,500 Miles (156,000 km) or 78 Months
105,000 Miles (168,000 km) or 84 Months
112,500 Miles (180,000 km) or 90 Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
120,000 Miles (192,000 km) or 96 Months
Miles (
Dealer Name:
Months
km) or
Miles (
Months
Date:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Mileage:
Date:
Date:
Dealer
Mileage:
Mileage:
Stamp:
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
9-12 Maintenance and schedules
km) or
Miles (
km) or
Miles (
Months
km) or
Miles (
Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
Miles (
km) or
Miles (
Months
km) or
Miles (
Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
km) or
Miles (
Months
km) or
Months
Dealer Name:
Miles (
km) or
Months
km) or
Miles (
Months
km) or
Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
Maintenance and schedules 9-13
Miles (
km) or
Miles (
Months
km) or
Miles (
Months
Months
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Dealer Name:
Date:
Date:
Date:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Mileage:
Dealer
Dealer
Dealer
Stamp:
Stamp:
Stamp:
9-14 Maintenance and schedules
km) or
MEMO
Maintenance and schedules 9-15
10 Technical and consumer information
Recommended fluids/lubricants and
capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-2
Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-4
Engine oil and oil filter
recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-7
Air conditioner system refrigerant and
oil recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-8
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-9
Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-10
When traveling or registering in another
country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)
plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . 10-12
Emission control information label . . . . . . . . . 10-12
Tire and Loading Information label . . . . . . . . . 10-13
Air conditioner specification label . . . . . . . . . . 10-13
Installing front license plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Installing front license plate with
grommets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-14
Vehicle load capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-15
Securing the load . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-17
Utili-track® channel system
(if so equipped) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-18
Loading tips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-22
Truck-camper loading information . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Crew cab models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
King Cab® models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Special Body vehicles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Location for center of gravity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-23
Vehicle load weight capacity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24
Measurement of weights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-24
Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Maximum load limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-25
Towing load/specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-28
Towing safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-29
Flat towing – 4WD with automatic
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-36
Flat towing – 2WD with automatic
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-37
Emission control system warranty . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-38
Reporting safety defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-39
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M)
test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40
Event Data Recorders (EDR) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-40
Owner's Manual/Service Manual order
information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10-41
RECOMMENDED FLUIDS/
LUBRICANTS AND CAPACITIES
The following are approximate capacities. The actual refill capacities may be a little different. When refilling, follow the procedure
described in the “Do-it-yourself” section to determine the proper refill capacity.
Capacity (approximate)
Fluid type
Metric
Measure
US
Measure
Imperial
Measure
80 L
21-1/8 gal
17-5/8 gal
With oil filter
change
5L
5-1/4 qt
4-3/8 qt
Without oil filter
change
4.7 L
5 qt
4-1/8 qt
12 L
3-1/8 gal
2-5/8 gal
Fuel
Engine oil*1
Drain and refill
*1: For additional information, refer to “Engine” in
the “Do-it-yourself” section of this manual.
Engine coolant
(with reservoir)
Automatic transmission fluid
Transfer fluid
Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
• For additional information, refer to “Fuel recommendation” in
this section.
• Genuine “NISSAN Motor Oil 0W-20 SN” (or equivalent) is recommended.
• If the above motor oil (or engine oil) is not available, a synthetic
0W-20 GF-5 SN motor oil (or engine oil) may be used. Damage
caused by the use of motor oil (or engine oil) other than as recommended is not covered under NISSAN’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty. For additional information, refer to “Engine oil and oil
filter recommendation” in this section.
• Pre-diluted Genuine NISSAN Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant (blue)
or equivalent
• Genuine NISSAN Matic P ATF or equivalent
• NISSAN recommends using Genuine NISSAN Matic P ATF (or
equivalent) ONLY in NISSAN automatic transmissions. Do not mix
Refill to the proper level according to the instruc- with other fluids. Using fluids that are not equivalent to Genuine
tions in the “Do-it-yourself” section.
NISSAN Matic P ATF may damage the automatic transmission.
Damage caused by the use of fluids other than as recommended is not covered under the NISSAN’s New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
1.5L
10-2 Technical and consumer information
1-5/8 qt
1-3/8 qt
• Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M or equivalent
• Using fluid other than Genuine NISSAN ATF D3M (or equivalent)
may cause deterioration in driveability and transfer durability,
and may damage the transfer. Damage caused by fluids other
than as recommended is not covered by the NISSAN’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty.
Capacity (approximate)
Fluid type
Recommended Fluids/Lubricants
Metric
Measure
US
Measure
Imperial
Measure
Front final drive oil
0.85 L
1-3/4 pt
1-1/2 pt
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil Hypoid Super GL-5 80W-90 or
equivalent conventional (non-synthetic) oil
Rear final drive oil
2.0 L
4-1/4 pt
3-1/2 pt
• Genuine NISSAN Differential Oil synthetic 75W-140 or API GL-5
synthetic gear oil, Viscosity SAE 75W-140
—
—
—
• Genuine NISSAN PSF-II or equivalent.
• Genuine NISSAN Super Heavy Duty Brake Fluid*2 or equivalent
DOT 3.
*2: Available in mainland U.S.A. through a NISSAN dealer.
Power Steering Fluid (PSF)
Brake fluid
—
—
—
Multi-purpose grease
—
—
—
• NLGI No. 2 (Lithium Soap base)
Air conditioning system refrigerant
—
—
—
• HFC-134a (R-134a)
• For additional information, refer to “Air conditioner specification
label” in this section.
Air conditioning system oil
—
—
—
• Genuine NISSAN A/C System Oil Type PAG (DH-PR) or equivalent
• For additional information, refer to “Air conditioner specification
label” in this section.
4.5 L
1-1/4 gal
1 gal
• Genuine NISSAN Windshield Washer Concentrate Cleaner & Antifreeze or equivalent
Windshield-washer fluid
Technical and consumer information 10-3
FUEL RECOMMENDATION
Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).
CAUTION
• Only vehicles with the E-85 filler door
label can operate on E-85. Fuel system or other damage can occur if
E-85 is used in vehicles that are not
designed to run on E-85.
• Using a fuel other than that specified
could adversely affect the emission
control system, and may also affect
the warranty coverage.
• Under no circumstances should a
leaded gasoline be used, because this
will damage the three-way catalyst.
• Do not use a fuel containing more
than 15% ethanol in your vehicle. Your
vehicle is not designed to run on a
fuel containing more than 15% ethanol. Using a fuel containing more
than 15% ethanol in a vehicle not specifically designed for a fuel containing more than 15% ethanol can adversely affect the emission control
devices and systems of the vehicle.
Damage caused by such fuel is not
covered by the NISSAN New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
• Do not use fuel that contains the octane booster methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).
Using fuel containing MMT may adversely affect vehicle performance
and vehicle emissions. Not all fuel
dispensers are labeled to indicate
MMT content, so you may have to
consult your gasoline retailer for
more details. Note that Federal and
California laws prohibit the use of
MMT in reformulated gasoline.
10-4 Technical and consumer information
• U.S. government regulations require
ethanol dispensing pumps to be
identified by a small, square, orange
and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.
Gasoline specifications
NISSAN recommends using gasoline that
meets the World-Wide Fuel Charter (WWFC)
specifications where it is available. Many of
the automobile manufacturers developed
this specification to improve emission control system and vehicle performance. Ask
your service station manager if the gasoline meets the WWFC specifications.
Reformulated gasoline
Some fuel suppliers are now producing reformulated gasolines. These gasolines are
specially designed to reduce vehicle emissions. NISSAN supports efforts towards
cleaner air and suggests that you use reformulated gasoline when available.
Gasoline containing oxygenates
Some fuel suppliers sell gasoline containing oxygenates such as ethanol, Methyl
Tert-butyl Ether (MTBE) and methanol with
or without advertising their presence.
NISSAN does not recommend the use of
fuels of which the oxygenate content and
the fuel compatibility for your NISSAN cannot be readily determined. If in doubt, ask
your service station manager.
If you use oxygenate-blend gasoline,
please take the following precautions as
the usage of such fuels may cause vehicle
performance problems and/or fuel system
damage.
• The fuel should be unleaded and have
an octane rating no lower than that
recommended for unleaded gasoline.
• If an oxygenate-blend other than
methanol blend is used, it should contain no more than 15% oxygenate.
• If a methanol blend is used, it should
contain no more than 5% methanol
(methyl alcohol, wood alcohol). It
should also contain a suitable amount
of appropriate cosolvents and corrosion inhibitors. If not properly formulated with appropriate cosolvents and
corrosion inhibitors, such methanol
blends may cause fuel system damage
and/or vehicle performance problems.
At this time, sufficient data is not available to ensure that all methanol blends
are suitable for use in NISSAN vehicles.
If any driveability problems such as engine
stalling and difficult hot-starting are experienced after using oxygenate-blend fuels,
immediately change to a non-oxygenate
fuel or a fuel with a low blend of MTBE.
Take care not to spill gasoline during refueling. Gasoline containing oxygenates
can cause paint damage.
E–15 fuel
E-15 fuel is a mixture of approximately 15%
fuel ethanol and 85% unleaded gasoline.
E-15 can only be used in vehicles designed
to run on E-15 fuel. U.S. government regulations require fuel ethanol dispensing
pumps to be identified with small, square,
orange and black label with the common
abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.
E–85 fuel
E-85 fuel is a mixture of approximately 85%
fuel ethanol and 15% unleaded gasoline.
E-85 can only be used in a Flexible Fuel
Vehicle (FFV). Do not use E-85 in your vehicle. U.S. government regulations require
fuel ethanol dispensing pumps to be identified by a small, square, orange and black
label with the common abbreviation or the
appropriate percentage for that region.
Technical and consumer information 10-5
Fuel containing MMT
Octane rating tips
MMT, or methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl, is an octane boosting additive. NISSAN does not recommend the
use of fuel containing MMT. Such fuel may
adversely affect vehicle performance, including the emissions control system. Note
that while some fuel pumps label MMT
content, not all do, so you may have to
consult your gasoline retailer for more details.
Using unleaded gasoline with an octane
rating lower than recommended can
cause persistent, heavy “spark knock.”
(“Spark knock” is a metallic rapping
noise.) If severe, this can lead to engine
damage. If you detect a persistent heavy
spark knock even when using gasoline
of the stated octane rating, or if you hear
steady spark knock while holding a
steady speed on level roads, it is recommended that you have a NISSAN dealer
correct the condition. Failure to correct
the condition is misuse of the vehicle, for
which NISSAN is not responsible.
Aftermarket fuel additives
NISSAN does not recommend the use of
any aftermarket fuel additives (for example, fuel injector cleaner, octane
booster, intake valve deposit removers,
etc.) which are sold commercially. Many of
these additives intended for gum, varnish
or deposit removal may contain active solvents or similar ingredients that can be
harmful to the fuel system and engine.
Incorrect ignition timing may result in
spark knock, after-run and/or overheating,
which may cause excessive fuel consumption or engine damage. If any of the above
symptoms are encountered, have your vehicle checked. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer for servicing.
10-6 Technical and consumer information
However, now and then you may notice
light spark knock for a short time while
accelerating or driving up hills. This is not
a cause for concern, because you get the
greatest fuel benefit when there is light
spark knock for a short time under heavy
engine load.
Oil additives
NISSAN does not recommend the use of oil
additives. The use of an oil additive is not
necessary when the proper oil type is used
and maintenance intervals are followed.
Oil which may contain foreign matter or
has been previously used should not be
used.
Oil viscosity
LTI2051
ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER
RECOMMENDATIONS
Selecting the correct oil
It is essential to choose the correct grade,
quality and viscosity engine oil to ensure
satisfactory engine life and performance.
For additional information, refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities”
in this section. NISSAN recommends the
use of an energy conserving oil in order to
improve fuel economy.
Select only engine oils that meet the
American Petroleum Institute (API) certification or International Lubricant Standardization and Approval Committee (ILSAC)
certification and SAE viscosity standard.
These oils have the API certification mark
on the front of the container. Oils which do
not have the specified quality label should
not be used as they could cause engine
damage.
The engine oil viscosity or thickness
changes with temperature. Because of
this, it is important to select the engine oil
viscosity based on the temperatures at
which the vehicle will be operated before
the next oil change. Choosing an oil viscosity other than that recommended could
cause serious engine damage.
Selecting the correct oil filter
Your new NISSAN vehicle is equipped with a
high-quality Genuine NISSAN oil filter. When
replacing, use a Genuine NISSAN oil filter for
the reason described in “Change intervals.”
Technical and consumer information 10-7
Change intervals
The oil and oil filter change intervals for
your engine are based on the use of the
specified quality oils and filters. Using engine oil and filters that are not of the specified quality, or exceeding recommended oil
and filter change intervals could reduce
engine life or cause severe damage to the
engine. Damage to the engine caused by
improper maintenance or use of incorrect
oil and filter quality and/or viscosity is not
covered by the NISSAN New Vehicle Limited
Warranty.
Your engine was filled with a high-quality
engine oil when it was built. You do not have
to change the oil before the first recommended change interval. Oil and filter
change intervals depend upon how you
use your vehicle.
NISSAN recommends the use of Genuine
NISSAN parts or equivalent. The use of
parts that do not meet or exceed NISSAN
specifications, can cause damage to your
vehicle, and have an effect on your warranty coverage. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer parts department
who can provide information on the proper
parts for your vehicle.
Operation under the following conditions
may require more frequent oil and filter
changes:
• repeated short distance driving at cold
outside temperatures
• driving in dusty conditions
• extensive idling
• towing a trailer
• stop and go commuting
For additional information, refer to the
“Maintenance and schedules” section of
this manual.
AIR CONDITIONER SYSTEM
REFRIGERANT AND OIL
RECOMMENDATIONS
The air conditioner system in your
NISSAN vehicle must be charged with the
refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) and
NISSAN A/C system oil Type PAG (DH-PR)
or the exact equivalents.
CAUTION
The use of any other refrigerant or oil
will cause severe damage to the air
conditioning system and will require
the replacement of all air conditioner
system components.
10-8 Technical and consumer information
The refrigerant HFC-134a (R-134a) in your
NISSAN vehicle does not harm the earth's
ozone layer. Although this refrigerant does
not affect the earth's atmosphere, certain
government regulations require the recovery and recycling of any refrigerant during
automotive air conditioner system service.
A NISSAN dealer has the trained technicians and equipment needed to recover
and recycle your air conditioner system refrigerant.
It is recommended that you visit a NISSAN
dealer when servicing your air conditioner
system.
SPECIFICATIONS
ENGINE
Model
VQ38DD
Type
Gasoline, 4-cycle, DOHC
Cylinder arrangement
6-cylinder, V-block, Slanted at 60°
Bore x Stroke
in (mm) 3.760 x 3.480 (95.5 x 88.4)
cu in (cm 3) 231.8 (3,799)
Displacement
Firing order
1–2–3–4–5–6
Idle speed
A/T in N (Neutral) position
Ignition timing (degree B.T.D.C. at idle speed)
Refer to the “Emission control information label” on the underside of the hood.
CO % at idle
Spark plug
Spark plug gap (Nominal)
Camshaft operation
FXE22HR-11
in (mm) 0.043 (1.1)
Timing chain
This spark ignition system complies with the Canadian standard ICES-002.
Technical and consumer information 10-9
WHEELS AND TIRES
Wheel Type
DIMENSIONS AND WEIGHTS
Offset in (mm)
Size
Steel
1.18 (30)
16 x 7JJ
Aluminum
1.18 (30)
16 x 7J
Aluminum
1.18 (30)
18 x 7.5J
Tires
Size
P265/70R16
P265/75R16
P265/60R18
Spare tire
Size
Steel 16”
Full size
Alloy 16”
Full size
Alloy 18”
Full size
Alloy 18”
P265/70R16
10-10 Technical and consumer information
Overall length
Short wheel base
Long wheel base
in (mm)
in (mm)
in (mm)
205.5 (5,220)
219.4 (5,574)
72.8 (1,850)
Overall width
Overall height (includes roof rails)
Crew Cab models
S, SV
in (mm)
70.1 (1,780)
Pro-4X
in (mm)
73.9 (1,878)
King Cab® models
S
in (mm)
69.7 (1,770)
SV
in (mm)
69.7 (1,770)
Track Width
Front and rear
in (mm)
61.8 (1,570)
Wheelbase
Short wheel base in (mm)
125.9 (3,200)
Long wheel base
in (mm)
139.9 (3,554)
Gross vehicle weight
lbs. (kg)
rating
Gross axle weight
Refer to the “F.M.V.S.S./
rating
C.M.V.S.S. certification label”
Front
lbs. (kg) in this section.
Rear
lbs. (kg)
WHEN TRAVELING OR REGISTERING
IN ANOTHER COUNTRY
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION
When planning to drive your NISSAN vehicle in another country, you should first
find out if the fuel available is suitable for
your vehicle's engine.
Using fuel with an octane rating that is too
low may cause engine damage. All gasoline vehicles must be operated with unleaded gasoline. Therefore, avoid taking
your vehicle to areas where appropriate
fuel is not available.
When transferring the registration of
your vehicle to another country, state,
province or district, it may be necessary
to modify the vehicle to meet local laws
and regulations.
The laws and regulations for motor vehicle
emission control and safety standards
vary according to the country, state, province or district; therefore, vehicle specifications may differ.
LTI0085
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
(VIN) PLATE
The VIN plate is attached as shown. This
number is the identification for your vehicle
and is used in the vehicle registration.
LTI2495
VQ38DD engine
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER
The number is stamped on the engine as
shown.
When any vehicle is to be taken into another country, state, province or district
and registered, its modifications, transportation and registration are the responsibility of the user. NISSAN is not responsible for any inconvenience that
may result.
Technical and consumer information 10-11
LTI0135
Type A (if so equipped)
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. CERTIFICATION
LABEL
WTI0099
Type B (if so equipped)
The Federal/Canadian Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard (F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.) certification label is affixed as shown. This label
contains valuable vehicle information, such
as: (GVWR), (GAWR), month and year of
manufacture, (VIN), etc. Review it carefully.
10-12 Technical and consumer information
LTI0133
EMISSION CONTROL
INFORMATION LABEL
The emission control information label is
attached to the underside of the hood as
shown.
LTI2252
Type A (if so equipped)
TIRE AND LOADING INFORMATION
LABEL
WTI0100
Type B (if so equipped)
The cold tire pressure is shown on the Tire
and Loading Information label. The label is
located as shown.
LTI2486
AIR CONDITIONER SPECIFICATION
LABEL
The air conditioner specification label is affixed as shown.
Technical and consumer information 10-13
INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE
VEHICLE LOADING INFORMATION
WARNING
LTI0137
INSTALLING FRONT LICENSE PLATE
WITH GROMMETS
Use the following steps to mount the front
license plate with grommets:
• It is extremely dangerous to
ride in a cargo area inside a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in these areas are more
likely to be seriously injured or
killed.
• Do not allow people to ride in
any area of your vehicle that is
not equipped with seats and
seat belts.
• Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a
seat belt properly.
1. Make holes on the plastic finisher at the
location mark (small dimple) using a 0.37
in (9.5 mm) drill. Apply light pressure to the
drill. Insert two plastic grommets provided. Install the license plate holder using
the two bolts (and washers) provided.
2. Mount the license plate using two
M6-14 mm bolts.
License plate bolt tightening torque:
3.8 - 4.7 ft-lb. (5.10 - 6.37 N·m)
10-14 Technical and consumer information
TERMS
It is important to familiarize yourself
with the following terms before
loading your vehicle:
• Curb Weight (actual weight of your
vehicle) - vehicle weight including:
standard and optional equipment,
fluids, emergency tools, and spare
tire assembly. This weight does
not include passengers and cargo.
• GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) - curb
weight plus the combined weight
of passengers and cargo.
• GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) - maximum total combined
weight of the unloaded vehicle,
passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer
tongue load and any other optional equipment. This information
is located on the F.M.V.S.S./
C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
• GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) maximum weight (load) limit
specified for the front or rear axle.
This information is located on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
• GCWR (Gross Combined Weight
rating) - The maximum total
weight rating of the vehicle, passengers, cargo, and trailer.
• Vehicle Capacity Weight, Load limit,
Total load capacity - maximum total weight limit specified of the load
(passengers and cargo) for the vehicle. This is the maximum combined weight of occupants and
cargo that can be loaded into the
vehicle. If the vehicle is used to tow
a trailer, the trailer tongue weight
must be included as part of the
cargo load. This information is located on the Tire and Loading Information label.
• Cargo capacity - permissible
weight of cargo, the subtracted
weight of occupants from the load
limit.
VEHICLE LOAD CAPACITY
Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR)
or the Gross Axle Weight Rating
(GAWR) for your vehicle. Both the
GVWR and GAWR are located on the
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
For additional information, refer to
“Measurement of weights” in this
section.
To get “the combined weight of occupants and cargo”, add the weight
of all occupants, then add the total
luggage weight. Examples are
shown in the following illustration.
Do not exceed the load limit of your
vehicle shown as “The combined
weight of occupants and cargo” on
the Tire and Loading Information label. Do not exceed the number of
occupants shown as “Seating Capacity” on the Tire and Loading Information label.
Technical and consumer information 10-15
Steps for determining correct
load limit
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX
lbs. or XXX kg” on your vehicle’s
placard.
2. Determine the combined weight
of the driver and passengers that
will be riding in your vehicle.
3. Subtract the combined weight of
the driver and passengers from
XXX lbs. or XXX kg.
4. The resulting figure equals the
available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the XXX amount equals
1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150
lbs. passengers in your vehicle,
the amount of available cargo
and luggage load capacity is 650
lbs. (1,400-750 (5 X 150) = 650 lbs.) or
(640-340 (5 X 70) = 300 kg.)
10-16 Technical and consumer information
LTI2320
Example
5. Determine the combined weight
of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight
may not safely exceed the available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
6. If your vehicle will be towing a
trailer, load from your trailer will be
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine
how this reduces the available
cargo and luggage load capacity
of your vehicle.
Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm that you do not exceed the GVWR
or the GAWR for your vehicle. For additional information, refer to “Measurement of weights” in this section.
WARNING
LTI0102
SECURING THE LOAD
• Properly secure all cargo with ropes
or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. Do not place cargo
higher than the seatbacks. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured
cargo could cause personal injury.
• Do not load your vehicle any heavier
than the GVWR or the maximum front
and rear GAWRs. If you do, parts of
your vehicle can break, tire damage
could occur, or it can change the way
your vehicle handles. This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury.
For your convenience, tie down hooks (if so
equipped) are placed at each corner of the
truck box. These may be used to help secure cargo loaded into the truck box.
Also check tires for proper inflation
pressures. For additional information, refer to the “Tire and Loading
Information label” in the “Do-ityourself” section of this manual.
Technical and consumer information 10-17
WARNING
LTI2082
UTILI-TRACK® CHANNEL SYSTEM (if
so equipped)
• Properly install and tighten the tiedown cleats into the Utili-track®
channel system. Also, do not attach
any rope or straps directly to the
channel. Failure to properly install
the tie-down cleats or attaching
ropes or straps directly to the channel can cause the cargo to become
unsecured. In a sudden stop or collision, unsecured cargo could cause
personal injury.
• Properly secure all cargo with ropes
or straps to help prevent it from sliding or shifting. In a sudden stop or
collision, unsecured cargo could
cause personal injury.
1. Side channels
2. Header channel
3. Floor channels
10-18 Technical and consumer information
The Utili-track® channel system allows you
to move tie-down clamps in the bed to the
best location to secure a load.
The tie-down cleats must be installed so
the clamp is properly seated in the notches
in the rail. If the tie-down cleat is not seated
in the notches, it will not be flush with the
rail and cannot be properly tightened. The
bolt in the center of the cleat must be tightened hand tight (20 – 40 in-lbs.)
Check the tightness of the tie-down cleat
periodically during a trip to make sure the
center bolt has not become loose.
Install the tie-down cleat as follows:
1. Remove the side channels by sliding
them out the back of the truck bed.
Properly store the side channels.
2. Loosen the center bolt completely.
LTI0103
3. Insert the cleat into the channel perpendicular to the channel as shown. Then
rotate the cleat clockwise 90° and slide it
to the desired location.
LTI0104
4. Position the cleat so the nubs on the
bottom fully seat into the channel
detents.
Technical and consumer information 10-19
WTI0124
5. There should be no gap between the
bottom of the cleat and the top of the
channel. Tighten the center bolt hand
tight (20-40 in-lbs.).
10-20 Technical and consumer information
LTI0106
CAUTION
• Install only one cleat per section of
channel.
• Applying loads at angles to the cleats
greater than 45° or loads greater
than 150 lbs. (header and floor channels) or 200 lbs. (side channels) may
cause damage to the channel or bed.
Technical and consumer information 10-21
LOADING TIPS
• The GVW must not exceed GVWR or
GAWR as specified on the F.M.V.S.S./
C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
• Do not load the front and rear axle
to the GAWR. Doing so will exceed
the GVWR.
WARNING
LTI0123
1 correct installation, 2 incorrect installation
WARNING
Do not install accessories over the gap
between the front and rear side channels. Doing this could affect the rear
structure in certain rear impacts, which
could result in serious injury.
10-22 Technical and consumer information
• Properly secure all cargo with
ropes or straps to help prevent
it from sliding or shifting. Do
not place cargo higher than the
seatbacks. In a sudden stop or
collision, unsecured cargo
could cause personal injury.
TRUCK-CAMPER LOADING
INFORMATION
• Do not load your vehicle any
heavier than the GVWR or the
maximum front and rear
GAWRs. If you do, parts of your
vehicle can break, tire damage
could occur, or it can change
the way your vehicle handles.
This could result in loss of control and cause personal injury.
• Overloading not only can
shorten the life of your vehicle
and the tire, but can also cause
unsafe vehicle handling and
longer braking distances. This
may cause a premature tire
failure which could result in a
serious accident and personal
injury. Failures caused by overloading are not covered by the
vehicle’s warranty.
CREW CAB MODELS
Crew Cab short wheel base models
should not be used to carry a slide-in
camper.
KING CAB® MODELS
This information is provided for you to
properly install a slide-in camper and is
based on the National Highway Traffic
Safety Administration regulations. It is recommended that, before installing the
camper, you carefully read the following information and ensure that the camper
meets the specifications.
LTI0128
This information may not apply to some
Canada model vehicles.
LOCATION FOR CENTER OF GRAVITY
SPECIAL BODY VEHICLES
The illustration indicates the recommended cargo center of gravity location.
Some vehicles are equipped with commercial or camper bodies. However, this Owner's Manual does not cover these options.
For additional information, refer to the
body manufacturer's instruction manual.
Crew Cab / King Cab®:
L1 = 48.4 in (1,230 mm)
Crew Cab LWB:
L1 = 48.6 in (1,234 mm)
WARNING
Improper loading may be dangerous. If a
load is too far back, it can affect handling
characteristics. If a load is too far forward, the front axle may be overloaded.
Technical and consumer information 10-23
truck's recommended center of gravity
zone when installed.
WARNING
Overloading or improper loading can
adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and performance and may lead to
accidents.
VEHICLE LOAD WEIGHT CAPACITY
LTI0129
When the truck is used to carry a slide-in
camper, the total cargo load of the truck
consists of the camper manufacturer's
weight figure,
• the weight of installed additional camper
equipment not included in the camper
manufacturer's weight figure,
• the weight of camper cargo,
• and the weight of passengers in the
camper.
The total cargo load should not exceed the
truck's cargo weight rating and the camper's center of gravity should fall within the
The vehicle payload weight capacity
shown on the Tire and Loading Information
label, refer to “Tire and Loading Information
label” in this section, indicates the maximum total weight of passengers, optional
equipment (air conditioning, trailer hitch,
etc.) and cargo that your vehicle is designed to carry.
Before driving a loaded vehicle, confirm
that you do not exceed the GVWR or the
GAWR for your vehicle. For additional information, refer to ''Vehicle loading information'' in this section.
Also check tires for proper inflation pressures. For additional information, refer to
the Tire and Loading Information label.
10-24 Technical and consumer information
MEASUREMENT OF WEIGHTS
Secure loose items to prevent
weight shifts that could affect the
balance of your vehicle. When the
truck camper is loaded, drive to a
scale and weigh on the front and on
the rear wheels separately to determine axle loads. Individual axle loads
should not exceed either of the
gross axle weight rating (GAWR). The
total of the axle loads should not exceed the gross vehicle weight rating
(GVWR). These ratings are given on
the vehicle certification label that is
located on the left side of the vehicle,
normally the dash, hinge pillar, door
latch post, or door edge next to the
driver. If weight ratings are exceeded,
move or remove items to bring all
weights below the ratings.
TOWING A TRAILER
WARNING
• Overloading or improper loading of a
trailer and its cargo can adversely affect vehicle handling, braking and
performance and may lead to
accidents.
• Do not tow a trailer when the TEMPORARY FULL SIZE spare tire is installed.
CAUTION
• Do not tow a trailer or haul a heavy
load for the first 500 mile (805 km).
Your engine, axle or other parts could
be damaged.
• For the first 500 miles (805 km) that
you tow a trailer, do not drive over 50
mph (80 km/h) and do not make
starts at full throttle. This helps the
engine and other parts of your vehicle wear in at the heavier loads.
Your new vehicle was designed to be used
primarily to carry passengers and cargo.
Remember that towing a trailer places additional loads on your vehicle's engine,
drive train, steering, braking and other systems.
A NISSAN Towing Guide (U.S. only) is available
on the website at www.nissanusa.com. This
guide includes information on trailer towing
capability and the special equipment required for proper towing.
MAXIMUM LOAD LIMITS
Maximum trailer loads
Never allow the total trailer load to exceed
the value specified in the “Towing Load/
Specification” chart found in this section.
The total trailer load equals trailer weight
plus its cargo weight.
• When towing a trailer load of 3,500 lbs.
(1,587 kg) or more, trailers with a brake
system MUST be used.
The maximum Gross Combined Weight
Rating (GCWR) should not exceed the value
specified in the following “Towing Load/
Specification” chart.
LTI0161
The GCWR equals the combined weight of
the towing vehicle (including passengers
and cargo) plus the total trailer load. Towing loads greater than these or using improper towing equipment could adversely
affect vehicle handling, braking and performance.
The ability of your vehicle to tow a trailer is
not only related to the maximum trailer
loads, but also the places you plan to tow.
Tow weights appropriate for level highway
driving may have to be reduced for low
traction situations (for example, on slippery
boat ramps).
Technical and consumer information 10-25
Temperature conditions can also affect
towing. For example, towing a heavy trailer
in high outside temperatures on graded
roads can affect engine performance and
cause overheating. The engine protection
mode, which helps reduce the chance of
engine damage, could activate and automatically decrease engine power. Vehicle
speed may decrease under high load. Plan
your trip carefully to account for trailer and
vehicle load, weather and road conditions.
CAUTION
Vehicle damage resulting from improper towing procedures is not covered by NISSAN warranties.
WARNING
Overheating can result in reduced engine power and vehicle speed. The reduced speed may be lower than other
traffic, which could increase the chance
of a collision. Be especially careful
when driving. If the vehicle cannot
maintain a safe driving speed, pull to
the side of the road in a safe area. Allow
the engine to cool and return to normal
operation. For additional information,
refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in
the “In case of emergency” section of
this manual.
10-26 Technical and consumer information
WTI0160
Tongue load
When using a weight carrying or a weight
distributing hitch, keep the tongue load between 10 - 15% of the total trailer load or use
the trailer tongue load specified by the
trailer manufacturer. The tongue load
must be within the maximum tongue load
limits shown in the following “Towing Load/
Specification” chart. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange cargo to allow
for proper tongue load.
Towing capacities are calculated assuming a base vehicle with driver and any options required to achieve the rating. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional
equipment, such as the trailer hitch, will
add weight to the vehicle and reduce your
vehicle’s maximum towing capacity and
trailer tongue load.
The vehicle and trailer need to be weighed
to confirm the vehicle is within the GVWR,
Front GAWR, Rear GAWR, Gross Combined
Weight Rating (GCWR) and Towing capacity.
CA0036
Maximum Gross Vehicle Weight
(GVW)/maximum Gross Axle
Weight (GAW)
The GVW of the towing vehicle must not
exceed the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating
(GVWR) shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.
certification label. The GVW equals the
combined weight of the unloaded vehicle,
passengers, luggage, hitch, trailer tongue
load and any other optional equipment. In
addition, front or rear GAW must not exceed the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR)
shown on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
All vehicle and trailer weights can be measured using platform type scales commonly
found at truck stops, highway weigh stations,
building supply centers or salvage yards.
To determine the available payload capacity
for tongue load, use the following procedure.
1. Locate the GVWR on the F.M.V.S.S./
C.M.V.S.S. certification label.
2. Weigh your vehicle on the scale with all
of the passengers and cargo that are
normally in the vehicle when towing a
trailer.
3. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from
the GVWR. The remaining amount is the
available maximum tongue load.
To determine the available towing capacity,
use the following procedure.
1. Find the GCWR for your vehicle on the
"Towing Load/Specification" chart found
in this section.
2. Subtract the actual vehicle weight from
the GCWR. The remaining amount is the
available maximum towing capacity.
To determine the Gross Trailer Weight,
weigh your trailer on a scale with all equipment and cargo, that are normally in the
trailer when it is towed. Make sure the
Gross Trailer Weight is not more than the
Gross Trailer Weight Rating shown on the
trailer and is not more than the calculated
available maximum towing capacity.
Also weigh the front and rear axles on the
scale to make sure the Front Gross Axle
Weight and Rear Gross Axle Weight are not
more than Front Gross Axle Weight and Rear
Gross Axle Weight on the F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S.
certification label. The cargo in the trailer and
vehicle may need to be moved or removed
to meet the specified ratings.
Example:
• Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) as weighed
on a scale- including passengers, cargo
and hitch - 5,185 lbs. (2352 kg).
Technical and consumer information 10-27
• Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) from
F.M.V.S.S./C.M.V.S.S. certification label 5,815 lbs. (2638 kg).
• Gross Combined Weight Rating (GCWR)
from “Towing Load/Specification" chart 11,133 lbs. (5050 kg).
• Maximum Trailer towing capacity from
“Towing Load/Specification" chart - 6,100
lbs. (2767 kg).
5,815 lbs. (2638 kg)
– 5,185 lbs. (2352 kg)
= 630 lbs. (286 kg)
GVWR
GVW
Available for
tongue weight
11,133 lbs. (5050 kg)
GCWR
– 5,185 lbs. (2352 kg)
GVW
= 5,948 lbs. (2698 kg) Capacity available
for towing
630 lbs. (286 kg)
Available tongue
weight
/ 5,948 lbs. (2698 kg) Available capacity
=
10 % tongue
weight
The available towing capacity may be less
than the maximum towing capacity due to
the passenger and cargo load in the vehicle.
Remember to keep trailer tongue weight
between 10 - 15 percent of the trailer weight
or within the trailer tongue load specification recommended by the trailer manufacturer. If the tongue load becomes excessive, rearrange the cargo to obtain the
proper tongue load. Do not exceed the
maximum tongue weight specification
shown in the “Towing Load/Specification”
chart even if the calculated available
tongue weight is greater than 15 percent. If
the calculated tongue weight is less than
10 percent, reduce the total trailer weight to
match the available tongue weight.
Always verify that available capacities are
within the required ratings.
Trailer frontal area
CAUTION
Exceeding the maximum trailer frontal
area specification may exceed the towing capacity of the vehicle. This may
affect the towing performance and
lead to vehicle damage.
10-28 Technical and consumer information
The trailer frontal area affects the towing
load of a trailer. The frontal area is the total
area of the vehicle and trailer that is affected by air resistance while towing. Do
not exceed the maximum trailer frontal
area specification shown in the "Towing
Load/Specification” chart. The frontal area
can be determined by multiplying the
width of the trailer by the height of the
trailer. For example, a trailer that is 8 feet
wide by 6 feet tall has a trailer frontal area of
48 square feet.
TOWING LOAD/SPECIFICATION
WARNING
The towing capacities provided in this
manual are for general reference only.
The safe towing capacity of your vehicle is affected by dealer and factory
installed options and passenger and
cargo loads. You must weigh the vehicle and trailer as described in this
manual to determine the actual vehicle
towing capacity. Do not exceed the
published maximum towing capacity
or the GCWR or the GVWR shown on the
FMVSS/CMVSS label. Doing so can result in an accident causing serious personal injury or property damage.
King Cab® models
Axle type
2WD
4WD
Maximum Towing Capacity*1, *2, *3
6,720 lbs. (3,048 kg)
6,510 lbs. (2,953 kg)
Maximum Tongue Load*2, *3
672 lbs. (305 kg)
651 lbs. (295 kg)
Maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating
11,427 lbs. (5,183 kg)
11,427 lbs. (5,183 kg)
Maximum trailer frontal area
30 sq feet (2.78 sq meters)
Crew Cab models
Axle type
2WD
4WD
Maximum Towing Capacity*1, *2, *3
6,640 lbs. (3,012 kg)
6,380 lbs. (2,894 kg)
Maximum Tongue Load*2, *3
664 lbs. (301 kg)
638 lbs. (289 kg)
Maximum Gross Combined Weight Rating
11,427 lbs. (5,183 kg)
11,427 lbs. (5,183 kg)
Maximum trailer frontal area
30 sq feet (2.78 sq meters)
*1:
• The towing capacity is calculated using the SAE International SAE J2807 test method. Additional passengers, cargo and/or optional equipment will add weight
to the vehicle and reduce your vehicle's maximum towing capacity.
• All towing above 1,000 lbs. (454 kg) requires the use of trailer brakes.
• NISSAN recommends the use of a tandem axle trailer whenever towing above 3,000 lbs. (1,361 kg).
*2: The maximum towing capacity when using the Genuine NISSAN step bumper as a ball mount is 3,500 lbs. (1,588 kg) and 350 lbs. (158 kg) tongue load.
*3: Use of a weight-distributing hitch system is recommended when towing over 5,000 lbs.
Technical and consumer information 10-29
TOWING SAFETY
Trailer hitch
Your vehicle may be equipped with an optional trailer tow package. The trailer tow
package includes a receiver-type frame
mounted hitch. This hitch is rated for the
maximum towing capacity of this vehicle
when the proper towing equipment is
used. Choose a proper ball mount and
hitch ball that is rated for the trailer to be
towed. Genuine NISSAN ball mounts and
hitch balls are available from a NISSAN
dealer.
If your vehicle is not equipped with the optional trailer tow package, check the towing capacity of your bumper hitch or
receiver-type frame mounted hitch.
Choose a proper hitch for your vehicle and
trailer. A Genuine NISSAN trailer hitch is
available from a NISSAN dealer. Make sure
the trailer hitch is securely attached to the
vehicle to help avoid personal injury or
property damage due to sway caused by
crosswinds, rough road surfaces or passing trucks.
WARNING
Trailer hitch components have specific
weight ratings. Your vehicle may be capable of towing a trailer heavier than
the weight rating of the hitch components. Never exceed the weight rating
of the hitch components. Doing so can
cause serious personal injury or property damage.
Hitch ball
Choose a hitch ball of the proper size and
weight rating for your trailer:
• The required hitch ball size is stamped on
most trailer couplers. Most hitch balls
also have the size printed on the top of
the ball.
• Choose the proper class hitch ball based
on the trailer weight.
• The diameter of the threaded shank of
the hitch ball must be matched to the ball
mount hole diameter. The hitch ball
shank should be no more than 1/16”
smaller than the hole in the ball mount.
• The threaded shank of the hitch ball must
be long enough to be properly secured to
the ball mount. There should be at least 2
threads showing beyond the lock washer
and nut.
10-30 Technical and consumer information
Ball mount
The hitch ball is attached to the ball mount
and the ball mount is inserted into the
hitch receiver. Choose a proper class ball
mount based on the trailer weight. Additionally, the ball mount should be chosen to
keep the trailer tongue level with the
ground.
Weight distribution hitch
This type of hitch is also called a “loadleveling” or “equalizing” hitch. A set of bars
attach to the ball mount and to the trailer
to distribute the tongue weight (hitch
weight) of your trailer. Many vehicles can't
carry the full tongue weight of a given
trailer, and need some of the tongue
weight transferred through the frame and
pushing down on the front wheels. This
gives stability to the tow vehicle.
LTI0132
Bumper towing
The Genuine NISSAN step bumper has provisions to install a trailer hitch ball and is
designed to tow trailers of a maximum
weight of 3,500 lbs. (1,588 kg).
To install a trailer hitch ball cut out the circle
A , then
in the center of the step bumper O
remove it to install the trailer hitch ball.
Weight carrying hitches
A weight carrying or “dead weight” ball
mount is one that is designed to carry the
whole amount of tongue weight and gross
weight directly on the ball mount and on
the receiver.
A weight-distributing hitch system (Class
IV) is recommended if you plan to tow trailers with a maximum weight over 5,000 lbs.
(2,268 kg). Check with the trailer and towing
equipment manufacturers to determine if
they recommend the use of a weightdistributing hitch system.
NOTE:
Follow the instructions provided by the
manufacturer for installing and using the
weight-distributing hitch system.
General set-up instructions are as follows:
1. Park unloaded vehicle on a level surface.
With the ignition on and the doors
closed, allow the vehicle to stand for several minutes so that it can level.
2. Measure the height of a reference point
on the front and rear bumpers at the
center of the vehicle.
3. Attach the trailer to the vehicle and adjust the hitch equalizers so that the front
bumper height is within 0 - .5 inches (0 –
13 mm) of the reference height measured in step 2. The rear bumper should
be no higher than the reference height
measured in step 2.
WARNING
A weight-distributing hitch system may
affect the operation of trailer surge
brakes. If you are considering use of a
weight-distributing hitch system with a
surge brake-equipped trailer, check with
the surge brake, hitch or trailer manufacturer to determine if and how this can be
done.
Properly adjust the weight distributing
hitch so the rear of the bumper is no
higher than the measured reference
height when the trailer is attached. If
the rear bumper is higher than the
measured reference height when
loaded, the vehicle may handle unpredictably which could cause a loss of vehicle control and cause serious personal injury or property damage.
Technical and consumer information 10-31
Sway control device
Class III hitch
Sudden maneuvers, wind gusts, and buffeting caused by other vehicles can affect
trailer handling. Sway control devices may
be used to help control these affects. If you
choose to use one, contact a reputable
trailer hitch supplier to make sure the sway
control device will work with the vehicle,
hitch, trailer and the trailer's brake system.
Follow the instructions provided by the
manufacturer for installing and using the
sway control device.
Class III trailer hitch equipment (receiver,
ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to
tow trailers of a maximum weight of 5,000
lbs. (2,268 kg).
Class I hitch
Class I trailer hitch equipment (receiver, ball
mount and hitch ball) can be used to tow
trailers of a maximum weight of 2,000 lbs.
(907 kg).
Class II hitch
Class II trailer hitch equipment (receiver,
ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to
tow trailers of a maximum weight of 3,500
lbs. (1,587 kg).
The Genuine NISSAN step bumper is considered a Class II ball mount.
Class IV hitch
Class IV trailer hitch equipment (receiver,
ball mount and hitch ball) can be used to
tow trailers of a maximum weight of 10,000
lbs. (4,535 kg). A weight distributing hitch
should be used to tow trailers that weigh
over 5,000 lbs. (2,268 kg).
Your vehicle may be equipped with Class IV
trailer hitch equipment that has a 10,000 lbs.
(4,535 kg) maximum weight rating, but your
vehicle is only capable of towing the maximum trailer weights shown in the “Towing
Load/Specification” chart in this section.
CAUTION
• Special hitches which include frame
reinforcements are required for towing above 2,000 lbs. (907 kg). Suitable
Genuine NISSAN hitches, ball mounts
and hitch balls for pickup trucks and
sport utility vehicles are available at
a NISSAN dealer.
10-32 Technical and consumer information
• The hitch should not be attached to
or affect the operation of the impactabsorbing bumper.
WARNING
• Do not use axle-mounted hitches.
• Do not modify the vehicle exhaust
system, brake system, etc. to install a
trailer hitch.
• To reduce the possibility of additional damage if your vehicle is
struck from the rear, where practical,
remove the receiver when not in use.
• Regularly check that all trailer hitch
mounting bolts are securely mounted.
Tire pressures
• When towing a trailer, inflate the
vehicle tires to the recommended
cold tire pressure indicated on the
Tire and Loading Information label.
• Trailer tire condition, size, load rating and proper inflation pressure
should be in accordance with the
trailer and tire manufacturer's
specifications.
Safety chains
Always use suitable safety chains between
your vehicle and the trailer. The safety chains
should be crossed and should be attached
to the hitch, not to the vehicle bumper or
axle. The safety chains can be attached to
the bumper if the hitch ball is mounted to the
bumper. Be sure to leave enough slack in the
chains to permit turning corners.
Trailer lights
CAUTION
When splicing into the vehicle electrical
system, a commercially available
power-type module/converter must
be used to provide power for all trailer
lighting. This unit uses the vehicle battery as a direct power source for all
trailer lights while using the vehicle tail
light, stop light and turn signal circuits
as a signal source. The module/
converter must draw no more than 15
milliamps from the stop and tail lamp
circuits. Using a module/converter that
exceeds these power requirements
may damage the vehicle's electrical
system. See a reputable trailer dealer
to obtain the proper equipment and to
have it installed.
Trailer lights should comply with federal
and/or local regulations. For assistance in
hooking up trailer lights, it is recommended
that you visit a NISSAN dealer or reputable
trailer dealer. Vehicles equipped with the
optional trailer tow package are equipped
with a 7-pin trailer harness connector. A flat
4–pin harness is available from your dealer
for vehicles without a tow package. If your
trailer is equipped with a flat 4-pin connector, an adapter will be needed to connect
the trailer lights to the vehicle. Adapters are
available at auto parts stores and hitch retailers.
Trailer brakes
If your trailer is equipped with a braking
system, make sure it conforms to federal
and/or local regulations and that it is properly installed.
Vehicles equipped with a 7–pin trailer harness connector are pre-wired for a trailer
brake controller. It is recommended that
you visit a NISSAN dealer for a trailer brake
adapter harness.
WARNING
Never connect a trailer brake system
directly to the vehicle brake system.
When towing a trailer load of 3,500 lbs.
(1587 kg) or more, trailers with a brake
system MUST be used. However, most
states require a separate braking system
on trailers with a loaded weight above a
specific amount. Make sure the trailer
meets the local regulations and the regulations where you plan to tow.
Several types of braking systems are available.
Surge Brakes -The surge brake actuator is
mounted on the trailer tongue with a hydraulic line running to each trailer wheel.
Surge brakes are activated by the trailer
pushing against the hitch ball when the
tow vehicle is braking. Hydraulic surge
brakes are common on rental trailers and
some boat trailers. In this type of system,
there is no hydraulic or electric connection
for brake operation between the tow vehicle and the trailer.
Electric Trailer Brakes -Electric braking
systems are activated by an electronic signal sent from a trailer brake controller (special brake-sensing module). If electric trailer
brakes are used, refer to “Electric trailer
brake controller" in this section.
Have a professional supplier of towing
equipment make sure the trailer brakes are
properly installed and demonstrate proper
brake function testing.
Technical and consumer information 10-33
Electric trailer brake controller
Trailers equipped with electric brakes may
require the installation of an aftermarket
trailer brake controller.
A Genuine NISSAN jumper harness is available that is specifically designed to be used
when installing an aftermarket brake controller.
Install the aftermarket electric trailer brake
controller according to the manufacturer's
instructions.
Pre-towing tips
• Be certain your vehicle maintains a level
position when a loaded and/or unloaded
trailer is hitched. Do not drive the vehicle if
it has an abnormal nose-up or nosedown condition; check for improper
tongue load, overload, worn suspension
or other possible causes of either condition.
• Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving.
• Keep the cargo load as low as possible in
the trailer to keep the trailer center of
gravity low.
• Load the trailer so approximately 60% of
the trailer load is in the front half and 40%
is in the back half. Also make sure the load
is balanced side to side.
• Check your hitch, trailer tire pressure, vehicle tire pressure, trailer light operation,
and trailer wheel lug nuts every time you
attach a trailer to the vehicle.
• Be certain your rearview mirrors conform
to all federal, state or local regulations. If
not, install any mirrors required for towing
before driving the vehicle.
• Determine the overall height of the vehicle and trailer so the required clearance
is known.
Trailer towing tips
In order to gain skill and an understanding
of the vehicle's behavior, you should practice turning, stopping and backing up in an
area which is free from traffic. Steering stability and braking performance will be
somewhat different than under normal
driving conditions.
• Always secure items in the trailer to prevent load shift while driving.
• Lock the trailer hitch coupler with a pin or
lock to prevent the coupler from inadvertently becoming unlatched.
10-34 Technical and consumer information
• Avoid abrupt starts, acceleration or stops.
• Avoid sharp turns or lane changes.
• Always drive your vehicle at a moderate
speed.
• When backing up, hold the bottom of the
steering wheel with one hand. Move your
hand in the direction in which you want
the trailer to go. Make small corrections
and back up slowly. If possible, have
someone guide you when you are backing up.
Always block the wheels on both vehicle
and trailer when parking. Parking on a
slope is not recommended; however, if you
must do so:
CAUTION
If you move the shift lever to the P
(Park) position before blocking the
wheels and applying the parking brake,
transmission damage could occur.
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
2. Have someone place blocks on the
downhill side of the vehicle and trailer
wheels.
3. After the wheel blocks are in place,
slowly release the brake pedal until the
blocks absorb the vehicle load.
4. Apply the parking brake.
5. Shift the transmission into P (Park).
indicator light (if so
6. Make sure the
equipped) indicates the transfer case is
in 4H, 4L, or 2H and that the ATP light is
indicator light is flashing,
off. If the
or the ATP light is ON, make sure the
transmission is in P (Park) (A/T) and turn
the 4WD switch to 2WD or 4H. For additional information, refer to “Automatic
transmission park warning light” in the
“Instruments and controls” section and
“Using 4-wheel drive (4WD)” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual.
7. Turn off the engine.
To drive away:
1. Start the vehicle.
2. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
3. Shift the transmission into gear.
4. Release the parking brake.
5. Drive slowly until the vehicle and trailer
are clear from the blocks.
6. Apply and hold the brake pedal.
7. Have someone retrieve and store the
blocks.
• While going downhill, the weight of the
trailer pushing on the tow vehicle may
decrease overall stability. Therefore, to
maintain adequate control, reduce your
speed and shift to a lower gear. Avoid
long or repeated use of the brakes when
descending a hill, as this reduces their
effectiveness and could cause overheating. Shifting to a lower gear instead provides “engine braking” and reduces the
need to brake as frequently.
• If the engine coolant temperature rises to
a high temperature, refer to “If your vehicle overheats” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.
• Trailer towing requires more fuel than
normal circumstances.
• Avoid towing a trailer for your vehicle's
first 500 miles (805 km).
• For the first 500 miles (805 km) that you do
tow, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h).
• Have your vehicle serviced more often
than at intervals specified. For additional
information, refer to “Maintenance
Schedules” in the “Maintenance and
schedules” section of this manual.
• When making a turn, your trailer wheels
will be closer to the inside of the turn than
your vehicle wheels. To compensate for
this, make a larger than normal turning
radius during the turn.
• Crosswinds and rough roads will adversely affect vehicle/trailer handling,
possibly causing vehicle sway. When being passed by larger vehicles, be prepared for possible changes in crosswinds
that could affect vehicle handling.
Do the following if the trailer begins to
sway:
1. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal
to allow the vehicle to coast and steer as
straight ahead as the road conditions
allow. This combination will help stabilize
the vehicle
– Do not correct trailer sway by steering
or applying the brakes.
2. When the trailer sway stops, gently apply
the brakes and pull to the side of the
road in a safe area.
Technical and consumer information 10-35
3. Try to rearrange the trailer load so it is
balanced as described in this section.
• Be careful when passing other vehicles.
Passing while towing a trailer requires
considerably more distance than normal
passing. Remember, the length of the
trailer must also pass the other vehicle
before you can safely change lanes.
• Downshift the transmission to a lower
gear for engine braking when driving
down steep or long hills. This will help
slow the vehicle without applying the
brakes.
• Avoid holding the brake pedal down too
long or too frequently. This could cause
the brakes to overheat, resulting in reduced braking efficiency.
• Increase your following distance to allow
for greater stopping distances while towing a trailer. Anticipate stops and brake
gradually.
• NISSAN recommends that the cruise
control not be used while towing a trailer.
• Some states or provinces have specific
regulations and speed limits for vehicles
that are towing trailers. Obey the local
speed limits.
• Check your hitch, trailer wiring harness
connections, and trailer wheel lug nuts
after 50 miles (80 km) of travel and at
every break.
• When launching a boat, don't allow the
water level to go over the exhaust tail
pipe or rear bumper.
• Make sure you disconnect the trailer
lights before backing the trailer into the
water or the trailer lights may burn out.
When towing a trailer, final drive gear oil
should be replaced and transmission oil/
fluid should be changed more frequently. For additional information, refer
to the “Do-it-yourself” section in this
manual.
10-36 Technical and consumer information
FLAT TOWING – 4WD WITH
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Towing a vehicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor home, is sometimes
called flat towing.
CAUTION
• DO NOT flat tow a 4WD vehicle
equipped with an automatic transmission. Flat towing or using a vehicle dolly WILL DAMAGE internal
transmission parts due to lack of
lubrication.
• For emergency towing procedures
refer to “Towing recommended by
NISSAN” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.
UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING
FLAT TOWING – 2WD WITH
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION
Towing a vehicle behind a recreational vehicle, such as a motor home, is sometimes
called flat towing.
CAUTION
• Failure to follow these guidelines can
result
in
severe
transmission
damage.
• Whenever flat towing your vehicle,
always tow forward, never backward.
• DO NOT tow any automatic transmission vehicle with all four wheels on
the ground. Doing so WILL DAMAGE
internal transmission parts due to
lack of transmission lubrication.
• For emergency towing procedures
refer to “Towing recommended by
NISSAN” in the “In case of emergency” section of this manual.
To tow a vehicle equipped with an automatic transmission, an appropriate vehicle
dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle’s drive wheels. Always follow the dolly
manufacturer’s recommendations when
using their product.
Automatic Transmission
To tow a vehicle equipped with an automatic transmission, an appropriate vehicle
dolly MUST be placed under the towed vehicle's drive wheels. Always follow the dolly
manufacturer's recommendations when
using their product.
NOTE:
If the battery is completely drained the
transmission will not manually shift to
other positions.
DOT (Department of Transportation) Quality Grades: All passenger car tires must
conform to federal safety requirements in
addition to these grades.
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall between tread
shoulder and maximum section width. For
example:
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature
A
Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of the tire when
tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one
and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100.
The relative performance of tires depends
upon the actual conditions of their use,
however, and may depart significantly from
the norm due to variations in driving habits,
service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
Technical and consumer information 10-37
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
WARRANTY
Traction AA, A, B and C
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured under controlled
conditions on specified government test
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire
marked C may have poor traction performance.
WARNING
The traction grade assigned to this tire
is based on straight-ahead braking
traction tests, and does not include acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or
peak traction characteristics.
tor Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A
represent higher levels of performance on
the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by law.
Your NISSAN vehicle is covered by the following emission warranties:
For USA
1. Emission Defects Warranty
WARNING
The temperature grade for this tire is
established for a tire that is properly
inflated and not overloaded. Excessive
speed, under-inflation, or excessive
loading, either separately or in combination, can cause heat build-up and
possible tire failure.
Temperature A, B and C
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C, representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat, and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under
controlled conditions on a specified indoor
laboratory test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden
tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a
level of performance which all passenger
car tires must meet under the Federal Mo-
10-38 Technical and consumer information
2. Emissions Performance Warranty
Details of this warranty may be found with
other vehicle warranties in your Warranty
Information Booklet which comes with
your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a
Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost,
you may obtain a replacement by writing
to:
• Nissan North America, Inc.
Consumer Affairs Department
P.O. Box 685003
Franklin, TN 37068-5003
For Canada
Emission Control System Warranty
Details of this warranty may be found with
other vehicle warranties in your Warranty
Information Booklet which comes with
your NISSAN vehicle. If you did not receive a
Warranty Information Booklet, or it is lost,
you may obtain a replacement by writing
to:
• Nissan Canada Inc.
5290 Orbitor Drive
Mississauga, Ontario, L4W 4Z5
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS
For USA
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying NISSAN.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints,
it may open an investigation, and if it
finds that a safety defect exists in a
group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However,
NHTSA cannot become involved in
individual problems between you,
your dealer, or NISSAN.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or
write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 400
Seventh Street, SW., Washington, D.C.
20590. You can also obtain other in-
formation about motor vehicle safety
from http://www.safercar.gov.
You may notify NISSAN by contacting our Consumer Affairs Department, toll-free, at 1-800-NISSAN-1.
For Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a
defect which could cause a crash or
could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Transport Canada in addition to notifying
NISSAN.
If Transport Canada receives complaints, it may open an investigation,
and if it finds that a safety defect
exists in a group of vehicles, it may
request that NISSAN conduct a recall
campaign.
However,
Transport
Canada cannot become involved in
individual problems between you,
your dealer, or NISSAN.
You may contact Transport Canada's Defect Investigations and Recalls Division toll free at 1-800-3330510. You may also report safety
defects
online
at:
https://
wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/
PCDB-BDPP/fc-cp.aspx?lang=eng
(English speakers) or https://
wwwapps.tc.gc.ca/Saf-Sec-Sur/7/
PCDB-BDPP/fc-cp.aspx?lang=fra
(French speakers)
Additional information concerning
motor vehicle safety may be obtained from Transport Canada's
Road Safety Information Centre at
1-800-333-0371
or
online
at
www.tc.gc.ca/roadsafety
(English
speakers)
or
www.tc.gc.ca/
securiteroutiere (French speakers).
To notify NISSAN of any safety concerns please contact our Consumer
Information Centre toll free at 1-800387-0122.
Technical and consumer information 10-39
READINESS FOR INSPECTION/
MAINTENANCE (I/M) TEST
WARNING
A vehicle equipped with Four-Wheel
Drive (4WD) should never be tested using a two wheel dynamometer (such as
the dynamometers used by some
states for emissions testing), or similar
equipment. Make sure you inform the
test facility personnel that your vehicle
is equipped with 4WD before it is placed
on a dynamometer. Using the wrong
test equipment may result in transmission damage or unexpected vehicle
movement which could result in serious vehicle damage or personal injury.
EVENT DATA RECORDERS (EDR)
If a powertrain system component is repaired or the battery is disconnected, the
vehicle may be reset to a “not ready” condition. Before taking the I/M test, check the
vehicle's inspection/maintenance test
readiness condition. Place the ignition
switch in the ON position without starting
the engine. If the Malfunction Indicator
Light (MIL) comes on steady for 20 seconds
and then blinks for 10 seconds, the I/M test
condition is “not ready”. If the MIL does not
blink after 20 seconds, the I/M test condition is “ready”. It is recommended that you
visit a NISSAN dealer to set the “ready condition” or to prepare the vehicle for testing.
Due to legal requirements in some states
and Canadian Provinces, your vehicle may
be required to be in what is called the
“ready condition” for an Inspection/
Maintenance (I/M) test of the emission
control system.
The vehicle is set to the “ready condition”
when it is driven through certain driving
patterns. Usually, the ready condition can
be obtained by ordinary usage of the vehicle.
10-40 Technical and consumer information
This vehicle is equipped with an Event Data
Recorder (EDR). The main purpose of an
EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data
that will assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less.
The EDR in this vehicle is designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were
operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger
safety belts were buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator and/or brake pedal;
and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
• Sounds are not recorded.
OWNER'S MANUAL/SERVICE
MANUAL ORDER INFORMATION
These data can help provide a better understanding of the circumstances in which
crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a nontrivial crash situation occurs; no data are
recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g.
name, gender, age and crash location) are
recorded. However, other parties, such as
law enforcement, could combine the EDR
data with the type of personally identifying
data routinely acquired during a crash investigation.
Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals for this
model year and prior can be purchased. A
Genuine NISSAN Service Manual is the best
source of service and repair information for
your vehicle. This manual is the same one
used by the factory-trained technicians
working at NISSAN dealerships. Genuine
NISSAN Owner’s Manuals can also be purchased.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special
equipment is required and access to the
vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to
the vehicle manufacturer and NISSAN
dealer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special equipment, can
read the information if they have access to
the vehicle or the EDR. EDR data will only be
accessed with the consent of the vehicle
owner or lessee or as otherwise required or
permitted by law.
www.nissan-techinfo.com
For Canada
To purchase a copy of a Genuine NISSAN
Service Manual or Owner’s Manual, for this
model year and prior, please contact your
nearest NISSAN dealer. For the phone number and location of a NISSAN dealer in your
area, call the NISSAN Information Center at
1-800-387-0122 and a bilingual NISSAN representative will assist you.
For USA
For current pricing and availability of Genuine NISSAN Service Manuals, contact:
For current pricing and availability of Genuine NISSAN Owner's Manuals, contact:
1-800-247-5321
Technical and consumer information 10-41
MEMO
10-42 Technical and consumer information
11 Index
4WD warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
A
Active Brake Limited Slip (ABLS)
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-34
Air bag (See supplemental restraint
system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-70
Air bag system
Front (See supplemental front impact
air bag system) . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-77
Air bag warning labels. . . . . . . . . . . .1-85
Air bag warning light . . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
Air bag warning light,
supplemental . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
Air cleaner housing filter . . . . . . . . . .8-17
Air conditioner
Air conditioner operation . . . .4-26, 4-34
Air conditioner service . . . . . . . . . .4-36
Air conditioner specification label . .10-13
Air conditioner system refrigerant
recommendations . . . . . . . . . . . .10-8
Air conditioner system refrigerant
and oil recommendations . . . . . . .10-8
Heater and air conditioner
controls. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-34
Servicing air conditioner . . . . . . . .4-36
Air flow charts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-27
Alarm system
(See vehicle security system) . . . . . . .2-25
Anchor point locations . . . . . . . . . . .1-33
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . . .2-15
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) . . . . . .5-33
Antifreeze . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40
Apps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Audio system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-36
AM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . .4-37
AM/FM radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-46
Auxiliary (AUX) devices operation . . .4-47
Bluetooth® audio . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-66
Bluetooth® streaming audio . . . . . .4-69
Compact disc (CD) player. . . . . . . .4-54
FM radio reception . . . . . . . . . . . .4-36
FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)
player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-44, 4-49
iPod® Player . . . . . . . . . . . .4-60, 4-63
iPod® player operation . . . . . .4-60, 4-63
Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-36
Steering wheel audio control
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-71
USB Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-56
Autolight switch. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31
Automatic
Automatic power window switch . . .2-51
Automatic transmission position
indicator light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Driving with automatic
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Automatic anti-glare inside mirror . . . .3-18
Automatic door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7
AUX jack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-55
B
Back button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40, 8-13
Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Battery replacement . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24
Key fob . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-24
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . . .8-24
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . . .5-13
Belt (See drive belt). . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15
Bluetooth® audio . . . . . . . . . . .4-66, 4-69
Bluetooth® hands-free phone
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-96
Bluetooth® connections . . . . . . . .4-93
Connecting procedure . . . . . .4-84, 4-99
Phone indicators . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-83
Text messaging . . . . . . . . .4-89, 4-100
Voice commands . . . . . . . . . . . .4-85
Bluetooth® Hands-Free Phone System
without Navigation System . . . . . . . .4-79
Booster seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-65
Brake
Anti-lock Braking System (ABS) . . . .5-33
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . .8-28
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16
Brake wear indicators . . . . . .2-24, 8-20
Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . .5-19
Self-adjusting brakes . . . . . . . . . . .8-20
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Brake system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20
Break-in schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Brightness control
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Brightness/contrast button . . . . . .4-9, 4-15
Bulb check/instrument panel. . . . . . . .2-15
Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
C
C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . . . .10-12
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . . . .4-79
Cargo
(See vehicle loading information) . . . . .10-14
Cargo lamp switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
CD care and cleaning. . . . . . . . . . . . .4-70
CD player (See audio system) . . . . . . .4-54
Child restraint with top tether strap . . . .1-32
Child restraints . . . . . . .1-25, 1-26, 1-28, 1-30
Precautions on child
restraints. . . . . . . . .1-39, 1-42, 1-54, 1-65
Top tether strap anchor point
locations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-33
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . . .3-7
Cleaning exterior and interior . . . . . .7-2, 7-4
Clock set/adjustment . . . . . . . . . .4-7, 4-13
11-2
Clock setting
(models with Navigation System) . . . . .4-13
Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-40
Compact disc (CD) player . . . . . . . . . .4-54
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-11
Compass and outside temperature
display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Compass display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-10
Connect phone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Console box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45
Control panel buttons . . . . . . . . .4-5, 4-10
Back button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Brightness/contrast button . . . .4-9, 4-15
Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5, 4-10
Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
With navigation system. . . . . . .4-10, 4-11
Controls
Audio controls (steering wheel) . . . . .4-71
Heater and air conditioner controls . .4-34
Heater and air conditioner controls
(manual) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22
Coolant
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . .8-5
Checking engine coolant level . . . . . .8-5
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . .2-7
Corrosion protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-7
Cruise control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-19
Cup holders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-46
Curtain side-impact and rollover
air bag . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-82
D
Daytime Running Lights (DRL) system . .2-32
Defroster switch
Rear window and outside mirror
defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Rear window defroster switch . . . . .2-29
Dimensions and weights . . . . . . . . . .10-10
Dimmer switch for instrument panel . . .2-33
Display controls (see control panel
buttons) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5, 4-10
Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Door open warning light . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Drive belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-15
Driving
Cold weather driving . . . . . . . . . . .5-40
Driving with automatic
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Precautions when starting and
driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
Driving the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
E
Economy - fuel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-29
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37
Emergency engine shutoff. . . . . . .5-12, 6-3
Emission control information label . . . .10-12
Emission control system warranty. . . .10-38
Engine
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . .5-13
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Changing engine coolant . . . . . . . . .8-5
Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . .8-6
Checking engine coolant level . . . . . .8-5
Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . .8-6
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . .2-7
Engine cooling system. . . . . . . . . . .8-4
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
Engine oil and oil filter
recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Engine oil pressure warning light . . . .2-17
Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Engine specifications . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Engine Block Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-41
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . . .2-7
Enter button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5, 4-10
Event Data recorders . . . . . . . . . . . .10-40
Exhaust gas (Carbon monoxide) . . . . . .5-2
Explanation of maintenance items . . . . .9-2
Explanation of scheduled maintenance
items . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-5
Extended storage switch . . . . . . . . . .8-23
Eyeglass case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45
F
First aid kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-2
Flashers
(See hazard warning flasher switch) . . . .6-2
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3, 6-4
Floor mat positioning aid . . . . . . . . . . .7-6
Fluid
Brake fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-11
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Engine coolant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Windshield-washer fluid . . . . . . . . .8-12
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Front air bag system
(See supplemental restraint system) . . .1-77
Front power seat adjustment . . . . . . . .1-5
Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Front-door pocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40
Fuel
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Fuel economy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Fuel octane rating . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-6
Fuel recommendation . . . . . . . . . .10-4
Fuel-filler cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Fuel-filler lid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Loose fuel cap warning . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Fuel efficient driving tips . . . . . . . . . . .5-21
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Fuel-filler door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20
Fusible links . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-22
G
Garage door opener, HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver. . . . . . . . . . . .2-56, 2-58, 2-59
Gas cap . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Gauge
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . .2-7
Fuel gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-8
Odometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Tachometer. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7
Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Glove box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44
H
Hands-free phone system, Bluetooth®. .4-96
Hazard warning flasher switch. . . . . . . .6-2
Head restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-10
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch. . . . . . . . . . .2-30
Headlights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-26
Heated seat switches . . . . . . . . . . . .2-35
Heater
Heater and air conditioner controls . .4-34
Heater operation . . . . . . . . . .4-25, 4-35
Hill descent control switch . . . . . . . . .2-36
Hill descent control system . . . . . . . . .5-37
Hill start assist system . . . . . . . . . . . .5-38
HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver. . . . . . . . . . . .2-56, 2-58, 2-59
11-3
Hood release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-13
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-34
I
Ignition switch
Push-button ignition switch . . . . . . .5-10
Immobilizer system . . . . . . . . . .2-27, 5-13
In-cabin microfilter . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-17
Increasing fuel economy . . . . . . . . . .5-23
Indicator
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery
discharge indicator . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
Indicator lights and audible reminders
(See warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Inside automatic anti-glare mirror. . . . .3-18
Instrument brightness control . . . . . . .2-33
Instrument panel . . . . . . . . . . . . .0-6, 2-2
Instrument panel dimmer switch . . . . .2-33
Intelligent Key system
Mechanical key. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3
Remote keyless entry operation . . . . .3-9
Troubleshooting guide . . . . . . . . . .3-12
Warning signals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-12
Interior light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-54
iPod® Player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-60, 4-63
J
Jump seat. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Jump starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-11, 8-14
11-4
K
Key . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-2
Key fob battery replacement . . . . . . . .8-24
Keyless entry
With Intelligent Key system
(See Intelligent Key system) . . . . . . . .3-9
Keys
NISSAN Intelligent Key® . . . . . . . .3-2, 3-8
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System
keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
L
Labels
Air conditioner specification label . . .10-13
C.M.V.S.S. certification label . . . . . . .10-12
Emission control information label . .10-12
Engine serial number . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Tire and Loading Information label . .10-13
Vehicle identification number (VIN) . .10-11
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Warning labels (for SRS). . . . . . . . . .1-85
Launch bar menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-9
License plate
Installing the license plate. . . . . . . .10-14
Light
Air bag warning light . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
Brake light (See stop light) . . . . . . . .8-28
Bulb check/instrument panel . . . . . .2-15
Bulb replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Charge warning light . . . . . . . . . . .2-17
Exterior and Interior lights . . . . . . . .8-28
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Fog lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-27
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . .2-30
Headlights. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-26
Interior light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-54
Light bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-26
Low tire pressure warning light . . . . .2-18
Low windshield-washer fluid
warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Passenger air bag and status light . . .1-79
Security indicator light . . . . . . . . . .2-23
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-26
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-55
Lock
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . .3-7
Door locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4
Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Loose fuel cap warning . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Low fuel warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-18
Low tire pressure warning light. . . . . . .2-18
Low windshield-washer fluid
warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Luggage (See vehicle loading
information) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-14
Luggage rack (see roof rack) . . . . . . . .2-48
M
N
P
Maintenance
General maintenance . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Inside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-3
Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . .8-2
Outside the vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-2
Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Under the hood and vehicle . . . . . . .9-4
Maintenance requirements. . . . . . . . . .9-2
Maintenance schedules . . . . . . . . . . . .9-7
Maintenance under severe operation
conditions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9-10
Malfunction indicator light. . . . . . . . . .2-22
Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . . . .1-3
Manual windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49
Map lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-55
Map pocket . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40
Meters and gauges . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Instrument brightness control . . . . .2-33
Mirror
Automatic anti-glare inside mirror . . .3-18
Outside mirrors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Vanity mirror. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Mobile apps. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Moonroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-52, 7-5
NISSAN Intelligent Key®. . . . . . . . . .3-2, 3-8
NISSAN Intelligent Key® battery discharge
indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-12
NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer
System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27, 5-13
NISSAN voice recognition system . . . .4-106
NissanConnect® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Parking
Parking brake operation . . . . . . . . .5-19
Parking/parking on hills. . . . . . . . . .5-31
Phone, Bluetooth® hands-free system . .4-96
Power
Front seat adjustment . . . . . . . . . . .1-5
Power door locks . . . . . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Power steering system . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-50
Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Power outlet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-39
Power steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Power steering fluid. . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Precautions
Maintenance precautions . . . . . . . . .8-2
On-pavement and off-road driving
precautions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6
Precautions on booster
seats . . . . . . . . . . .1-39, 1-42, 1-54, 1-65
Precautions on child
restraints. . . . . . . . .1-39, 1-42, 1-54, 1-65
Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . .1-15
Precautions on supplemental restraint
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-70
Precautions when starting and
driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
Programmable features . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-13
O
Octane rating (See fuel octane rating) . .10-6
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Oil
Capacities and recommended
fuel/lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Changing engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
Changing engine oil filter . . . . . . . . .8-6
Checking engine oil level . . . . . . . . .8-6
Engine oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6
Engine oil and oil filter
recommendation . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
Engine oil viscosity . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-7
One shot call . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-99
Outside mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-19
Overhead sunglasses holder . . . . . . . .2-45
Overheat
If your vehicle overheats . . . . . . . . .6-13
Owner's manual order form . . . . . . . .10-41
Owner's manual/service manual order
information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-41
11-5
R
Radio
Car phone or CB radio . . . . . . . . . .4-79
FM/AM/SAT radio with compact disc (CD)
player . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-44, 4-49
Steering wheel audio control switch . .4-71
Readiness for inspection maintenance (I/M)
test . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-40
Rear power windows . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-51
Rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
Rear sliding window . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-52
Rear Sonar System (RSS) . . . . . . . . . .5-39
Rear sonar system OFF switch. . . . . . .2-38
Rear window and outside mirror
defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Rear window defroster switch . . . . . . .2-29
Rearview mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
RearView Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-16
Recommended Fluids . . . . . . . . . . . .10-2
Recorders
Event Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-40
Refrigerant recommendation . . . . . . .10-8
Registering a vehicle in another
country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Reporting safety defects (US only) . . . .10-39
Roof rack . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-48
S
Safety
Child safety rear door lock . . . . . . . . .3-7
Child seat belts. .1-28, 1-39, 1-42, 1-54, 1-65
11-6
Reporting safety defects (US only) . .10-39
Seat
Jump seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-7
Seat adjustment
Front manual seat adjustment . . . . . .1-3
Front power seat adjustment . . . . . . .1-5
Seat belt
Child safety . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-25
Infants and small children . . . . . . . .1-26
Injured person. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Larger children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-26
Precautions on seat belt usage . . . . .1-15
Pregnant women . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-18
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Seat belt maintenance . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Seat belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-15, 7-6
Shoulder belt height adjustment . . . .1-24
Three-point type with retractor . . . . .1-19
Seat belt extenders . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-24
Seat belt warning light . . . . . . . . .1-18, 2-20
Seatback pockets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-41
Seats
Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Front seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-2
Manual front seat adjustment . . . . . .1-3
Rear seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-6
Security indicator light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-23
Security system
(NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System),
engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27, 5-13
Security systems
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . .2-25
Self-adjusting brakes. . . . . . . . . . . . .8-20
Service manual order form. . . . . . . . .10-41
Servicing air conditioner. . . . . . . . . . .4-36
Setting button . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-13
Shifting
Automatic transmission . . . . . . . . .5-15
Shoulder belt height adjustment. . . . . .1-24
Side air bag system (See supplemental
side air bag, curtain and rollover air bag
systems) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-82
Siri® Eyes-Free. . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-73, 4-76
Smartphone connectivity . . . . . . . . . .4-72
Sonar
Rear system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-39
Spark plug replacement . . . . . . . . . . .8-16
Spark plugs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-16
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-9
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Speedometer and odometer . . . . . . . .2-4
SRS warning label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-85
Stability control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-35
Standard maintenance . . . . . . . . .9-7, 9-8
Starting
Before starting the engine . . . . . . . .5-13
Jump starting. . . . . . . . . . . . .6-11, 8-14
Precautions when starting and
driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2
Push starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-13
Starting the engine
(gasoline engine only) . . . . . . . . . . . .5-13
Steering
Power steering fluid . . . . . . . . . . . .8-10
Power steering system . . . . . . . . . .5-32
Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Steering wheel audio control switch. . . .4-71
Stop light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-28
Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-40
Storage tray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-44
Sun visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Sunglasses case . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45
Sunglasses holder . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-45
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-52, 7-5
Supplemental air bag warning
labels. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-85
Supplemental air bag warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
Supplemental front impact air bag
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-77
Supplemental restraint system
Information and warning labels. . . . .1-85
Precautions on supplemental restraint
system . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-70
Supplemental restraint system
(Supplemental air bag system) . . . . . . .1-70
Switch
Autolight switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-31
Automatic power window switch. . . .2-51
Electronic locking rear differential (E-Lock)
system switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-37
Fog light switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . .6-2
Headlight and turn signal switch . . . .2-30
Headlight control switch . . . . . . . . .2-30
Hill descent control switch . . . . . . . .2-36
Instrument brightness control . . . . .2-33
Power door lock switch. . . . . . . .3-5, 3-6
Rear sonar system OFF switch . . . . .2-38
Rear window and outside mirror
defroster switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-29
Rear window defroster switch . . . . .2-29
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7
Tailgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-20
Tailgate latch . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-24, 3-25
Temperature gauge
Engine coolant temperature gauge . . .2-7
Theft (NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System),
engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27, 5-13
Three-way catalyst . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
Tie down hooks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-25
Tilting steering wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Tire
Flat tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3, 6-4
Spare tire . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5, 6-6, 8-41
Tire and Loading Information
label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-13
Tire chains. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-37
Tire pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-30
Tire rotation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-38
Tires of 4-wheel drive . . . . . . . . . . .8-40
Types of tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-36
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . .10-37
Wheel/tire size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-10
Wheels and tires . . . . . . . . . .8-30, 10-10
Tire pressure
Low tire pressure warning light . . . . .2-18
Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3
Top tether strap child restraint . . . . . . .1-32
Towing
2-wheel drive models . . . . . . . . . . .6-16
Flat towing . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-36, 10-37
Tow truck towing. . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-14
Towing load/specification . . . . . . .10-28
Trailer towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-25
Towing a trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-25
Transceiver
HomeLink® Universal
Transceiver . . . . . . . . . .2-56, 2-58, 2-59
Transmission
Driving with automatic
transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-14
Travel (See registering a vehicle in
another country) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Trip computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9
Trip odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5
Troubleshooting guide
(NISSAN voice recognition system) . . . .4-110
Truck - camper loading . . . . . . . . . . .10-23
Truck box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-20
Turn signal switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-33
U
Under seat storage bin . . . . . . . . . . .2-42
Uniform tire quality grading . . . . . . . .10-37
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection Port
(models with Navigation System) . . . . .4-58
USB (Universal Serial Bus) Connection Port
(models without Navigation System) . . .4-55
USB interface
Audio file operation . . . . . . . . . . . .4-59
11-7
Using 4-Wheel Drive (4WD). . . . . . . . . .5-23
V
Vanity mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-17
Variable voltage control system . . . . . .8-15
Vehicle dimensions and weights . . . . .10-10
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) OFF
switch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-36
Vehicle Dynamic Control (VDC) system. .5-35
Vehicle identification . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Vehicle identification number (VIN) . . . .10-11
Vehicle identification number (VIN)
plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Vehicle immobilizer system . . . . .2-27, 5-13
Vehicle loading information . . . . . . . .10-14
Vehicle recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-16
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . . . .2-25
Vehicle security system
(NISSAN Vehicle Immobilizer System),
engine start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-27, 5-13
Ventilators . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-22
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-16
Voice Prompt Interrupt . . . . . . . .4-82, 4-99
Voice recognition system . . . . . . . . .4-106
W
Warning
4WD warning light . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-15
Air bag warning light . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
Anti-lock brake warning light . . . . . .2-15
Battery charge warning light . . . . . .2-17
11-8
Brake warning light . . . . . . . . . . . .2-16
Door open warning light . . . . . . . . .2-17
Engine oil pressure warning light . . . .2-17
Hazard warning flasher switch . . . . . .6-2
Loose fuel cap warning . . . . . . . . . .2-6
Low fuel warning light. . . . . . . . . . .2-18
Low tire pressure warning light . . . . .2-18
Low windshield-washer fluid warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-19
Passenger air bag and status light . . .1-79
Seat belt warning light . . . . . . .1-18, 2-20
Supplemental air bag warning
light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .1-85, 2-20
TPMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4
Vehicle security system . . . . . . . . .2-25
Warning labels (for SRS). . . . . . . . . .1-85
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Warning lights, indicator lights and
audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-14
Warning/indicator lights and audible
reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Audible reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Indicator lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Warning lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-21
Weights
(See dimensions and weights) . . . . . .10-10
Wheel/tire size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-10
Wheels and tires. . . . . . . . . . . .8-30, 10-10
When traveling or registering in another
country . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .10-11
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-49
Locking passengers' windows . . . . .2-51
Manual windows. . . .
Power windows . . . .
Rear power windows .
Rear sliding window . .
Windshield wiper blades .
Windshield-washer fluid .
Wiper
Wiper blades . . . . . .
Wiper and washer switch
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
. . .
.2-49
.2-50
.2-51
.2-52
.8-18
.8-12
. . . . . . . . . .8-18
. . . . . . . . . .2-28
MEMO
MEMO
MEMO
MEMO
MEMO
GAS STATION INFORMATION
FUEL RECOMMENDATION:
Use unleaded regular gasoline with an octane rating of at least 87 AKI (Anti-Knock Index) number (Research octane number 91).
CAUTION
• Only vehicles with the E-85 filler door
label can operate on E-85. Fuel system or other damage can occur if
E-85 is used in vehicles that are not
designed to run on E-85.
• Using a fuel other than that specified
could adversely affect the emission
control system, and may also affect
the warranty coverage.
• Under no circumstances should a
leaded gasoline be used, because
this will damage the three-way
catalyst.
• Do not use a fuel containing more
than 15% ethanol in your vehicle. Your
vehicle is not designed to run on a
fuel containing more than 15% ethanol. Using a fuel containing more
than 15% ethanol in a vehicle not specifically designed for a fuel containing more than 15% ethanol can adversely affect the emission control
devices and systems of the vehicle.
Damage caused by such fuel is not
covered by the NISSAN New Vehicle
Limited Warranty.
• Do not use fuel that contains the octane booster methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).
Using fuel containing MMT may adversely affect vehicle performance
and vehicle emissions. Not all fuel
dispensers are labeled to indicate
MMT content, so you may have to
consult your gasoline retailer for
more details. Note that Federal and
California laws prohibit the use of
MMT in reformulated gasoline.
• U.S. government regulations require
ethanol dispensing pumps to be
identified by a small, square, orange
and black label with the common abbreviation or the appropriate percentage for that region.
For additional information, refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants and capacities”
in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
ENGINE OIL RECOMMENDATION:
Refer to “Recommended fluids/lubricants
and capacities” in the “Technical and consumer information” section of this manual.
COLD TIRE PRESSURE:
For additional information, refer to “Tire and
Loading Information label” in the “Technical
and consumer information” section of this
manual.
The label is typically located on the driver
side center pillar or on the driver's door. For
additional information, refer to “Wheels and
tires” in the “Do-it-yourself” section of this
manual.
RECOMMENDED NEW VEHICLE
BREAK-IN PROCEDURE:
During the first 1,200 miles (2,000 km) of
vehicle use, follow the break-in procedure
recommendations for the future reliability
and economy of your new vehicle. For additional information, refer to “Break-in
schedule” in the “Starting and driving” section of this manual. Failure to follow these
recommendations may result in vehicle
damage or shortened engine life.
Printing : July 2020
Publication No.: OM20EA 0D40U1
Printed in the U.S.A.
D40-D